IDT IDT82P2288BBBLANK Octal t1/e1/j1 long haul / short haul transceiver Datasheet

Octal T1/E1/J1 Long Haul /
Short Haul Transceiver
IDT82P2288
Version 6
March 04, 2009
6024 Silver Creek Valley Road, San Jose, California 95138
Telephone: 1-800-345-7015 or 408-284-8200• TWX: 910-338-2070 • FAX: 408-284-2775
Printed in U.S.A.
© 2008 Integrated Device Technology, Inc.
DISCLAIMER
Integrated Device Technology, Inc. reserves the right to make changes to its products or specifications at any time, without notice, in order to improve design or performance and to supply the best possible product. IDT does not assume any responsibility for use of any circuitry described other than the circuitry embodied in an IDT product. The Company makes no representations that circuitry
described herein is free from patent infringement or other rights of third parties which may result from its use. No license is granted by implication or otherwise under any patent, patent rights or other
rights, of Integrated Device Technology, Inc.
LIFE SUPPORT POLICY
Integrated Device Technology's products are not authorized for use as critical components in life support devices or systems unless a specific written agreement pertaining to such intended use is executed between the manufacturer and an officer of IDT.
1. Life support devices or systems are devices or systems which (a) are intended for surgical implant into the body or (b) support or sustain life and whose failure to perform, when properly used in
accordance with instructions for use provided in the labeling, can be reasonably expected to result in a significant injury to the user.
2. A critical component is any components of a life support device or system whose failure to perform can be reasonably expected to cause the failure of the life support device or system, or to affect its
safety or effectiveness.
Table of Contents
TABLE OF CONTENTS ........................................................................................................................................................... 3
LIST OF TABLES .................................................................................................................................................................... 7
LIST OF FIGURES ................................................................................................................................................................... 9
FEATURES ............................................................................................................................................................................ 11
APPLICATIONS ..................................................................................................................................................................... 11
BLOCK DIAGRAM ................................................................................................................................................................ 12
1 PIN ASSIGNMENT .......................................................................................................................................................... 13
2 PIN DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................................................................... 14
3 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................ 22
3.1
3.2
T1 / E1 / J1 MODE SELECTION ..................................................................................................................................................................
RECEIVER IMPEDANCE MATCHING .........................................................................................................................................................
3.2.1 Line Monitor ....................................................................................................................................................................................
3.3 ADAPTIVE EQUALIZER ..............................................................................................................................................................................
3.4 DATA SLICER ..............................................................................................................................................................................................
3.5 CLOCK AND DATA RECOVERY ................................................................................................................................................................
3.6 RECEIVE JITTER ATTENUATOR ...............................................................................................................................................................
3.7 DECODER ....................................................................................................................................................................................................
3.7.1 Line Code Rule ...............................................................................................................................................................................
3.7.1.1 T1 / J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................
3.7.1.2 E1 Mode ...........................................................................................................................................................................
3.7.2 Decode Error Detection .................................................................................................................................................................
3.7.2.1 T1 / J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................
3.7.2.2 E1 Mode ...........................................................................................................................................................................
3.7.3 LOS Detection ................................................................................................................................................................................
3.8 FRAME PROCESSOR .................................................................................................................................................................................
3.8.1 T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.8.1.1 Synchronization Searching ...............................................................................................................................................
3.8.1.2 Error Event And Out Of Synchronization Detection ..........................................................................................................
3.8.1.3 Overhead Extraction (T1 Mode SLC-96 Format Only) .....................................................................................................
3.8.1.4 Interrupt Summary ............................................................................................................................................................
3.8.2 E1 Mode ..........................................................................................................................................................................................
3.8.2.1 Synchronization Searching ...............................................................................................................................................
3.8.2.2 Error Event And Out Of Synchronization Detection ..........................................................................................................
3.8.2.3 Overhead Extraction .........................................................................................................................................................
3.8.2.4 V5.2 Link ..........................................................................................................................................................................
3.8.2.5 Interrupt Summary ............................................................................................................................................................
3.9 PERFORMANCE MONITOR ........................................................................................................................................................................
3.9.1 T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.9.2 E1 Mode ..........................................................................................................................................................................................
3.10 ALARM DETECTOR ....................................................................................................................................................................................
3.10.1 T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.10.2 E1 Mode ..........................................................................................................................................................................................
3.11 HDLC RECEIVER .........................................................................................................................................................................................
3.11.1 HDLC Channel Configuration ........................................................................................................................................................
3.11.2 HDLC Mode .....................................................................................................................................................................................
3.11.2.1 HDLC Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................
Table of Contents
3
23
24
24
27
27
27
27
29
29
29
29
29
29
29
31
34
34
34
38
39
39
42
44
47
48
48
48
53
53
56
58
58
60
61
61
61
61
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.12
3.13
3.14
3.15
3.16
3.17
3.18
3.19
3.20
3.21
3.22
3.23
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
BIT-ORIENTED MESSAGE RECEIVER (T1/J1 ONLY) ..............................................................................................................................
INBAND LOOPBACK CODE DETECTOR (T1/J1 ONLY) ...........................................................................................................................
ELASTIC STORE BUFFER ..........................................................................................................................................................................
RECEIVE CAS/RBS BUFFER .....................................................................................................................................................................
3.15.1 T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.15.2 E1 Mode ..........................................................................................................................................................................................
RECEIVE PAYLOAD CONTROL .................................................................................................................................................................
RECEIVE SYSTEM INTERFACE .................................................................................................................................................................
3.17.1 T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.17.1.1 Receive Clock Master Mode ............................................................................................................................................
3.17.1.2 Receive Clock Slave Mode ..............................................................................................................................................
3.17.1.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode ...............................................................................................................................................
3.17.1.4 Offset ................................................................................................................................................................................
3.17.1.5 Output On RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) & RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) ..................................................................................
3.17.2 E1 Mode ..........................................................................................................................................................................................
3.17.2.1 Receive Clock Master Mode ............................................................................................................................................
3.17.2.2 Receive Clock Slave Mode ..............................................................................................................................................
3.17.2.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode ...............................................................................................................................................
3.17.2.4 Offset ................................................................................................................................................................................
3.17.2.5 Output On RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) & RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) ..................................................................................
TRANSMIT SYSTEM INTERFACE ..............................................................................................................................................................
3.18.1 T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.18.1.1 Transmit Clock Master Mode ............................................................................................................................................
3.18.1.2 Transmit Clock Slave Mode .............................................................................................................................................
3.18.1.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode ..............................................................................................................................................
3.18.1.4 Offset ................................................................................................................................................................................
3.18.2 E1 Mode ..........................................................................................................................................................................................
3.18.2.1 Transmit Clock Master Mode ............................................................................................................................................
3.18.2.2 Transmit Clock Slave Mode .............................................................................................................................................
3.18.2.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode ..............................................................................................................................................
3.18.2.4 Offset ................................................................................................................................................................................
TRANSMIT PAYLOAD CONTROL ..............................................................................................................................................................
FRAME GENERATOR .................................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.1 Generation ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.1.1 T1 / J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.1.2 E1 Mode ...........................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.2 HDLC Transmitter ..........................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.2.1 HDLC Channel Configuration ...........................................................................................................................................
3.20.2.2 HDLC Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.2.3 Interrupt Summary ............................................................................................................................................................
3.20.2.4 Reset ................................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.3 Automatic Performance Report Message (T1/J1 Only) ..............................................................................................................
3.20.4 Bit-Oriented Message Transmitter (T1/J1 Only) ..........................................................................................................................
3.20.5 Inband Loopback Code Generator (T1/J1 Only) ..........................................................................................................................
3.20.6 All ‘Zero’s & All ‘One’s ...................................................................................................................................................................
3.20.7 Change Of Frame Alignment .........................................................................................................................................................
TRANSMIT BUFFER ....................................................................................................................................................................................
ENCODER ....................................................................................................................................................................................................
3.22.1 Line Code Rule ...............................................................................................................................................................................
3.22.1.1 T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................
3.22.1.2 E1 Mode ...........................................................................................................................................................................
3.22.2 BPV Error Insertion ........................................................................................................................................................................
3.22.3 All ‘One’s Insertion ........................................................................................................................................................................
TRANSMIT JITTER ATTENUATOR ............................................................................................................................................................
Table of Contents
4
64
64
65
65
65
66
68
71
71
72
72
73
74
76
77
77
77
78
78
78
80
80
81
81
82
83
86
87
87
87
88
88
90
90
90
92
95
95
95
95
95
96
97
97
98
98
98
99
99
99
99
99
99
99
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.24 WAVEFORM SHAPER / LINE BUILD OUT ...............................................................................................................................................
3.24.1 Preset Waveform Template .........................................................................................................................................................
3.24.1.1 T1/J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................
3.24.1.2 E1 Mode .........................................................................................................................................................................
3.24.2 Line Build Out (LBO) (T1 Only) ...................................................................................................................................................
3.24.3 User-Programmable Arbitrary Waveform ..................................................................................................................................
3.25 LINE DRIVER .............................................................................................................................................................................................
3.26 TRANSMITTER IMPEDANCE MATCHING ...............................................................................................................................................
3.27 TESTING AND DIAGNOSTIC FACILITIES ...............................................................................................................................................
3.27.1 PRBS Generator / Detector .........................................................................................................................................................
3.27.1.1 Pattern Generator ...........................................................................................................................................................
3.27.1.2 Pattern Detector .............................................................................................................................................................
3.27.2 Loopback ......................................................................................................................................................................................
3.27.2.1 System Loopback ...........................................................................................................................................................
3.27.2.2 Payload Loopback ..........................................................................................................................................................
3.27.2.3 Local Digital Loopback 1 ................................................................................................................................................
3.27.2.4 Remote Loopback ..........................................................................................................................................................
3.27.2.5 Local Digital Loopback 2 ................................................................................................................................................
3.27.2.6 Analog Loopback ............................................................................................................................................................
3.27.3 G.772 Non-Intrusive Monitoring ..................................................................................................................................................
3.28 INTERRUPT SUMMARY ............................................................................................................................................................................
100
100
100
101
101
101
109
109
109
109
110
110
111
111
111
111
111
111
111
111
113
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
POWER-ON SEQUENCE ...........................................................................................................................................................................
RESET ........................................................................................................................................................................................................
RECEIVE / TRANSMIT PATH POWER DOWN .........................................................................................................................................
MICROPROCESSOR INTERFACE ...........................................................................................................................................................
4.4.1 SPI Mode .......................................................................................................................................................................................
4.4.2 Parallel Microprocessor Interface ..............................................................................................................................................
INDIRECT REGISTER ACCESS SCHEME ...............................................................................................................................................
4.5.1 Indirect Register Read Access ...................................................................................................................................................
4.5.2 Indirect Register Write Access ...................................................................................................................................................
115
115
115
115
116
116
117
117
117
REGISTER MAP .........................................................................................................................................................................................
5.1.1 T1/J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................
5.1.1.1 Direct Register ................................................................................................................................................................
5.1.1.2 Indirect Register .............................................................................................................................................................
5.1.2 E1 Mode ........................................................................................................................................................................................
5.1.2.1 Direct Register ................................................................................................................................................................
5.1.2.2 Indirect Register .............................................................................................................................................................
REGISTER DESCRIPTION ........................................................................................................................................................................
5.2.1 T1/J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................
5.2.1.1 Direct Register ................................................................................................................................................................
5.2.1.2 Indirect Register .............................................................................................................................................................
5.2.2 E1 Mode ........................................................................................................................................................................................
5.2.2.1 Direct Register ................................................................................................................................................................
5.2.2.2 Indirect Register .............................................................................................................................................................
118
118
118
125
126
126
132
134
135
135
228
236
236
329
JTAG INSTRUCTIONS AND INSTRUCTION REGISTER (IR) ..................................................................................................................
JTAG DATA REGISTER ............................................................................................................................................................................
6.2.1 Device Identification Register (IDR) ...........................................................................................................................................
6.2.2 Bypass Register (BYP) ................................................................................................................................................................
6.2.3 Boundary Scan Register (BSR) ...................................................................................................................................................
TEST ACCESS PORT CONTROLLER ......................................................................................................................................................
339
340
340
340
340
343
4 OPERATION .................................................................................................................................................................. 115
4.5
5 PROGRAMMING INFORMATION ................................................................................................................................. 118
5.1
5.2
6 IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG TEST ACCESS PORT ........................................................................................................... 339
6.1
6.2
6.3
Table of Contents
5
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7 PHYSICAL AND ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................................................................... 346
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6
7.7
7.8
7.9
7.10
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS ............................................................................................................................................................
RECOMMENDED OPERATING CONDITIONS .........................................................................................................................................
D.C. CHARACTERISTICS .........................................................................................................................................................................
DIGITAL I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS ...............................................................................................................................................
CLOCK FREQUENCY REQUIREMENT ....................................................................................................................................................
T1/J1 LINE RECEIVER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS ...................................................................................................................
E1 LINE RECEIVER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS ........................................................................................................................
T1/J1 LINE TRANSMITTER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS ............................................................................................................
E1 LINE TRANSMITTER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS ................................................................................................................
JITTER TOLERANCE ................................................................................................................................................................................
7.10.1 T1/J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................
7.10.2 E1 Mode ........................................................................................................................................................................................
7.11 JITTER TRANSFER ...................................................................................................................................................................................
7.11.1 T1/J1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................
7.11.2 E1 Mode ........................................................................................................................................................................................
7.12 MICROPROCESSOR TIMING SPECIFICATION .......................................................................................................................................
7.12.1 Motorola Non-Multiplexed Mode .................................................................................................................................................
7.12.1.1 Read Cycle Specification ...............................................................................................................................................
7.12.1.2 Write Cycle Specification ................................................................................................................................................
7.12.2 Intel Non-Multiplexed Mode .........................................................................................................................................................
7.12.2.1 Read Cycle Specification ...............................................................................................................................................
7.12.2.2 Write Cycle Specification ................................................................................................................................................
7.12.3 SPI Mode .......................................................................................................................................................................................
346
346
347
348
348
349
350
350
351
351
351
353
354
354
356
357
357
357
358
359
359
360
361
ORDERING INFORMATION ................................................................................................................................................ 362
DOCUMENT HISTORY ........................................................................................................................................................ 362
Table of Contents
6
March 04, 2009
List of Tables
Table 1:
Table 2:
Table 3:
Table 4:
Table 5:
Table 6:
Table 7:
Table 8:
Table 9:
Table 10:
Table 11:
Table 12:
Table 13:
Table 14:
Table 15:
Table 16:
Table 17:
Table 18:
Table 19:
Table 20:
Table 21:
Table 22:
Table 23:
Table 24:
Table 25:
Table 26:
Table 27:
Table 28:
Table 29:
Table 30:
Table 31:
Table 32:
Table 33:
Table 34:
Table 35:
Table 36:
Table 37:
Table 38:
Table 39:
Table 40:
Table 41:
Table 42:
Table 43:
Table 44:
Table 45:
Table 46:
Table 47:
Table 48:
Operating Mode Selection ...........................................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.1 ...........................................................................................................................................................
Impedance Matching Value For The Receiver .............................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.2 ...........................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.3 & Chapter 3.4 ....................................................................................................................................
Criteria Of Speed Adjustment Start ..............................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.6 ...........................................................................................................................................................
Excessive Zero Error Definition ...................................................................................................................................................................
LOS Condition In T1/J1 Mode ......................................................................................................................................................................
LOS Condition In E1 Mode ..........................................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.7 ...........................................................................................................................................................
The Structure of SF .....................................................................................................................................................................................
The Structure of ESF ...................................................................................................................................................................................
The Structure of T1 DM ...............................................................................................................................................................................
The Structure of SLC-96 ..............................................................................................................................................................................
Interrupt Source In T1/J1 Frame Processor ................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.8.1 ........................................................................................................................................................
The Structure Of TS0 In CRC Multi-Frame ..................................................................................................................................................
FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error Criteria ............................................................................................................................................................
Interrupt Source In E1 Frame Processor .....................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.8.2 ........................................................................................................................................................
Monitored Events In T1/J1 Mode .................................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.9.1 ........................................................................................................................................................
Monitored Events In E1 Mode .....................................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.9.2 ........................................................................................................................................................
RED Alarm, Yellow Alarm & Blue Alarm Criteria .........................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.10.1 ......................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.10.2 ......................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.11.1 ......................................................................................................................................................
Interrupt Summarize In HDLC Mode ...........................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.11.2 ......................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.12 .........................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.13 .........................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.14 .........................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.15 .........................................................................................................................................................
A-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern .....................................................................................................................................................................
µ-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern .....................................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.16 .........................................................................................................................................................
Operating Modes Selection In T1/J1 Receive Path .....................................................................................................................................
Operating Modes Selection In E1 Receive Path ..........................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.17 .........................................................................................................................................................
Operating Modes Selection In T1/J1 Transmit Path ....................................................................................................................................
Operating Modes Selection In E1 Transmit Path .........................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.18 .........................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.19 .........................................................................................................................................................
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.1.1 ...................................................................................................................................................
E1 Frame Generation ..................................................................................................................................................................................
Control Over E Bits ......................................................................................................................................................................................
List of Tables
7
23
23
24
26
27
28
28
30
32
32
33
34
35
36
37
40
40
45
47
49
50
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
63
63
64
64
65
67
69
69
70
71
77
79
80
86
88
89
91
92
92
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
Table 49:
Table 50:
Table 51:
Table 52:
Table 53:
Table 54:
Table 55:
Table 56:
Table 57:
Table 58:
Table 59:
Table 60:
Table 61:
Table 62:
Table 63:
Table 64:
Table 65:
Table 66:
Table 67:
Table 68:
Table 69:
Table 70:
Table 71:
Table 72:
Table 73:
Table 74:
Table 75:
Table 76:
Table 77:
Table 78:
Table 79:
Table 80:
Table 81:
Table 82:
Table 83:
Table 84:
Table 85:
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Interrupt Summary In E1 Mode .................................................................................................................................................................... 93
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.1.2 ................................................................................................................................................... 93
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.2.1 ................................................................................................................................................... 95
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.2.2 ~ Chapter 3.20.2.4 .................................................................................................................... 95
APRM Message Format .............................................................................................................................................................................. 96
APRM Interpretation .................................................................................................................................................................................... 97
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.3 ...................................................................................................................................................... 97
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.4 & Chapter 3.20.5 .......................................................................................................................... 97
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.6, Chapter 3.20.7 & Chapter 3.21 ................................................................................................... 98
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.22 ......................................................................................................................................................... 99
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.23 ....................................................................................................................................................... 100
PULS[3:0] Setting In T1/J1 Mode .............................................................................................................................................................. 101
LBO PULS[3:0] Setting In T1 Mode ........................................................................................................................................................... 101
Transmit Waveform Value For E1 75 W .................................................................................................................................................... 102
Transmit Waveform Value For E1 120 W .................................................................................................................................................. 103
Transmit Waveform Value For T1 0~133 ft ............................................................................................................................................... 103
Transmit Waveform Value For T1 133~266 ft ........................................................................................................................................... 104
Transmit Waveform Value For T1 266~399 ft ........................................................................................................................................... 104
Transmit Waveform Value For T1 399~533 ft ........................................................................................................................................... 105
Transmit Waveform Value For T1 533~655 ft ........................................................................................................................................... 105
Transmit Waveform Value For J1 0~655ft ................................................................................................................................................. 106
Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 0 dB LBO .......................................................................................................................................... 106
Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -7.5 dB LBO ...................................................................................................................................... 107
Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -15.0 dB LBO .................................................................................................................................... 107
Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -22.5 dB LBO .................................................................................................................................... 108
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.24 ....................................................................................................................................................... 108
Impedance Matching Value For The Transmitter ...................................................................................................................................... 109
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.25 & Chapter 3.26 .............................................................................................................................. 109
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.27.1 .................................................................................................................................................... 110
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.27.2 & Chapter 3.27.3 ........................................................................................................................ 113
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.28 ....................................................................................................................................................... 114
Parallel Microprocessor Interface .............................................................................................................................................................. 116
Related Bit / Register In Chapter 4 ............................................................................................................................................................ 117
IR Code ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 340
IDR ............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 340
Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence ................................................................................................................................................................. 340
TAP Controller State Description ............................................................................................................................................................... 343
List of Tables
8
March 04, 2009
List of Figures
Figure 1. 256-Pin PBGA (Top View) ........................................................................................................................................................................... 13
Figure 2. Receive / Transmit Line Circuit .................................................................................................................................................................... 24
Figure 3. Receive Path Monitoring (Twisted Pair) ....................................................................................................................................................... 25
Figure 4. Transmit Path Monitoring (Twisted Pair) ...................................................................................................................................................... 25
Figure 5. Receive Path Monitoring (COAX) ................................................................................................................................................................ 26
Figure 6. Transmit Path Monitoring (COAX) ............................................................................................................................................................... 26
Figure 7. Jitter Attenuator ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 27
Figure 8. AMI Bipolar Violation Error ........................................................................................................................................................................... 30
Figure 9. B8ZS Excessive Zero Error ......................................................................................................................................................................... 30
Figure 10. HDB3 Code Violation & Excessive Zero Error ............................................................................................................................................ 30
Figure 11. E1 Frame Searching Process ..................................................................................................................................................................... 43
Figure 12. Basic Frame Searching Process ................................................................................................................................................................ 44
Figure 13. TS16 Structure Of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame .......................................................................................................................................... 46
Figure 14. Standard HDLC Packet .............................................................................................................................................................................. 61
Figure 15. Overhead Indication In The FIFO ............................................................................................................................................................... 62
Figure 16. Signaling Output In T1/J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................. 66
Figure 17. Signaling Output In E1 Mode ...................................................................................................................................................................... 66
Figure 18. T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping - G.802 Mode .............................................................................................................................................. 72
Figure 19. T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping - One Filler Every Fourth Channel Mode .................................................................................................... 73
Figure 20. T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping - Continuous Channels Mode ..................................................................................................................... 73
Figure 21. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 1 In Receive Path .................................................................................................................................... 74
Figure 22. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 0 In Receive Path .................................................................................................................................... 75
Figure 23. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 1 In Receive Path .................................................................................................................................... 75
Figure 24. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 0 In Receive Path .................................................................................................................................... 76
Figure 25. E1 To T1/J1 Format Mapping - G.802 Mode .............................................................................................................................................. 81
Figure 26. E1 To T1/J1 Format Mapping - One Filler Every Fourth Channel Mode .................................................................................................... 82
Figure 27. E1 To T1/J1 Format Mapping - Continuous Channels Mode ..................................................................................................................... 82
Figure 28. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 1 In Transmit Path ................................................................................................................................... 83
Figure 29. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 0 In Transmit Path ................................................................................................................................... 84
Figure 30. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 1 In Transmit Path ................................................................................................................................... 84
Figure 31. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 0 In Transmit Path ................................................................................................................................... 85
Figure 32. DSX-1 Waveform Template ...................................................................................................................................................................... 100
Figure 33. T1/J1 Pulse Template Measurement Circuit ............................................................................................................................................ 100
Figure 34. E1 Waveform Template ............................................................................................................................................................................ 101
Figure 35. E1 Pulse Template Measurement Circuit ................................................................................................................................................. 101
Figure 36. G.772 Non-Intrusive Monitor .................................................................................................................................................................... 112
Figure 37. Hardware Reset When Powered-Up ........................................................................................................................................................ 115
Figure 38. Hardware Reset In Normal Operation ...................................................................................................................................................... 115
Figure 39. Read Operation In SPI Mode ................................................................................................................................................................... 116
Figure 40. Write Operation In SPI Mode .................................................................................................................................................................... 116
Figure 41. JTAG Architecture .................................................................................................................................................................................... 339
Figure 42. JTAG State Diagram ................................................................................................................................................................................ 345
Figure 43. I/O Timing in Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................... 348
Figure 44. T1/J1 Jitter Tolerance Performance Requirement .................................................................................................................................... 352
Figure 45. E1 Jitter Tolerance Performance Requirement ........................................................................................................................................ 353
Figure 46. T1/J1 Jitter Transfer Performance Requirement (AT&T62411 / GR-253-CORE / TR-TSY-000009) ....................................................... 355
Figure 47. E1 Jitter Transfer Performance Requirement (G.736) .............................................................................................................................. 356
Figure 48. Motorola Non-Multiplexed Mode Read Cycle ........................................................................................................................................... 357
List of Figures
9
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
Figure 49.
Figure 50.
Figure 51.
Figure 52.
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Motorola Non-Multiplexed Mode Write Cycle ...........................................................................................................................................
Intel Non-Multiplexed Mode Read Cycle ..................................................................................................................................................
Intel Non-Multiplexed Mode Write Cycle ..................................................................................................................................................
SPI Timing Diagram .................................................................................................................................................................................
List of Figures
10
358
359
360
361
March 04, 2009
Octal T1/E1/J1 Long Haul /
IDT82P2288
Short Haul Transceiver
FEATURES
• Three HDLC controllers per link with separate 128-byte transmit
and receive FIFOs per controller
• Programmable bit insertion and bit inversion on per channel/
timeslot basis
• Provides Bit Oriented Message (BOM) generation and detection
• Provides Automatic Performance Report Message (APRM) generation
• Detects and generates alarms (AIS, RAI)
• Provides performance monitor to count Bipolar Violation error,
Excess Zero error, CRC error, framing bit error, far end CRC error,
out of frame and change of framing alignment position
• Supports System Loopback, Payload Loopback, Digital Loopback
and Inband Loopback
• Detects and generates selectable PRBS and QRSS
LINE INTERFACE
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Each link can be configured as T1, E1 or J1
Supports T1/E1/J1 long haul/short haul line interface
HPS for 1+1 protection without external relays
Receive sensitivity exceeds -36 dB @ 772 Hz and -43 dB @ 1024
Hz
Selectable internal line termination impedance: 100 Ω (for T1), 75
Ω / 120 Ω (for E1) and 110 Ω (for J1)
Supports AMI/B8ZS (for T1/J1) and AMI/HDB3 (for E1) line encoding/decoding
Provides T1/E1/J1 short haul pulse templates, long haul LBO (per
ANSI T1.403 and FCC68: 0 dB, -7.5 dB, -15 dB, -22 dB) and userprogrammable arbitrary pulse template
Supports G.772 non-intrusive monitoring
Supports T1.102 line monitor
Transmit line short-circuit detection and protection
Separate Transmit and Receive Jitter Attenuators (2 per link)
Indicates the interval between the write pointer and the read
pointer of the FIFO in JA
Loss of signal indication with programmable thresholds according
to ITUT-T G.775, ETS 300 233 (E1) and ANSI T1.403 (T1/J1)
Supports Analog Loopback, Digital Loopback and Remote Loopback
Each receiver and transmitter can be individually powered down
CONTROL INTERFACE
• Supports Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) microprocessor and parallel Intel/Motorola non-multiplexed microprocessor interface
• Global hardware and software reset
• Two general purpose I/O pins
• Per link power down
GENERAL
• Flexible reference clock (N x 1.544 MHz or N x 2.048 MHz)
(0<N<5)
• JTAG boundary scan
• 3.3 V I/O with 5 V tolerant inputs
• Low power consumption (Typical 900 mW)
• 3.3 V and 1.8 V power supply
• 256-pin PBGA package
FRAMER
• Each link can be configured as T1, E1 or J1
• Frame alignment/generation for T1 (per ITU-T G.704, TA-TSY000278, TR-TSY-000008), E1 (per ITU-T G.704), J1 (per JT
G.704) and un-framed mode
• Supports T1/J1 Super Frame and Extended Super Frame, T1 Digital Multiplexer and Switch Line Carrier - 96, E1 CRC Multi-frame
and Signaling Multi-frame
• Signaling extraction/insertion for CAS and RBS signaling
• Provides programmable system interface supporting MitelTM STbus, AT&TTM CHI and MVIP bus, 8.192 Mb/s multiplexed bus and
1.544 Mb/s or 2.048 Mb/s non-multiplexed bus
APPLICATIONS
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
C.O, PABX, ISDN PRI
Wireless Base Stations
T1/E1/J1 ATM Gateways, Multiplexer
T1/E1/J1 Access Networks
LAN/WAN Router
Digital Cross Connect
SONET/SDH Add/Drop Equipment
The IDT and the IDT logo are registered trademarks of Integrated Device Technology, Inc.
11
 2008 Integrated Device Technology, Inc.
March 04, 2009
DSC-6044/6
Block Diagram
12
RSCKn
Receive
System
RSFSn Interface
RSIGn
(LP 3)
Transmit
System
Interface
(LP 1, 2)
RSDn
TSDn
TSIGn
TSFSn
TSCKn
Note:
LP1, 2 - System Loopback
LP3 - Payload Loopback
LP4 - Local Digital Loopback 1
LP5 - Remote Loopback
LP6 - Local Digital Loopback 2
LP7 - Analog Loopback
MRSCK
MRSFS
MRSIGA[1:2]/
MRSIGB[1:2]
MRSDA[1:2]/
MRSDB[1:2]
MTSDA[1:2]/
MTSDB[1:2]
MTSIGA[1:2]/
MTSIGB[1:2]
MTSFS
MTSCK
IEEE1149.1
JTAG
Receive
Payload
Control
PRBS
Generator /
Detector
Transmit
Payload
Control
Receive
CAS/
RBS
Buffer
Inband
Loopback Code
Detector
HDLC Receiver
#1, #2, #3
B8ZS/
HDB3/
AMI
Decoder
(LP 5)
Receive
Jitter
Attenuator
Transmit
Jitter
Attenuator
Clock Generator
Bit-Oriented
Message
Receiver
Alarm
Detector
Frame Processor
Performance Monitor
(LP 4)
Transmit
Buffer
B8ZS/
HDB3/AMI
Encoder
Data
Slicer
G.772
Monitor
CLK&Data
Recovery
(DPLL)
(LP 6)
Waveform
Shaper / Line
Build Out
One of the Eight Links
REFB_OUT
REFA_OUT
CLK_SEL[2:0]
OSCO
OSCI
CLK_GEN_1.544
CLK_GEN_2.048
Control Interface
Elastic
Store
Buffer
Frame Generator
Inband Automatic
HDLC Bit-Oriented
Loopback Performance
Transmitter Message
Report
Code
#1, #2, #3 Transmitter
Generator Message
Adaptive
Equalizer
Line
Driver
RTIPn
(LP 7)
TTIPn
TRINGn
GNDD / GNDA
VDDDIO / VDDDC /
VDDAR / VDDAT /
VDDAX / VDDAP /
VDDAB
Receive
Internal
Termination RRINGn
Transmit
Internal
Termination
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
BLOCK DIAGRAM
GPIO[1:0]
RESET
THZ
A[10:0]
D[7:1]
D[0]/SDO
CS
REFR
RW/WR/SDI
DS/RD/SCLK
MPM
SPIEN
INT
TDO
TDI
TMS
TCK
TRST
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
1
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
PIN ASSIGNMENT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
A
TTIP4
TRING4
VDDAT4
VDDAR4
VDDAR3
TRING3
TTIP3
TTIP2
TRING2
VDDAR1
TRING1
TTIP1
VDDAP
RESET
REFA_
OUT
CLK_GE
N_1.544
A
B
TSIG8
VDDAX4
GNDA
RTIP4
VDDAT3
GNDA
VDDAX3
VDDAX2
VDDAT2
GNDA
GNDA
VDDAT1
OSCI
REFB_
OUT
CLK_SEL
2
THZ
B
C
TSIG7
TSD8
GNDA
RRING4
GNDA
GNDA
GNDA
GNDA
VDDAR2
GNDA
RTIP1
VDDAX1
OSCO
CLK_SEL
1
IC
REFR
C
D
TSIG6/
MTSIGB2
TSD7
GNDA
GNDA
RRING3
RTIP3
GNDA
RTIP2
RRING2
GNDA
RRING1
VDDAB
GPIO1
CLK_GE
N_2.048
CLK_SEL
0
IC
D
E
TSIG4
TSD5/
MTSDA2
TSIG5/
MTSIGA2
TSD6/
MTSDB2
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GPIO0
VDDAX5
VDDAT5
TTIP5
E
TSIG2/
MTSIGB1
TSD3
TSIG3
TSD4
VDDDIO
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDA
RTIP5
GNDA
TRING5
F
G
TSFS8
TSD1/
MTSDA1
TSIG1/
MTSIGA1
TSD2/
MTSDB1
VDDDIO
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDA
RRING5
GNDA
VDDAR5
G
H
TSFS6
TSCK7
TSFS7
TSCK8
VDDDIO
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
GNDD
RRING6
VDDAT6
VDDAR6
TRING6
H
J
TSCK6
TSFS5
TSCK5
TSFS4
VDDDIO
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDIO
RTIP6
GNDA
VDDAX6
TTIP6
J
K
TSCK4
TSFS3
TSCK3
TSFS2
VDDDIO
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDIO
GNDA
GNDA
VDDAX7
TTIP7
K
L
TSCK2
TSFS1/
MTSFS
TSCK1/
MTSCK
RSIG8
RSD8
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDC
VDDDIO
RTIP7
GNDA
GNDA
TRING7
L
M
RSIG7
RSD7
RSFS5
RSCK3
A0
A5
D4
D0/SDO
MPM
VDDDIO
RRING7
GNDA
VDDAR7
VDDAT7
M
F
N
RSIG5/
RSD5/
MRSIGA2 MRSDA2
RSIG6/
RSD6/
MRSIGB2 MRSDB2
RSIG4
RSFS7
RSCK5
RSFS2
A1
A6
D5
DS/RD
/SCLK
SPIEN
IC
GNDA
RTIP8
RRING8
VDDAR8
N
P
RSD4
RSIG3
RSD1/
MRSDA1
RSCK7
RSFS4
RSCK2
A2
A7
A10
D3
RW/WR
/SDI
IC
GNDA
GNDA
GNDA
VDDAT8
P
R
RSD3
RSD2/
MRSDB1
RSFS8
RSFS6
RSCK4
RSFS1/
MRSFS
A3
A8
D7
D2
CS
IC
TRST
TDO
VDDAX8
TRING8
R
RSIG2/
RSIG1/
MRSIGB1 MRSIGA1
RSCK8
RSCK6
RSFS3
RSCK1/
MRSCK
A4
A9
D6
D1
INT
IC
TDI
TMS
TCK
TTIP8
T
T
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Figure 1. 256-Pin PBGA (Top View)
Pin Assignment
13
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
2
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
PIN DESCRIPTION
Name
Type
Pin No.
Description
Line and System Interface
RTIP[1]
RTIP[2]
RTIP[3]
RTIP[4]
RTIP[5]
RTIP[6]
RTIP[7]
RTIP[8]
Input
RRING[1]
RRING[2]
RRING[3]
RRING[4]
RRING[5]
RRING[6]
RRING[7]
RRING[8]
TTIP[1]
TTIP[2]
TTIP[3]
TTIP[4]
TTIP[5]
TTIP[6]
TTIP[7]
TTIP[8]
RTIP[1:8] / RRING[1:8]: Receive Bipolar Tip/Ring for Link 1 ~ 8
These pins are the differential line receiver inputs.
D11
D9
D5
C4
G14
H13
M13
N15
Output
TRING[1]
TRING[2]
TRING[3]
TRING[4]
TRING[5]
TRING[6]
TRING[7]
TRING[8]
RSD[1] / MRSDA[1]
RSD[2] / MRSDB[1]
RSD[3]
RSD[4]
RSD[5] / MRSDA[2]
RSD[6] / MRSDB[2]
RSD[7]
RSD[8]
C11
D8
D6
B4
F14
J13
L13
N14
A12
A8
A7
A1
E16
J16
K16
T16
TTIP[1:8] / TRING[1:8]: Transmit Bipolar Tip/Ring for Link 1 ~ 8
These pins are the differential line driver outputs and can be set to high impedance state globally or individually. A
logic high on the THZ pin sets all these pins to high impedance state. When the T_HZ bit (b4, T1/J1-023H,... / b4,
E1-023H,...) * is set to ‘1’, the TTIPn/TRINGn pins in the corresponding link are set to high impedance state.
Besides, TTIPn/TRINGn will also be set to high impedance state by other ways (refer to Chapter 3.25 Line Driver for
details).
A11
A9
A6
A2
F16
H16
L16
R16
High-Z
Output
P3
R2
R1
P1
N2
M4
M2
L5
RSD[1:8]: Receive Side System Data for Link 1 ~ 8
The processed data stream is output on these pins.
In Receive Clock Master mode, the RSDn pins are updated on the active edge of the corresponding RSCKn.
In Receive Clock Slave mode, determined by the RSLVCK bit (b4, T1/J1-010H / b4, E1-010H), the RSDn pins are
updated on the active edge of the corresponding RSCKn or all eight RSDn pins are updated on the active edge of
RSCK[1].
MRSDA[1:2] / MRSDB[1:2]: Multiplexed Receive Side System Data A / B for Link 1 ~ 8
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the MRSDA[1:2] pins or the MRSDB[1:2] pins are used to output the processed data
stream. Using a byte-interleaved multiplexing scheme, the MRSDA[1]/MRSDB[1] pins output the data from Link 1 to
Link 4, while the MRSDA[2]/MRSDB[2] pins output the data from Link 5 to Link 8. The data on the MRSDA[1:2]/
MRSDB[1:2] pins are updated on the active edge of the MRSCK. The data on MRSDA[1:2] is the same as the data
on MRSDB[1:2]. MRSDB[1:2] are for back-up purpose.
Note:
* The contents in the brackets indicate the position of the preceding bit and the address of the register. After the address, if the punctuation ‘,...’ is followed, this bit is in a per-link control register and the listed address belongs to Link 1. Users can find the omitted addresses in Chapter 5. If there is no punctuation following the address, this bit is in a global control register.
Pin Description
14
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Name
Type
Pin No.
Description
RSIG[1] / MRSIGA[1]
RSIG[2] / MRSIGB[1]
RSIG[3]
RSIG[4]
RSIG[5] / MRSIGA[2]
RSIG[6] / MRSIGB[2]
RSIG[7]
RSIG[8]
High-Z
Output
T2
T1
P2
N3
N1
M3
M1
L4
RSIG[1:8]: Receive Side System Signaling for Link 1 ~ 8
The extracted signaling bits are output on these pins. They are located in the lower nibble (b5 ~ b8) and are channel/timeslot-aligned with the data output on the corresponding RSDn pin.
In Receive Clock Master mode, the RSIGn pins are updated on the active edge of the corresponding RSCKn.
In Receive Clock Slave mode, determined by the RSLVCK bit (b4, T1/J1-010H / b4, E1-010H), the RSIGn pins are
updated on the active edge of the corresponding RSCKn or all eight RSIGn are updated on the active edge of
RSCK[1].
MRSIGA[1:2] / MRSIGB[1:2]: Multiplexed Receive Side System Signaling A / B for Link 1 ~ 8
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the MRSIGA[1:2] pins or the MRSIGB[1:2] pins are used to output the extracted signaling bits. The signaling bits are located in the lower nibble (b5 ~ b8) and are channel/timeslot-aligned with the data
output on the corresponding MRSDA[1:2]/MRSDB[1:2] pins. Using the byte-interleaved multiplexing scheme, the
MRSIGA[1]/MRSIGB[1] pins output the signaling bits from Link 1 to Link 4, while the MRSDA[2]/MRSDB[2] pins output the signaling bits from Link 5 to Link 8. The signaling bits on the MRSIGA[1:2]/MRSIGB[1:2] pins are updated on
the active edge of the MRSCK. The signaling bits on MRSIGA[1:2] is the same as the signaling bits on
MRSIGB[1:2]. MRSIGB[1:2] are for back-up purpose.
RSFS[1] / MRSFS Output / Input
RSFS[2]
RSFS[3]
RSFS[4]
RSFS[5]
RSFS[6]
RSFS[7]
RSFS[8]
R6
N6
T5
P5
M5
R4
N4
R3
RSFS[1:8]: Receive Side System Frame Pulse for Link 1 ~ 8
In T1/J1 Receive Clock Master mode, RSFSn outputs the pulse to indicate each F-bit, every second F-bit in SF
frame, the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multi-frame or the first F-bit of every second SF multi-frame.
In T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave mode, RSFSn inputs the pulse at a rate of integer multiple of 125 µs to indicate the
start of a frame.
In E1 Receive Clock Master mode, RSFSn outputs the pulse to indicate the Basic frame, CRC Multi-frame, Signaling Multi-frame, or both the CRC Multi-frame and Signaling Multi-frame, or the TS1 and TS16 overhead.
In E1 Receive Clock Slave mode, RSFSn inputs the pulse at a rate of integer multiple of 125 µs to indicate the start
of a frame.
RSFSn is updated/sampled on the active edge of the corresponding RSCKn. The active polarity of RSFSn is determined by the FSINV bit (b4, T1/J1-048H,... / b4, E1-048H,...).
MRSFS: Multiplexed Receive Side System Frame Pulse for Link 1 ~ 8
In Receive Multiplexed mode, MRSFS inputs the pulse at a rate of integer multiple of 125 µs to indicate the start of
a frame on the multiplexed data bus. MRSFS is sampled on the active edge of MRSCK. The active polarity of
MRSFS is determined by the FSINV bit (b4, T1/J1-048H,... / b4, E1-048H,...).
RSFS[1:8]/MRSCK are Schmitt-triggered inputs/outputs with pull-up resistors.
RSCK[1] / MRSCK Output / Input
RSCK[2]
RSCK[3]
RSCK[4]
RSCK[5]
RSCK[6]
RSCK[7]
RSCK[8]
T6
P6
M6
R5
N5
T4
P4
T3
RSCK[1:8]: Receive Side System Clock for Link 1 ~ 8
In Receive Clock Master mode, the RSCKn pins output a (gapped) 1.544 MHz (for T1/J1 mode) / 2.048 MHz (for E1
mode) clock used to update the signal on the corresponding RSDn, RSIGn and RSFSn pins.
In Receive Clock Slave mode, the RSCKn pins input a 1.544 MHz (for T1/J1 mode only), 2.048 MHz or 4.096 MHz
clock used to update the signals on the corresponding RSDn and RSIGn pins and sample the signals on the corresponding RSFSn pins. Selected by the RSLVCK bit (b4, T1/J1-010H / b4, E1-010H), the RSCK[1] pin can be used
for all eight links.
MRSCK: Multiplexed Receive Side System Clock for Link 1 ~ 8
In Receive Multiplexed mode, MRSCK inputs a 8.192 MHz or 16.384 MHz clock used to update the signals on the
corresponding MRSDA/MRSDB and MRSIGA/MRSIGB pins and sample the signal on the corresponding MRSFS
pin.
RSCK[1:8]/MRSCK are Schmitt-triggered inputs/outputs with pull-up resistors.
Pin Description
15
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Name
Type
Pin No.
Description
TSD[1] / MTSDA[1]
TSD[2] / MTSDB[1]
TSD[3]
TSD[4]
TSD[5] / MTSDA[2]
TSD[6] / MTSDB[2]
TSD[7]
TSD[8]
Input
G2
G4
F2
F4
E2
E4
D2
C2
TSD[1:8]: Transmit Side System Data for Link 1 ~ 8
The data stream from the system side is input on these pins.
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the TSDn pins are sampled on the active edge of the corresponding TSCKn.
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, selected by the TSLVCK bit (b1, T1/J1-010H / b1, E1-010H), the TSDn pins are sampled on the active edge of the corresponding TSCKn or all eight TSDn pins are sampled on the active edge of
TSCK[1].
MTSDA[1:2] / MTSDB[1:2]: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Data A / B for Link 1 ~ 8
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, selected by the MTSDA bit (b2, T1/J1-010H / b2, E1-010H), the MTSDA[1:2] pins or
the MTSDB[1:2] pins are used to input the data stream. Using a byte-interleaved multiplexing scheme, the
MTSDA[1]/MTSDB[1] pins input the data for Link 1 to Link 4, while the MTSDA[2]/MTSDB[2] pins input the data for
Link 5 to Link 8. The data on the MTSDA[1:2]/MTSDB[1:2] pins are sampled on the active edge of MTSCK.
TSD[1:8]/MTSDA[1:2]/MTSDB[1:2] are Schmitt-triggered inputs.
TSIG[1] / MTSIGA[1]
TSIG[2] / MTSIGB[1]
TSIG[3]
TSIG[4]
TSIG[5] / MTSIGA[2]
TSIG[6] / MTSIGB[2]
TSIG[7]
TSIG[8]
Input
G3
F1
F3
E1
E3
D1
C1
B1
TSIG[1:8]: Transmit Side System Signaling for Link 1 ~ 8
The signaling bits are input on these pins. They are located in the lower nibble (b5 ~ b8) and are channel/timeslotaligned with the data input on the corresponding TSDn pin.
In Transmit Clock Master mode, TSIGn is sampled on the active edge of the corresponding TSCKn.
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, selected by the TSLVCK bit (b1, T1/J1-010H / b1, E1-010H), TSIGn is sampled on
the active edge of the corresponding TSCKn or all eight TSIGn are updated on the active edge of TSCK[1].
MTSIGA[1:2] / MTSIGB[1:2]: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Signaling A / B for Link 1 ~ 8
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, selected by the MTSDA bit (b2, T1/J1-010H / b2, E1-010H), the MTSIGA[1:2] pins or
the MTSIGB[1:2] pins are used to input the signaling bits. The signaling bits are located in the lower nibble (b5 ~ b8)
and are channel/timeslot-aligned with the data input on the corresponding MTSDA[1:2]/MTSDB[1:2] pins. Using the
byte-interleaved multiplexing scheme, the MTSIGA[1]/MTSIGB[1] pins input the signaling bits for Link 1 to Link 4,
while the MTSIGA[2]/MTSIGB[2] pins input the signaling bits for Link 5 to Link 8. The signaling bits on the
MTSIGA[1:2]/MTSIGB[1:2] pins are sampled on the active edge of MTSCK.
TSIG[1:8]/MTSIGA[1:2]/MTSIGB[1:2] are Schmitt-triggered inputs.
TSFS[1] / MTSFS
TSFS[2]
TSFS[3]
TSFS[4]
TSFS[5]
TSFS[6]
TSFS[7]
TSFS[8]
Output / Input
L2
K4
K2
J4
J2
H1
H3
G1
TSFS[1:8]: Transmit Side System Frame Pulse for Link 1 ~ 8
In T1/J1 Transmit Clock Master mode, TSFSn outputs the pulse to indicate each F-bit or the first F-bit of every SF/
ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multi-frame.
In T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave mode, TSFSn inputs the pulse to indicate each F-bit or the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/
T1 DM/SLC-96 multi-frame.
In E1 Transmit Clock Master mode, TSFSn outputs the pulse to indicate the Basic frame, CRC Multi-frame and/or
Signaling Multi-frame.
In E1 Transmit Clock Slave mode, TSFSn inputs the pulse to indicate the Basic frame, CRC Multi-frame and/or Signaling Multi-frame.
TSFSn is updated/sampled on the active edge of the corresponding TSCKn. The active polarity of TSFSn is
selected by the FSINV bit (b1, T1/J1-042H,... / b1, E1-042H,...).
MTSFS: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Frame Pulse for Link 1 ~ 8
In T1/J1 Transmit Multiplexed mode, MTSFS inputs the pulse to indicate each F-bit or the first F-bit of every SF/
ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multi-frame of one link on the multiplexed data bus.
In E1 Transmit Multiplexed mode, MTSFS inputs the pulse to indicate each Basic frame, CRC Multi-frame and/or
Signaling Multi-frame of one link on the multiplexed data bus.
MTSFS is sampled on the active edge of MTSCK. The active polarity of MTSFS is selected by the FSINV bit (b1, T1/
J1-042H,... / b1, E1-042H,...).
TSFS[1:8]/MTSFS are Schmitt-triggered inputs/outputs with pull-up resistors.
Pin Description
16
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
Name
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Type
Pin No.
Description
L3
L1
K3
K1
J3
J1
H2
H4
TSCK[1:8]: Transmit Side System Clock for Link 1 ~ 8
In Transmit Clock Master mode, TSCKn outputs a (gapped) 1.544 MHz (for T1/J1 mode) / 2.048 MHz (for E1 mode)
clock used to sample the signal on the corresponding TSDn and TSIGn pins and update the signal on the corresponding TSFSn pin.
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, TSCKn inputs a 1.544 MHz (for T1/J1 mode only), 2.048 MHz or 4.096 MHz clock
used to sample the signal on the corresponding TSDn, TSIGn and TSFSn pins. Selected by the TSLVCK bit (b1, T1/
J1-010H / b1, E1-010H), the TSCK[1] can be used for all eight links.
TSCK[1] / MTSCK Output / Input
TSCK[2]
TSCK[3]
TSCK[4]
TSCK[5]
TSCK[6]
TSCK[7]
TSCK[8]
MTSCK: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Clock for Link 1 ~ 8
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, MTSCK inputs a 8.192 MHz or 16.384 MHz clock used to sample the signal on the
corresponding MTSDA/MTSDB, MTSIGA/MTSIGB and MTSFS pins.
TSCK[1:8]/MTSCK are Schmitt-triggered inputs/outputs with pull-up resistors.
Clock Generator
OSCI
Input
B13
OSCI: Crystal Oscillator Input
This pin is connected to an external clock source. In T1 mode E1 Rate of Transmit System interface, this clock must
keep the source same with system transmit clock (TSCKn/MTSCK).
The clock frequency of OSCI is defined by CLK_SEL[2:0]. The clock accuracy should be ±32 ppm and duty cycle
should be from 40% to 60%.
OSCO
Output
C13
OSCO: Crystal Oscillator Output
This pin outputs the inverted, buffered clock input from OSCI.
CLK_SEL[0]
CLK_SEL[1]
CLK_SEL[2]
Input
D15
C14
B15
CLK_SEL[2:0]: Clock Selection
These three pins select the input clock signal:
When the CLK_SEL[2] pin is low, the input clock signal is N X 1.544 MHz;
When the CLK_SEL[2] pin is high, the input clock signal is N X 2.048 MHz.
When the CLK_SEL[1:0] pins are ‘00’, the N is 1;
When the CLK_SEL[1:0] pins are ‘01’, the N is 2;
When the CLK_SEL[1:0] pins are ‘10’, the N is 3;
When the CLK_SEL[1:0] pins are ‘11’, the N is 4.
CLK_SEL[2:0] are Schmitt-trigger inputs.
CLK_GEN_1.544
Output
A16
CLK_GEN_1.544: Clock Generator 1.544 MHz Output
This pin outputs the 1.544 MHz clock signal generated by the Clock Generator.
CLK_GEN_2.048
Output
D14
CLK_GEN_2.048: Clock Generator 2.048 MHz Output
This pin outputs the 2.048 MHz clock signal generated by the Clock Generator.
REFA_OUT
Output
A15
REFA_OUT: Reference Clock Output A
The frequecy is 2.048 MHz (E1) or 1.544 MHz (T1/J1)
When no LOS is detected, this pin outputs a recovered clock from the Clock and Data Recovery function block of
one of the eight links. The link is selected by the RO1[2:0] bits (b2~0, T1/J1-007H / b2~0, E1-007H).
When LOS is detected, this pin outputs MCLK or high level, as selected by the REFH_LOS bit (b0, T1/J1-03EH,... /
b0, E1-03EH,...). *
Note: MCLK is a clock derived from OSCI using an internal PLL, and the frequency is 2.048 MHz (E1) or 1.544 MHz
(T1/J1).
REFB_OUT
Output
B14
REFB_OUT: Reference Clock Output B
The frequecy is 2.048 MHz (E1) or 1.544 MHz (T1/J1)
When no LOS is detected, this pin outputs a recovered clock from the Clock and Data Recovery function block of
one of the eight links. The link is selected by the RO2[2:0] bits (b5~3, T1/J1-007H / b5~3, E1-007H).
When LOS is detected, this pin outputs MCLK or high level, as selected by the REFH_LOS bit (b0, T1/J1-03EH,... /
b0, E1-03EH,...). *
Note:
* This feature is available in ZB revision only.
Pin Description
17
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
Name
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Type
Pin No.
Description
Control Interface
RESET
Input
A14
RESET: Reset (Active Low)
A low pulse for more than 100 ns on this pin resets the device. All the registers are accessible 2 ms after the reset.
The RESET pin is a Schmitt-trigger input with a weak pull-up resistor. The OSCI clock must exist when the device is
reset.
GPIO[0]
GPIO[1]
Output / Input
E13
D13
General Purpose I/O [1:0]
These two pins can be defined as input pins or output pins by the DIR[1:0] bits (b1~0, T1/J1-006H / b1~0, E1-006H)
respectively. When the pins are input, their polarities are indicated by the LEVEL[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1-006H / b3~2,
E1-006H) respectively. When the pins are output, their polarities are controlled by the LEVEL[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1006H / b3~2, E1-006H) respectively.
GPIO[1:0] are Schmitt-trigger input/output with a pull-up resistor.
THZ
Input
B16
THZ: Transmit High-Z
A high level on this pin puts all the TTIPn/TRINGn pins into high impedance state.
THZ is a Schmitt-trigger input.
INT
Output
T11
INT: Interrupt (Active Low)
This is the open drain, active low interrupt output. This pin will stay low until all the active unmasked interrupt indication bits are cleared.
REFR
Output
C16
REFR:
This pin should be connected to ground via an external 10K resistor.
CS
Input
R11
CS: Chip Select (Active Low)
This pin must be asserted low to enable the microprocessor interface. The signal must be asserted high at least
once after power up to clear the internal test modes. A transition from high to low must occur on this pin for each
Read/Write operation and can not return to high until the operation is completed.
CS is a Schmitt-trigger input.
A[0]
A[1]
A[2]
A[3]
A[4]
A[5]
A[6]
A[7]
A[8]
A[9]
A[10]
Input
M7
N7
P7
R7
T7
M8
N8
P8
R8
T8
P9
A[10:0]: Address Bus
In parallel mode, the signals on these pins select the register for the microprocessor to access.
In SPI mode, these pins should be connected to ground.
A[10:0] are Schmitt-trigger inputs.
D[0] / SDO
D[1]
D[2]
D[3]
D[4]
D[5]
D[6]
D[7]
Output / Input
M10
T10
R10
P10
M9
N9
T9
R9
D[7:0]: Bi-directional Data Bus
In parallel mode, the signals on these pins are the data for Read / Write operation.
In SPI mode, the D[7:1] pins should be connected to the ground through a 10 K resistor.
D[7:0] are Schmitt-trigger inputs/outputs.
MPM
Input
M11
MPM: Micro Controller Mode
In parallel mode, set this pin low for Motorola mode or high for Intel mode.
In SPI mode, set this pin to a fixed level (high or low). This pin is useless in SPI mode.
MPM is a Schmitt-trigger input.
Pin Description
SDO: Serial Data Output
In SPI mode, the data is serially output on this pin.
18
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Name
Type
Pin No.
RW / WR / SDI
Input
P11
Description
RW: Read / Write Select
In parallel Motorola mode, this pin is active high for read operation and active low for write operation.
WR: Write Strobe (Active Low)
In parallel Intel mode, this pin is active low for write operation.
SDI: Serial Data Input
In SPI mode, the address/control and/or data are serially input on this pin.
RW / WR / SDI is a Schmitt-trigger input.
DS / RD / SCLK
Input
N10
DS: Data Strobe (Active Low)
In parallel Motorola mode, this pin is active low.
RD: Read Strobe (Active Low)
In parallel Intel mode, this pin is active low for read operation.
SCLK: Serial Clock
In SPI mode, this pin inputs the timing for the SDO and SDI pins. The signal on the SDO pin is updated on the falling
edge of SCLK, while the signal on the SDI pin is sampled on the rising edge of SCLK.
DS / RD / SCLK is a Schmitt-trigger input.
SPIEN
Input
N11
SPIEN: Serial Microprocessor Interface Enable
When this pin is low, the microprocessor interface is in parallel mode.
When this pin is high, the microprocessor interface is in SPI mode.
SPIEN is a Schmitt-trigger input.
JTAG (per IEEE 1149.1)
TRST
Input
R13
TRST: Test Reset (Active Low)
A low signal on this pin resets the JTAG test port. This pin is a Schmitt-triggered input with an internal pull-up resistor. It must be connected to the RESET pin or ground when JTAG is not used.
TMS
Input
T14
TMS: Test Mode Select
The signal on this pin controls the JTAG test performance and is sampled on the rising edge of TCK. This pin is a
Schmitt-triggered input with an internal pull-up resistor.
TCK
Input
T15
TCK: Test Clock
The clock for the JTAG test is input on this pin. TDI and TMS are sampled on the rising edge of TCK and TDO is
clocked out of the device on the falling edge of TCK. This pin is a Schmitt-triggered input with an internal pull-up
resistor.
TDI
Input
T13
TDI: Test Input
The test data is sampled at this pin on the rising edge of TCK. This pin is a Schmitt-triggered input with an internal
pull-up resistor.
TDO
High-Z
R14
TDO: Test Output
The test data are output on this pin. It is updated on the falling edge of TCK. This pin is High-Z except during the
process of data scanning.
Power & Ground
VDDDIO
Pin Description
Power
F5, G5, VDDDIO: 3.3 V I/O Power Supply
H5, J5,
J12, K5,
K12, L12,
M12
19
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Name
Type
Pin No.
VDDDC
Power
H6, H7, VDDDC: 1.8 V Digital Core Power Supply
H8, J6,
J7, J8,
J9, J10,
J11, K6,
K7,
K8, K9,
K10,
K11,
L6, L7,
L8, L9,
L10,
L11
VDDAR[1]
VDDAR[2]
VDDAR[3]
VDDAR[4]
VDDAR[5]
VDDAR[6]
VDDAR[7]
VDDAR[8]
Power
A10
C9
A5
A4
G16
H15
M15
N16
VDDAR[8:1]: 3.3 V Power Supply for Receiver
VDDAT[1]
VDDAT[2]
VDDAT[3]
VDDAT[4]
VDDAT[5]
VDDAT[6]
VDDAT[7]
VDDAT[8]
Power
B12
B9
B5
A3
E15
H14
M16
P16
VDDAT[8:1]: 3.3 V Power Supply for Transmitter
VDDAX[1]
VDDAX[2]
VDDAX[3]
VDDAX[4]
VDDAX[5]
VDDAX[6]
VDDAX[7]
VDDAX[8]
Power
C12
B8
B7
B2
E14
J15
K15
R15
VDDAX[8:1]: 3.3 V Power Supply for Transmit Driver
VDDAP
Power
A13
VDDAP: 3.3 V Power Analog PLL
VDDAB
Power
D12
VDDAB: 3.3 V Power Analog Bias
GNDD
Ground
Pin Description
Description
E5, E6, GNDD: Digital Ground
E7, E8,
E9, E10,
E11, E12,
F6, F7,
F8, F9,
F10, F11,
F12, G6,
G7, G8,
G9, G10,
G11, G12,
H9, H10,
H11, H12
20
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Name
Type
GNDA
Ground
Pin No.
Description
B3, B6, GNDA: Analog Ground
B10, B11,
C3, C5,
C6, C7,
C8, C10,
D3, D4,
D7, D10,
F13, F15,
G13, G15,
J14, K13,
K14, L14,
L15, M14,
N13, P13,
P14, P15
TEST
IC
Pin Description
-
N12
P12
R12
T12
C15
D16
IC: Internally Connected
These pins are for IDT use only and should be connected to ground.
21
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
and adaptation to backplane timing may be enabled. In the Receive
System Interface, various operating modes can be selected to output
signals to the system.
The IDT82P2288 is a highly featured single device solution for T1/
E1/J1 trunks. Each link of the IDT82P2288 can be independently configured. The configuration is performed through an SPI or parallel microprocessor interface.
SYSTEM INTERFACE
On the system side, if the device is in T1/J1 mode, the data stream of
1.544 Mbit/s can be converted to/from the data stream of 2.048 Mbit/s
by software configuration. In addition, the eight links can be grouped into
two sets with four links in each set. Each set can be multiplexed to or demultiplexed from one of the two 8.192 Mbit/s buses. If the device is in E1
mode, four of the eight links can be multiplexed to or de-multiplexed
from one of the two 8.192 Mbit/s buses.
LINE INTERFACE - RECEIVE PATH
In the receive path, the signals from the line side are coupled into the
RTIPn and RRINGn pins and pass through an Impedance Terminator.
An Adaptive Equalizer is provided to increase the sensitivity for small
signals. Clock and data are recovered from the digital pulses output from
the slicer. After passing through the Receive Jitter Attenuator (can be
enabled or disabled), the recovered data is decoded using B8ZS (for T1/
J1) / HDB3 (for E1) or AMI line code rules and clocked into the Frame
Processor. Loss of signal, line code violations and excessive zero are
detected.
FRAMER - TRANSMIT PATH
In the transmit path, the Transmit System Interface inputs the signals
with various operating modes. In T1/J1 mode, the signals can be
processed by a Transmit Payload Control to execute the signaling insertion, idle code substitution, data insertion, data inversion and test pattern
generation or detection on a per-channel basis. The transmit path of
each transceiver can be configured to generate SF, ESF, T1 DM or SLC96. The framer can also be disabled (unframed mode). The Framer can
transmit Yellow alarm and AIS alarm. Inband loopback codes and bit
oriented message can be transmitted. Up to three HDLC links (in ESF
and T1 DM format) or two HDLC links (in SF and SLC-96 format) are
provided to insert the HDLC message on the DL bit (in ESF format) / D
bit in CH24 (in T1 DM format) or any arbitrary position. After passing
through a Transmit Buffer, the processed data and clock are input to the
Encoder.
FRAMER - RECEIVE PATH
In T1/J1 Mode, the recovered data and clock of each link can be
configured in Super Frame (SF), Extended Super Frame (ESF), T1
Digital Multiplexer (DM) or Switch Line Carrier - 96 (SLC-96) formats.
(The T1 DM and SLC-96 formats only exist in T1 mode). The framing
can also be bypassed (unframed mode). The Framer detects and indicates the out of SF/ESF/DM/SLC-96 synchronization event, the Yellow,
Red and AIS alarms. The Framer also detects the presence of inband
loopback codes and bit-oriented messages. Frame Alignment Signal
errors, CRC-6 errors, out of SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 events and Frame
Alignment position changes are counted. Up to three HDLC links (in
ESF and T1 DM format) or two HDLC links (in SF and SLC-96 format)
are provided to extract the HDLC message on the DL bit (in ESF format)
/ D bit in CH24 (in T1 DM format) or any arbitrary position. In the T1/J1
receive path, signaling debounce, signaling freeze, idle code substitution, digital milliwatt code insertion, idle code insertion, data inversion
and pattern generation or detection are supported on a per-channel
basis. An Elastic Store Buffer that supports controlled slip and adaptation to backplane timing may be enabled. In the Receive System Interface, various operating modes can be selected to output signals to the
system.
In E1 mode, the signals can be processed by a Transmit Payload
Control to execute the signaling insertion, idle code substitution, data
insertion, data inversion and test pattern generation or detection on a
per-timeslot basis. The transmit path of each transceiver can be configured to generate Basic Frame, CRC Multi-Frame and Signaling MultiFrame. The framer can be disabled (unframed mode). The Framer can
transmit Remote Alarm Indication signal, the Remote Signaling MultiFrame Alarm Indication signal, AIS alarm and FEBE. Three HDLC links
are provided to insert the HDLC message on TS16, the Sa National bits
or any arbitrary timeslot. The processed data and clock are input to the
Encoder.
In E1 Mode, the recovered data and clock of each link can be configured to frame to Basic Frame, CRC Multi-Frame and Signaling MultiFrame. The framing can be bypassed (unframed mode). The Framer
detects and indicates the following event: out of Basic Frame Sync, out
of CRC Multi-Frame, out of Signaling Multi-Frame, Remote Alarm Indication signal and Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication signal.
The Framer also monitors Red and AIS alarms. Basic Frame Alignment
Signal errors, Far End Block Errors (FEBE) and CRC errors are
counted. Up to three HDLC links are provided to extract the HDLC
message on TS16, the Sa National bits or any arbitrary timeslot. In the
E1 receive path, signaling debounce, signaling freezing, idle code
substitution, digital milliwatt code insertion, trunk conditioning, data
inversion and pattern generation or detection are also supported on a
per-timeslot basis. An Elastic Store Buffer that supports slip buffering
Functional Description
LINE INTERFACE - TRANSMIT PATH
The data is encoded using AMI or B8ZS (for T1/J1) and HDB3 (for
E1) line code rules. The Transmit Jitter Attenuator, if enabled, is
provided with a FIFO in the transmit data path. A de-jittered clock is
generated by an integrated digital phase-locked loop and is used to read
data from the FIFO. The shapes of the pulses are user programmable to
ensure that the T1/E1/J1 pulse template is met after the signal passing
through different cable lengths and types. Bipolar violation can be
inserted for diagnostic purposes if AMI line code rule is enabled. The
signal is transmitted on the TTIPn and TRINGn pins through an Impedance Terminator.
22
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
TEST AND DIAGNOSES
3.1
To facilitate the testing and diagnostic functions, Analog Loopback,
Remote Digital Loopback, Remote Loopback, Local Digital Loopback,
Payload Loopback and System Loopback are also integrated in the
IDT82P2288. A programmable pseudo random bit sequence can be
generated in receive/transmit direction and detected in the opposite
direction for testing purpose.
Each link in the IDT82P2288 can be configured as a duplex T1 transceiver, or a duplex E1 transceiver, or a duplex J1 transceiver. When it is
in T1 mode, Super Frame (SF), Extended Super Frame (ESF), T1
Digital Multiplexer (T1 DM) and Switch Line Carrier - 96 (SLC-96)
framing formats can be selected. When it is in J1 mode, Super Frame
(SF) and Extended Super Frame (ESF) formats can be selected. All the
selections are made by the TEMODE bit, the T1/J1 bit and the FM[1:0]
bits as shown in Table 1.
The G.772 Non-intrusive monitoring and JTAG are also supported by
the IDT82P2288.
T1 / E1 / J1 MODE SELECTION
Table 1: Operating Mode Selection
TEMODE
T1/J1
0
1
1
0
X
FM[1:0]
Operating Mode
00
T1 mode SF format
01
T1 mode ESF format
10
T1 mode T1 DM format
11
T1 mode SLC-96 format
00
J1 mode SF format
01
J1 mode ESF format
X
E1 mode
Table 2: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.1
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
T1/J1 Or E1 Mode
020, 120, 220, 320, 420, 520, 620, 720
TEMODE
T1/J1
FM[1:0]
Functional Description
23
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.2
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
RECEIVER IMPEDANCE MATCHING
When the R_TERM[2] bit is ‘1’, the internal impedance matching
circuit is disabled, and different external resistors should be used to
realize different impedance matching.
The receiver impedance matching can be realized by using internal
impedance matching circuit or external impedance matching circuit.
Figure 2 shows the appropriate components to connect with the
cable for one link. Table 3 lists the recommended matching resistor
values for the receiver.
When the R_TERM[2] bit is ‘0’, the internal impedance matching
circuit is enabled. 100 Ω, 110 Ω, 75 Ω or 120 Ω internal impedance
matching circuit can be selected by the R_TERM[1:0] bits.
Table 3: Impedance Matching Value For The Receiver
Internal Termination
Cable Configuration
RR
R_TERM[2:0]
000
120 Ω (E1)
001
100 Ω (T1)
010
110 Ω (J1)
011
A
•
1:1
•
•
RX Line
RR
•
B
2:1
• •
TX Line
RT
120 Ω
D5
100 Ω
·
VDDAX RRING
D4
· TTIP
D3
VDDAX
D2
D1
Note: 1. Common decoupling capacitor
2. Cp 0-560 (pF)
3. D1 - D8, Motorola - MBR0540T1;
·
3.3 V
VDDAR
RTIP
Cp
RT
120 Ω
1XX
110 Ω
VDDAR
D8
·
D7
VDDAR
D6
RR
R_TERM[2:0]
75 Ω
IDT82P2288
(one of the eight identical links)
75 Ω (E1)
External Termination
68µF 1
0.1µF
•
GNDA
3.3 V
VDDAX
68µF 1
0.1µF
GNDA
•
TRING
International Rectifier - 11DQ04 or 10BQ060
Figure 2. Receive / Transmit Line Circuit
3.2.1
LINE MONITOR
the signal by 22 dB, as selected by the MG[1:0] bits (b1~0, T1/J102AH,...). For normal operation, the Monitor Gain should be set to 0 dB,
i.e., the Monitor Gain of the monitored link should be 0 dB.
In both T1/J1 and E1 short haul applications, the Protected NonIntrusive Monitoring per T1.102 can be performed between two devices.
The monitored link of one device is in normal operation, and the monitoring link of the other device taps the monitored one through a high
impedance bridging circuit. Refer to Figure 3&Figure 4 (Twisted Pair)
and Figure 5&Figure 6 (COAX).
The monitoring link can be configured to any of the External or
Partially Internal Impedance Matching mode. Here the external r or
internal IM is used for voltage division, not for impedance matching. That
is, the r (IM) and the R make up of a resistance bridge. The resistive
attenuation of this bridge is 20lg(r/(2R+r)) dB for Twisted Pair or 20lg(r/
(R+r)) dB for COAX. The value of resistive attenuation should be consistent with the setting of Monitor Gain (22 dB).
After the high resistance bridging circuit, the signal arriving at RTIPn/
RRINGn of the monitoring link is dramatically attenuated. To compensate this bridge resistive attenuation, Monitor Gain can be used to boost
Functional Description
24
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
In case of LOS, REFH_LOS bit (b0, T1/J1-03EH) determines the
outputs on the REFA_OUT and REFB_OUT pins. When set to 0, the
output is MCLK; when set to 1, the output is high level.
DSX cross
connect point
RTIPn
monitor gain
= 0 dB
RR
RRINGn
R
monitored link
RTIPn
R
monitor gain
= 22 dB
r
RRINGn
monitoring link
Figure 3. Receive Path Monitoring (Twisted Pair)
DSX cross
connect point
TTIPn
TRINGn
monitored link
R
R
RTIPn
r
monitor gain
= 22 dB
RRINGn
monitoring link
Figure 4. Transmit Path Monitoring (Twisted Pair)
Functional Description
25
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
DSX cross connect point
RTIPn
RR
Monitor Gain
= 0 dB
RRINGn
R
Monitored Link
RTIPn
r
Monitor Gain
=22 dB
RRINGn
Monitoring Link
Figure 5. Receive Path Monitoring (COAX)
DSX cross connect point
TTIPn
TRINGn
R
Monitored Link
RTIPn
r
Monitor Gain
=22 dB
RRINGn
Monitoring Link
Figure 6. Transmit Path Monitoring (COAX)
Table 4: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.2
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
R_TERM[2:0]
Transmit And Receive Termination Configuration
032, 132, 232, 332, 432, 532, 632, 732
MG[1:0]
Receive Configuration 2
02A, 12A, 22A, 32A, 42A, 52A, 62A, 72A
Functional Description
26
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.3
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
ADAPTIVE EQUALIZER
In short haul application, the receive sensitivity is -10 dB in both T1/
J1 and E1 modes. In long haul application, the receive sensitivity is -36
dB in T1/J1 mode or -43 dB in E1 mode.
The Adaptive Equalizer can remove most of the signal distortion due
to intersymbol interference caused by cable attenuation and distortion.
Usually, the Adaptive Equalizer is off in short haul applications and is on
in long haul applications, which is configured by the EQ_ON bit.
3.4
DATA SLICER
The Data Slicer is used to generate a standard amplitude mark or a
space according to the amplitude of the input signals. The criteria of
mark or space generation are based on a selected ratio of the incoming
signal amplitude against the peak value detected during the observation
period. This ratio is selected by the SLICE[1:0] bits. The output of the
Data Slicer is forwarded to the Clock and Data Recovery unit.
The peak detector keeps on measuring the peak value of the
incoming signals during a selectable observation period. The observation period is selected by the UPDW[1:0] bits. A shorter observation
period allows quicker response to pulse amplitude variation, while a
longer observation period can minimize the possible overshoots.
Based on the observed peak value for a period, the equalizer will be
adjusted to achieve a normalized signal. The LATT[4:0] bits indicate the
signal attenuation introduced by the cable in approximately 2 dB per
step.
Table 5: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.3 & Chapter 3.4
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
EQ_ON
Receive Configuration 1
029, 129, 229, 329, 429, 529, 629, 729
Receive Configuration 2
02A, 12A, 22A, 32A, 42A, 52A, 62A, 72A
LATT[4:0]
Line Status Register 1
037, 137, 237, 337, 437, 537, 637, 737
REFH_LOS
Reference Clock Output Control
03E, 13E, 23E, 33E, 43E, 53E, 63E, 73E
UPDW[1:0]
SLICE[1:0]
3.5
CLOCK AND DATA RECOVERY
The Clock and Data Recovery is used to recover the clock signal
from the received data. It is accomplished by Digital Phase Locked Loop
(DPLL). The recovered clock tracks the jitter in the data output from the
Data Slicer and keeps the phase relationship between data and clock
during the absence of the incoming pulse.
Jittered Data
Jittered Clock
SJET provides two reference clock outputs REFA_OUT and
REFB_OUT. These pins output a recovered clock from the Clock and
Data Recovery function block of one of the eight links. The link is
selected by the RO1[2:0] for REFA_OUT and with RO2[2:0] for
REFB_OUT.
DPLL
read
pointer De-jittered Clock
The FIFO is used as a pool to buffer the jittered input data, then the
data is clocked out of the FIFO by a de-jittered clock. The depth of the
FIFO can be 32 bits, 64 bits or 128 bits, as selected by the RJA_DP[1:0]
bits. Accordingly, the constant delay produced by the Jitter Attenuator is
16 bits, 32 bits or 64 bits. The 128-bit FIFO is used when large jitter
tolerance is expected, while the 32-bit FIFO is used in delay sensitive
applications.
RECEIVE JITTER ATTENUATOR
The Receive Jitter Attenuator of each link can be chosen to be used
or not. This selection is made by the RJA_E bit.
The DPLL is used to generate a de-jittered clock to clock out the data
stored in the FIFO. The DPLL can only attenuate the incoming jitter
whose frequency is above Corner Frequency (CF). The jitter whose
frequency is lower than the CF passes through the DPLL without any
attenuation. In T1/J1 applications, the CF of the DPLL can be 5 Hz or
1.26 Hz, as selected by the RJA_BW bit. In E1 applications, the CF of
The Jitter Attenuator consists of a FIFO and a DPLL, as shown in
Figure 7.
Functional Description
write
pointer
De-jittered Data
Figure 7. Jitter Attenuator
When Loss of Signal (LOS) is detected (Chapter 3.7.3 LOS Detection) on the link selected for REFA_OUT/REFB_OUT, this pin outputs
MCLK (delivered from OSCI input) or a high level signal as selected by
the REFH_LOS bit.
3.6
FIFO
32/64/128
27
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
the DPLL can be 6.77 Hz or 0.87 Hz, as selected by the RJA_BW bit.
The lower the CF is, the longer time is needed to achieve synchronization.
read and write pointer of the FIFO will be written into the RJITT[6:0] bits.
When the RJITT_TEST bit is ‘1’, the current interval will be compared
with the old one in the RJITT[6:0] bits and the larger one will be indicated by the RJITT[6:0] bits.
If the incoming data moves faster than the outgoing data, the FIFO
will overflow. If the incoming data moves slower than the outgoing data,
the FIFO will underflow. The overflow or underflow is captured by the
RJA_IS bit. When the RJA_IS bit is ‘1’, an interrupt will be reported on
the INT pin if enabled by the RJA_IE bit.
The performance of Receive Jitter Attenuator meets the ITU-T I.431,
G.703, G.736 - 739, G.823, G.824, ETSI 300011, ETSI TBR 12/13,
AT&T TR62411, TR43802, TR-TSY 009, TR-TSY 253, TR-TRY 499
standards. Refer to Chapter 7.10 Jitter Tolerance and Chapter 7.11 Jitter
Transfer for details.
To avoid overflow or underflow, the JA-Limit function can be enabled
by setting the RJA_LIMT bit. When the JA-Limit function is enabled, the
speed of the outgoing data will be adjusted automatically if the FIFO is
close to its full or emptiness. The criteria of speed adjustment start are
listed in Table 6. Though the JA-Limit function can reduce the possibility
of FIFO overflow and underflow, the quality of jitter attenuation is deteriorated.
Table 7: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.6
Bit
Criteria Of Speed Adjustment Start
32 bits
2-bit close to full or empty
64 bits
3-bit close to full or empty
128 bits
4-bit close to full or empty
Receive Jitter Attenuation Configuration
027, 127, 227, 327,
427, 527, 627, 727
RJA_IS
Interrupt Status 1
03B, 13B, 23B,
33B, 43B, 53B,
63B, 73B
RJA_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 1
034, 134, 234, 334,
434, 534, 634, 734
RJITT[6:0]
Receive Jitter Measure Value Indication
039, 139, 239, 339,
439, 539, 639, 739
RJA_DP[1:0]
RJA_BW
RJA_LIMT
RJITT_TEST
Selected by the RJITT_TEST bit, the real time interval between the
read and write pointer of the FIFO or the peak-peak interval between the
read and write pointer of the FIFO can be indicated in the RJITT[6:0]
bits. When the RJITT_TEST bit is ‘0’, the current interval between the
Functional Description
Address (Hex)
RJA_E
Table 6: Criteria Of Speed Adjustment Start
FIFO Depth
Register
28
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.7
DECODER
3.7.1
LINE CODE RULE
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
When the Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error or the B8ZS Code Violation
(CV) Error is detected, it will be indicated by the CV_IS bit. When the
Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is detected, it will be indicated by the
EXZ_IS bit. When the CV_IS bit or the EXZ_IS bit is ‘1’, an interrupt will
be reported by the INT pin if enabled by the corresponding CV_IE bit or
the EXZ_IE bit.
3.7.1.1 T1 / J1 Mode
In T1/J1 mode, the AMI and B8ZS line code rules are provided. The
selection is made by the R_MD bit.
3.7.2.2 E1 Mode
3.7.1.2 E1 Mode
The decode errors can be divided into three types in E1 mode:
• Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error: When AMI line code rule is used, the
BPV error will be detected if two consecutive pulses are received
with the same polarity (refer to Figure 8). The event of the Bipolar
Violation (BPV) Error is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
• HDB3 Code Violation (CV) Error: When HDB3 line code rule is
used, a CV error is detected if two consecutive BPV errors are
detected, and the pulses that have the same polarity as the previous pulse are not the HDB3 zero substitution pulsed (refer to
Figure 10).
• Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error: EXZ error can be detected in both
AMI and HDB3 line code rules. There are two standards defining
the EXZ error: ANSI and FCC. The EXZ_DEF bit chooses a standard for the corresponding link to judge the EXZ error. Table 8
shows the definition of EXZ. To count the event of the Excessive
Zero (EXZ) Error, the EXZ_ERR[1:0] bits should be set to ‘01’. The
Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is counted in an internal 16-bit EXZ
counter. The content in the EXZ counter is transferred to the EXZ
Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers in two ways:
- When the CNT_MD bit is ‘0’, the Manual-Report mode is
selected. The EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error
Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers when there is a transition
from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the CNT_TRF bit;
- When the CNT_MD bit is ‘1’, the Auto-Report mode is selected.
The EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error Counter
L-Byte & H-Byte registers every one second automatically.
In E1 mode, the AMI and HDB3 line code rules are provided. The
selection is made by the R_MD bit.
3.7.2
DECODE ERROR DETECTION
3.7.2.1 T1 / J1 Mode
The decode errors can be divided into three types in T1/J1 mode:
• Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error: When AMI line code rule is used, the
BPV error will be detected if two consecutive pulses are received
with the same polarity (refer to Figure 8). The event of the Bipolar
Violation (BPV) Error is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
• B8ZS Code Violation (CV) Error: When B8ZS line code rule is
used, a CV error is detected when the received code does not
match the standard B8ZS line code pattern (expect the Excessive
Zero error).
• Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error: EXZ error can be detected in both
AMI and B8ZS line code rules. There are two standards defining
the EXZ error: ANSI and FCC. The EXZ_DEF bit chooses a standard for the corresponding link to judge the EXZ error. Table 8
shows the definition of EXZ. To count the event of the Excessive
Zero (EXZ) Error, the EXZ_ERR[1:0] bits should be set to ‘01’. The
Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is counted in an internal 16-bit EXZ
counter. The content in the EXZ counter is transferred to the EXZ
Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers in two ways:
- When the CNT_MD bit is ‘0’, the Manual-Report mode is
selected. The EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error
Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers when there is a transition
from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the CNT_TRF bit;
- When the CNT_MD bit is ‘1’, the Auto-Report mode is selected.
The EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error Counter
L-Byte & H-Byte registers every one second automatically.
After the content in the counter is transferred to the EXZ Error
Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers, the counter will be cleared to ‘0’ and
start a new round counting automatically. No error event is lost during
data transferring.
The overflow of the counter is reflected by the CNTOV_IS bit, and
can trigger an interrupt if the corresponding CNT_IE bit is set.
After the content in the counter is transferred to the EXZ Error
Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers, the counter will be cleared to ‘0’ and
start a new round counting automatically. No error event is lost during
data transferring.
When the Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error or the HDB3 Code Violation
(CV) Error is detected, it will be indicated by the CV_IS bit. When the
Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is detected, it will be indicated by the
EXZ_IS bit. When the CV_IS bit or the EXZ_IS bit is ‘1’, an interrupt will
be reported by the INT pin if enabled by the corresponding CV_IE bit or
the EXZ_IE bit.
The overflow of the counter is reflected by the CNTOV_IS bit, and
can trigger an interrupt if the corresponding CNT_IE bit is set.
Functional Description
29
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 8: Excessive Zero Error Definition
ANSI
FCC
AMI
More than 15 consecutive 0s are More than 80 consecutive 0s are
detected.
detected.
B8ZS
More than 7 consecutive 0s are More than 7 consecutive 0s are
detected (refer to Figure 9).
detected (refer to Figure 9).
HDB3
More than 3 consecutive 0s are More than 3 consecutive 0s are
detected (refer to Figure 10).
detected (refer to Figure 10).
clock
RTIPn
1
RRINGn
3
5
2
V
4
7
6
Bipolar violation
Figure 8. AMI Bipolar Violation Error
clock
RTIPn
RRINGn
2
4
1
6
3
5
8
8 consecutive
zeros
7
9
Excessive zero
Figure 9. B8ZS Excessive Zero Error
Code violation
clock
RTIPn
RRINGn
1
2
4 consecutive
zeros
3
5
4
V
V
6
Excessive zero
Figure 10. HDB3 Code Violation & Excessive Zero Error
Functional Description
30
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.7.3
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
LOS DETECTION
When the LOS is detected, it will be indicated by the LOS_S bit.
Selected by the LOS_IES bit, a transition from '0' to '1' on the LOS_S bit
or any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the LOS_S bit will set
the LOS_IS bit to ‘1’. When the LOS_IS bit is ‘1’, an interrupt will be
reported by the INT pin if enabled by the LOS_IE bit.
The Loss of Signal (LOS) Detector monitors the amplitude and
density of the received signal. When the received signal is below an
amplitude for continuous intervals, the LOS is detected. When the
received signal is above the amplitude and the density of marks meets
the requirement, the LOS is cleared.
During LOS, if the RAISE bit is set to ‘1’, all ’One’s will be inserted to
the received data stream.
The different criteria for LOS Declaring/Clearing are illustrated in
Table 9 and Table 10. In T1/J1 mode, the LOS detection supports ANSI
T1.231 and I.431. In E1 mode, the LOS detection supports ITU-T G.775
and I.431. The criteria are selected by the LAC bit.
Functional Description
31
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 9: LOS Condition In T1/J1 Mode
Short Haul Application
Loss of Signal in T1/J1
Mode
LOS
Detecte
d
Amplitude
Continuous Intervals
Amplitude
LOS
Cleared
Mark Density
ANSI T1.231
Long Haul Application
I.431
ANSI T1.231
I.431
below 800 mVpp
below 800 mVpp
below Q dB *
below Q dB *
175 bits
1544 bits
175 bits
1544 bits
above 1 Vpp
above 1 Vpp
above Q + 4 dB *
above Q + 4 dB *
12.5% (16 marks in a hopping 12.5% (16 marks in a hopping 12.5% (16 marks in a hopping 12.5% (16 marks in a hopping
128-bit window **) with less 128-bit window **) with less 128-bit window **) with less 128-bit window **) with less
than 100 continuous zeros
than 100 continuous zeros
than 100 continuous zeros
than 100 continuous zeros
Note:
* The Q dB is set in the LOS[4:0] bits.
** A hopping 128-bit window means this: An entire 128 bits is taken from the data stream and is checked. If the criteria are not met, all the 128 bits are thrown and another 128 bits are
caught for checking.
Table 10: LOS Condition In E1 Mode
Short Haul Application
Long Haul Application
Loss of Signal in E1 Mode
G.775
LOS
Detecte
d
Amplitude
Continuous Intervals
Amplitude
LOS
Cleared
Mark Density
I.431
G.775
I.431
below 800 mVpp
below 800 mVpp
below Q dB *
below Q dB *
32 bits
2048 bits
32 bits
2048 bits
above 1 Vpp
above 1 Vpp
above Q + 4 dB *
above Q + 4 dB *
12.5% (4 marks in a hopping 12.5% (4 marks in a hopping 12.5% (4 marks in a hopping 12.5% (4 marks in a hopping
32-bit window **) with less 32-bit window **) with less 32-bit window **) with less 32-bit window **) with less
than 16 continuous zeros
than 16 continuous zeros
than 16 continuous zeros
than 16 continuous zeros
Note:
* The Q dB is set in the LOS[4:0] bits.
** A hopping 32-bit window means this: An entire 32 bits is taken from the data stream and is checked. If the criteria are not met, all the 32 bits are thrown and another 32 bits are caught
for checking.
Functional Description
32
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 11: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.7
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
R_MD
Receive Configuration 0
028, 128, 228, 328, 428, 528, 628, 728
Maintenance Function Control 2
031, 131, 231, 331, 431, 531, 631, 731
CNTL[7:0]
EXZ Error Counter L-Byte
03D, 13D, 23D, 33D, 43D, 53D, 63D, 73D
CNTH[7:0]
EXZ Error Counter H-Byte
03C, 13C, 23C, 33C, 43C, 53C, 63C, 73C
Interrupt Status 1
03B, 13B, 23B, 33B, 43B, 53B, 63B, 73B
Interrupt Enable Control 1
034, 134, 234, 334, 434, 534, 634, 734
Maintenance Function Control 1
02C, 12C, 22C, 32C, 42C, 52C, 62C, 72C
LOS_S
Line Status Register 0
036, 136, 236, 336, 436, 536, 636, 736
LOS_IES
Interrupt Trigger Edges Select
035, 135, 235, 335, 435, 535, 635, 735
LOS_IS
Interrupt Status 0
03A, 13A, 23A, 33A, 43A, 53A, 63A, 73A
LOS_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 0
033, 133, 233, 333, 433, 533, 633, 733
LOS[4:0]
Receive Configuration 1
029, 129, 229, 329, 429, 529, 629, 729
EXZ_ERR
EXZ_DEF
CNT_MD
CNT_TRF
CV_IS
EXZ_IS
CNTOV_IS
CV_IE
EXZ_IE
CNT_IE
LAC
RAISE
Functional Description
33
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.8
FRAME PROCESSOR
3.8.1.1 Synchronization Searching
3.8.1
T1/J1 MODE
Super Frame (SF) Format
The structure of T1/J1 SF is illustrated in Table 12. The SF is made
up of 12 frames. Each frame consists of one overhead bit (F-bit) and 24
8-bit channels. Its Frame Alignment Pattern is ‘100011011100’ for T1
and ‘10001101110X’ for J1 located in the F-bit position. The same
pattern is a mimic pattern if it is received in the data stream other than Fbit. The synchronization criteria of SF format is selected by the MIMICC
bit. When the MIMICC bit is set to ‘1’, the SF synchronization is acquired
if two consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are received error free in
the data stream without a mimic pattern. When the MIMICC bit is set to
‘0’, the SF synchronization is acquired if two consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are received error free in the data stream. In this case,
the existence of mimic patterns is ignored. If a mimic pattern exists
during the frame searching procedure, the MIMICI bit will be set to indicate the presence of a mimic pattern.
In T1/J1 mode, the Frame Processor searches for the frame alignment patterns in the standard Super-Frame (SF), Extended SuperFrame (ESF), T1 Digital Multiplexer (DM) or Switch Line Carrier - 96
(SLC-96) framing formats. The T1 DM and SLC-96 formats are only
supported in T1 mode. The Frame Processor acquires frame alignment
per ITU-T requirement.
When frame alignment is achieved, the Framer Processor continues
to monitor the received data stream. The Frame Processor will declare
framing bit errors or bit error events if any. The Frame Processor can
also detect out-of-frame events based on selected criteria.
The Frame Processor can also be bypassed by setting the UNFM bit.
The SF synchronization is indicated by ‘0’ in the OOFV bit. The
RMFBI bit is set at the first bit of each SF frame.
Table 12: The Structure of SF
F-Bit (Frame Alignment)
The Bit In Each Channel
Frame No. In The SF
Ft
1
1
2
3
0
0
4
5
0
1
6
7
1
0
8
9
1
1
10
11
12
Fs
1
0
X
Data Bit
Signaling Bit
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-7
A (bit 8)
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-8
-
1-7
B (bit 8)
Note:
‘X’ should be logic 0 in T1 FAS.
‘X’ can be logic 0 or 1 in J1 FAS because this position is used as Yellow Alarm Indication bit.
Functional Description
34
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Extended Super Frame (ESF) Format
ESF synchronization is acquired if four consecutive Frame Alignment
Patterns are detected error free in the received data stream without a
mimic pattern. When the MIMICC bit is set to ‘0’, the ESF synchronization is acquired if a single correct Frame Alignment Pattern and a single
correct CRC-6 based on this correct Frame Alignment Pattern are
found. In this case, the existence of mimic patterns is ignored. If a mimic
pattern exists during the frame searching procedure, the MIMICI bit will
be set to indicate the presence of a mimic pattern.
The structure of T1/J1 ESF is illustrated in Table 13. The ESF is
made up of 24 frames. Each frame consists of one overhead bit (F-bit)
and 24 8-bit channels. The F-bit in Frame (4n) (0<n<7) is for Frame
Alignment; the F-bit in Frame (2n-1) (0<n<13) is for Data Link; and the
F-bit in Frame (4n-2) (0<n<7) is for CRC checking.
The Frame Alignment Pattern is ‘001011’, which is located in Frame
(4n) (0<n<7). The same pattern is a mimic pattern if it is received in the
data stream other than F-bit. The synchronization criteria of ESF format
is selected by the MIMICC bit. When the MIMICC bit is set to ‘1’, the
The ESF synchronization is indicated by ‘0’ in the OOFV bit. The
RMFBI bit is set at the first bit of each ESF frame.
Table 13: The Structure of ESF
F-Bit Assignment
The Bit In Each Channel
Frame No. In The ESF
Frame Alignment
Data Link
CRC
Data Bit
Signaling Bit
1
-
DL
-
1-8
-
2
-
-
C1
1-8
-
3
-
DL
-
1-8
-
4
0
-
-
1-8
-
5
-
DL
-
1-8
-
6
-
-
C2
1-7
A (bit 8)
7
-
DL
-
1-8
-
8
0
-
-
1-8
-
9
-
DL
-
1-8
-
10
-
-
C3
1-8
-
11
-
DL
-
1-8
-
12
1
-
-
1-7
B (bit 8)
13
-
DL
-
1-8
-
14
-
-
C4
1-8
-
15
-
DL
-
1-8
-
16
0
-
-
1-8
-
17
-
DL
-
1-8
-
18
-
-
C5
1-7
C (bit 8)
19
-
DL
-
1-8
-
20
1
-
-
1-8
-
21
-
DL
-
1-8
-
22
-
-
C6
1-8
-
23
-
DL
-
1-8
-
24
1
-
-
1-7
D (bit 8)
Functional Description
35
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1 Digital Multiplexer (DM) Format (T1 only)
The synchronization criteria of T1 DM format are selected by the
DDSC bit. When the DDSC bit is ‘0’, the T1 DM synchronization is
acquired if one correct DDS pattern is received before the first F-bit of a
single correct Frame Alignment Pattern. When the DDSC bit is ‘1’, the
T1 DM synchronization is acquired if a single correct Frame Alignment
Pattern is received and twelve correct DDS patterns before each F-bit of
the correct Frame Alignment Pattern are all detected.
The structure of T1 DM is illustrated in Table 14. The T1 DM is made
up of 12 frames. Each frame consists of one overhead bit (F-bit) and 24
8-bit channels. Except for channel 24, all other channels carry data.
Channel 24 should be ‘0DY11101’. Its Frame Alignment Pattern is
‘100011011100’ in the F-bit. The fixed 6 bits in channel 24 are called
DDS.
The T1-DM synchronization is indicated by ‘0’ in the OOFV bit. The
RMFBI bit is set at the first bit of each T1 DM frame.
Table 14: The Structure of T1 DM
F-Bit (Frame Alignment)
Frame No. In The T1 DM
Channel 24
Ft
1
Fs
1
0DY11101
2
3
0
0
0DY11101
4
5
0
1
1
0
1
1
0DY11101
0DY11101
10
11
0DY11101
0DY11101
8
9
0DY11101
0DY11101
6
7
0DY11101
1
0
0DY11101
0DY11101
12
0
0DY11101
Note:
In Channel 24, the ‘D’ bit is used for data link, and the ‘Y’ bit is used for alarm. The other 6 bits are fixed and they are called ‘DDS’ pattern.
Functional Description
36
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Switch Line Carrier - 96 (SLC-96) Format (T1 only)
tions. If the Frame Alignment Pattern is found in 24 consecutive F-bit
positions in the data stream, the SLC-96 synchronization is acquired.
The first frame is numbered from the frame whose F-bit contains the first
‘1’ of the Frame Alignment Pattern.
The structure of SLC-96 is illustrated in Table 15. The SLC-96 is
made up of 6 SFs, but some F-bit are used as Concentrator Bits, Spoiler
Bits, Maintenance Bits, Alarm Bits and Switch Bits. Each frame consists
of one overhead bit (F-bit) and 24 8-bit channels. Its Frame Alignment
Pattern is ‘001000110111001000110111’ in 24 consecutive F-bit posi-
The SLC-96 synchronization is indicated by ‘0’ in the OOFV bit. The
RMFBI bit is set at the first bit of each SLC-96 frame.
Table 15: The Structure of SLC-96
The Bit In Each Channel
Frame No.
The Bit In Each Channel
F-Bit (Frame Alignment) - Ft
Frame No.
Data Bit
Signaling Bit
F-Bit (Frame Alignment) - Fs
Data Bit
Signaling Bit
1
1
1-8
-
2
0
1-8
-
3
0
1-8
-
4
0
1-8
-
5
1
1-8
-
6
1
1-7
A (bit 8)
7
0
1-8
-
8
1
1-8
-
9
1
1-8
-
10
1
1-8
-
11
0
1-8
-
12
0
1-7
B (bit 8)
13
1
1-8
-
14
0
1-8
-
15
0
1-8
-
16
0
1-8
-
17
1
1-8
-
18
1
1-7
C (bit 8)
19
0
1-8
-
20
1
1-8
-
21
1
1-8
-
22
1
1-8
-
23
0
1-8
-
24
C1 (Concentrator Bit)
1-7
D (bit 8)
25
1
1-8
-
26
C2 (Concentrator Bit)
1-8
-
27
0
1-8
-
28
C3 (Concentrator Bit)
1-8
-
29
1
1-8
-
30
C4 (Concentrator Bit)
1-7
A (bit 8)
31
0
1-8
-
32
C5 (Concentrator Bit)
1-8
-
33
1
1-8
-
34
C6 (Concentrator Bit)
1-8
-
35
0
1-8
-
36
C7 (Concentrator Bit)
1-7
B (bit 8)
37
1
1-8
-
38
C8 (Concentrator Bit)
1-8
-
39
0
1-8
-
40
C9 (Concentrator Bit)
1-8
-
41
1
1-8
-
42
C10 (Concentrator Bit)
1-7
C (bit 8)
43
0
1-8
-
44
C11 (Concentrator Bit)
1-8
-
45
1
1-8
-
46
0 (Spoiler Bit)
1-8
-
47
0
1-8
-
48
1 (Spoiler Bit)
1-7
D (bit 8)
49
1
1-8
-
50
0 (Spoiler Bit)
1-8
-
51
0
1-8
-
52
M1 (Maintenance Bit)
1-8
-
53
1
1-8
-
54
M2 (Maintenance Bit)
1-7
A (bit 8)
55
0
1-8
-
56
M3 (Maintenance Bit)
1-8
-
57
1
1-8
-
58
A1 (Alarm Bit)
1-8
-
Functional Description
37
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 15: The Structure of SLC-96 (Continued)
The Bit In Each Channel
Frame No.
The Bit In Each Channel
F-Bit (Frame Alignment) - Ft
Frame No.
Data Bit
Signaling Bit
F-Bit (Frame Alignment) - Fs
Data Bit
Signaling Bit
59
0
1-8
-
60
A2 (Alarm Bit)
1-7
B (bit 8)
61
1
1-8
-
62
S1 (Switch Bit)
1-8
-
63
0
1-8
-
64
S2 (Switch Bit)
1-8
-
65
1
1-8
-
66
S3 (Switch Bit)
1-7
C (bit 8)
67
0
1-8
-
68
S4 (Switch Bit)
1-8
-
69
1
1-8
-
70
1 (Spoiler Bit)
1-8
-
71
0
1-8
-
72
0
1-7
D (bit 8)
3.8.1.2 Error Event And Out Of Synchronization Detection
next received ESF frame, a single CRC-6 error event is generated.
This error event is captured by the BEEI bit and is forwarded to the
Performance Monitor.
• Excessive CRC-6 Error: Once the accumulated CRC-6 errors
exceed 319 occasions (> 319) in a 1 second fixed window, an
excessive CRC-6 error event is generated. This error event is captured by the EXCRCERI bit and is forwarded to the Performance
Monitor.
• Severely Frame Alignment Bit Error: When 2 or more frame alignment bit errors are detected in a 1-ESF-frame fixed window, the
severely frame alignment bit error occurs. This error event is captured by the SFEI bit.
After the frame is in synchronization, the Frame Processor continues
to monitor the received data stream to detect errors and judge if it is out
of synchronization.
Super Frame (SF) Format
In SF format, two kinds of errors are detected:
• Severely Ft Bit Error: Each received Ft bit is compared with the
expected one (refer to Table 12). Each unmatched Ft bit leads to
an Ft bit error event. When 2 or more Ft bit errors are detected in a
6-basic-frame fixed window, the severely Ft bit error occurs. This
error event is captured by the SFEI bit.
• F Bit Error: Each received F bit is compared with the expected one
(refer to Table 12). Each unmatched F bit leads to an F bit error
event. This error event is captured by the FERI bit and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
When the Frame Alignment Bit Error number exceeds the ratio set in
the M2O[1:0] bits, it is out of synchronization. Then if the REFEN bit is
‘1’, the Frame Processor will start to search for synchronization again.
Additionally, the Excessive CRC-6 Error also leads to out of ESF
synchronization. In this condition, both the REFEN bit being ‘1’ and the
REFCRCE bit being ‘1’ will allow the Frame Processor to search for
synchronization again. If the REFEN bit is ‘0’, no error can lead to
reframe except for manually setting. The manual reframe is executed by
a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the REFR bit. During out of synchronization
state, the error event detection is suspended.
When the F Bit Error number exceeds the ratio set in the M2O[1:0]
bits, it is out of synchronization. Then if the REFEN bit is ‘1’, the Frame
Processor will start to search for synchronization again. If the REFEN bit
is ‘0’, no error can lead to reframe except for manually setting. The
manual reframe is executed by a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the REFR
bit. During out of synchronization state, the error event detection is
suspended.
Once resynchronized, if the new-found F bit position differs from the
previous one, the change of frame alignment event is generated. This
event is captured by the COFAI bit and is forwarded to the Performance
Monitor.
Once resynchronized, if the new-found F bit position differs from the
previous one, the change of frame alignment event is generated. This
event is captured by the COFAI bit and is forwarded to the Performance
Monitor.
T1 Digital Multiplexer (DM) Format (T1 only)
Extended Super Frame (ESF) Format
In T1 DM format, three kinds of errors are detected:
• Severely Ft Bit Error: Each received Ft bit is compared with the
expected one (refer to Table 14). Each unmatched Ft bit leads to
an Ft bit error event. When 2 or more Ft bit errors are detected in a
6-basic-frame fixed window, the severely Ft bit error occurs. This
error event is captured by the SFEI bit.
• F Bit Error: Each received F bit is compared with the expected one
(refer to Table 14). Each unmatched F bit leads to an F bit error
In ESF format, four kinds of errors are detected:
• Frame Alignment Bit Error: Each received Frame Alignment bit is
compared with the expected one (refer to Table 13). Each
unmatched bit leads to a frame alignment bit error event. This error
event is captured by the FERI bit and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
• CRC-6 Error: When the local calculated CRC-6 of the current
received ESF frame does not match the received CRC-6 of the
Functional Description
38
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
event. This error event is captured by the FERI bit and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
• DDS Pattern Error: The received 6-bit DDS in each CH24 is compared with the DDS pattern - ‘0XX11101’ (MSB left and ‘X’ is not
cared). When one or more bits do not match the DDS pattern, a
single DDS pattern error event is generated. This error event is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
manual reframe is executed by a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the REFR
bit. During out of synchronization state, the error event detection is
suspended.
Once resynchronized, if the new-found F bit position differs from the
previous one, the change of frame alignment event is generated. This
event is captured by the COFAI bit and is forwarded to the Performance
Monitor.
The 6-bit DDS pattern and its following F-bit make up a 7-bit pattern.
When one or more bits do not match its pattern (refer to Table 14), a
single error is generated. When this error number exceeds the ratio set
in the M2O[1:0] bits, it is out of synchronization. Then if the REFEN bit is
‘1’, the Frame Processor will start to search for synchronization again. If
the REFEN bit is ‘0’, no error can lead to reframe except for manually
setting. The manual reframe is executed by a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on
the REFR bit. During out of synchronization state, the error event detection is suspended.
3.8.1.3 Overhead Extraction (T1 Mode SLC-96 Format Only)
In SLC-96 format, the Concentrator bits, Maintenance bits, Alarm bits
and Switch bits are all extracted to the RDL0, RDL1 & RDL2 registers
respectively.
All these extractions will be set to de-bounce if the SCDEB bit is set
to ‘1’. Thus, the value in the RDL0, RDL1 & RDL2 registers are updated
if the received corresponding code is the same for 2 consecutive SLC96 frames. Whether de-bounced or not, a change indication will be set in
the SCCI bit, SCMI bit, SCAI bit and SCSI bit respectively if the corresponding codes in the RDL0, RDL1 & RDL2 registers differ from the
previous ones.
Once resynchronized, if the new-found F bit position differs from the
previous one, the change of frame alignment event is generated. This
event is captured by the COFAI bit and is forwarded to the Performance
Monitor.
The value in the RDL0, RDL1 & RDL2 registers is held during out of
SLC-96 synchronization state.
Switch Line Carrier - 96 (SLC-96) Format (T1 only)
3.8.1.4 Interrupt Summary
In SLC-96 format, only one kind of error is detected:
• F Bit Error: The Ft bit in each odd frame and the Fs bit in Frame
(2n) (0<n<12 and n=36) is compared with the expected one (refer
to Table 15). Each unmatched bit leads to a F-bit error event. This
error event is captured by the FERI bit and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
The interrupt sources in this block are summarized in Table 16.
When there are conditions meeting the interrupt sources, the corresponding Status bit will be asserted high. When there is a transition
(from ‘1’ to ‘0’ or from ‘0’ to ‘1’) on the Status bit, the corresponding
Status Interrupt Indication bit will be set to ‘1’ (If the Status bit does not
exist, the source will cause its Status Interrupt Indication bit to ‘1’
directly) and the Status Interrupt Indication bit will be cleared by writing
‘1’. A ‘1’ in the Status Interrupt Indication bit indicates an interrupt
occurred. The interrupt is reported by the INT pin if its Status Interrupt
Enable bit was set to ‘1’.
Each unmatched Ft bit in the odd frame and each unmatched Fs bit
in Frame (2n) (0<n<12 and n=36) are also counted separately. When the
number of either of them exceeds the ratio set in the M2O[1:0] bits, it is
out of synchronization. Then if the REFEN bit is ‘1’, the Frame
Processor will start to search for synchronization again. If the REFEN bit
is ‘0’, no error can lead to reframe except for manually setting. The
Functional Description
39
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 16: Interrupt Source In T1/J1 Frame Processor
Status Bit
Interrupt Indication
Bit
Interrupt Enable
Bit
OOFV
OOFI
OOFE
The first bit of each SF / ESF / T1 DM / SLC-96 frame is received.
-
RMFBI
RMFBE
The new-found F bit position differs from the previous one.
-
COFAI
COFAE
In SF / T1 DM / SLC-96 format, the F Bit Error occurs.
In ESF format, the Frame Alignment Bit Error occurs.
-
FERI
FERE
In ESF format, the CRC-6 Error occurs.
(This interrupt does not exist in other formats.)
-
BEEI
BEEE
In SF / T1 DM format, the Severely Ft Bit Error occurs.
In ESF format, the Severely Frame Alignment Bit Error occurs.
(This interrupt does not exist in SLC-96 format.)
-
SFEI
SFEE
In SLC-96 format, the Concentrator bits differ from the previous ones.
-
SCCI
SCCE
In SLC-96 format, the Maintenance bits differ from the previous ones.
-
SCMI
SCME
In SLC-96 format, the Alarm bits differ from the previous ones.
-
SCAI
SCAE
In SLC-96 format, the Switch bits differ from the previous ones.
-
SCSI
SCSE
Sources
It is out of synchronization.
Table 17: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.8.1
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
FRMR Mode 0
04D, 14D, 24D, 34D, 44D, 54D, 64D, 74D
FRMR Mode 1
04E, 14E, 24E, 34E, 44E, 54E, 64E, 74E
FRMR Status
04F, 14F, 24F, 34F, 44F, 54F, 64F, 74F
FRMR Interrupt Indication 0
052, 152, 252, 352, 452, 552, 652, 752
FRMR Interrupt Indication 1
053, 153, 253, 353, 453, 553, 653, 753
FRMR Interrupt Control 0
050, 150, 250, 350, 450, 550, 650, 750
UNFM
REFEN
REFR
REFCRCE
MIMICC
M2O[1:0]
DDSC
OOFV
MIMICI
EXCRCERI
OOFI
RMFBI
SFEI
BEEI
FERI
COFAI
OOFE
Functional Description
40
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 17: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.8.1 (Continued)
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
FRMR Interrupt Control 1
051, 151, 251, 351, 451, 551, 651, 751
C[11:1]
RDL1 & RDL0
057, 157, 257, 357, 457, 557, 657, 757 & 056,
156, 256, 356, 456, 556, 656, 756
M[3:1]
RDL1
057, 157, 257, 357, 457, 557, 657, 757
RDL2
058, 158, 258, 358, 458, 558, 658, 758
DLB Interrupt Indication
05D, 15D, 25D, 35D, 45D, 55D, 65D, 75D
DLB Interrupt Control
05C, 15C, 25C, 35C, 45C, 55C, 65C, 75C
RMFBE
SFEE
BEEE
FERE
COFAE
A[2:1]
S[4:1]
SCAI
SCSI
SCMI
SCCI
SCDEB
SCAE
SCSE
SCME
SCCE
Functional Description
41
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.8.2
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 MODE
frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame), and stores these data in registers.
The CRC Sub Multi-Frame alignment 4 bit codeword in the National bit
positions Sa4 to Sa8 can also be extracted and stored in registers, and
updated every CRC Sub Multi-Frame.
In E1 mode, the Frame Processor searches for Basic Frame
synchronization, CRC Multi-frame synchronization, and Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-frame synchronization in the received data
stream. Figure 11 shows the searching process.
The Framer Processor identifies the Remote Alarm bit (bit 3 of TS0
of NFAS frames) and Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm (bit 6 of
TS16 of the frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame). The ‘de-bounced’
Remote Alarm and Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm can be indicated if the corresponding bit has been a certain logic for 1 or 4 consecutive times. The AIS (Alarm Indication Signal) Alarm can also be
detected. The Frame Processor can also declare a Red Alarm if the outof-frame condition has persisted for at least 100 ms.
Once the frame is synchronized, the Frame Processor keeps on
monitoring the received data stream. If there are any framing bit errors,
CAS Multi-Frame alignment pattern errors, CRC Multi-Frame alignment
pattern errors or CRC errors, the Frame Processor will indicate these
errors. The status of loss of frame, loss of Signaling Multi-Frame and
loss of CRC Multi-Frame can also be detected and declared based on
user-selectable criteria. A software reset can also make the Frame
Processor reframe.
An interrupt output is provided to indicate status changes and the
occurrence of some events. The interrupts may be generated every
Basic Frame, CRC Sub Multi-Frame, CRC Multi-Frame or Signaling
Multi-Frame.
The Frame Processor can extract the data stream in TS16, and
output the extracted data on a separate pin. The Frame Processor also
extracts the contents of the International bits (from both the FAS and the
NFAS frames), the National bits and the Extra bits (from TS16 in the
Functional Description
The Frame Processor can also be bypassed by setting the UNFM bit.
42
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Out of sync.
OOFV = 1, OOCMFV = 1,
OOSMFV = 1, OOOFV = 0
search for Basic Fframe alignment pattern
(refer to Basic Frame)
find FAS in
Nth frame
No (N=N+1)
Yes
3 consecutive FAS or NFAS
errors (criteria selected by the
BIT2C) or manually re-frame
find NFAS in
(N+1)th frame
No (skip one
frame, N=N+3)
Yes
find FAS in
(N+2)th frame
Yes
No (N=N+3)
Basic Frame sync. acquired
OOFV = 0
Start to check FAS errors
> 914
CRC
search for CRC Multi-Frame
errors in
alignment pattern if CRCEN =
one
1 (refer to CRC Multi-Frame)
second
search for Signaling Multi-Frame
alignment if CASEN = 1 (refer to
Signaling Multi-Frame)
Start 8ms and
400ms timer
find Signaling
Multi-Frame alignment
pattern
No
find 2 CRC Multi-Frame
alignment patterns within 8ms, with the
interval time of each pattern being a
multiple of 2ms
Yes
No, and
8ms
expired
Lock the Sync. Position
Start Offline Frame
search OOOFV = 1
find FAS in
nth frame
No (n = n+1)
Yes
CRC Multi-Frame sync.
acquired; Start CRC and
E-bits processing;
OOCMFV = 0, OOFV = 0 CRC
to CRC interworking
find NFAS in
(n+1)th frame
No (skip one
frame, n=n+3)
Yes
Yes
Signaling
Multi-Frame sync.
acquired
check for out
of Signaling Multi-Frame
Sync conditions which criteria
are set in the SMFASC
& TS16C
No
Yes
find FAS in
th
(n+2) frame
Yes
No (n=n+3)
Basic Frame sync. acquired
OOOFV = 0
Start 8ms timer
No, and
8ms
expired
find 2 CRC Multi-Frame
alignment patterns within 8ms, with the
interval time of each pattern being a
multiple of 2ms
Yes
No, and 400ms
expired with
basic frame sync.
C2NCIWV = 1
CRC to non-CRC
interworking
Stop CRC processing if
C2NCIWCK = 0
Figure 11. E1 Frame Searching Process
Functional Description
43
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.8.2.1 Synchronization Searching
Basic Frame
STEP1: Search
for 7-bit Frame Alignment
Sequence (FAS) (X0011011)
th
in the N frame
The algorithm used to search for the E1 Basic Frame alignment
pattern (as shown in Figure 12) meets the ITU-T Recommendation
G.706 4.1.2 and 4.2.
Generally, it is performed by detecting a successive FAS/NFAS/FAS
sequence. If STEP 2 is not met, a new searching will start after the
following frame is skipped. If STEP 3 is not met, a new searching will
start immediately in the next frame. Once the Basic Frame alignment
pattern is detected in the received PCM data stream, the Basic Frame
synchronization is found and the OOFV bit will be set to ‘0’ for indication.
No (skip
one frame,
N=N+3)
No (N=N+1)
Yes
STEP 2: Find logic 1 in the
2nd bit of TS0 of the (N+1)th frame to ensure
that this is a non-frame alignment
sequence (NFAS)
Yes
STEP 3: Search for
the correct 7-bit FAS (X0011011)
th
in the TS0 in the (N+2)
frame
No
(N=N+3)
Yes
Basic Frame
Synchronization Found
Figure 12. Basic Frame Searching Process
Functional Description
44
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
CRC Multi-Frame
The first bit of TS0 of each frame is called the International (Si) bit.
The Si bit in each even frame is the CRC bit. Thus, there are C1, C2,
C3, C4 in each SMF. The C1 is the most significant bit, while the C4 is
the least significant bit. The Si bit in the first six odd frames is the CRC
Multi-Frame alignment pattern. Its pattern is ‘001011’. The Si bit in
Frame 13 and Frame 15 are E1 and E2 bits. The value of the E bits can
indicate the Far End Block Errors (FEBE).
The CRC Multi-Frame is provided to enhance the ability of verifying
the data stream. The structure of TS0 of the CRC Multi-Frame is illustrated in Table 18.
A CRC Multi-Frame consists of 16 continuous Basic Frames (No. 0 –
15) which are numbered from a Basic Frame with FAS. Each CRC MultiFrame can be divided into two Sub Multi-Frames (SMF I & SMF II).
Table 18: The Structure Of TS0 In CRC Multi-Frame
SMF
Basic Frame
No. / Type
the Eight Bits in Timeslot 0
1 (Si bit)
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
0 / FAS
C1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1 / NFAS
0
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
2 / FAS
C2
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
3 / NFAS
0
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
4 / FAS
C3
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
5 / NFAS
1
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
6 / FAS
C4
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
CRC-4
7 / NFAS
0
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
Multi-Frame
8 / FAS
C1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
9 / NFAS
1
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
10 / FAS
C2
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
11 / NFAS
1
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
12 / FAS
C3
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
13 / NFAS
E1
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
14 / FAS
C4
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
15 / NFAS
E2
1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
SMF I
SMF II
After the Basic Frame has been synchronized, the Frame Processor
initiates an 8 and a 400 ms timer to check the CRC Multi-Frame alignment signal if the CRCEN bit is ‘1’. The CRC Multi-Frame synchronization is declared with a ‘0’ in the OOCMFV bit only if at least two CRC
Multi-Frame alignment patterns are found within 8 ms, with the interval
time of each pattern being a multiple of 2 ms. Then if the received CRC
Multi-Frame alignment signal does not meet its pattern, it will be indicated by the CMFERI bit.
operation searches in parallel with the pre-found Basic Frame synchronization searching process. After the new Basic Frame synchronization
is found by this offline search, the 8 ms timer is restarted to check
whether the two CRC Multi-Frame alignment patterns are found within 8
ms, with the interval time of each pattern being a multiple of 2 ms again.
If the condition can not be met, the procedure will go on until the 400 ms
timer ends. If the condition still can not be met at that time and the Basic
Frame is still synchronized, the device declares by the C2NCIWV bit to
run under the CRC to non-CRC interworking process. In this process,
the CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern can still be searched if the
C2NCIWCK bit is logic 1.
If the 2 CRC Multi-Frame alignment patterns can not be found within
8ms with the interval time being a multiple of 2 ms, an offline search for
the Basic Frame alignment pattern will start which is indicated in the
OOOFV bit. The process is the same as shown in Figure 12. This offline
Functional Description
45
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
CAS Signaling Multi-Frame
After the Basic Frame has been synchronized, the Frame Processor
starts to search for CAS Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signal if the
CASEN bit is ‘1’.
TS16 (Bit 1 - Bit 8)
F0
The Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern is located in the high
nibble (Bit 1 ~ Bit 4) of TS16. Its pattern is ‘0000’. When the pattern is
found in TS16 and the high nibble of the previous TS16 are not all zeros,
the Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization is acquired and it is indicated
with a ‘0’ in the OOSMFV bit. The frame containing the Signaling MultiFrame alignment pattern is Frame 0 of Signaling Multi-Frame. The TS16
structure of the Signaling Multi-Frame is shown in Figure 13. The entire
content in TS16 of Frame 0 of Signaling Multi-Frame is ‘0000XYXX’. ‘Y’
is for remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm indication and ‘X’s are extra
bits. The codeword ‘ABCD’ are the signaling bits for different timeslots.
0
0
0
0
X0
Signaling Multi-Frame
alignment pattern
F1
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
A
B
C
for TS15
X2
B
C
D
for TS17
D
A
B
C
D
for TS18
for TS2
F15
X1
RMAI
Extra Bits
for TS1
F2
Y
D
A
B
C
D
for TS31
Figure 13. TS16 Structure Of CAS Signaling MultiFrame
Functional Description
46
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.8.2.2 Error Event And Out Of Synchronization Detection
secutive seconds, the CFEBEV bit is set, otherwise this bit will be
cleared.
• NT FEBE Error (per ETS 300 233): If the 4-bit Sa6 codeword of a
CRC Sub Multi-Frame is matched with ‘0001’ or ‘0011’, the Network Terminal Far End Block Error event is generated. This error
event is captured by the TFEBEI bit and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
• NT CRC Error (per ETS 300 233): If the 4-bit Sa6 codeword of a
CRC Sub Multi-Frame is matched with ‘0010’ or ‘0011’, the Network Terminal CRC Error event is generated. This error event is
captured by the TCRCEI bit and is forwarded to the Performance
Monitor.
After the frame is in synchronization, the Frame Processor keeps on
monitoring the received data stream to detect errors and judge if it is out
of synchronization.
The following ten kinds of errors are detected:
• FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error: The criteria of this error are determined by the WORDERR bit and the CNTNFAS bit (refer to
Table 19). This error event is captured by the FERI bit and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
Table 19: FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error Criteria
WORDER
R
CNTNFA
S
Error Generation
0
0
Each bit error in FAS is counted as an error event.
1
0
A FAS pattern error is counted as an error event.
0
1
Each bit error in FAS or NFAS error is counted as
an error event.
1
1
A FAS pattern error or NFAS error is counted as an
error event.
Various errors will lead to out of synchronization:
Out Of Basic Frame Synchronization
If there is one or more bit errors in a FAS pattern, a FAS pattern error
will occur. If the NFAS bit position is received as zero, a NFAS error will
occur. Determined by the BIT2C bit, if this bit is ‘0’, 3 consecutive FAS
pattern errors lead to out of Basic frame synchronization; if this bit is ‘1’,
3 consecutive FAS pattern errors or 3 consecutive NFAS errors lead to
out of Basic frame synchronization. Then if the REFEN bit is ‘1’, the
Frame Processor will start to search for synchronization again. Additionally, Excessive CRC-4 Error also leads to out of Basic frame synchronization. In this condition, both the REFEN bit being ‘1’ and the REFCRCE
bit being ‘1’ will allow the Frame Processor to search for synchronization
again. If the REFEN bit is ‘0’, no error can lead to reframe except for
manually setting. The manual reframe searches from Basic frame and is
executed by a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the REFR bit. During out of
Basic frame synchronization state, the FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error
detection is suspended.
• CRC Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error: The received CRC
Multi-Frame alignment signals are compared with the expected
ones (‘001011’). When one or more bits do not match, a single
CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern error event is generated. This
error event is captured by the CMFERI bit.
• CRC-4 Error: When the local calculated CRC-4 of the current
received CRC Sub Multi-Frame does not match the received CRC4 of the next received CRC Sub Multi-Frame, a single CRC-4 error
event is generated. This error event is captured by the CRCEI bit
and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
• Excessive CRC-4 Error: Once the accumulated CRC-4 errors are
not less than 915 occasions (915 is included) in a 1 second fixed
window, an excessive CRC-4 error event is generated. This error
event is captured by the EXCRCERI bit.
• CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error: The received
Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signals are compared with the
expected ones (‘0000’). When one or more bits do not match, a
single CAS Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern error event is
generated. This error event is captured by the SMFERI bit.
• Far End Block Error (FEBE): When any of the CRC error indication
(E1 or E2) bits is received as a logic 0, a far end block error event
is generated. This error event is captured by the FEBEI bit and is
forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
• Continuous RAI & FEBE Error: When a logic 1 is received in the A
bit and a logic 0 is received in any of the E1 or E2 bit for 10 ms, the
RAICRCV bit is set. This bit is cleared if any of the conditions is not
met.
• Continuous FEBE Error: When a logic 0 is received in any of the
E1 or E2 bits on ≥ 990 occasions per second for the latest 5 con-
Functional Description
Once resynchronized, if the new-found Basic frame alignment
pattern position differs from the previous one, the change of frame alignment event is generated. This event is captured by the COFAI bit and is
forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
Out Of CRC Multi-Frame Synchronization
The conditions introducing out of Basic frame synchronization will
also cause out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization. During out of CRC
Multi-Frame synchronization state, the FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error
detection, CRC Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error detection, CRC-4
Error detection, Excessive CRC-4 Error detection, Far End Block Error
detection, Continuous RAI & FEBE Error detection, Continuous FEBE
Error detection, NT CRC Error detection and NT FEBE Error detection
are suspended.
Out Of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Synchronization
The conditions introducing out of Basic frame synchronization will
also cause out of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization.
In addition, determined by the SMFASC bit and the TS16C bit, if the
CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error occurs or all the
contents in TS16 are zeros, it is out of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame
synchronization. Then no matter what the value in the REFEN bit is, the
Frame Processor will search for the CAS Signaling Multi-Frame
47
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
synchronization again only if the Basic frame is in synchronization.
During out of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization state, the CAS
Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error detection is suspended.
Extra Bit Extraction
The Extra bits (X bits, refer to Figure 13) are extracted to the X[0:2]
bits in the TS16 Spare register. The X[0:2] bits in the TS16 Spare
register are updated at the first bit of the next CAS Signaling MultiFrame and are held during out of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame state.
3.8.2.3 Overhead Extraction
International Bit Extraction
Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication Bit Extraction
The International bits (Si bits, refer to Table 18) are extracted to the
Si[0:1] bits in the TS0 International / National register. The Si[0:1] bits in
the TS0 International / National register are updated on the boundary of
the associated FAS/NFAS frame and are held during out of Basic frame
state.
The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication bit (Y bit, refer to
Figure 13) are extracted to the Y bit in the TS16 Spare register. The Y bit
in the TS16 Spare register is updated at the first bit of the next CAS
Signaling Multi-Frame and is held during out of CAS Signaling MultiFrame state.
Remote Alarm Indication Bit Extraction
Sa6 Code Detection Per ETS 300 233
The Remote Alarm Indication bit (A bit, refer to Table 18) is extracted
to the A bit in the TS0 International / National register. The A bit in the
TS0 International / National register is updated on the boundary of the
associated NFAS frame and is held during out of Basic frame state.
When Basic frame is synchronized, any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits
(MSB is the first received bit) are compared with 0x888, 0xAAA, 0xCCC,
0xEEE and 0xFFF. When CRC Multi-Frame is synchronized, any 3
consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are
compared if the Sa6SYN bit is ‘1’. If a matched code is detected, the
corresponding indication bit in the Sa6 Code Indication register will be
set.
National Bit Extraction
The National bits (Sa bits, refer to Table 18) are extracted to the
Sa[4:8] bits in the TS0 International / National register. The Sa[4:8] bits
in the TS0 International / National register are updated on the boundary
of the associated NFAS frame and are held during out of Basic frame.
3.8.2.4 V5.2 Link
The V5.2 link ID signal, i.e., 2 out of 3 sliding Sa7 bits being logic 0, is
detected with the indication in the V52LINKV bit. This detection is
disabled when the Basic Frame is out of synchronization.
National Bit Codeword Extraction
The five sets of the National Bit codewords (Sa4[1:4] to Sa8[1:4] in
the CRC Sub Multi-Frame, refer to Table 18) are extracted to the corresponding SaX Codeword register. Here the ‘X’ is from 4 through 8. The
National Bit codeword extraction will be set to de-bounce if the SaDEB
bit is set to ‘1’. Thus, the SaX Codeword registers are updated if the
received National Bit codeword is the same for 2 consecutive CRC Sub
Multi-Frames. Whether de-bounced or not, a change indication will be
set in the SaXI bit (‘X’ is from 4 through 8) if the corresponding codeword
in the SaX Codeword register differs from the previous one.
3.8.2.5 Interrupt Summary
The interrupt sources in this block are summarized in Table 20.
When there are conditions meeting the interrupt sources, the corresponding Status bit will be asserted high. When there is a transition
(from ‘1’ to ‘0’ or from ‘0’ to ‘1’) on the Status bit, the corresponding
Status Interrupt Indication bit will be set to ‘1’ (If the Status bit does not
exist, the source will cause its Status Interrupt Indication bit to ‘1’
directly) and the Status Interrupt Indication bit will be cleared by a write
signal. A ‘1’ in the Status Interrupt Indication bit means an interrupt
occurred. The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if its Status Interrupt Enable bit is ‘1’.
The value in the SaX Codeword registers is held during out of CRC
Multi-Frame synchronization state.
Functional Description
48
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 20: Interrupt Source In E1 Frame Processor
Sources
Status Bit
Interrupt Indication Bit
Interrupt Enable Bit
C2NCIWV
C2NCIWI
C2NCIWE
OOFV
OOFI
OOFE
It is out of CRC multi-frame synchronization.
OOCMFV
OOCMFI
OOCMFE
It is out of CAS Signaling multi-frame synchronization.
OOSMFV
OOSMFI
OOSMFE
The new-found Basic frame alignment pattern position differs from the previous one.
-
COFAI
COFAE
FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error occurs.
-
FERI
FERE
CRC Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error occurs.
-
CMFERI
CMFERE
CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error occurs.
-
SMFERI
SMFERE
CRC-4 Error occurs.
-
CRCEI
CRCEE
OOOFV
OOOFI
OOOFE
-
FEBEI
FEBEE
Continuous RAI & FEBE Error occurs.
RAICRCV
RAICRCI
RAICRCE
Continuous FEBE Error occurs.
CFEBEV
CFEBEI
CFEBEE
At the first bit of each CRC Multi-Frame.
-
ICMFPI
ICMFPE
At the first bit of each CRC Sub Multi-Frame.
-
ICSMFPI
ICSMFPE
At the first bit of each CAS Signaling Multi-Frame.
-
ISMFPI
ISMFPE
There is change in the corresponding SaX[1:4] bits. The ‘X’ is from 4 through 8.
-
Sa4I / Sa5I / Sa6I / Sa7I
/ Sa8I
Sa4E / Sa5E / Sa6E /
Sa7E / Sa8E
Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords are matched
with 0x888, 0xAAA, 0xCCC, 0xEEE or 0xFFF.
-
Sa6SCI
Sa6SCE
NT FEBE Error occurs.
-
TFEBEI
TFEBEE
NT CRC Error occurs.
-
TCRCEI
TCRCEE
V52LINKV
V52LINKI
V52LINKE
In CRC to Non-CRC inter-working.
It is out of Basic frame synchronization.
Offline Basic frame search indication.
Far End Block Error occurs.
2 out of 3 sliding Sa7 bits are received as logic 0.
Functional Description
49
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 21: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.8.2
Bit
Register
E1 Address (Hex)
FRMR Mode 0
04D, 14D, 24D, 34D, 44D, 54D, 64D, 74D
FRMR Mode 1
04E, 14E, 24E, 34E, 44E, 54E, 64E, 74E
FRMR Status
04F, 14F, 24F, 34F, 44F, 54F, 64F, 74F
FRMR Interrupt Indication 0
052, 152, 252, 352, 452, 552, 652, 752
FRMR Interrupt Control 0
050, 150, 250, 350, 450, 550, 650, 750
UNFM
REFEN
REFCRCE
REFR
CRCEN
C2NCIWCK
CASEN
WORDERR
CNTNFAS
BIT2C
SMFASC
TS16C
OOFV
OOCMFV
OOOFV
C2NCIWV
OOSMFV
EXCRCERI
C2NCIWI
OOFI
OOCMFI
OOSMFI
OOOFI
OOFE
OOCMFE
OOOFE
C2NCIWE
OOSMFE
Functional Description
50
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 21: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.8.2 (Continued)
Bit
Register
E1 Address (Hex)
FRMR Interrupt Indication 1
053, 153, 253, 353, 453, 553, 653, 753
FRMR Interrupt Control 1
051, 151, 251, 351, 451, 551, 651, 751
Overhead Error Status
05F, 15F, 25F, 35F, 45F, 55F, 65F, 75F
Overhead Interrupt Indication
061, 161, 261, 361, 461, 561, 661, 761
CMFERI
FERI
CRCEI
SMFERI
COFAI
ICMFPI
ICSMFPI
ISMFPI
CMFERE
FERE
CRCEE
SMFERE
COFAE
ICMFPE
ICSMFPE
ISMFPE
RAICRCV
CFEBEV
V52LINKV
FEBEI
TFEBEI
TCRCEI
RAICRCI
CFEBEI
V52LINKI
Functional Description
51
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 21: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.8.2 (Continued)
Bit
Register
E1 Address (Hex)
Overhead Interrupt Control
060, 160, 260, 360, 460, 560, 660, 760
TS0 International / National
054, 154, 254, 354, 454, 554, 654, 754
TS16 Spare
055, 155, 255, 355, 455, 555, 655, 755
Sa4 Codeword ~ Sa8 Codeword
056 ~ 05A, 156 ~ 15A, 256 ~ 25A, 356 ~ 35A, 456 ~
45A, 556 ~ 55A, 656 ~ 65A, 756 ~ 75A
Sa Codeword Interrupt Indication
05D, 15D, 25D, 35D, 45D, 55D, 65D, 75D
Sa Codeword Interrupt Control
05C, 15C, 25C, 35C, 45C, 55C, 65C, 75C
Sa6 Codeword Indication
05B, 15B, 25B, 35B, 45B, 55B, 65B, 75B
FEBEE
TFEBEE
TCRCEE
RAICRCE
CFEBEE
V52LINKE
Si[0:1]
A
Sa[4:8]
X[0:2]
Y
SaX[1:4] (‘X’ is from 4 to 8)
SaXI (‘X’ is from 4 to 8)
Sa6SCI
SaXE (‘X’ is from 4 to 8)
SaDEB
Sa6SYN
Sa6SCE
Sa6-8I
Sa6-AI
Sa6-CI
Sa6-EI
Sa6-FI
Functional Description
52
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.9
PERFORMANCE MONITOR
3.9.1
T1/J1 MODE
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
• Manual-Update: Content in the internal counters is transfered to
indirect registers when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the
UPDAT bit, no matter whether the AUTOUPD bit is ‘1’ or ‘0’.
Several internal counters are used to count different events for
performance monitoring. For different framing format, the counters are
used differently. The overflow of each counter is reflected by an Overflow Indication Bit, and can trigger an interrupt if the corresponding
Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit is set. This is shown in Table 22.
All the internal counters will be resetted after the update and will start
a new round of counting. No error event is lost during the update.
The indirect registers are addressed by the LINKSEL[2:0] and
ADDR[3:0] bits. The LINKSEL[2:0] bits select the link and the ADDR[3:0]
bits select the specific PMON indirect register. Data read from the indirect register is held in the DAT[7:0] bits.
The internal counters can be updated in two ways:
• Auto-Update: Content in the internal counters is transfered to indirect registers every one second automatically if the AUTOUPD bit
is ‘1’;
Functional Description
53
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 22: Monitored Events In T1/J1 Mode
Format
SF
Event
Counter
Overflow Interrupt Indication Bit
Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or B8ZS
Code Violation (CV) Error (in B8ZS decoding)
LCV[15:0]
LCVOVI
LCVOVE
F Bit Error
FER[11:0]
FEROVI
FEROVE
The new-found F bit position differs from the previous one
COFA[2:0]
COFAOVI
COFAOVE
Out of SF synchronization
OOF[4:0]
OOFOVI
OOFOVE
PRGD[15:0]
PRGDOVI
PRGDOVE
Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or B8ZS
Code Violation (CV) Error (in B8ZS decoding)
LCV[15:0]
LCVOVI
LCVOVE
Frame Alignment Bit Error
FER[11:0]
FEROVI
FEROVE
CRC-6 Error
CRCE[9:0]
CRCOVI
CRCOVE
The new-found F bit position differs from the previous one
COFA[2:0]
COFAOVI
COFAOVE
Out of ESF synchronization
OOF[4:0]
OOFOVI
OOFOVE
PRGD[15:0]
PRGDOVI
PRGDOVE
Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or B8ZS
Code Violation (CV) Error (in B8ZS decoding)
LCV[15:0]
LCVOVI
LCVOVE
F Bit Error
FER[11:0]
FEROVI
FEROVE
DDS Pattern Error
DDSE[9:0]
DDSOVI
DDSOVE
The new-found F bit position differs from the previous one
COFA[2:0]
COFAOVI
COFAOVE
Out of T1 DM synchronization
OOF[4:0]
OOFOVI
OOFOVE
PRGD[15:0]
PRGDOVI
PRGDOVE
Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or B8ZS
Code Violation (CV) Error (in B8ZS decoding)
LCV[15:0]
LCVOVI
LCVOVE
F Bit Error
FER[11:0]
FEROVI
FEROVE
The new-found F bit position differs from the previous one
COFA[2:0]
COFAOVI
COFAOVE
Out of SLC-96 synchronization
OOF[4:0]
OOFOVI
OOFOVE
PRGD[15:0]
PRGDOVI
PRGDOVE
PRGD Bit Error
ESF
PRGD Bit Error
T1 DM
(T1 only)
PRGD Bit Error
SLC-96
(T1 only)
PRGD Bit Error
Functional Description
54
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 23: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.9.1
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
LCV[15:0]
ID* - LCV Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 09 & 08
FER[11:0]
ID - FER Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 03 & 02
COFA[2:0]
ID - COFA Counter Mapping
PMON ID - 04
OOF[4:0]
ID - OOF Counter Mapping
PMON ID - 05
PRGD[15:0]
ID - PRGD Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 07 & 06
CRCE[9:0]
ID - CRCE Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 01 & 00
DDSE[9:0]
ID - DDSE Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 0B & 0A
LCVOVI
PMON Interrupt 1
0C6, 1C6, 2C6, 3C6, 4C6, 5C6, 6C6, 7C6
PMON Interrupt 0
0C5, 1C5, 2C5, 3C5, 4C5, 5C5, 6C5, 7C5
PMON Interrupt Control 1
0C4, 1C4, 2C4, 3C4, 4C4, 5C4, 6C4, 7C4
PMON Interrupt Control 0
0C3, 1C3, 2C3, 3C3, 4C3, 5C3, 6C3, 7C3
PMON Access Port
00E
PMON Access Data
00F
PMON Control
0C2, 1C2, 2C2, 3C2, 4C2, 5C2, 6C2, 7C2
FEROVI
COFAOVI
OOFOVI
PRGDOVI
CRCOVI
DDSOVI
LCVOVE
FEROVE
COFAOVE
OOFOVE
PRGDOVE
CRCOVE
DDSOVE
LINKSEL[2:0]
ADDR[3:0]
DAT[7:0]
UPDAT
AUTOUPD
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Performance Monitor function block.
Functional Description
55
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.9.2
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 MODE
• Manual-Update: Content in the internal counters is transfered to
indirect registers when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the
UPDAT bit, no matter whether the AUTOUPD bit is ‘1’ or ‘0’.
Several internal counters are used to count different events for
performance monitoring. The overflow of each counter is reflected by an
Overflow Indication Bit, and can trigger an interrupt if the corresponding
Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit is set. This is shown in Table 24.
All the internal counters will be resetted after the update and will start
a new round of counting. No error event is lost during the update.
The internal counters can be updated in two ways:
• Auto-Update: Content in the internal counters is transfered to indirect registers every one second automatically if the AUTOUPD bit
is ‘1’;
The indirect registers are addressed by the LINKSEL[2:0] and
ADDR[3:0] bits. The LINKSEL[2:0] bits select the link and the ADDR[3:0]
bits select the specific PMON indirect register. Data read from the indirect register is held in the DAT[7:0] bits.
Table 24: Monitored Events In E1 Mode
Event
Counter
Overflow
Interrupt
Indication Bit
Overflow
Interrupt Enable
Bit
Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or HDB3 Code Violation (CV) Error (in HDB3 decoding)
LCV[15:0]
LCVOVI
LCVOVE
FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error
FER[11:0]
FEROVI
FEROVE
CRC-4 Error
CRCE[9:0]
CRCOVI
CRCOVE
Far End Block Error
FEBE[9:0]
FEBEOVI
FEBEOVE
The the new-found Basic frame alignment pattern position differs from the previous one
COFA[2:0]
COFAOVI
COFAOVE
Out of Basic frame synchronization
OOF[4:0]
OOFOVI
OOFOVE
PRGD Bit Error
PRGD[15:0]
PRGDOVI
PRGDOVE
NT FEBE Error
TFEBE[9:0]
TFEBEOVI
TFEBEOVE
NT CRC Error
TCRCE[9:0]
TCRCOVI
TCRCOVE
Functional Description
56
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 25: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.9.2
Bit
Register
E1 Address (Hex)
LCV[15:0]
ID* - LCV Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 09 & 08
FER[11:0]
ID - FER Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 03 & 02
CRCE[9:0]
ID - CRCE Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 01 & 00
FEBE[9:0]
ID - FEBE Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 0D & 0C
COFA[2:0]
ID - COFA Counter Mapping
PMON ID - 04
OOF[4:0]
ID - OOF Counter Mapping
PMON ID - 05
PRGD[15:0]
ID - PRGD Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 07 & 06
TFEBE[9:0]
ID - TFEBE Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 0F & 0E
TCRCE[9:0]
ID - TCRCE Counter Mapping 1 & 0
PMON ID - 0B & 0A
LCVOVI
PMON Interrupt 1
0C6, 1C6, 2C6, 3C6, 4C6, 5C6, 6C6, 7C6
PMON Interrupt 0
0C5, 1C5, 2C5, 3C5, 4C5, 5C5, 6C5, 7C5
PMON Interrupt Control 1
0C4, 1C4, 2C4, 3C4, 4C4, 5C4, 6C4, 7C4
PMON Interrupt Control 0
0C3, 1C3, 2C3, 3C3, 4C3, 5C3, 6C3, 7C3
PMON Access Port
00E
PMON Access Data
00F
PMON Control
0C2, 1C2, 2C2, 3C2, 4C2, 5C2, 6C2, 7C2
FEROVI
CRCOVI
FEBEOVI
COFAOVI
OOFOVI
PRGDOVI
TFEBEOVI
TCRCOVI
LCVOVE
FEROVE
CRCOVE
FEBEOVE
COFAOVE
OOFOVE
PRGDOVE
TFEBEOVE
TCRCOVE
LINKSEL[2:0]
ADDR[3:0]
DAT[7:0]
UPDAT
AUTOUPD
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Performance Monitor function block.
Functional Description
57
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.10 ALARM DETECTOR
The status of the RED alarm, Yellow alarm and Blue alarm are indicated by the corresponding Status bit. Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or
from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the Status bit will set the corresponding Interrupt Indication bit to ‘1’ and the Interrupt Indication bit will be cleared by writing a
‘1’. A ‘1’ in the Interrupt Indication bit means there is an interrupt. The
interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if its Interrupt Enable bit is ‘1’.
3.10.1 T1/J1 MODE
The RED alarm, Yellow alarm and Blue alarm are detected in this
block (refer to Table 26).
Table 26: RED Alarm, Yellow Alarm & Blue Alarm Criteria
Status
Bit
Interrupt Indication
Bit
Interrupt Enable
Bit
The in SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 synchronization status persists Mx120 ms.
Here ‘M’ is decided by the
REDCTH[7:0] bits.
RED
REDI
REDE
Less than 77 ’One’s are detected on the
T1 SF/
Bit 2 of each channel during a 40 ms fixed
SLCwindow and this status persists for Nx40
96
ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the
Format
YELDTH[7:0] bits.
More than 76 ’One’s are detected on
the Bit 2 of each channel during a 40
ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40 ms. Here ‘M’ is decided
by the YELCTH[7:0] bits.
YEL
YELI
YELE
More than 7 ‘0xFF00’ (MSB first) are
detected on the DL bits during a 40 ms
T1 ESF
fixed window and this status persists for
Format
Nx40 ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the
YELDTH[7:0] bits.
Less than 8 ‘0xFF00’ (MSB first) are
detected on the DL bits during a 40 ms
fixed window and this status persists
for Mx40 ms. Here ‘M’ is decided by
the YELCTH[7:0] bits.
YEL
YELI
YELE
Less than 4 ’One’s are detected on the Y
bit (Bit 6 in each CH 24) during a 40 ms
T1 DM
fixed window and this status persists for
Format
Nx40 ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the
Alarm*
YELDTH[7:0] bits.
More than 3 ’One’s are detected on the
Y bit (Bit 6 in each CH 24) during a 40
ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40 ms. Here ‘M’ is decided
by the YELCTH[7:0] bits.
YEL
YELI
YELE
Less than 4 zeros are detected on the Fbit of the 12nd frame during a 40 ms fixed
J1 SF
window and this status persists for Nx40
Format
ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the
YELDTH[7:0] bits.
More than 3 zeros are detected on the
F-bit of the 12nd frame during a 40 ms
fixed window and this status persists
for Mx40 ms. Here ‘M’ is decided by
the YELCTH[7:0] bits.
YEL
YELI
YELE
Less than 3 zeros are detected on the DL
bits during a 40 ms fixed window and this
J1 ESF
status persists for Nx40 ms. Here ‘N’ is
Format
decided by the YELDTH[7:0] bits.
More than 2 zeros are detected on the
DL bits during a 40 ms fixed window
and this status persists for Mx40 ms.
Here ‘M’ is decided by the
YELCTH[7:0] bits.
YEL
YELI
YELE
Less than 61 zeros are detected in a 40
ms fixed window and this status persists
for Nx40 ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the
AISDTH[7:0] bits.
More than 60 zeros are detected in a
40 ms fixed window and this status
persists for Mx40 ms. Here ‘M’ is
decided by the AISCTH[7:0] bits.
AIS
AISI
AISE
RED Alarm
(per T1.403,
T1.231)
Declare Condition
Clear Condition
The out of SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 synchronization status persists Nx40 ms.
Here ‘N’ is decided by the REDDTH[7:0]
bits.
Yellow
Blue Alarm
(per T1.231)
Note: * The Yellow Alarm can only be detected when the frame is synchronized.
Functional Description
58
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 27: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.10.1
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
REDDTH[7:0]
RED Declare Threshold
0BC, 1BC, 2BC, 3BC, 4BC, 5BC, 6BC, 7BC
REDCTH[7:0]
RED Clear Threshold
0BD, 1BD, 2BD, 3BD, 4BD, 5BD, 6BD, 7BD
YELDTH[7:0]
Yellow Declare Threshold
0BE,1BE, 2BE, 3BE, 4BE, 5BE, 6BE, 7BE
YELCTH[7:0]
Yellow Clear Threshold
0BF, 1BF, 2BF, 3BF, 4BF, 5BF, 6BF, 7BF
AISDTH[7:0]
AIS Declare Threshold
0C0, 1C0, 2C0, 3C0, 4C0, 5C0, 6C0, 7C0
AISCTH[7:0]
AIS Clear Threshold
0C1, 1C1, 2C1, 3C1, 4C1, 5C1, 6C1, 7C1
Alarm Status
0B9, 1B9, 2B9, 3B9, 4B9, 5B9, 6B9, 7B9
Alarm Indication
0BB, 1BB, 2BB, 3BB, 4BB, 5BB, 6BB, 7BB
Alarm Control
0BA, 1BA, 2BA, 3BA, 4BA, 5BA, 6BA, 7BA
RED
YEL
AIS
REDI
YELI
AISI
REDE
YELE
AISE
Functional Description
59
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.10.2 E1 MODE
The AIS in TS16 is detected on the base of Basic frame synchronization. The AIS in TS16 will be declared when TS16 contains less than 4
zeros in each of two 16-consecutive-Basic-frame periods. The AIS in
TS16 will be cleared when TS16 contains more than 3 zeros in a 16consecutive-Basic-frame period. The AIS in TS16 status is reflected by
the TS16AISV bit. Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the
TS16AISV bit will set the TS16AISI bit to ‘1’ and the TS16AISI bit will be
cleared by writing a ‘1’. A ‘1’ in the TS16AISI bit means there is an interrupt. The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if the TS16AISE bit is
‘1’.
The Remote alarm, Remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm, RED
alarm, AIS alarm, AIS in TS16 and LOS in TS16 are detected in this
block.
The Remote Alarm Indication bit is the A bit (refer to Table 18). It is
detected on the base of Basic frame synchronization. The criteria of
Remote alarm detection are defined by the RAIC bit. If the RAIC bit is
‘0’, the Remote alarm will be declared when 4 consecutive A bits are
received as ‘1’, and the Remote alarm will be cleared when a single A bit
is received as ‘0’. If the RAIC bit is ‘1’, the Remote alarm will be declared
when a single A bit is received as ‘1’, and the Remote alarm will be
cleared when a single A bit is received as ‘0’. The Remote alarm status
is reflected by the RAIV bit. Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’)
on the RAIV bit will set the RAII bit to ‘1’ and the RAII bit will be cleared
by writing a ‘1’. A ‘1’ in the RAII bit means there is an interrupt. The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if the RAIE bit is ‘1’.
The LOS in TS16 is detected on the base of Basic frame synchronization. The LOS in TS16 will be declared when 16 consecutive TS16 are
all received as ‘0’. The LOS in TS16 will be cleared when 16 consecutive
TS16 are not all received as ‘0’. The LOS in TS16 status is reflected by
the TS16LOSV bit. Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the
TS16LOSV bit will set the TS16LOSI bit to ‘1’ and the TS16LOSI bit will
be cleared by writing a ‘1’. A ‘1’ in the TS16LOSI bit means there is an
interrupt. The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if the TS16LOSE
bit is ‘1’.
The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication bit is the Y bit
(refer to Figure 13). It is detected on the base of CAS Signaling MultiFrame synchronization. The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm will be
declared when 3 consecutive Y bits are received as ‘1’, and the Remote
Signaling Multi-Frame alarm will be cleared when a single Y bit is
received as ‘0’. The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm status is
reflected by the RMAIV bit. Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’)
on the RMAIV bit will set the RMAII bit to ‘1’ and the RMAII bit will be
cleared by writing a ‘1’. A ‘1’ in the RMAII bit means there is an interrupt.
The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if the RMAIE bit is ‘1’.
Table 28: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.10.2
Bit
RAIC
AISC
Register
E1 Address (Hex)
Alarm Criteria Control
0BC, 1BC, 2BC, 3BC,
4BC, 5BC, 6BC, 7BC
Alarm Status
0B9, 1B9, 2B9, 3B9, 4B9,
5B9, 6B9, 7B9
Alarm Indication
0BB, 1BB, 2BB, 3BB, 4BB,
5BB, 6BB, 7BB
Alarm Control
0BA, 1BA, 2BA, 3BA, 4BA,
5BA, 6BA, 7BA
RAIV
The criteria of RED alarm detection meet I.431. The RED alarm will
be declared when out of Basic frame synchronization persists for 100
ms, and the RED alarm will be cleared when in Basic frame synchronization persists for 100 ms. The RED alarm status is reflected by the
RED bit. Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the RED bit will
set the REDI bit to ‘1’ and the REDI bit will be cleared by writing a ‘1’. A
‘1’ in the REDI bit means there is an interrupt. The interrupt will be
reported by the INT pin if the REDE bit is ‘1’.
RMAIV
RED
AIS
TS16AISV
TS16LOSV
RAII
The AIS alarm is detected whether it is in synchronization or not. The
criteria of AIS alarm are defined by the AISC bit. When the AISC bit is
‘0’, the criteria meet I.431. The AIS alarm will be declared when less
than 3 zeros are detected in a 512-bit fixed window and it is out of Basic
frame synchronization, and the AIS alarm will be cleared when more
than 2 zeros are detected in a 512-bit fixed window. When the AISC bit
is ‘1’, the criteria meet G.775. The AIS alarm will be declared when less
than 3 zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit fixed
windows, and the AIS alarm will be cleared when more than 2 zeros are
detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit fixed windows. The AIS alarm
status is reflected by the AIS bit. Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’
to ‘0’) on the AIS bit will set the AISI bit to ‘1’ and the AISI bit will be
cleared by writing a ‘1’. A ‘1’ in the AISI bit means there is an interrupt.
The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if the AISE bit is ‘1’.
RMAII
REDI
AISI
TS16AISI
TS16LOSI
RAIE
RMAIE
REDE
AISE
TS16AISE
TS16LOSE
Functional Description
60
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.11 HDLC RECEIVER
HDLC #1 is fixed in the DL bit (in ESF format) and D bit in CH24 (in T1
DM format) respectively (refer to Table 13 & Table 14), the other HDLC
channels are configured as follows:
• Set the EVEN bit and/or the ODD bit to select the even and/or odd
frames;
• Set the TS[4:0] bits to define the channel/timeslot of the assigned
frame;
• Set the BITEN[7:0] bits to select the bits of the assigned channel/
timeslot.
The HDLC Receiver extracts the HDLC data stream from the
selected position and processes the data according to the selected
mode.
3.11.1 HDLC CHANNEL CONFIGURATION
In T1/J1 mode ESF & T1 DM formats, three HDLC Receivers (#1, #2
& #3) per link are provided for HDLC extraction from the received data
stream. In T1/J1 mode SF & SLC-96 formats, two HDLC Receivers (#2
& #3) per link are provided for HDLC extraction. In E1 mode, three
HDLC Receivers (#1, #2 & #3) per link are provided for HDLC extraction.
Except in T1/J1 mode ESF & T1 DM formats, the HDLC channel of
Then all the functions of the HDLC Receiver will be enabled only if
the corresponding RDLEN bit is set to ‘1’.
Table 29: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.11.1
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
RHDLC1 Assignment (E1 only) / RHDLC2 Assignment /
RHDLC3 Assignment
08C, 18C, 28C, 38C, 48C, 58C, 68C, 78C (E1 only) / 08D, 18D,
28D, 38D, 48D, 58D, 68D, 78D / 08E, 18E, 28E, 38E, 48E, 58E,
68E, 78E
RHDLC1 Bit Select (E1 only) / RHDLC2 Bit Select /
RHDLC3 Bit Select
08F, 18F, 28F, 38F, 48F, 58F, 68F, 78F (E1 only) / 090, 190, 290,
390, 490, 590, 690, 790 / 091, 191, 291, 391, 491, 591, 691, 791
RHDLC Enable Control
08B, 18B, 28B, 38B, 48B, 58B, 68B, 78B
EVEN
ODD
TS[4:0]
BITEN[7:0]
RDLEN3
RDLEN2
RDLEN1
serve as the opening flag of the next HDLC packet. Following the
opening flag, two-byte address is compared if the address comparison
mode is selected. Before the closing flag, two bytes of CRC-CCITT
frame check sequences (FCS) are provided to check all the HDLC
packet (excluding the opening flag and closing flag).
3.11.2 HDLC MODE
Setting the RHDLCM bit to ‘0’ (default) in the corresponding HDLC
Receiver selects the HDLC mode (per Q.921).
3.11.2.1 HDLC Mode
The structure of a standard HDLC packet consists of the following
parts as shown in Figure 14. Each HDLC packet starts with a 7E (Hex)
opening flag and ends with the same flag. The closing flag may also
Flag
one byte
'01111110'
FCS
two bytes
Information
Control
Address
(optional)
Flag
n bytes
one byte
low byte high byte
address address
one byte one byte
one byte
'01111110'
b7
b0 b7
C/R b0
Figure 14. Standard HDLC Packet
Functional Description
61
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
After the stuffed zero (the zero following five consecutive ’One’s) is
discarded, the data stream between the opening flag and the FCS is
divided into blocks. Each block (except the last block) has 32 bytes. The
block will be pushed into a FIFO with one-byte overhead ahead until any
of the following invalid packet conditions occurs:
• A packet with error FCS;
• The data between the opening flag and the closing flag is less than
5 bytes (including the FCS, excluding the flags);
• The extracted HDLC packet does not consist of an integral number
of octets;
• A 7F (Hex) abort sequence is received;
• Address is not matched if the address comparison is enabled. (The
address comparison mode is selected by the ADRM[1:0] bits. If
high byte address comparison is required, the high byte address
position (the byte following the opening flag) is compared with the
If any of the above conditions is detected, the current block will be
discarded, but the one-byte overhead will still be written into the FIFO.
The overhead consists of the M[2:0] bits and the length indication bits as
shown in Figure 15.
overhead (one byte)
bit 7
M2
value in the HA[7:0] bits, or with ‘0xFC’ or ‘0xFE’. Here the ‘C/R’ bit
position is excluded to compare. If low byte address comparison is
required, the high byte address position is compared with the value
in the LA[7:0] bits. Here the ‘C/R’ bit position is included to compare. If both bytes address comparison is required, the high byte
address position is compared with the value in the HA[7:0] bits, or
with ‘0xFC’ or ‘0xFE’. Here the ‘C/R’ bit position is excluded to
compare. And the low byte position (the byte following the high
byte address position) is compared with the value in the LA[7:0]
bits.
M1
M0
bit 0
Length Indication
M[2:0]:
= 000: A valid short HDLC packet is received, i.e., the data stream between the opening flag and the FCS is less than 32 bytes (including 32
bytes).
= 001: The current block is not the last block of the HDLC packet.
= 010: The current block is the last block of a valid long (more than 32 bytes) HDLC packet.
= 011: Reserved.
= 100: An invalid short HDLC packet is received and the current block is discarded.
= 101: The current block is the last block of an invalid long HDLC packet and the block is discarded.
= 110: Reserved.
= 111: Reserved.
The Length Indication is valid when the M2 bit is zero: Length Indication = N - 1 (N is the number of byte).
Otherwise, the Length Indication is zero.
Figure 15. Overhead Indication In The FIFO
The FIFO depth is 128 bytes. The FIFO is accessed by the DAT[7:0]
bits. When the overhead is read from the FIFO, it will be indicated by the
PACK bit. When all valid HDLC blocks are pushed into the FIFO or all
the blocks are read from the FIFO, it will be indicated by the EMP bit.
Functional Description
The interrupt sources in this block are summarized in Table 30.
When there are conditions meeting the interrupt sources, the corresponding Interrupt Indication bit will be set to ‘1’ and the Interrupt Indication bit will be cleared by writing a ‘1’. A ‘1’ in the Interrupt Indication bit
means there is an interrupt. The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin
if its Interrupt Enable bit is ‘1’.
62
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 30: Interrupt Summarize In HDLC Mode
Interrupt Indication
Bit
Interrupt Enable
Bit
A block is pushed into the
FIFO.
RMBEI
RMBEE
Data is still attempted to write
into the FIFO when the FIFO
has been already full (128
bytes).
OVFLI
OVFLE
Sources
The HDLC Receiver will be reset when there is a transition from ‘0’
to ‘1’ on the RRST bit. The reset will clear the FIFO, the PACK bit and
the EMP bit.
Table 31: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.11.2
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
RHDLCM
ADRM[1:0]
RRST
RHDLC1 Control Register / RHDLC2 Control Register / RHDLC3 Control
Register
092, 192, 292, 392, 492, 592, 692, 792 / 093, 193, 293, 393, 493,
593, 693, 793 / 094, 194, 294, 394, 494, 594, 694, 794
HA[7:0]
RHDLC1 High Address / RHDLC2 High Address / RHDLC3 High Address
LA[7:0]
RHDLC1 Low Address / RHDLC2 Low Address / RHDLC3 Low Address
DAT[7:0]
RHDLC1 Data / RHDLC2 Data / RHDLC3 Data
PACK
EMP
RMBEI
OVFLI
RMBEE
OVFLE
0A1, 1A1, 2A1, 3A1, 4A1, 5A1, 6A1, 7A1 / 0A2, 1A2, 2A2, 3A2,
4A2, 5A2, 6A2, 7A2 / 0A3, 1A3, 2A3, 3A3, 4A3, 5A3, 6A3, 7A3
0A4, 1A4, 2A4, 3A4, 4A4, 5A4, 6A4, 7A4 / 0A5, 1A5, 2A5, 3A5,
4A5, 5A5, 6A5, 7A5 / 0A6, 1A6, 2A6, 3A6, 4A6, 5A6, 6A6, 7A6
098, 198, 298, 398, 498, 598, 698, 798 / 099, 199, 299, 399, 499,
599, 699, 799 / 09A, 19A, 29A, 39A, 49A, 59A, 69A, 79A
RHDLC1 RFIFO Access Status /
095, 195, 295, 395, 495, 595, 695, 795 / 096, 196, 296, 396, 496,
596, 696, 796 / 097, 197, 297, 397, 497, 597, 697, 797
RHDLC1 Interrupt Indication / RHDLC2 Interrupt Indication / RHDLC3
Interrupt Indication
09E, 19E, 29E, 39E, 49E, 59E, 69E, 79E / 09F, 19F, 29F, 39F, 49F,
59F, 69F, 79F / 0A0, 1A0, 2A0, 3A0, 4A0, 5A0, 6A0, 7A0
RHDLC1 Interrupt Control / RHDLC2 Interrupt Control / RHDLC3 Interrupt
Control
09B, 19B, 29B, 39B, 49B, 59B, 69B, 79B / 09C, 19C, 29C, 39C,
49C, 59C, 69C, 79C / 09D, 19D, 29D, 39D, 49D, 59D, 69D, 79D
Functional Description
63
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.12 BIT-ORIENTED MESSAGE RECEIVER (T1/J1
ONLY)
3.13 INBAND LOOPBACK CODE DETECTOR (T1/J1
ONLY)
The Bit-Oriented Message (BOM) can only be received in the ESF
format in T1/J1 mode.
The Inband Loopback Code Detector tracks the loopback activate/
deactivate codes only in framed or unframed T1/J1 data stream, and
meets ANSI T1.403 9.3.1.
The BOM pattern is ‘111111110XXXXXX0’ which occupies the DL of
the F-bit in the ESF format (refer to Table 13). The six ‘X’s represent the
message. The BOM is declared only when the pattern is matched and
the received message is identical 4 out of 5 consecutive times or 8 out of
10 consecutive times and differs from the previous message. The identification time is selected by the AVC bit. After a new BOM is declared, the
message is loaded into the BOC[5:0] bits. Every time when the BOC[5:0]
bits are updated, it will be indicated by the BOCI bit. A ‘1’ in the BOCI bit
means there is an interrupt. The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin
if the BOCE bit is ‘1’.
The received data stream is compared with the target activate/deactivate code whose length and content are programmed in the ASEL[1:0]/
DSEL[1:0] bits and the ACT[7:0]/DACT[7:0] bits respectively. In framed
mode, the F-bit is selected by the IBCDIDLE bit to compare with the
target activate/deactivate code or not. In unframed mode, all 193 bits are
compared with the target activate/deactivate code.
After four consecutive correct activate/deactivate codes are found in
the received data stream, the Inband Loopback Code Detector keeps on
monitoring the bit error, i.e., the bit differs from the target activate/deactivate code. If in more than 126 consecutive 39.8ms fixed periods, less
than 600 bit errors are detected in each 39.8ms, the activate/deactivate
code is detected and the corresponding LBA/LBD bit will indicate it.
Once more than 600 bit errors are detected in a 39.8ms fixed period, the
activate/deactivate code is out of synchronization and the corresponding
LBA/LBD bit will be cleared. However, even if the F-bit is compared,
whether it is matched or not, the result will not cause bit errors, that is,
the comparison result of the F-bit is discarded.
Table 32: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.12
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
BOC Control
081, 181, 281, 381, 481,
581, 681, 781
BOC[5:0]
RBOC Code
083, 183, 283, 383, 483,
583, 683, 783
BOCI
BOC Interrupt Indication
082, 182, 282, 382, 482,
582, 682, 482
AVC
BOCE
Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the LBA/LBD bit will
set the LBAI/LBDI bit, which means there is an interrupt. The interrupt
will be reported by the INT pin if the corresponding LBAE/LBDE bit is set
to ‘1’.
Table 33: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.13
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
IBCD Detector Configuration
076, 176, 276, 376,
476, 576, 676, 776
ACT[7:0]
IBCD Activate Code
078, 178, 278, 378,
478, 578, 678, 778
DACT[7:0]
IBCD Deactivate Code
079, 179, 279, 379,
479, 579, 679, 779
IBCD Detector Status
077, 177, 277, 377,
477, 577, 677, 777
IBCD Interrupt Indication
07B, 17B, 27B, 37B,
47B, 57B, 67B, 77B
IBCD Interrupt Control
07A, 17A, 27A, 37A,
47A, 57A, 67A, 77A
ASEL[1:0]
DSEL[1:0]
IBCDIDLE
LBA
LBD
LBAI
LBDI
LBAE
LBDE
Functional Description
64
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.14 ELASTIC STORE BUFFER
3.15 RECEIVE CAS/RBS BUFFER
In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, a 2basic-frame depth Elastic Store Buffer is used to synchronize the
incoming frames to the (Multiplexed) Receive Side System Clock
derived from the RSCKn/MRSCK pin, and to the (Multiplexed) Receive
Side System Frame Pulse derived from the RSFSn/MRSFS pin. A write
pointer is used to write the data to the Elastic Store Buffer, while a read
pointer is used to read the data from the Elastic Store Buffer.
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer extracts the signaling bits from the
received data stream.
3.15.1 T1/J1 MODE
In SF/ESF/SLC-96 format, the signaling bits are located in the Bit 8
of Frame 6n (n = 1,2 in SF format; 1 ≤ n ≤ 4 in ESF format; 1 ≤ n ≤ 12 in
SLC-96 format) (refer to Table 12, Table 13 and Table 15 respectively).
The signaling codewords (AB or ABCD) are clocked out on the RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins. They are in the lower nibble of the channel with
its corresponding data serializing on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSIGB) pins
(as shown in Figure 16).
When the average frequency of the incoming data is greater than the
average frequency of the (Multiplexed) Receive Side System Clock
(RSCKn/MRSCK), the write pointer will be faster than the read pointer
and the Elastic Store Buffer will be filled. Until there is less than or equal
to 2 bytes between the write pointer and the read pointer, a frame will be
deleted after its prior frame is read. When the read pointer crosses the
frame boundary, a controlled slip will occur with a ‘1’ indicated in the
SLIPD bit.
When the EXTRACT bit is set to ‘1’, the signaling bits in its corresponding channel are extracted to the A,B,C,D bits in the Extracted
Signaling Data/Extract Enable register. In SF format, the C,D bits in the
register are the repetition of the signaling bits A,B. The data in the
A,B,C,D bits in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable register are
the data to be output on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins. However,
in T1-DM format, there is no signaling bits.
When the average frequency of the incoming data is less than the
average frequency of the RSCKn/MRSCK, the write pointer will be
slower than the read pointer and the Elastic Store Buffer will be empty.
Until there is less than or equal to 2 bytes between the write pointer and
the read pointer, the frame will be repeated after it is read. When the
read pointer crosses the next frame boundary, a controlled slip will occur
with a ‘0’ indicated in the SLIPD bit.
Signaling de-bounce will be executed when the DEB bit is set to ‘1’.
Thus, the A,B,C,D bits in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable
register are updated only if 2 consecutive received AB/ABCD codewords
of the same channel are identical.
Signaling freezing is performed automatically when it is out of frame
synchronization or when slips occurs in the Elastic Store Buffer. It is also
performed when the FREEZE bit is set to ‘1’. The signaling freezing
freezes the signaling data in the A,B,C,D bits in the Extracted Signaling
Data/Extract Enable register as the previous valid value.
When the slip occurs, the SLIPI bit will indicate it. An interrupt on the
INT pin will occur if the SLIPE bit is ‘1’.
In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, if it is
out of synchronization, the trunk code programmed in the
TRKCODE[7:0] bits will be set to replace the data if the TRKEN bit is set
to ‘1’.
In the ESF and SLC-96 format, if the SIGF bit is set to ‘0’, the
extracted signaling bits are in 4 states signaling, i.e., the signaling bits
on Framer 6 & 18 of a signaling multi-frame are recognized as ‘A’ and
the signaling bits on Framer 12 & 24 are recognized as ‘B’. Only the
signaling bits A & B will be saved in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract
Enable register, and the C & D bits in the Extracted Signaling Data/
Extract Enable register are Don’t-Care. If the SIGF bit is set to ‘1’, the
extracted signaling bits are in 16 states signaling, i.e., four signaling bits
A, B, C & D are all saved in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable
register.
In Receive Clock Master mode, the Elastic Store Buffer is bypassed
unless the device is in the Payload Loopback diagnosis mode (refer to
Chapter 3.27.2.2 Payload Loopback).
Table 34: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.14
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
ELST Configuration
07C, 17C, 27C, 37C,
47C, 57C, 67C, 77C
SLIPI
ELST Interrupt Indication
07D, 17D, 27D, 37D,
47D, 57D, 67D, 77D
TRKCODE[7:0]
ELST Trunk Code
07E, 17E, 27E, 37E,
47E, 57E, 67E, 77E
SLIPD
SLIPE
Each time the extracted signaling bits stored in the Extracted
Signaling Data/Extract Enable register are changed, it is captured by the
corresponding COSI[X] bit (1 ≤ X ≤ 24). When the SIGE bit is set to ‘1’,
any one of the COSI[X] bits being ‘1’ will generate an interrupt and will
be reported by the INT pin.
TRKEN
Functional Description
The EXTRACT bit and the A,B,C,D bits are in the indirect registers of
the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer. They are accessed by specifying the
address in the ADDRESS[6:0] bits. Whether the data is read from or
written into the specified indirect register is determined by the RWN bit
and the data is in the D[7:0] bits. The access status is indicated in the
BUSY bit. Refer to Chapter 4.5 Indirect Register Access Scheme for
details about the indirect registers write/read access.
65
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Channel 24
RSDn/
MRSDA(MRSDB)
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 24
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 F 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB)
A B C D
A B C D
Channel 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 F 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A B C D
A B C D
F-bit
A B C D
F-bit
Figure 16. Signaling Output In T1/J1 Mode
3.15.2 E1 MODE
Signaling freezing is performed automatically when it is out of Basic
frame synchronization, out of Signaling multi-frame synchronization or
slips occurs in the Elastic Store Buffer. It is also performed when the
FREEZE bit is set to ‘1’. The signaling freezing freezes the signaling
data in the A,B,C,D bits in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable
register as the previous valid value.
In Signaling Multi-Frame, the signaling bits are located in TS16 (refer
to Figure 13), which are Channel Associated Signalings (CAS). The
signaling codewords (ABCD) are clocked out on the RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins. They are in the lower nibble of the timeslot with
its corresponding data serializing on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pins
(as shown in Figure 17).
Each time the extracted signaling bits in the A,B,C,D bits in the
Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable register are changed, it is
captured by the corresponding COSI[X] bit (1 ≤ X ≤ 30). When the SIGE
bit is set to ‘1’, any one of the COSI[X] bits being ‘1’ will generate an
interrupt and will be reported by the INT pin.
When the EXTRACT bit is set to ‘1’, the signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot are extracted to the A,B,C,D bits in the Extracted
Signaling Data/Extract Enable register. The data in the A,B,C,D bits in
the register are the data to be output on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB)
pins. The bits corresponding to TS0 and TS16 output on the RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins are Don’t-Care.
The EXTRACT bit and the A,B,C,D bits are in the indirect registers of
the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer. They are accessed by specifying the
address in the ADDRESS[6:0] bits. Whether the data is read from or
written into the specified indirect register is determined by the RWN bit
and the data is in the D[7:0] bits. The access status is indicated in the
BUSY bit. Refer to Chapter 4.5 Indirect Register Access Scheme for
details about the indirect registers write/read access.
Signaling de-bounce will be executed when the DEB bit is set to ‘1’.
Thus, the A,B,C,D bits in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable
register are updated only if 2 consecutive received ABCD codewords of
the same timeslot are identical.
TS31
TS0
TS1
RSDn/
1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1 2 3 4 5 6 78
MRSDA(MRSDB)
RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB)
ABCD
TS15
TS16
TS17
1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1 2 3 4 5 6 78
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
TS31
TS0
1 2 3 4 5 6 78 1 2 3 4 5 6 78
ABCD
Figure 17. Signaling Output In E1 Mode
Functional Description
66
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 35: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.15
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
ID* - Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable
RCRB ID - 01~18 (for T1/J1) / 01~0F & 11~1F (for E1)
RCRB Configuration
0D2, 1D2, 2D2, 3D2, 4D2, 5D2, 6D2, 7D2
RCRB State Change Indication 3 (E1 only) & RCRB State
Change Indication 2 ~ 0
0D9, 1D9, 2D9, 3D9, 4D9, 5D9, 6D9, 7D9 (E1 only) &
0D8, 1D8, 2D8, 3D8, 4D8, 5D8, 6D8, 7D8 & 0D7,
1D7, 2D7, 3D7, 4D7, 5D7, 6D7, 7D7 & 0D6, 1D6,
2D6, 3D6, 4D6, 5D6, 6D6, 7D6
RCRB Access Control
0D4, 1D4, 2D4, 3D4, 4D4, 5D4, 6D4, 7D4
D[7:0]
RCRB Access Data
0D5, 1D5, 2D5, 3D5, 4D5, 5D5, 6D5, 7D5
BUSY
RCRB Access Status
0D3, 1D3, 2D3, 3D3, 4D3, 5D3, 6D3, 7D3
EXTRACT
A,B,C,D
DEB
FREEZE
SIGF (T1/J1 only)
SIGE
COSI[X] (1 ≤ X ≤ 24 in T1/J1) (1 ≤ X ≤
30 in E1)
ADDRESS[6:0]
RWN
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer function block.
Functional Description
67
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.16 RECEIVE PAYLOAD CONTROL
• Selected by the GSUBST[2:0] bits, the data of all channels/
timeslots of the corresponding link will be replaced by the data
trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits, or the milliwatt pattern defined
in the Table 36 and Table 37. When the GSUBST[2:0] bits are set
to ‘000’, these replacements will be performed on a per-channel/
per-TS basis by setting the SUBST[2:0] bits in the corresponding
channel/timeslot.
• When the SIGFIX bit is set to ‘1’, the signaling bits (ABCD) will be
fixed to the value set in the POL bit. This function is only supported
in the SF, ESF and SLC-96 formats in T1/J1 mode.
• Invert the most significant bit, the even bits and/or the odd bits by
setting the SINV, OINV, EINV bits.
• When the TESTEN bit is enabled and the PRBSDIR bit is ‘1’, the
received data will be replaced by the test pattern generated from
the PRBS Generator/Detector. The received data can be replaced
in unframed mode, in 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode.
This selection is made by the PRBSMODE[1:0] bits. In unframed
mode, all the received data stream is replaced and the per-channel/per-TS configuration in the TEST bit is ignored. In 8-bit-based
mode or in 7-bit-based mode, the received data will only be
replaced on the channel/timeslot configured by the TEST bit. Refer
to Chapter 3.27.1 PRBS Generator / Detector for details.
Different test patterns can be inserted in the received data stream or
the received data stream can be extracted to the PRBS Generator/
Detector for test in this block.
To enable all the functions in the Receive Payload Control, the PCCE
bit must be set to ‘1’.
The following methods can be executed on the data to be output on
the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pins on a per-channel/per-TS basis or on a
global basis of the corresponding link (the methods are arranged from
the highest to the lowest in priority):
• When the TESTEN bit is enabled and the PRBSDIR bit is ‘0’, the
received data will be extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector.
The received data can be extracted in unframed mode, in 8-bitbased mode or in 7-bit-based mode. This selection is made by the
PRBSMODE[1:0] bits. In unframed mode, all the received data
stream is extracted and the per-channel/per-TS configuration in
the TEST bit is ignored. In 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based
mode, the received data will only be extracted on the channel/
timeslot configured by the TEST bit. Refer to Chapter 3.27.1 PRBS
Generator / Detector for details.
Functional Description
68
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
output on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins on a per-channel/per-TS
basis or on a global basis of the corresponding link (the methods are
arranged from the highest to the lowest in priority):
• Selected by the ABXX bit, the signaling bits can be valid in the
upper 2-bit positions of the lower nibble of each channel or in the
lower nibble of each channel. The other bits of the channel are
Don’t Care conditions. This function is only supported in T1/J1
mode ESF/SLC-96 format.
• Enabled by the SIGSNAP bit, the signaling snapshot will be executed. The signaling snapshot means that the signaling bits of the
first basic frame are locked and output as the signaling bits of the
current whole multi-frame. This function is not supported in T1 DM
format.
• Enabled by the GSTRKEN bit, the signaling bits (ABCD) of all
channels/timeslots of the corresponding link will be replaced by the
signaling trunk conditioning code in the A,B,C,D bits. When the
GSTRKEN bit is ‘0’, the replacement will be performed on a perchannel/per-TS basis by setting the STRKEN bit in the corresponding channel/timeslot.
Table 36: A-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Byte
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
Byte
2
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
Byte
3
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
Byte
4
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
Byte
5
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
Byte
6
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
Byte
7
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
Byte
8
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
The indirect registers of the Receive Payload Control are accessed
by specifying the address in the ADDRESS[6:0] bits. Whether the data is
read from or written into the specified indirect register is determined by
the RWN bit and the data is in the D[7:0] bits. The access status is indicated in the BUSY bit. Refer to Chapter 4.5 Indirect Register Access
Scheme for details about the indirect registers write/read access.
Table 37: µ-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Byte
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
Byte
2
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Byte
3
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Byte
4
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
Byte
5
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
Byte
6
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Byte
7
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Byte
8
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
The following methods can be executed on the signaling bits to be
Functional Description
69
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 38: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.16
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
RPLC Control Enable
0D1, 1D1, 2D1, 3D1, 4D1, 5D1, 6D1, 7D1
TPLC / RPLC / PRGD Test Configuration
0C7, 1C7, 2C7, 3C7, 4C7, 5C7, 6C7, 7C7
ID * - Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code
RPLC ID - 41~58 (for T1/J1) / 41~4F & 51~5F (for E1)
RPLC Configuration
0D0, 1D0, 2D0, 3D0, 4D0, 5D0, 6D0, 7D0
ID - Data Trunk Conditioning Code
RPLC ID - 21~38 (for T1/J1) / 20~3F (for E1)
ID - Channel Control (for T1/J1) / Timeslot Control (for
E1)
RPLC ID - 01~18 (for T1/J1) / 00~1F (for E1)
RPLC Access Control
0CE, 1CE, 2CE, 3CE, 4CE, 5CE, 6CE, 7CE
D[7:0]
RPLC Access Data
0CF, 1CF, 2CF, 3CF, 4CF, 5CF, 6CF, 7CF
BUSY
RPLC Access Status
0CD, 1CD, 2CD, 3CD, 4CD, 5CD, 6CD, 7CD
PCCE
SIGFIX (T1/J1 only)
POL (T1/J1 only)
ABXX (T1/J1 only)
TESTEN
PRBSDIR
PRBSMODE[1:0]
TEST
STRKEN
A,B,C,D
GSUBST[2:0]
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
DTRK[7:0]
SUBST[2:0]
SINV
OINV
EINV
ADDRESS[6:0]
RWN
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Receive Payload Control function block.
Functional Description
70
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.17 RECEIVE SYSTEM INTERFACE
In the Receive Clock Master mode, the device outputs clock
(M)RSCKn/(M)RSFSn, and this clock is derived from line side signal or
MCLK (When LOSS).
The Receive System Interface determines how to output the received
data stream to the system backplane. The data from the eight links can
be aligned with each other or be output independently. The timing clocks
and framing pulses can be provided by the system backplane or
obtained from the far end. The Receive System Interface supports
various configurations to meet various requirements in different applications.
In the Receive Clock Master mode, if RSCKn outputs pulses during
the entire T1/J1 frame, the Receive System Interface is in Receive Clock
Master Full T1/J1 mode. If only the clocks aligned to the selected channels are output on RSCKn, the Receive System Interface is in Receive
Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 mode.
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, clock (M)RSCKn/(M)RSFSn is
from outside. To avoid shatter data, this clock should keep the source
same with line side. If the backplane data rate is 2.048 Mbit/s, and the
Receive System Interface is in T1 mode E1 rate, the receive data (1.544
Mb/s) should be mapped to 2.048 Mb/s and there are 3 kinds of
mapping schemes.
3.17.1 T1/J1 MODE
In T1/J1 mode, the Receive System Interface can be set in Nonmultiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In the Non-multiplexed Mode,
the RSDn pin is used to output the received data from each link at the bit
rate of 1.544 Mb/s or 2.048 Mb/s (T1/J1 mode E1 rate). While in the
Multiplexed Mode, the received data from the eight links is converted to
2.048 Mb/s format and byte interleaved to form two high speed data
streams and output on the MRSDA1 (MRSDB1) and MRSDA2
(MRSDB2) pins at the bit rate of 8.192 Mb/s.
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, since the received data from the
eight links should be converted to 2.048 Mb/s format first and then multiplexed to 8.192 Mb/s, there are still 3 kinds of schemes to be selected.
Table 39 summarizes how to set the Receive System Interface of
each link into various operating modes and the pins’ direction of the
Receive System Interface in different operating modes.
Table 39: Operating Modes Selection In T1/J1 Receive Path
RMUX
RMOD
E
0
G56K, GAP
/ FBITGAP
00 / 0
not all 0s 1
0
1
1
X
X
X
MAP[1:0]
2
X
Receive System Interface Pin
Operating Mode
Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1
Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1
00
Receive Clock Slave - T1/J1 Rate
01
Receive Clock Slave - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802
10
Receive Clock Slave - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every Four
CHs
11
Receive Clock Slave - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs
01
Receive Multiplexed - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802
10
Receive Multiplexed - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every Four CHs
11
Receive Multiplexed - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs
Input
Output
X
RSCKn, RSFSn,
RSDn, RSIGn
RSCKn, RSFSn
RSDn, RSIGn
MRSCK,
MRSFS
MRSDA[1:2],
MRSIGA[1:2]
(MRSDB[1:2],
MRSIGB[1:2]) 3
NOTE:
1. When the G56K, GAP bits in RPLC indirect registers are set, the PCCE bit must be set to ‘1’.
2. The MAP[1:0] bits can not be set to ‘00’ in the Receive Multiplexed mode.
3. In Receive Multiplexed mode, two sets of multiplexed data and signaling pins (A and B) are provided. Their functions are the same. One is the backup for the other.
Functional Description
71
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.17.1.1 Receive Clock Master Mode
The RSCKn is gapped during the F-bit if the FBITGAP bit is set to ‘1’.
The RSCKn is also gapped during the channels or the Bit 8 duration by
selecting the G56K & GAP bits in the Receive Payload Control. The data
in the corresponding gapped duration is a don't care condition.
In the Receive Clock Master mode, each link uses its own timing
signal on the RSCKn pin and framing pulse on the RSFSn pin to output
the data on each RSDn pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn pin are perchannel aligned with the data on the RSDn pin.
3.17.1.2 Receive Clock Slave Mode
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, the system data rate can be 1.544
Mb/s or 2.048 Mb/s. If the system data rate is 1.544 Mb/s, it works in T1/
J1 mode. If the system data rate is 2.048 Mb/s, the received data stream
(1.544 Mb/s) should be mapped to the same rate as the system side,
that is, to work in T1/J1 mode E1 rate. Three kinds of schemes are
provided by selecting the MAP[1:0] bits:
• T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802 (refer to Figure 18): Channel 1 to
Channel 15 of Frame N from the device are converted into TS1 to
TS15 of Frame N on the system side; Channel 16 to Channel 24 of
Frame N from the device are converted into TS17 to TS25 of
Frame N on the system side. The F-bit of Frame N from the device
is converted into the first bit of TS26 of Frame (N-1) on the system
side. TS0, TS16, TS27~TS31 and the other 7 bits in TS26 on the
system side are all filled with ‘0’s and they are meaningless.
• T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every Fourth CH (refer to
Figure 19): One dummy byte is inserted on the system side before
3 bytes of Frame N from the device are converted. This process
repeats 8 times and the conversion of Frame N of 1.544 Mb/s data
rate to 2.048 Mb/s data rate is completed. However, the F-bit of
Frame N of the 1.544 Mb/s data rate is inserted as the 8th bit of
Frame N of the 2.048 Mb/s data rate. The dummy bytes are filled
with all ‘0’s and they are meaningless.
• T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs (refer to Figure 20):
Channel 1 to Channel 24 of Frame N from the device are converted into TS1 to TS24 of Frame N on the system side. The F-bit
of Frame N from the device is converted into the 8th bit of Frame N
on the system side. The first 7 bits and TS25 to TS31 on the system side are all filled with ‘0’s and they are meaningless.
In the Receive Clock Master mode, the data on the system interface
is clocked by the RSCKn. The active edge of the RSCKn used to update
the pulse on the RSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the RSCKn used to update the data on the RSDn and RSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the RSFSn is ahead.
In the Receive Clock Master mode, the RSFSn can indicate each Fbit or the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multi-frame. In SF
format, the RSFSn can also indicate every second F-bit or the first F-bit
of every second SF multi-frame. All the indications are selected by the
CMFS bit and the ALTIFS bit. The active polarity of the RSFSn is
selected by the FSINV bit.
The Receive Clock Master mode includes two sub-modes: Receive
Clock Master Full T1/J1 mode and Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/
J1 mode.
Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1 Mode
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the RSCKn is a
standard 1.544 MHz clock, and the data in the F-bit and all 24 channels
in a standard T1/J1 frame are clocked out by the RSCKn.
Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 Mode
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the RSCKn is a
gapped 1.544 MHz clock (no clock signal during the selected position).
1.544
Mb/s
F CH1
2.048
Mb/s
TS0
CH2
TS1
filler
CH14
TS2
CH15
CH16
CH17
TS14 TS15 TS16 TS17 TS18
CH23
CH24 F
TS24 TS25
CH1
TS26 TS27~TS31
the 1st bit filler
filler
CH2
filler
CH23
TS0
TS1
filler
Figure 18. T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping - G.802 Mode
Functional Description
72
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
1.544
Mb/s
F CH1
2.048
Mb/s
TS0
CH3
CH2
TS1
TS2
CH4
TS3
TS4
filler the 8th bit
CH5
TS5
CH7
CH6
TS6
TS7
filler
CH22
TS8
TS9
CH23
CH24 F CH1
CH2
TS28 TS29 TS30 TS31 TS0
filler
filler
TS1
filler the 8th bit
Figure 19. T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping - One Filler Every Fourth Channel Mode
1.544
Mb/s
F
2.048
Mb/s
TS0
filler
CH1
TS1
CH2
CH3
TS2
TS3
CH24 F
CH23
TS23
TS24
TS25~TS31
filler
the 8th bit
CH1
CH2
TS0
CH24 F
TS1
TS2
CH1
TS24
filler the 8th bit
Figure 20. T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping - Continuous Channels Mode
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, the timing signal on the RSCKn
pin and the framing pulse on the RSFSn pin to output the data on the
RSDn pin are provided by the system side. When the RSLVCK bit is set
to ‘0’, each link uses its own RSCKn and RSFSn; when the RSLVCK bit
is set to ‘1’ and all eight links are in the Receive Clock Slave mode, the
eight links use the RSCK[1] and RSFS[1] to output the data. The
signaling bits on the RSIGn pin are per-channel aligned with the data on
the RSDn pin.
the EDGE bit determines the active edge to update the data on the
RSDn and RSIGn pins. The pulse on the RSFSn pin is always sampled
on its first active edge.
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, the RSFSn asserts at a rate of
integer multiple of 125 µs to indicate the start of a frame. The active
polarity of the RSFSn is selected by the FSINV bit. If the pulse on the
RSFSn pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs, this detection will be indicated by the RCOFAI bit. If the RCOFAE bit is enabled, an interrupt will
be reported by the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit is ‘1’.
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, the data on the system interface is
clocked by the RSCKn. The active edge of the RSCKn used to sample
the pulse on the RSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the RSCKn used to update the data on the RSDn and RSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the RSFSn is ahead. The data rate of the system side is 1.544 Mb/s
or 2.048 Mb/s. When it is 2.048 Mb/s, the RSCKn can be selected by the
CMS bit to be the same rate as the data rate on the system side (2.048
MHz) or double the data rate (4.096 MHz). If all eight links use the
RSCK[1] and RSFS[1] to output the data, the CMS bit of the eight links
should be set to the same value. If the speed of the RSCKn is double the
data rate, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this case,
Functional Description
3.17.1.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, since the received data from the
eight links should be mapped to 2.048 Mb/s format first, the 3 kinds of
schemes should be selected by the MAP[1:0] bits. The mapping per
G.802, per One Filler Every Four CHs and per Continuous CHs are the
same as the description in Chapter 3.17.1.2 Receive Clock Slave Mode.
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, two multiplexed buses are used to
output the data from all eight links. The data of Link 1 to Link 4 is byteinterleaved output on the multiplexed bus 1, while the data of Link 5 to
Link 8 is byte-interleaved output on the multiplexed bus 2. When the
data from the four links is output on one multiplexed bus, the sequence
73
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
of the data is arranged by setting the channel offset. The data from
different links on one multiplexed bus must be shifted at a different
channel offset to avoid data mixing.
mines the active edge to update the data on the MRSDA (MRSDB) and
MRSIGA (MRSIGB) pins. The pulse on the MRSFS pin is always
sampled on its first active edge.
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the timing signal on the MRSCK
pin and the framing pulse on the MRSFS pin are provided by the system
side and common to all eight links. The signaling bits on the MRSIGA
(MRSIGB) pin are per-channel aligned with the corresponding data on
the MRSDA (MRSDB) pin.
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the MRSFS asserts at a rate of
integer multiple of 125 µs to indicate the start of a frame. The active
polarity of the MRSFS is selected by the FSINV bit. The FSINV bit of the
eight links should be set to the same value. If the pulse on the MRSFS
pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs, this detection will be indicated by
the RCOFAI bit. If the RCOFAE bit is enabled, an interrupt will be
reported by the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit is ‘1’.
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface is
clocked by the MRSCK. The active edge of the MRSCK used to sample
the pulse on the MRSFS is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the MRSCK used to update the data on the MRSDA (MRSDB) and
MRSIGA (MRSIGB) is determined by the DE bit. The FE bit and the DE
bit of the eight links should be set to the same value respectively. If the
FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse on the MRSFS is ahead.
The MRSCK can be selected by the CMS bit to be the same rate as the
data rate on the system side (8.192 MHz) or double the data rate
(16.384 MHz). The CMS bit of the eight links should be set to the same
value. If the speed of the MRSCK is double the data rate, there will be
two active edges in one bit duration. In this case, the EDGE bit deter-
3.17.1.4 Offset
Bit offset and channel offset are both supported in all the operating
modes. The offset is between the framing pulse on RSFSn/MRSFS pin
and the start of the corresponding frame output on the RSDn/
MRSDA(MRSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin are always per-channel aligned with the data on
the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin.
Figure 21 to Figure 24 show the base line without offset.
FE = 1, DE = 1
Receive Clock Slave mode / Receive Multiplexed mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Receive Clock Master mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
Figure 21. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 1 In Receive Path
Functional Description
74
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
FE = 0, DE = 0
Receive Clock Slave mode / Receive Multiplexed mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Receive Clock Master mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
Figure 22. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 0 In Receive Path
FE = 0, DE = 1
Receive Clock Slave mode / Receive Multiplexed mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Receive Clock Master mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
Figure 23. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 1 In Receive Path
Functional Description
75
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
FE = 1, DE = 0
Receive Clock Slave mode / Receive Multiplexed mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Receive Clock Master mode:
RSFSn / MRSFS
RSCKn / MRSCK
RSDn / MRSDA(B)
Figure 24. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 0 In Receive Path
The bit offset and channel offset are configured when the BOFF[2:0]
bits and the TSOFF[6:0] bits are not ‘0’ respectively.
the TSOFF[6:0] bits are set, the start of the corresponding frame output
on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin will delay ‘16 x M’ clock cycles to the
framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin. (Here ‘M’ is defined by the
TSOFF[6:0].)
When the CMS bit is ‘0’ and the BOFF[2:0] bits are set, the start of
the corresponding frame output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin will
delay ‘N’ clock cycles to the framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin.
(Here ‘N’ is defined by the BOFF[2:0] bits.) When the CMS bit is ‘0’ and
the TSOFF[6:0] bits are set, the start of the corresponding frame output
on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin will delay ‘8 x M’ clock cycles to the
framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin. (Here ‘M’ is defined by the
TSOFF[6:0].)
In Non-multiplexed mode, the channel offset can be configured from
0 to 23 channels (0 & 23 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the channel
offset can be configured from 0 to 127 channels (0 & 127 are included).
3.17.1.5 Output On RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) & RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB)
The output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and the RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins can be configured by the TRI bit of the corresponding link to be in high impedance state or to output the processed
data stream.
When the CMS bit is ‘1’ (i.e., in double clock mode) and the
BOFF[2:0] bits are set, the start of the corresponding frame output on
the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin will delay ‘2 x N’ clock cycles to the
framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin. (Here ‘N’ is defined by the
BOFF[2:0] bits.) When the CMS bit is ‘1’ (i.e., in double clock mode) and
Functional Description
76
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.17.2 E1 MODE
In the Receive Clock Master mode, if RSCKn outputs pulses during
the entire E1 frame, the Receive System Interface is in Receive Clock
Master Full E1 mode. If only the clocks aligned to the selected timeslots
are output on RSCKn, the Receive System Interface is in Receive Clock
Master Fractional E1 mode.
In E1 mode, the Receive System Interface can be set in Non-multiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In the Non-multiplexed Mode, the
RSDn pin is used to output the received data from each link at the bit
rate of 2.048 Mb/s. While in the Multiplexed Mode, the received data
from the eight links is byte interleaved to form two high speed data
streams and output on the MRSDA1 (MRSDB1) and MRSDA2
(MRSDB2) pins at the bit rate of 8.192 Mb/s.
Table 40 summarizes how to set the receive system interface of each
link into various operating modes and the pins’ direction of the receive
system interface in different operating modes.
In the Non-multiplexed mode, if the RSCK is from outside, the
receive system interface is in Receive Clcok Slave mode, otherwise if
the device outputs RSCK, the receive system interface is in Receive
Clcok Master mode.
Table 40: Operating Modes Selection In E1 Receive Path
Receive System Interface Pin
RMUX
0
1
RMODE
0
G56K, GAP
00
Operating Mode
Receive Clock Master Full E1
not both 0s 1 Receive Clock Master Fractional E1
Input
Output
X
RSCKn, RSFSn, RSDn, RSIGn
1
X
Receive Clock Slave
RSCKn, RSFSn
RSDn, RSIGn
X
X
Receive Multiplexed
MRSCK, MRSFS
MRSDA[1:2], MRSIGA[1:2] (MRSDB[1:2], MRSIGB[1:2]) 2
NOTE:
1. When the G56K, GAP bits in RPLC indirect registers are set, the PCCE bit must be set to ‘1’.
2. In Receive Multiplexed mode, two sets of multiplexed data and signaling pins (A and B) are provided. Their functions are the same. One is the backup for the other.
3.17.2.1 Receive Clock Master Mode
Receive Clock Master Full E1 Mode
In the Receive Clock Master mode, each link uses its own timing
signal on the RSCKn pin and framing pulse on the RSFSn pin to output
the data on each RSDn pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn pin are pertimeslot aligned with the data on the RSDn pin.
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the RSCKn is a
standard 2.048 MHz clock, and the data in all 32 timeslots in a standard
E1 frame is clocked out by the RSCKn.
In the Receive Clock Master mode, the data on the system interface
is clocked by the RSCKn. The active edge of the RSCKn used to update
the pulse on the RSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the RSCKn used to update the data on the RSDn and RSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the RSFSn is ahead.
Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 Mode
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the RSCKn is a
gapped 2.048 MHz clock (no clock signal during the selected timeslot).
The RSCKn is gapped during the timeslots or the Bit 8 duration by
selecting the G56K & GAP bits in the Receive Payload Control. The data
in the corresponding gapped duration is a don't care condition.
In the Receive Clock Master mode, the RSFSn can indicate the
Basic frame, CRC Multi-frame, Signaling Multi-frame, or both the CRC
Multi-frame and Signaling Multi-frame, or the TS1 and TS 16 overhead.
All the indications are selected by the OHD bit, the SMFS bit and the
CMFS bit. The active polarity of the RSFSn is selected by the FSINV bit.
3.17.2.2 Receive Clock Slave Mode
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, the timing signal on the RSCKn
pin and framing pulse on the RSFSn pin to output the data on the RSDn
pin are provided by the system side. When the RSLVCK bit is set to ‘0’,
each link uses its own RSCKn and RSFSn; when the RSLVCK bit is set
to ‘1’ and all eight links are in the Receive Clock Slave mode, the eight
links use the RSCK[1] and RSFS[1] to output the data. The signaling bits
on the RSIGn pin are per-timeslot aligned with the data on the RSDn
pin.
The Receive Clock Master mode includes two sub-modes: Receive
Clock Master Full E1 mode and Receive Clock Master Fractional E1
mode.
Functional Description
77
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, the data on the system interface is
clocked by the RSCKn. The active edge of the RSCKn used to sample
the pulse on the RSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the RSCKn used to update the data on the RSDn and RSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the RSFSn is ahead. The speed of the RSCKn can be selected by
the CMS bit to be the same rate as the data rate on the system side
(2.048 MHz) or double the data rate (4.096 MHz). If all eight links use
the RSCK[1] and RSFS[1] to output the data, the CMS bit of the eight
links should be set to the same value. If the speed of the RSCKn is
double the data rate, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In
this case, the EDGE bit determines the active edge to update the data
on the RSDn and RSIGn pins. The pulse on the RSFSn pin is always
sampled on its first active edge.
bit of the eight links should be set to the same value respectively. If the
FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse on the MRSFS is ahead.
The MRSCK can be selected by the CMS bit to be the same rate as the
data rate on the system side (8.192 MHz) or double the data rate
(16.384 MHz). The CMS bit of the eight links should be set to the same
value. If the speed of the MRSCK is double the data rate, there will be
two active edges in one bit duration. In this case, the EDGE bit determines the active edge to update the data on the MRSDA (MRSDB) and
MRSIGA (MRSIGB) pins. The pulse on the MRSFS pin is always
sampled on its first active edge.
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the MRSFS asserts at a rate of
integer multiple of 125 µs to indicate the start of a frame. The active
polarity of the MRSFS is selected by the FSINV bit. The FSINV bit of the
eight links should be set to the same value. If the pulse on the MRSFS
pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs, this detection will be indicated by
the RCOFAI bit. If the RCOFAE bit is enabled, an interrupt will be
reported by the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit is ‘1’.
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, the RSFSn asserts at a rate of
integer multiple of 125 µs to indicate the start of a frame. The active
polarity of the RSFSn is selected by the FSINV bit. If the pulse on the
RSFSn pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs, this detection will be indicated by the RCOFAI bit. If the RCOFAE bit is enabled, an interrupt will
be reported by the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit is ‘1’.
3.17.2.4 Offset
Except that in the Receive Master mode, when the OHD bit, the
SMFS bit and the CMFS bit are set to TS1 and TS16 overhead indication, the bit offset and timeslot offset are both supported in all the other
conditions. The offset is between the framing pulse on RSFSn/MRSFS
pin and the start of the corresponding frame output on the RSDn/
MRSDA(MRSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin are always per-timeslot aligned with the data on
the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin.
3.17.2.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, two multiplexed buses are used to
output the data from all eight links. The data of Link 1 to Link 4 is byteinterleaved output on the multiplexed bus 1, while the data of Link 5 to
Link 8 is byte-interleaved output on the multiplexed bus 2. When the
data from the four links is output on one multiplexed bus, the sequence
of the data is arranged by setting the timeslot offset. The data from
different links on one multiplexed bus must be shifted at a different
timeslot offset to avoid data mixing.
Refer to Chapter 3.17.1.4 Offset for the base line without offset in
different operating modes and the configuration of the offset.
In Non-multiplexed mode, the timeslot offset can be configured from
0 to 31 timeslots (0 & 31 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the timeslot
offset can be configured from 0 to 127 timeslots (0 & 127 are included).
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the timing signal on the MRSCK
pin and the framing pulse on the MRSFS pin are provided by the system
side and common to all eight links. The signaling bits on the MRSIGA
(MRSIGB) pin are per-timeslot aligned with the corresponding data on
the MRSDA (MRSDB) pin.
3.17.2.5 Output On RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) & RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB)
The output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and the RSIGn/
MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins can be configured by the TRI bit of the corresponding link to be in high impedance state or to output the processed
data stream.
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface is
clocked by the MRSCK. The active edge of the MRSCK used to sample
the pulse on the MRSFS is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the MRSCK used to update the data on the MRSDA (MRSDB) and
MRSIGA (MRSIGB) is determined by the DE bit. The FE bit and the DE
Functional Description
78
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 41: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.17
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
Backplane Global Configuration
010
RBIF Mode
047, 147, 247, 347, 447, 547, 647, 747
ID * - Channel Control (for T1/J1) / Timeslot Control (for E1)
RPLC ID - 01~18 (for T1/J1) / 00~1F (for E1)
RBIF Operation
046, 146, 246, 346, 446, 546, 646, 746
RPLC Control Enable
0D1, 1D1, 2D1, 3D1, 4D1, 5D1, 6D1, 7D1
RBIF Frame Pulse
048, 148, 248, 348, 448, 548, 648, 748
RBIF Bit Offset
04A, 14A, 24A, 34A, 44A, 54A, 64A, 74A
RCOFAI
RTSFS Change Indication
04BH, 14B, 24B, 34B, 44B, 54B, 64B, 74B
RCOFAE
RTSFS Interrupt Control
04C, 14C, 24C, 34C, 44C, 54C, 64C, 74C
TSOFF[6:0]
RBIT TS Offset
049, 149, 249, 349, 449, 549, 649, 749
RMUX
RSLVCK
RMODE
MAP[1:0] (T1/J1 only)
G56K
GAP
FBITGAP (T1/J1 only)
FE
DE
CMS
TRI
PCCE
CMFS
ALTIFS (T1/J1 only)
FSINV
OHD (E1 only)
SMFS (E1 only)
EDGE
BOFF[2:0]
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Receive Payload Control function block.
Functional Description
79
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.18 TRANSMIT SYSTEM INTERFACE
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the device outputs TSCKn and
TSFSn; however in Transmit Clock Slave mode, TSCKn & TSFSn are
input to the device from outside.
The Transmit System Interface determines how to input the data to
the device. The data input to the eight links can be aligned with each
other or input independently. The timing clocks and framing pulses can
be provided by the system backplane or obtained from the processed
data of each link. The Transmit System Interface supports various
configurations to meet various requirements in different applications.
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, if TSCKn outputs pulses during
the entire T1/J1 frame, the Transmit System Interface is in Transmit
Clock Master Full T1/J1 mode. If only the clocks aligned to the selected
channels are output on TSCKn, the Transmit System Interface is in
Transmit Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 mode.
3.18.1 T1/J1 MODE
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the backplane data rate may be
1.544 Mb/s (i.e., the line data rate), 2.048 Mb/s or 8.192 Mb/s. If the
backplane data rate is 2.048 Mb/s or 8.192 Mb/s, the Transmit System
Interface is in T1/J1 mode E1 rate and the data to be transmitted is
mapped to 1.544 Mb/s in device per 3 kinds of schemes.
In T1/J1 mode, the Transmit System Interface can be set in Nonmultiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In the Non-multiplexed Mode,
the TSDn pin is used to input the data to each link at the bit rate of 1.544
Mb/s or 2.048 Mb/s (T1/J1 mode E1 rate). While in the Multiplexed
Mode, the data is byte-interleaved from two high speed data streams
and inputs on the MTSDA1 (MTSDB1) and MTSDA2 (MTSDB2) pins at
the bit rate of 8.192 Mb/s. The demultiplexed data input to the eight links
is 2.048 Mb/s on the system side and converted into 1.544 Mb/s format
to the device.
Table 42 summarizes how to set the transmit system interface of
each link into various operating modes and the pins’ direction of the
transmit system interface in different operating modes.
Table 42: Operating Modes Selection In T1/J1 Transmit Path
TMU
X
TMOD
E
0
G56K, GAP
/ FBITGAP
00 / 0
not all 0s 1
0
1
1
X
X
X
MAP[1:0] 2
X
Transmit System Interface Pin
Operating Mode
Transmit Clock Master Full T1/J1
Transmit Clock Master Fractional T1/J1
00
Transmit Clock Slave - T1/J1 Rate
01
Transmit Clock Slave - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802
10
Transmit Clock Slave - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every
Four CHs
11
Transmit Clock Slave - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs
01
Transmit Multiplexed - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802
10
Transmit Multiplexed - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every
Four CHs
11
Transmit Multiplexed - T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs
Input
Output
TSDn, TSIGn
TSCKn,
TSFSn
TSDn, TSIGn, TSCKn,
TSFSn
X
MTSCK, MTSFS,
MTSDA[1:2], MTSIGA[1:2]
(MTSDB[1:2], MTSIGB[1:2])
X
3
NOTE:
1. When the G56K, GAP bits in TPLC indirect registers are set, the PCCE bit must be set to ‘1’.
2. The MAP[1:0] bits can not be set to ‘00’ in the Transmit Multiplexed mode.
3. In Transmit Multiplexed mode, two sets of multiplexed data and signaling pins (A and B) are provided corresponding to two multiplexed buses. Their functions are the same. One is
the backup for the other. One set is selected by the MTSDA bit when used.
Functional Description
80
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.18.1.1 Transmit Clock Master Mode
The TSCKn is gapped during the F-bit if the FBITGAP bit is set to ‘1’.
The TSCKn is also gapped during the channels or the Bit 8 duration by
selecting the G56K & GAP bits in the Transmit Payload Control. The
data in the corresponding gapped duration is a Don't Care condition.
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, each link uses its own timing
signal on the TSCKn pin and framing pulse on the TSFSn pin to input
the data on each TSDn pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn pin are perchannel aligned with the data on the TSDn pin.
3.18.1.2 Transmit Clock Slave Mode
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the system data rate can be 1.544
Mb/s or 2.048 Mb/s. If the system data rate is 1.544 Mb/s, it works in T1/
J1 mode. If the system data rate is 2.048 Mb/s, the data stream to be
transmitted should be mapped to 1.544 Mb/s, that is, to work in T1/J1
mode E1 rate. Three kinds of schemes are provided by selecting the
MAP[1:0] bits:
• T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802 (refer to Figure 25): TS1 to TS15
of Frame N on the system side are converted into Channel 1 to
Channel 15 of Frame N to the device; TS17 to TS25 of Frame N on
the system side are converted into Channel 16 to Channel 24 of
Frame N to the device. The first bit of TS26 of Frame (N-1) on the
system side is converted into the F-bit of Frame N to the device.
TS0, TS16, TS27~TS31 and the other 7 bits in TS26 on the system side are all discarded.
• T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every Fourth CHs (refer to
Figure 26): The 8th bit of Frame N on the system side is converted
to the F-bit of the Frame N to the device. Then one byte of the system side is discarded after the previous three bytes are converted
into the device. This process repeats 8 times and the conversion of
one frame is completed. Then the process goes on.
• T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs (refer to Figure 27): TS1
to TS24 of Frame N on the system side are converted into Channel
1 to Channel 24 of Frame N to the device. The 8th bit of Frame N
on the system side is converted into the F-bit of Frame N to the
device. The first 7 bits and TS25 to TS31 on the system side are all
discarded.
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the data on the system interface
is clocked by the TSCKn. The active edge of the TSCKn used to update
the pulse on the TSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the TSCKn used to sample the data on the TSDn and TSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the TSFSn is ahead.
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the TSFSn can indicate each Fbit or the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multi-frame. The
indications are selected by the FSTYP bit. The active polarity of the
TSFSn is selected by the FSINV bit.
The Transmit Clock Master mode includes two sub-modes: Transmit
Clock Master Full T1/J1 mode and Transmit Clock Master Fractional T1/
J1 mode.
Transmit Clock Master Full T1/J1 Mode
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the TSCKn is a
standard 1.544 MHz clock, and the data in the F-bit and all 24 channels
in a standard T1/J1 frame are clocked in by the TSCKn.
Transmit Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 Mode
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the TSCKn is a
gapped 1.544 MHz clock (no clock signal during the selected channel).
discarded
2.048
Mb/s
TS0
1.544
Mb/s
F CH1
the 1st bit discarded discarded discarded
discarded
TS1
CH2
TS2
TS14 TS15 TS16 TS17 TS18
CH14
CH15
CH16
CH17
TS24 TS25
CH23
CH24 F
TS26 TS27~TS31
CH1
CH2
TS0
TS1
CH23
Figure 25. E1 To T1/J1 Format Mapping - G.802 Mode
Functional Description
81
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
discarded
discarded the 8th bit
2.048
Mb/s
TS0
1.544
Mb/s
F CH1
TS1
TS2
CH2
TS4
TS3
CH3
CH4
discarded
TS5
CH5
TS6
TS7
TS8
discarded
TS9
CH7
CH6
discarded the 8th bit
TS28 TS29 TS30 TS31 TS0
CH22
CH23
CH24 F CH1
TS1
CH2
Figure 26. E1 To T1/J1 Format Mapping - One Filler Every Fourth Channel Mode
discarded the 8th bit
2.048
Mb/s
TS0
1.544
Mb/s
F
TS1
CH1
discarded discarded the 8th bit
TS2
TS3
CH2
CH3
TS23
TS25~TS31
TS24
CH23
CH24 F
CH1
TS0
TS1
TS2
CH2
TS24
CH24 F
CH1
Figure 27. E1 To T1/J1 Format Mapping - Continuous Channels Mode
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the timing signal on the TSCKn
pin and the framing pulse on the TSFSn pin to input the data on the
TSDn pin are provided by the system side. When the TSLVCK bit is set
to ‘0’, each link uses its own TSCKn and TSFSn; when the TSLVCK bit
is set to ‘1’ and all eight links are in the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the
eight links use the TSCK[1] and TSFS[1] to input the data. The signaling
bits on the TSIGn pin are per-channel aligned with the data on the TSDn
pin.
the EDGE bit determines the active edge to sample the data on the
TSDn and TSIGn pins. The pulse on the TSFSn pin is always sampled
on its first active edge.
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the TSFSn can indicate each F-bit
or the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multi-frame. The indications are selected by the FSTYP bit. The active polarity of the TSFSn is
selected by the FSINV bit. If the pulse on the TSFSn pin is not an integer
multiple of 125 µs, this detection will be indicated by the TCOFAI bit. If
the TCOFAE bit is enabled, an interrupt will be reported by the INT pin
when the TCOFAI bit is ‘1’.
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the data on the system interface
is clocked by the TSCKn. The active edge of the TSCKn used to sample
the pulse on the TSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the TSCKn used to sample the data on the TSDn and TSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the TSFSn is ahead. The data rate of the system side is 1.544 Mb/s
or 2.048 Mb/s. When it is 2.048 Mb/s, the TSCKn can be selected by the
CMS bit to be the same rate as the data rate on the system side (2.048
MHz) or double the data rate (4.096 MHz). If all eight links use the
TSCK[1] and TSFS[1] to input the data, the CMS bit of the eight links
should be set to the same value. If the speed of the TSCKn is double the
data rate, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this case,
Functional Description
3.18.1.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, since the demultiplexed data rate
on the system side (2.048 Mb/s) should be mapped to the data rate in
the line side (1.544 Mb/s), 3 kinds of schemes should be selected by the
MAP[1:0] bits. The schemes per G.802, per One Filler Every Four CHs
and per Continuous CHs are the same as the description in
Chapter 3.18.1.2 Transmit Clock Slave Mode.
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, two multiplexed buses are used to
transmit the data to all eight links. The data of Link 1 to Link 4 is byteinterleaved input from the multiplexed bus 1, while the data of Link 5 to
Link 8 is byte-interleaved input from the multiplexed bus 2. When the
82
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
data on one multiplexed bus is input to four links, the sequence of the
data is arranged by setting the channel offset. The data to different links
from one multiplexed bus must be shifted at a different channel offset to
avoid data mixing.
mines the active edge to sample the data on the MTSDA (MTSDB) and
MTSIGA (MTSIGB) pins. The pulse on the MTSFS pin is always
sampled on its first active edge.
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the MTSFS can indicate each Fbit of the first link or the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multiframe of the first link. The indications are selected by the FSTYP bit. The
active polarity of the MTSFS is selected by the FSINV bit. The FSTYP
bit and the FSINV bit of the eight links should be set to the same value. If
the pulse on the MTSFS pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs, this
detection will be indicated by the TCOFAI bit. If the TCOFAE bit is
enabled, an interrupt will be reported by the INT pin when the TCOFAI
bit is ‘1’.
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the timing signal on the MTSCK
pin and the framing pulse on the MTSFS pin are provided by the system
side and common to all eight links. The signaling bits on the MTSIGA
(MTSIGB) pin are per-channel aligned with the corresponding data on
the MTSDA (MTSDB) pin.
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface is
clocked by the MTSCK. The active edge of the MTSCK used to sample
the pulse on the MTSFS is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the MTSCK used to sample the data on the MTSDA (MTSDB) and
MTSIGA (MTSIGB) is determined by the DE bit. The FE bit and the DE
bit of the eight links should be set to the same value respectively. If the
FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse on the MTSFS is ahead.
The MTSCK can be selected by the CMS bit to be the same rate as the
data rate on the system side (8.192 MHz) or double the data rate
(16.384 MHz). The CMS bit of the eight links should be set to the same
value. If the speed of the MTSCK is double the data rate, there will be
two active edges in one bit duration. In this case, the EDGE bit deter-
3.18.1.4 Offset
Bit offset and channel offset are both supported in all the operating
modes. The offset is between the framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS
pin and the start of the corresponding frame input on the TSDn/
MTSDA(MTSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn/
MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin are always per-channel aligned with the data on
the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin.
Figure 28 to Figure 31 show the base line without offset.
FE = 1, DE = 1
Transmit Clock Slave mode / Transmit Multiplexed mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Transmit Clock Master mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
Figure 28. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 1 In Transmit Path
Functional Description
83
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
FE = 0, DE = 0
Transmit Clock Slave mode / Transmit Multiplexed mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Transmit Clock Master mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
Figure 29. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 0 In Transmit Path
FE = 0, DE = 1
Transmit Clock Slave mode / Transmit Multiplexed mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Transmit Clock Master mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
Figure 30. No Offset When FE = 0 & DE = 1 In Transmit Path
Functional Description
84
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
FE = 1, DE = 0
Transmit Clock Slave mode / Transmit Multiplexed mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
F-bit (T1/J1)
Bit 1 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 1 of CH1(T1/J1)
Bit 2 of TS0 (E1)
Bit 2 (T1/J1)
Bit 3 (E1)
Transmit Clock Master mode:
TSFSn / MTSFS
TSCKn / MTSCK
TSDn / MTSDA(B)
Figure 31. No Offset When FE = 1 & DE = 0 In Transmit Path
The bit offset and channel offset are configured when the BOFF[2:0]
bits and the TSOFF[6:0] bits are not ‘0’ respectively.
When the CMS bit is ‘1’ (i.e., in double clock mode) and the
BOFF[2:0] bits are set, the start of the corresponding frame input on the
TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin will delay ‘2 x N’ clock cycles to the framing
pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin. (Here ‘N’ is defined by the BOFF[2:0]
bits.) When the CMS bit is ‘1’ (i.e., in double clock mode) and the
TSOFF[6:0] bits are set, the start of the corresponding frame input on
the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin will delay ‘16 x M’ clock cycles to the
framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin. (Here ‘M’ is defined by the
TSOFF[6:0].)
When the CMS bit is ‘0’ and the BOFF[2:0] bits are set, the start of
the corresponding frame input on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin will
delay ‘N’ clock cycles to the framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin.
(Here ‘N’ is defined by the BOFF[2:0] bits.) When the CMS bit is ‘0’ and
the TSOFF[6:0] bits are set, the start of the corresponding frame input
on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin will delay ‘8 x M’ clock cycles to the
framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin. (Here ‘M’ is defined by the
TSOFF[6:0].)
Functional Description
In Non-multiplexed mode, the channel offset can be configured from
0 to 23 channels (0 & 23 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the channel
offset can be configured from 0 to 127 channels (0 & 127 are included).
85
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.18.2 E1 MODE
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, if TSCKn outputs pulses during
the entire E1 frame, the Transmit System Interface is in Transmit Clock
Master Full E1 mode. If only the clocks aligned to the selected timeslots
are output on TSCKn, the Transmit System Interface is in Transmit
Clock Master Fractional E1 mode.
In E1 mode, the Transmit System Interface can be set in Non-multiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In the Non-multiplexed Mode, the
TSDn pin is used to input the data to each link at the bit rate of 2.048
Mb/s. While in the Multiplexed Mode, the data is byte interleaved from
two high speed data streams and inputs on the MTSDA1 (MTSDB1) and
MTSDA2 (MTSDB2) pins at the bit rate of 8.192 Mb/s.
Table 43 summarizes how to set the transmit system interface of
each link into various operating modes and the pins’ direction of the
transmit system interface in different operating modes.
In the Non-multiplexed mode, if the TSCK is from outside, the
transmit system interface is in Transmit Clock Slave mode, otherwise if
the device outputs clock TSCK from itself, the transmit system interface
is in Transmit Clock Master mode.
Table 43: Operating Modes Selection In E1 Transmit Path
Transmit System Interface Pin
TMUX
0
1
TMODE
0
G56K, GAP
00
not both 0s 1
Operating Mode
Transmit Clock Master Full E1
Transmit Clock Master Fractional E1
Input
Output
TSDn, TSIGn
TSCKn, TSFSn
1
X
Transmit Clock Slave
TSCKn, TSFSn, TSDn, TSIGn
X
X
X
Transmit Multiplexed
MTSCK, MTSFS, MTSDA[1:2],
MTSIGA[1:2] (MTSDB[1:2],
MTSIGB[1:2]) 2
X
NOTE:
1. When the G56K, GAP bits in TPLC indirect registers are set, the PCCE bit must be set to ‘1’.
2. In Transmit Multiplexed mode, two sets of multiplexed data and signaling pins (A and B) are provided corresponding to two multiplexed buses. Their functions are the same. One is the
backup for the other. One set is selected by the MTSDA bit when used.
Functional Description
86
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.18.2.1 Transmit Clock Master Mode
should be set to the same value. If the speed of the TSCKn is double the
data rate, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this case,
the EDGE bit determines the active edge to sample the data on the
TSDn and TSIGn pins. The pulse on the TSFSn pin is always sampled
on its first active edge.
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, each link uses its own timing
signal on the TSCKn pin and framing pulse on the TSFSn pin to input
the data on each TSDn pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn pin are pertimeslot aligned with the data on the TSDn pin.
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the TSFSn can indicate the Basic
frame, CRC Multi-frame and/or Signaling Multi-frame. The indications
are selected by the FSTYP bit. The active polarity of the TSFSn is
selected by the FSINV bit. If the pulse on the TSFSn pin is not an integer
multiple of 125 µs, this detection will be indicated by the TCOFAI bit. If
the TCOFAE bit is enabled, an interrupt will be reported by the INT pin
when the TCOFAI bit is ‘1’.
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the data on the system interface
is clocked by the TSCKn. The active edge of the TSCKn used to update
the pulse on the TSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the TSCKn used to sample the data on the TSDn and TSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the TSFSn is ahead.
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the TSFSn can indicate the
Basic frame, CRC Multi-frame and/or Signaling Multi-frame. The indications are selected by the FSTYP bit. The active polarity of the TSFSn is
selected by the FSINV bit.
3.18.2.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, two multiplexed buses are used to
transmit the data to all eight links. The data of Link 1 to Link 4 is byteinterleaved input from the multiplexed bus 1, while the data of Link 5 to
Link 8 is byte-interleaved input from the multiplexed bus 2. When the
data on one multiplexed bus is input to four links, the sequence of the
data is arranged by setting the timeslot offset. The data to different links
from one multiplexed bus must be shifted at a different timeslot offset to
avoid data mixing.
The Transmit Clock Master mode includes two sub-modes: Transmit
Clock Master Full E1 mode and Transmit Clock Master Fractional E1
mode.
Transmit Clock Master Full E1 Mode
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the TSCKn is a
standard 2.048 MHz clock, and the data in all 32 timeslots in a standard
E1 frame are clocked in by the TSCKn.
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the timing signal on the MTSCK
pin and the framing pulse on the MTSFS pin are provided by the system
side and common to all eight links. The signaling bits on the MTSIGA
(MTSIGB) pin are per-timeslot aligned with the corresponding data on
the MTSDA (MTSDB) pin.
Transmit Clock Master Fractional E1 Mode
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock
Master mode, the special feature in this mode is that the TSCKn is a
gapped 2.048 MHz clock (no clock signal during the selected timeslot).
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface is
clocked by the MTSCK. The active edge of the MTSCK used to sample
the pulse on the MTSFS is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the MTSCK used to sample the data on the MTSDA (MTSDB) and
MTSIGA (MTSIGB) is determined by the DE bit. The FE bit and the DE
bit of the eight links should be set to the same value respectively. If the
FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse on the MTSFS is ahead.
The MTSCK can be selected by the CMS bit to be the same rate as the
data rate on the system side (8.192 MHz) or double the data rate
(16.384 MHz). The CMS bit of the eight links should be set to the same
value. If the speed of the MTSCK is double the data rate, there will be
two active edges in one bit duration. In this case, the EDGE bit determines the active edge to sample the data on the MTSDA (MTSDB) and
MTSIGA (MTSIGB) pins. The pulse on the MTSFS pin is always
sampled on its first active edge.
The TSCKn is gapped during the timeslots or the Bit 8 duration by
selecting the G56K & GAP bits in the Transmit Payload Control. The
data in the corresponding gapped duration is a don't care condition.
3.18.2.2 Transmit Clock Slave Mode
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the timing signal on the TSCKn
pin and the framing pulse on the TSFSn pin to input the data on the
TSDn pin are provided by the system side. When the TSLVCK bit is set
to ‘0’, each link uses its own TSCKn and TSFSn; when the TSLVCK bit
is set to ‘1’ and all eight links are in the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the
eight links use the TSCK[1] and TSFS[1] to input the data. The signaling
bits on the TSIGn pin are per-timeslot aligned with the data on the TSDn
pin.
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the MTSFS can indicate the Basic
frame, CRC Multi-frame and/or Signaling Multi-frame of the first link. The
indications are selected by the FSTYP bit. The active polarity of the
MTSFS is selected by the FSINV bit. The FSTYP bit and the FSINV bit
of the eight links should be set to the same value. If the pulse on the
MTSFS pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs, this detection will be
indicated by the TCOFAI bit. If the TCOFAE bit is enabled, an interrupt
will be reported by the INT pin when the TCOFAI bit is ‘1’.
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the data on the system interface
is clocked by the TSCKn. The active edge of the TSCKn used to sample
the pulse on the TSFSn is determined by the FE bit. The active edge of
the TSCKn used to sample the data on the TSDn and TSIGn is determined by the DE bit. If the FE bit and the DE bit are not equal, the pulse
on the TSFSn is ahead. The speed of the TSCKn can be selected by the
CMS bit to be the same rate as the data rate on the system side (2.048
Mb/s) or double the data rate (4.096 Mb/s). If all eight links use the
TSCK[1] and TSFS[1] to input the data, the CMS bit of the eight links
Functional Description
87
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.18.2.4 Offset
3.19 TRANSMIT PAYLOAD CONTROL
Bit offset and timeslot offset are both supported in all the operating
modes. The offset is between the framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS
pin and the start of the corresponding frame input on the TSDn/
MTSDA(MTSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn/
MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin are always per-timeslot aligned with the data on
the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin.
Different test patterns can be inserted in the data stream to be transmitted or the data stream to be transmitted can be extracted to the
PRBS Generator/Detector for test in this block.
To enable all the functions in the Transmit Payload Control, the
PCCE bit must be set to ‘1’.
The following methods can be executed on the data input from the
TSDn/MTSDA (MTSDB) pins on a per-channel/per-TS basis or on a
global basis of the corresponding link (the methods are arranged from
the highest to the lowest in priority):
• When the TESTEN bit is enabled and the PRBSDIR bit is ‘1’, the
data to be transmitted will be extracted to the PRBS Generator/
Detector. The data to be transmitted can be extracted in unframed
mode, in 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode. This selection
is made by the PRBSMODE[1:0] bits. In unframed mode, all the
data stream to be transmitted is extracted and the per-channel/perTS configuration in the TEST bit is ignored. In 8-bit-based mode or
in 7-bit-based mode, the data will only be extracted on the channel/
timeslot configured by the TEST bit. Refer to Chapter 3.27.1 PRBS
Generator / Detector for details.
• Configured by the ZCS[2:0] bits, four types of Zero Code Suppression can be selected to implement to the data of all the channels of
the corresponding link. This function is only supported in T1/J1
mode.
• Selected by the GSUBST[2:0] bits, the data of all channels/
timeslots of the corresponding link will be replaced by the trunk
code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits, the milliwatt pattern defined in
Table 36 and Table 37, or the payload loopback data from the
Elastic Store Buffer (refer to Chapter 3.27.2.2 Payload Loopback).
When the GSUBST[2:0] bits are set to ‘000’, these replacements
will be performed on a per-channel/per-TS basis by setting the
SUBST[2:0] bits in the corresponding channel/timeslot.
• Controlled by the SIGINS bit, the signaling bits input from the
TSIGn/MTSIGA (MTSIGB) pins (after processed by the signaling
trunk conditioning replacement and/or valid signaling bits selection) can be inserted into its signaling bit position of the data
stream to be transmitted.
• Invert the most significant bit, the even bits and/or the odd bits by
setting the SINV, OINV, EINV bits.
• When the TESTEN bit is enabled and the PRBSDIR bit is ‘0’, the
data to be transmitted will be replaced by the test pattern generated from the PRBS Generator/Detector. The data to be transmitted can be replaced in unframed mode, in 8-bit-based mode or in
7-bit-based mode. This selection is made by the PRBSMODE[1:0]
bits. In unframed mode, all the data stream to be transmitted is
replaced and the per-channel/per-TS configuration in the TEST bit
is ignored. In 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode, the data
will only be replaced on the channel/timeslot configured by the
TEST bit. Refer to Chapter 3.27.1 PRBS Generator / Detector for
details.
Refer to Chapter 3.18.1.4 Offset for the base line without offset in
different operating modes and the configuration of the offset.
In Non-multiplexed mode, the timeslot offset can be configured from
0 to 31 timeslots (0 & 31 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the timeslot
offset can be configured from 0 to 127 timeslots (0 & 127 are included).
Table 44: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.18
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
Backplane Global Configuration
010
MAP[1:0]
(T1/J1 only)
TBIF Operating Mode
043, 143, 243, 343,
443, 543, 643, 743
G56K
GAP
ID * - Channel Control (for T1/J1) /
Timeslot Control (for E1)
TPLC ID * - 01~18 (for
T1/J1) / 00~1F (for E1)
PCCE
TPLC Control Enable
0CC, 1CC, 2CC, 3CC,
4CC, 5CC, 6CC, 7CC
TBIF Option Register
042, 142, 242, 342,
442, 542, 642, 742
TBIF Bit Offset
045, 145, 245, 345,
445, 545, 645, 745
TCOFAI
RTSFS Change Indication
04B, 14B, 24B, 34B,
44B, 54B, 64B, 74B
TCOFAE
RTSFS Interrupt Control
04C, 14C, 24C, 34C,
44C, 54C, 64C, 74C
TSOFF[6:0]
TBIF TS Offset
044, 144, 244, 344,
444, 544, 644, 744
TMUX
MTSDA
TSLVCK
TMODE
FBITGAP
(T1/J1 only)
FE
DE
FSTYP
FSINV
CMS
EDGE
BOFF[2:0]
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Transmit Payload Control function block.
Functional Description
88
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
The following methods can be executed on the signaling bits input
from the TSIGn/MTSIGA (MTSIGB) pins on a per-channel/per-TS basis
or on a global basis of the corresponding link. The processed signaling
bits will be inserted to the data stream to be transmitted if frame is
generated. The methods are arranged from the highest to the lowest in
priority:
• Selected by the ABXX bit, the signaling bits can be valid in the
upper 2-bit positions of the lower nibble of each channel or in the
lower nibble of each channel. The other bits of the channel are
Don’t Care conditions. This function is only supported in T1/J1
mode ESF/SLC-96 format.
• Enabled by the SIGSNAP bit, the signaling snapshot will be executed. The signaling snapshot means that the signaling bits of the
first basic frame are locked and output as the signaling bits of the
current whole multi-frame. This function is not supported in T1 DM
format.
• Enabled by the GSTRKEN bit, the signaling bits (ABCD) of all
channels/timeslots of the corresponding link will be replaced by the
signaling trunk conditioning code in the A,B,C,D bits. When the
GSTRKEN bit is ‘0’, the replacement can be performed on a perchannel/per-TS basis by setting the STRKEN bit in the corresponding channel/timeslot.
Table 45: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.19
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
TPLC Control Enable
0CC, 1CC, 2CC, 3CC,
4CC, 5CC, 6CC, 7CC
TPLC / RPLC / PRGD Test
Configuration
0C7, 1C7, 2C7, 3C7,
4C7, 5C7, 6C7, 7C7
ID * - Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code
TPLC ID * - 41~58 (for
T1/J1) / 41~4F &
51~5F (for E1)
TPLC Configuration
0CB, 1CB, 2CB, 3CB,
4CB, 5CB, 6CB, 7CB
ID * - Data Trunk Conditioning Code
TPLC ID * - 21~38 (for
T1/J1) / 20~3F (for
E1)
ID * - Channel Control (for
T1/J1) / Timeslot Control (for
E1)
TPLC ID * - 01~18 (for
T1/J1) / 00~1F (for
E1)
TPLC Access Control
0C9, 1C9, 2C9, 3C9,
4C9, 5C9, 6C9, 7C9
D[7:0]
TPLC Access Data
0CA, 1CA, 2CA, 3CA,
4CA, 5CA, 6CA, 7CA
BUSY
TPLC Access Status
0C8, 1C8, 2C8, 3C8,
4C8, 5C8, 6C8, 7C8
PCCE
ABXX (T1/J1 only)
TESTEN
PRBSDIR
PRBSMODE[1:0]
TEST
SIGINS (T1/J1 only)
A,B,C,D
STRKEN
ZCS[2:0] (T1/J1
only)
GSUBST[2:0]
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
The indirect registers of the Transmit Payload Control are accessed
by specifying the address in the ADDRESS[6:0] bits. Whether the data is
read from or written into the specified indirect register is determined by
the RWN bit and the data is in the D[7:0] bits. The access status is indicated in the BUSY bit. Refer to Chapter 4.5 Indirect Register Access
Scheme for details about the indirect registers write/read access.
DTRK[7:0]
SUBST[2:0]
SINV
OINV
EINV
ADDRESS[6:0]
RWN
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Transmit Payload Control function block.
Functional Description
89
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.20 FRAME GENERATOR
the FDLBYP bit is set to ‘0’. When all of the five kinds of replacements
are enabled, the priority from highest to lowest is: Yellow alarm signal,
Bit-Oriented Code, Automatic Performance Report Message, HDLC
data and idle code.
3.20.1 GENERATION
3.20.1.1 T1 / J1 Mode
In T1/J1 mode, the data to be transmitted can be generated as
Super-Frame (SF), Extended Super-Frame (ESF), T1 Digital Multiplexer
(DM) or Switch Line Carrier - 96 (SLC-96) format.
The Yellow alarm signal will be manually inserted in the data stream
to be transmitted when the XYEL bit is set, or the Yellow alarm signal will
be inserted automatically by setting the AUTOYELLOW bit when Red
alarm is declared in the received data stream. The Yellow alarm signal is
transmitted in the DL bit position. Its pattern is ‘FF00’ in T1 mode or
‘FFFF’ in J1 mode.
Super Frame (SF) Format
The SF is generated when the FDIS bit is ‘0’.
The Frame Alignment Pattern (‘100011011100’ for T1 /
‘10001101110X’ for J1) will replace the F-bit of each frame if the FDIS bit
is set to ‘0’. The F-bit of the 12th frame in J1 mode should be ‘0’ unless
Yellow alarm signal is transmitted.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, configured by the MIMICEN bit, the mimic
pattern can be inserted into the bit right after each F-bit. The content of
the mimic pattern is the same as the F-bit. The mimic pattern insertion is
for diagnostic purpose.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, one Ft bit (the F-bit in odd frame, refer to
Table 12) will be inverted if the FtINV bit is set; one Fs bit (the F-bit in
even frame, refer to Table 12) will be inverted if the FsINV bit is set.
T1 Digital Multiplexer (DM) Format (T1 only)
The T1 DM is generated when the FDIS bit is ‘0’.
The Frame Alignment Pattern (‘100011011100’) will replace the F-bit
of each frame if the FDIS bit is set to ‘0’.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, configured by the MIMICEN bit, the mimic
pattern can be inserted into the bit right after each F-bit. The content of
the mimic pattern is the same as the F-bit. The mimic pattern insertion is
for diagnostic purpose.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, one Ft bit (the F-bit in odd frame, refer to
Table 14) will be inverted if the FtINV bit is set; one Fs bit (the F-bit in
even frame, refer to Table 14) will be inverted if the FsINV bit is set.
The Yellow alarm signal will be manually inserted in the data stream
to be transmitted when the XYEL bit is set, or the Yellow alarm signal will
be inserted automatically by setting the AUTOYELLOW bit when Red
alarm is declared in the received data stream. The pattern and the position of the Yellow alarm is different in T1 and J1 modes:
• In T1 mode, the Yellow alarm signal is logic 0 on the 2nd bit of
each channel;
• In J1 mode, the Yellow alarm signal is logic 1 on the 12th F-bit
position.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, configured by the MIMICEN bit, the mimic
pattern can be inserted into the bit right after each F-bit. The content of
the mimic pattern is the same as the F-bit. The mimic pattern insertion is
for diagnostic purpose.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, the DDS pattern (‘0XX11101’) will replace
the Bit 8 & 5~1 of each Channel 24 (refer to Table 14).
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, one 6-bit DDS pattern will be inverted if the
DDSINV bit is set.
Extended Super Frame (ESF) Format
The ‘D’ bit in Bit 7 of each Channel 24 can be replaced with the
HDLC data when the FDIS bit and the FDLBYP bit are both ‘0’s. (Refer
to Chapter 3.20.2 HDLC Transmitter for details).
The ESF is generated when the FDIS bit is ‘0’.
The Frame Alignment Pattern (‘001011’) will replace the F-bit in
Frame (4n) (0<n<7) if the FDIS bit is set to ‘0’.
The Yellow alarm signal will be manually inserted in the data stream
to be transmitted when the XYEL bit is set, or the Yellow alarm signal will
be inserted automatically by setting the AUTOYELLOW bit when Red
alarm is declared in the received data stream. The Yellow alarm signal is
‘0’ transmitted in the ‘Y’ bit in Bit 6 of each Channel 24. The ‘Y’ bit should
be ‘1’ when there is no Yellow alarm signal to be transmitted.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, one Frame Alignment bit (refer to Table 13
for its position) will be inverted if the FsINV bit is set.
When the FDIS bit and the CRCBYP bit are both ‘0’s, the calculated
6-bit CRC of the previous ESF frame will be inserted in the current CRCbit positions in every 4th frame starting with Frame 2 (refer to Table 13)
of the current ESF frame.
Switch Line Carrier - 96 (SLC-96) Format (T1 only)
The SLC-96 is generated when the FDIS bit is ‘0’.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, one 6-bit CRC pattern will be inverted if the
CRCINV bit is set.
The Frame Alignment Pattern (‘001000110111001000110111’), the
Spoiler Bit and all the other Ft bits (the F-bit in odd frame) will replace
their F-bit (refer to Table 15 for their values and positions) if the FDIS bit
is set to ‘0’.
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, the DL bit (refer to Table 13) can be
replaced with the Yellow alarm signal, the Bit-Oriented Code (refer to
Chapter 3.20.4 Bit-Oriented Message Transmitter (T1/J1 Only)), the
Automatic Performance Report Message (refer to Chapter 3.20.3 Automatic Performance Report Message (T1/J1 Only)), the HDLC data (refer
to Chapter 3.20.2 HDLC Transmitter) or the idle code (‘FFFF’ for T1 /
‘FF7E’ for J1). The latter four kinds of replacements are enabled only if
Functional Description
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, one Synchronization Fs bit will be inverted if
the FsINV bit is set; one Ft bit will be inverted if the FtINV bit is set.
90
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
When the FDIS bit and the FDLBYP bit are both ‘0’s, the contents in
the XDL0, XDL1 & XDL2 registers will replace the Concentrator (C) bits,
the Maintenance (M) bits, the Alarm (A) bits and the Switch (S) bits
respectively (refer to Table 15).
Table 46: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.1.1
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
T1/J1 Mode
062, 162, 262, 362, 462,
562, 662, 762
Error Insertion
06F, 16F, 26F, 36F, 46F, 56F,
66F, 76F
FGEN Maintenance 1
06C, 16C, 26C, 36C, 46C,
56C, 66C, 76C
FGEN Maintenance 0
06B, 16B, 26B, 36B, 46B,
56B, 66B, 76B
C[11:1]
XDL1 & XDL0
066, 166, 266, 366, 466,
566, 666, 766 & 065, 165,
265, 365, 465, 565, 665, 765
M[3:1]
XDL1
066, 166, 266, 366, 466,
566, 666, 766
XDL2
067, 167, 267, 367, 467,
567, 667, 767
FGEN Interrupt Indication
06E, 16E, 26E, 36E, 46E,
56E, 66E, 76E
FGEN Interrupt Control
06D, 16D, 26D, 36D, 46D,
56D, 66D, 76D
FDIS
When the FDIS bit is ‘0’, configured by the MIMICEN bit, the mimic
pattern can be inserted into the bit right after each F-bit. The content of
the mimic pattern is the same as the F-bit. The mimic pattern insertion is
for diagnostic purpose.
CRCBYP
FDLBYP
FtINV
The Yellow alarm signal will be manually inserted in the data stream
to be transmitted when the XYEL bit is set, or the Yellow alarm signal will
be inserted automatically by setting the AUTOYELLOW bit when Red
alarm is declared in the received data stream. The Yellow alarm signal is
logic 0 on the 2nd bit of each channel.
CRCINV
Interrupt Summary
MIMICEN
FsINV
DDSINV
At the first bit of each basic frame, the BFI bit will be set. In this
condition, if the BFE bit is enabled, an interrupt will be reported by the
INT pin.
XYEL
AUTOYELLOW
At the first bit of each SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multiframe, the MFI bit
will be set. In this condition, if the MFE bit is enabled, an interrupt will be
reported by the INT pin.
A[2:1]
S[4:1]
BFI
MFI
BFE
MFE
Functional Description
91
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.20.1.2 E1 Mode
If the FAS1INV bit is set, one FAS bit will be inverted; if the FASALLINV
bit is set, one 7-bit FAS pattern will be inverted; if the NFASINV bit is set,
one NFAS bit will be inverted.
In E1 mode, the Frame Generator can generate Basic Frame, CRC-4
Multi-Frame and Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame. The
Frame Generator can also transmit alarm indication signal when special
conditions occurs in the received data stream. International bits,
National bits and Extra bits replacements and data inversions are all
supported in the Frame Generator.
When the Basic frame is generated, if the SiDIS bit is ‘0’, the value
set in the Si[1] and Si[0] bits will replace the International bit (Bit 1) of
FAS frame and NFAS frame respectively.
When the Basic frame is generated, the Remote Alarm Indication
(RAI) can be transmitted as logic 1 in the A bit position. It is transmitted
manually when the REMAIS bit is ‘1’. It can also be transmitted automatically when the AUTOYELLOW bit is set to ‘1’. In this case, the RAI
transmission criteria are selected by the G706RAI bit.
The generation of the Basic frame, CRC Multi-Frame and Channel
Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame are controlled by the FDIS bit,
the GENCRC bit, the CRCM bit and the SIGEN bit. Refer to Table 47 for
details.
When the Basic frame is generated, the setting in the SaX[1] bit will
be transmitted in the Sa bit position if enabled by the corresponding
SaXEN bit (‘X’ is from 4 to 8).
Table 47: E1 Frame Generation
FDI
S
GENCR
C
CRC
M
SIGE
N
0
0
X
X
0
1
0
X
CRC Multi-Frame
0
1
0
X
Modified CRC Multi-Frame
0
1
1
X
Channel Associated Signaling (CAS)
Multi-Frame
0
0
X
1
0
1
0
1
Desired Frame Type
Basic Frame
The CRC Multi-Frame is generated on the base of the Basic frame
generation. When it is generated, the CRC Multi-Frame alignment
pattern (‘001011’) will replace the Bit 1 of TS0 of the first 6 odd frames;
the calculated 4-bit CRC of the previous Sub-Multi-Frame will be
inserted in the CRC-bit positions of the current Sub-Multi-Frame. The
CRC-bit position is the Bit 1 of TS0 of each even frame. Refer to
Table 18 for the CRC Multi-Frame structure. If the CRCPINV bit is set,
one 6-bit CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern will be inverted; if the
CRCINV bit is set, all 4 calculated CRC bits in one Sub-Multi-Frame will
be inverted.
When the CRC Multi-Frame is generated, since 14 International bit
positions have been occupied by the CRC Multi-Frame alignment
pattern and CRC-4 checking bits, the remaining 2 International bit positions are inserted by the E bits. The control over the E bits is illustrated
in Table 48.
When the Basic frame is generated, the Frame Alignment Sequence
(FAS) (‘0011011’) will replace the Bit 2 ~ Bit 8 of TS0 of each even
frame; the NFAS bit (‘1’) will replace the Bit 2 of TS0 of each odd frame.
Table 48: Control Over E Bits
FEBEDIS
OOCMFV
SiDIS
E Bits Insertion
0
0
X
A single zero is inserted into the E bit when a CRC-4 Error event is detected in the receive path. (the E1 bit corresponds to
SMFI and the E2 bit corresponds to SMFII)
0
1
X
The value in the Si[1] bit is inserted into the E1 bit position. The value in the Si[0] bit is inserted into the E2 bit position.
1
X
0
The value in the Si[1] bit is inserted into the E1 bit position. The value in the Si[0] bit is inserted into the E2 bit position.
1
X
1
The E bit positions are unchanged.
When the CRC Multi-Frame is generated, the setting in the SaX[1:4]
bits will be transmitted in the Sa bit position if enabled by the corresponding SaXEN bit (‘X’ is from 4 to 8).
When the Signaling Multi-Frame is generated, if the XDIS bit is ‘0’,
the value set in the FGEN Extra register will be inserted into the Extra
bits (the Bit 5, 7 & 8 of TS16 of Frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame).
The Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame is generated
on the base of the Basic frame generation. When it is generated, the
Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern (‘0000’) will replace the high
nibble (Bit 1 ~ Bit 4) of TS16 of every 16 Basic frames. If the CASPINV
bit is set, one 4-bit Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern will be
inverted.
When the Signaling Multi-Frame is generated, the value in the
MFAIS bit will be continuously transmitted in the Y bit position (the Bit 6
of TS16 of Frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame).
Functional Description
When the Signaling Multi-Frame is generated, all the bits in TS16
can be overwritten by all ‘Zero’s or all ’One’s by setting the TS16LOS bit
or the TS16AIS bit respectively. The all zeros overwritten takes a higher
priority.
92
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
When the Modified CRC Multi-Frame is generated, only the Sa bit
position and the calculated CRC-4 bit position can be changed. All the
other bits are transparently transmitted unless all ’One’s or all ‘Zero’s are
transmitted (refer to Chapter 3.20.6 All ‘Zero’s & All ‘One’s).
The frame can only be generated on the base of the FDIS bit being
‘0’. If the FDIS bit is set to ‘1’, the data received from the Transmit
Payload Control will be transmitted transparently to the HDLC Transmitter.
Table 49: Interrupt Summary In E1 Mode
Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Indication Bit
Interrupt Enable Bit
At the first bit of each FAS.
FASI
FASE
At the first bit of each Basic frame.
BFI
BFE
At the first bit of each CRC Multi-Frame.
MFI
MFE
At the first bit of each CRC Sub Multi-Frame.
SMFI
SMFE
At the first bit of each Signaling Multi-Frame.
SIGMFI
SIGMFE
Table 50: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.1.2
Bit
Register
E1 Address (Hex)
E1 Mode
062, 162, 262, 362, 462, 562, 662, 762
Error Insertion
06F, 16F, 26F, 36F, 46F, 56F, 66F, 76F
FGEN International Bit
063, 163, 263, 363, 463, 563, 663, 763
FDIS
GENCRC
CRCM
SIGEN
SiDIS
FEBEDIS
XDIS
FAS1INV
FASALLINV
NFASINV
CRCPINV
CASPINV
CRCINV
Si[1]
Si[0]
Functional Description
93
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 50: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.1.2
Bit
Register
E1 Address (Hex)
FGEN Maintenance 0
06B, 16B, 26B, 36B, 46B, 56B, 66B, 76B
SaX[1:4] (‘X’ is from 4 to 8)
Sa4 Code-word ~ Sa8 Code-word
065 ~ 069, 165 ~ 169, 265 ~ 269, 365 ~ 369,
465 ~ 469, 565 ~ 569, 665 ~ 669, 765 ~ 769
SaXEN (‘X’ is from 4 to 8)
FGEN Sa Control
064, 164, 264, 364, 464, 564, 664, 764
OOCMFV
FRMR Status
04F, 14F, 24F, 34F, 44F, 54F, 64F, 74F
X[0:2]
FGEN Extra
06A, 16A, 26A, 36A, 46A, 56A, 66A, 76A
FGEN Interrupt Indication
06E, 16E, 26E, 36E, 46E, 56E, 66E, 76E
FGEN Interrupt Control
06D, 16D, 26D, 36D, 46D, 56D, 66D, 76D
REMAIS
AUTOYELLOW
G706RAI
MFAIS
TS16LOS
TS16AIS
FASI
BFI
MFI
SMFI
SIGMFI
FASE
BFE
MFE
SMFE
SIGMFE
Functional Description
94
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.20.2 HDLC TRANSMITTER
Table 51: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.2.1
The HDLC Transmitter inserts the data into the selected position to
form HDLC packet data stream.
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
THDLC1 Assignment (E1
only) / THDLC2 Assignment / THDLC3 Assignment
085, 185, 285, 385, 485, 585,
685, 785 (E1 only) / 086, 186,
286, 386, 486, 586, 686, 786 /
087, 187, 287, 387, 487, 587,
687, 787
THDLC1 Bit Select (E1
only) / THDLC2 Bit Select /
THDLC3 Bit Select
088, 188, 288, 388, 488, 588,
688, 788 (E1 only) / 089, 189,
289, 389, 489, 589, 689, 789 /
08A, 18A, 28A, 38A, 48A, 58A,
68A, 78A
THDLC Enable Control
084, 184, 284, 384, 484, 584,
684, 784
3.20.2.1 HDLC Channel Configuration
EVEN
In T1/J1 mode ESF & T1 DM formats, three HDLC Transmitters (#1,
#2 & #3) per link are provided for HDLC insertion to the data stream to
be transmitted. In T1/J1 mode SF & SLC-96 formats, two HDLC Transmitters (#2 & #3) per link are provided for HDLC insertion. In E1 mode,
three HDLC Transmitters (#1, #2 & #3) per link are provided for HDLC
insertion. Except in T1/J1 mode ESF & T1 DM formats, the HDLC
channel of HDLC Transmitter #1 is fixed in the DL bit (in ESF format)
and D bit in CH24 (in T1 DM format) respectively (refer to Table 13 &
Table 14), the other HDLC channel is configured as the follows:
• Set the EVEN bit and/or the ODD bit to select the even and/or odd
frames;
• Set the TS[4:0] bits to define the channel/timeslot of the assigned
frame;
• Set the BITEN[7:0] bits to select the bits of the assigned channel/
timeslot.
ODD
3.20.2.2 HDLC Mode
Then all the functions of the HDLC Transmitter will be enabled only if
the corresponding TDLEN bit is set to ‘1’.
Setting the THDLCM bit to ‘0’ (default) in the HDLC Transmitter
selects the HDLC mode (per Q.921).
TS[4:0]
BITEN[7:0]
TDLEN3
TDLEN2
TDLEN1
Table 52: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.2.2 ~ Chapter 3.20.2.4
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
THDLC1 Control / THDLC2 Control / THDLC3 Control
0A7, 1A7, 2A7, 3A7, 4A7, 5A7, 6A7, 7A7 / 0A8, 1A8, 2A8, 3A8, 4A8,
5A8, 6A8, 7A8 / 0A9, 1A9, 2A9, 3A9, 4A9, 5A9, 6A9, 7A9
THDLC1 Data / THDLC2 Data / THDLC3 Data
0AD, 1AD, 2AD, 3AD, 4AD, 5AD, 6AD, 7AD / 0AE, 1AE, 2AE, 3AE,
4AE, 5AE, 6AE, 7AE / 0AF, 1AF, 2AF, 3AF, 4AF, 5AF, 6AF, 7AF
TFIFO1 Status / TFIFO2 Status / TFIFO3 Status
0B0, 1B0, 2B0, 3B0, 4B0, 5B0, 6B0, 7B0 / 0B1, 1B1, 2B1, 3B1, 4B1,
5B1, 6B1, 7B1 / 0B2, 1B2, 2B2, 3B2, 4B2, 5B2, 6B2, 7B2
THDLC Enable Control
084, 184, 284, 384, 484, 584, 684, 784
TFIFO1 Threshold / TFIFO2 Threshold / TFIFO3 Threshold
0AA, 1AA, 2AA, 3AA, 4AA, 5AA, 6AA, 7AA / 0AB, 1AB, 2AB, 3AB,
4AB, 5AB, 6AB, 7AB / 0AC, 1AC, 2AC, 3AC, 4AC, 5AC, 6AC, 7AC
THDLC1 Interrupt Indication / THDLC2 Interrupt Indication /
THDLC3 Interrupt Indication
0B6, 1B6, 2B6, 3B6, 4B6, 5B6, 6B6, 7B6 / 0B7, 1B7, 2B7, 3B7, 4B7,
5B7, 6B7, 7B7 / 0B8, 1B8, 2B8, 3B8, 4B8, 5B8, 6B8, 7B8
THDLC1 Interrupt Control / THDLC2 Interrupt Control /
THDLC3 Interrupt Control
0B3, 1B3, 2B3, 3B3, 4B3, 5B3, 6B3, 7B3 / 0B4, 1B4, 2B4, 3B4, 4B4,
5B4, 6B4, 7B4 / 0B5, 1B5, 2B5, 3B5, 4B5, 5B5, 6B5, 7B5
THDLCM
EOM
ABORT
TRST
DAT[7:0]
FUL
EMP
RDY
TDLEN3
TDLEN2
TDLEN1
HL[1:0]
LL[1:0]
RDYI
UDRUNI
RDYE
UDRUNE
Functional Description
95
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.20.3 AUTOMATIC PERFORMANCE REPORT MESSAGE (T1/J1
ONLY)
• The Frame Alignment Bit Error event detected in the Frame Processor;
• The Severely Frame Alignment Bit Error event detected in the
Frame Processor;
• The Buffer Slip event occurred in the Elastic Store Buffer.
The Automatic Performance Report Message (APRM) can only be
transmitted in the ESF format in T1/J1 mode.
Five kinds of events are counted every second in the APRM:
• The Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error / HDB3 Code Violation (CV)
Error event detected in the B8ZS/HDL3/AMI Decoder;
• The CRC-6 Error event detected in the Frame Processor;
Enabled by the AUTOPRM bit, the Automatic Performance Report
Message is generated every one second and transmitted on the DL bit
positions. The APRM format is illustrated in Table 53.
Table 53: APRM Message Format
Octet No.
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
1
Flag (‘01111110’)
2
SAPI (‘001110C/R0’)
3
TEI (‘00000001’)
4
Control (‘00000011’)
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
5
G3
LV
G4
U1
U2
G5
SL
G6
6
FE
SE
LB
G1
R
G2
Nm
Ni
7
G3
LV
G4
U1
U2
G5
SL
G6
8
FE
SE
LB
G1
R
G2
Nm
Ni
9
G3
LV
G4
U1
U2
G5
SL
G6
10
FE
SE
LB
G1
R
G2
Nm
Ni
11
G3
LV
G4
U1
U2
G5
SL
G6
12
FE
SE
LB
G1
R
G2
Nm
Ni
13
FCS
14
The APRM is transmitted bit by bit from Bit 1 to Bit 8 and from Octet
No. 1 to Octet No. 14. In the above table, the value in the C/R bit position, the R bit position, the U1 bit position, the U2 bit position and the LB
bit position are determined by the CRBIT bit, the RBIT bit, the U1BIT bit,
the U2BIT bit and the LBBIT bit in the APRM Control register respectively.
Functional Description
The Nm and Ni bit position is a module 4 counter.
The remaining bits in Octet No.5 to Octet No. 12 interpret the event
numbers counted by the APRM. The details are listed in Table 54. Their
default value are ‘0’s.
96
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 54: APRM Interpretation
A Logic 1 In The Following Bit Position
Interpretation
G1
CRC-6 Error event = 1
G2
1 < CRC-6 Error event ≤ 5
G3
5 < CRC-6 Error event ≤ 10
G4
10 < CRC-6 Error event ≤ 100
G5
100 < CRC-6 Error event ≤ 319
G6
CRC-6 Error event > 320
SE
Severely Frame Alignment Bit Error event ≥ 1
FE
Frame Alignment Bit Error event ≥ 1
LV
Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error / HDB3 Code Violation (CV) Error event ≥ 1
SL
Buffer Slip event ≥ 1
3.20.5 INBAND LOOPBACK CODE GENERATOR (T1/J1 ONLY)
Table 55: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.3
Bit
Register
The Inband Loopback Code Generator can only transmit inband
loopback code in a framed or unframed T1/J1 data stream.
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
The length and the content of the inband loopback code are
programmed in the CL[1:0] bits and the IBC[7:0] bits respectively. The
code can only be transmitted when the IBCDEN bit is enabled. In framed
mode, which is configured by the IBCDUNFM bit, the bits in all 24 channels are overwritten with the inband loopback code and the F-bit is not
changed. In unframed mode, which is configured by the IBCDUNFM bit,
all the bits in 24 channels and the F-bit are overwritten with the inband
loopback code.
AUTOPRM
CRBIT
RBIT
U1BIT
APRM Control
07F, 17F, 27F, 37F, 47F,
57F,67F, 77F
U2BIT
LBBIT
Table 56: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.4 & Chapter 3.20.5
3.20.4 BIT-ORIENTED MESSAGE TRANSMITTER (T1/J1 ONLY)
The Bit Oriented Message (BOM) can only be transmitted in the ESF
format in T1/J1 mode.
The BOM pattern is ‘111111110XXXXXX0’ which occupies the DL of
the F-bit in the ESF format. The six ‘X’s represent the code that is
programmed in the XBOC[5:0] bits. The BOM is transmitted only if the
XBOC[5:0] bits are not all ’One’s.
Bit
Register
T1/J1 Address (Hex)
XBOC[5:0]
XBOC Code
080, 180, 280, 380, 480, 580, 680,
780
IBC[7:0]
XIBC Code
075, 175, 275, 375, 475, 575, 675,
775
XIBC Control
074, 174, 274, 374, 474, 574, 674,
774
CL[1:0]
IBCDEN
IBCDUNFM
Functional Description
97
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.20.6 ALL ‘ZERO’S & ALL ‘ONE’S
In other Transmit Clock Slave modes, whether the Transmit Buffer is
bypassed and the source of the transmit clock selection are selected by
the XTS bit. When the XTS bit is set to ‘1’, line side timing is from
internal clock generator, but backplane timing is from backplane, so the
Transmit Buffer is selected to accommodate the different clocks. If these
two clocks are not locked, an internal slip will occur in the Transmit
Buffer. The source of the transmit clock is from the master clock generated by the internal clock generator (1.544 MHz in T1/J1 mode or 2.048
MHz in E1 mode). When the XTS bit is set to ‘0’, the line side timing is
also from the backplane timing, so the Transmit Buffer is bypassed. The
source of the transmit clock is from the processed clock from the backplane.
After all the above processes, all ’One’s or all ‘Zero’s will overwrite all
the data stream if the TAIS bit and the TXDIS bit are set. The all zeros
transmission takes a higher priority.
3.20.7 CHANGE OF FRAME ALIGNMENT
Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the COFAEN bit will
lead to one-bit deletion or one-bit repetition in the data stream to be
transmitted, that is, to change the frame alignment position. The one-bit
deletion or repetition occurs randomly.
3.21 TRANSMIT BUFFER
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, whether the Transmit Buffer is
bypassed and the source of the transmit clock selection are the same as
that described in other Transmit Clock Slave modes.
Transmit Buffer can be used in the circumstances that backplane
timing is different from the line side timing in Transmit Slave mode.
The function of timing option is also integrated in this block. The
source of the transmit clock can be selected in the recovered clock from
the line side, the processed clock from the backplane or the master
clock generated by the clock generator.
In most applications of Transmit Clock Slave mode, the XTS bit can
be set to ‘0’ to bypass the Transmit Buffer (The Transmit Buffer is
selected automatically in T1/J1 mode E1 rate).
In Transmit Master mode, the Transmit Buffer is bypassed automatically. The source of the transmit clock can be selected between the
recovered clock from the line side and the master clock generated by
the internal clock generator (1.544 MHz in T1/J1 mode or 2.048 MHz in
E1 mode). The selection is made by the XTS bit.
Table 57: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.20.6, Chapter 3.20.7 &
Chapter 3.21
Bit
Address (Hex)
FGEN Maintenance 1
06C, 16C, 26C, 36C,
46C, 56C, 66C, 76C
Transmit Timing Option
070, 170, 270, 370, 470,
570, 670, 770
TAIS
In Transmit Clock Slave T1/J1 mode E1 rate, for the backplane
timing is 2.048 MHz from backplane and the line timing is 1.544 MHz
from the internal clock generator, the Transmit Buffer is selected automatically to absorb high frequency mapping jitter due to the E1 to T1/J1
mapping scheme. In this case, 1.544 MHz must be locked to 2.048 MHz
by PLL of the internal clock generator. The XTS bit in the Transmit
Timing Option register does not take effect.
Functional Description
Register
TXDIS
COFAEN
XTS
98
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.22 ENCODER
3.23 TRANSMIT JITTER ATTENUATOR
3.22.1 LINE CODE RULE
3.22.1.1 T1/J1 Mode
The Transmit Jitter Attenuator of each link can be chosen to be used
or not. This selection is made by the TJA_E bit.
In T1/J1 mode, the B8ZS line code rule or the AMI line code rule can
be selected by the T_MD bit.
The Jitter Attenuator consists of a FIFO and a DPLL, as shown in
Figure 7.
3.22.1.2 E1 Mode
The FIFO is used as a pool to buffer the jittered input data, then the
data is clocked out of the FIFO by a de-jittered clock. The depth of the
FIFO can be 32 bits, 64 bits or 128 bits, as selected by the TJA_DP[1:0]
bits. Accordingly, the constant delay produced by the Jitter Attenuator is
16 bits, 32 bits or 64 bits. The 128-bit FIFO is used when large jitter
tolerance is expected, and the 32-bit FIFO is used in delay sensitive
applications.
In E1 mode, the HDB3 line code rule or the AMI line code rule can be
selected by the T_MD bit.
3.22.2 BPV ERROR INSERTION
For test purpose, a BPV error can be inserted to the data stream to
be transmitted by a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the BPV_INS bit.
The DPLL is used to generate a de-jittered clock to clock out the data
stored in the FIFO. The DPLL can only attenuate the incoming jitter
whose frequency is above Corner Frequency (CF). The jitter which
frequency is lower than the CF passes through the DPLL without any
attenuation. In T1/J1 applications, the CF of the DPLL can be 5 Hz or
1.26 Hz, as selected by the TJA_BW bit. In E1 applications, the CF of
the DPLL can be 6.77 Hz or 0.87 Hz, as selected by the TJA_BW bit.
The lower the CF is, the longer time is needed to achieve synchronization.
3.22.3 ALL ‘ONE’S INSERTION
When the LOS is detected in the receive path, all ‘One’s will be
inserted automatically to the data stream to be transmitted by setting the
ATAO bit.
Table 58: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.22
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
T_MD
Transmit Configuration 0
022, 122, 222, 322,
422, 522, 622, 722
BPV_INS
Maintenance Function Control 2
031, 131, 231, 331,
431, 531, 631, 731
ATAO
Maintenance Function Control 1
02C, 12C, 22C, 32C,
42C, 52C, 62C, 72C
If the incoming data moves faster than the outgoing data, the FIFO
will overflow. If the incoming data moves slower than the outgoing data,
the FIFO will underflow. The overflow or underflow is captured by the
TJA_IS bit. When the TJA_IS bit is ‘1’, an interrupt will be reported on
the INT pin if enabled by the TJA_IE bit.
To avoid overflowing or underflowing, the JA-Limit function can be
enabled by setting the TJA_LIMT bit. When the JA-Limit function is
enabled, the speed of the outgoing data will be adjusted automatically if
the FIFO is close to its full or emptiness. The criteria of speed adjustment start are listed in Table 6. Though the LA-Limit function can reduce
the possibility of FIFO overflow and underflow, the quality of jitter attenuation is deteriorated.
Selected by the TJITT_TEST bit, the real time interval between the
read and write pointer of the FIFO or the peak-peak interval between the
read and write pointer of the FIFO can be indicated in the TJITT[6:0]
bits. When the TJITT_TEST bit is ‘0’, the current interval between the
read and write pointer of the FIFO will be written into the TJITT[6:0] bits.
When the TJITT_TEST bit is ‘1’, the current interval is compared with
the old one in the TJITT[6:0] bits and the larger one will be indicated by
the TJITT[6:0] bits.
The performance of Receive Jitter Attenuator meets the ITUT I.431,
G.703, G.736 - 739, G.823, G.824, ETSI 300011, ETSI TBR 12/13,
AT&T TR62411, TR43802, TR-TSY 009, TR-TSY 253, TR-TRY 499
standards. Refer to Chapter 7.10 Jitter Tolerance and Chapter 7.10
Jitter Tolerance for details.
Functional Description
99
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.24 WAVEFORM SHAPER / LINE BUILD OUT
Table 59: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.23
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
Transmit Jitter Attenuation Configuration
021, 121, 221,
321, 421, 521,
621, 721
TJA_E
TJA_DP[1:0]
TJA_LIMT
3.24.1.1 T1/J1 Mode
TJITT_TEST
TJA_IS
Interrupt Status 1
03B, 13B, 23B,
33B, 43B, 53B,
63B, 73B
TJA_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 1
034, 134, 234,
334, 434, 534,
634, 734
TJITT[6:0]
3.24.1 PRESET WAVEFORM TEMPLATE
Transmit Jitter Measure Value Indication
In T1/J1 applications, the waveform template is shown in Figure 32,
which meets T1.102 and G.703, and it is measured in the far end as
shown in Figure 33.
1.2
1
038, 138, 238,
338, 438, 538,
638, 738
0.8
Normalized Amplitude
TJA_BW
According to the various cables, configured by the PULS[3:0] bits,
three ways of manipulating the waveform shaper can be selected before
the data is transmitted:
• Preset Waveform Template;
• Line Build Out (LBO) Filter (T1 only);
• User-Programmable Arbitrary Waveform.
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
-0.2
-0.4
-0.6
0
250
500
750
1000
1250
Time (ns)
Figure 32. DSX-1 Waveform Template
TTIPn
Cable
IDT82P2288
RLOAD VOUT
TRINGn
Note: RLOAD = 100 Ω + 5%
Figure 33. T1/J1 Pulse Template Measurement Circuit
In T1 applications, to meet the template, five preset waveform
templates are provided corresponding to five grades of cable length.
The selection is made by the PULS[3:0] bits. In J1 applications, the
PULS[3:0] bits should be set to ‘0010’. The details are listed in Table 60.
Functional Description
100
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
To meet the template, two preset waveform templates are provided
corresponding to two kinds of cable impedance. The selection is made
by the PULS[3:0] bits. In internal impedance matching mode, if the cable
impedance is 75 Ω, the PULS[3:0] bits should be set to ‘0000’; if the
cable impedance is 120 Ω, the PULS[3:0] bits should be set to ‘0001’. In
external impedance matching mode, for both 75 Ω and 120 Ω cable
impedance, the PULS[3:0] bits should be set to ‘0001’.
Table 60: PULS[3:0] Setting In T1/J1 Mode
Cable Configuration
PULS[3:0]
T1 - 0 ~ 133 ft
0010
T1 - 133 ~ 266 ft
0011
T1 - 266 ~ 399 ft
0100
T1 - 399 ~ 533 ft
0101
T1 - 533 ~ 655 ft
0110
J1 - 0 ~ 655 ft
0010
3.24.2 LINE BUILD OUT (LBO) (T1 ONLY)
In long haul applications, the output on the TTIPn/TRINGn pins
should be attenuated before transmission to prevent the cross-talk in the
far end. Three LBOs are used to implement the pulse attenuation. Four
grades of attenuation with each step of 7.5 dB are specified in the FCC
Part 68 Regulations. The attenuation grade is selected by the PULS[3:0]
bits. The details are listed in Table 61.
3.24.1.2 E1 Mode
In E1 applications, the waveform template is shown in Figure 34,
which meets G.703, and it is measured on the near line side as shown in
Figure 35.
Table 61: LBO PULS[3:0] Setting In T1 Mode
1.20
Normalized Amplitude
1.00
0.80
PULS[3:0]
0 dB LBO
0010
-7.5 dB LBO
1001
-15.0 dB LBO
1010
-22.5 dB LBO
1011
3.24.3 USER-PROGRAMMABLE ARBITRARY WAVEFORM
0.60
User-programmable arbitrary waveform can be used in both short
haul applications and long haul applications if the PULS[3:0] bits are set
to ‘11XX’ in the corresponding link. This allows the transmitter performance to be tuned for a wide variety of line condition or special application.
0.40
0.20
0.00
-0.20
Cable Configuration
-0.6
-0.4
-0.2
0
0.2
0.6
0.4
Time In Unit Intervals
Figure 34. E1 Waveform Template
There are twelve standard templates which are stored in a local
ROM. One of them can be selected as reference and made some
changes to get the desired waveform.
TTIPn
IDT82P2288
RLOAD
VOUT
TRINGn
Note: RLOAD = 75 Ω or 120 Ω (+ 5%)
Figure 35. E1 Pulse Template Measurement Circuit
Functional Description
Each pulse shape can extend up to 4 UIs (Unit Interval) addressed
by the UI[1:0] bits, and each UI is divided into 16 sub-phases addressed
by the SAMP[3:0] bits. The pulse amplitude of each phase is represented by a binary byte, within the range from +63 to -63, stored in the
WDAT[6:0] bits in signed magnitude form. The maximum number +63
(D) represents the positive maximum amplitude of the transmit pulse
while the most negative number -63 (D) represents the maximum negative amplitude of the transmit pulse. Thus, up to 64 bytes are used. For
each channel, a 64 bytes RAM is available.
To do this, the first step is to choose a set of waveform value, which
is the most similar to the desired pulse shape, from the following 12
tables (Table 62 to Table 73), and set the SCAL[5:0] bits to the corresponding standard value. Table 62 to Table 73 list the sample data and
the standard scaling value of each of the 12 templates.
Modifying the corresponding sample data can get the desired
transmit pulse shape. By increasing or decreasing by ‘1’ from the standard value in the SCAL[5:0] bits, the pulse amplitude can be scaled up
101
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
or down at the percentage ratio against the standard pulse amplitude if
necessary. For different pulse shapes, the value of the SCAL[5:0] bits
and the scaling percentage ratio are different. The values are listed in
Table 62 to Table 73.
9. Table 70 - Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 0 dB LBO
Do the followings step by step, the desired waveform can be
programmed based on the selected waveform template:
12. Table 73 - Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -22.5 dB LBO
10. Table 71 - Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -7.5 dB LBO
11. Table 72 - Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -15.0 dB LBO
Table 62: Transmit Waveform Value For E1 75 Ω
1. Select the UI by the UI[1:0] bits;
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
Sample 1
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0001100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
1. Table 62 - Transmit Waveform Value For E1 75 Ω
Sample 11
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
2. Table 63 - Transmit Waveform Value For E1 120 Ω
Sample 12
0110000
0000000
0000000
0000000
3. Table 64 - Transmit Waveform Value For T1 0~133 ft
Sample 13
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
6. Table 67 - Transmit Waveform Value For T1 399~533 ft
Sample 15
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
7. Table 68 - Transmit Waveform Value For T1 533~655 ft
Sample 16
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
2. Specify the sample address in the selected UI by the SAMP[3:0]
bits;
3. Write sample data to the WDAT[6:0] bits. It contains the data to be
stored in the RAM, addressed by the selected UI and the corresponding
sample address;
4. Set the RW bit to ‘0’ to write data to RAM, or to ‘1’ to read data
from RAM;
5. Set the DONE bit to implement the read or write operation;
(Repeat the above steps until all the sample data are written to or
read from the internal RAM).
6. Write the scaling data to the SCAL[5:0] bits to scale the amplitude
of the waveform based on the selected standard pulse amplitude.
Table 62 to Table 73 give all the sample data based on preset pulse
templates and LBOs in details for reference. For preset pulse templates
and LBOs, scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude is not
supported.
4. Table 65 - Transmit Waveform Value For T1 133~266 ft
5. Table 66 - Transmit Waveform Value For T1 266~399 ft
8. Table 69 - Transmit Waveform Value For J1 0~655 ft
Functional Description
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘100001’. One step change of this value
results in 3% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
102
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 63: Transmit Waveform Value For E1 120 Ω
Table 64: Transmit Waveform Value For T1 0~133 ft
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
Sample 1
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 1
0010111
1000010
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0100111
1000001
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0100111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0001111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0100110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0100100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0100011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
1001010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
1001010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
0111100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
1001001
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
1000111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
1000101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
1000100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
0000000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
1000011
0000000
0000000
0000000
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘100001’. One step change of this value
results in 3% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
Functional Description
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘110110’. One step change of this value
results in 2% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
103
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 65: Transmit Waveform Value For T1 133~266 ft
Table 66: Transmit Waveform Value For T1 266~399 ft
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
Sample 1
0011011
1000011
0000000
0000000
Sample 1
0011111
1000011
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0101100
1000010
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0110001
1000010
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0101011
1000001
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0101111
1000001
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0101010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0101100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0101000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0101011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0101000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0101010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0100111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0101001
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0100110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0101000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
1010000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
1010111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
1001111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
1010011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
1001101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
1010000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
1001010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
1001011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
1001000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
1001000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
1000110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
1000110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
1000100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
1000100
0000000
0000000
0000000
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘110110’. One step change of this value
results in 2% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
Functional Description
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘110110’. One step change of this value
results in 2% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
104
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 67: Transmit Waveform Value For T1 399~533 ft
Table 68: Transmit Waveform Value For T1 533~655 ft
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
Sample 1
0100000
1000011
0000000
0000000
Sample 1
0100000
1000011
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0111000
1000010
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0111111
1000010
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0110011
1000001
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0111000
1000001
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0101111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0110011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0101110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0101111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0101101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0101110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0101100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0101101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0101010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0101100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0101000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0101001
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
1011000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
1011111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
1011000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
1011110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
1010011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
1010111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
1001100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
1001111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
1001000
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
1001001
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
1000110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
1000111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
1000100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
1000100
0000000
0000000
0000000
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘110110’. One step change of this value
results in 2% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
Functional Description
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘110110’. One step change of this value
results in 2% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
105
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 69: Transmit Waveform Value For J1 0~655ft
Table 70: Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 0 dB LBO
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
Sample 1
0010111
1000010
0000000
0000000
Sample 1
0010111
1000010
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0100111
1000001
0000000
0000000
Sample 2
0100111
1000001
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0100111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 3
0100111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0100110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 4
0100110
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 5
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 6
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 7
0100101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0100100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 8
0100100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0100011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 9
0100011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
1001010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 10
1001010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
1001010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 11
1001010
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
1001001
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 12
1001001
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
1000111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
1000111
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
1000101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
1000101
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
1000100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
1000100
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
1000011
0000000
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
1000011
0000000
0000000
0000000
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘110110’. One step change of this value
results in 2% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
Functional Description
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘110110’. One step change of this value
results in 2% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
106
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 71: Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -7.5 dB LBO
Table 72: Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -15.0 dB LBO
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
Sample 1
0000000
0010100
0000010
0000000
Sample 1
0000000
0110101
0001111
0000011
Sample 2
0000010
0010010
0000010
0000000
Sample 2
0000000
0110011
0001101
0000010
Sample 3
0001001
0010000
0000010
0000000
Sample 3
0000000
0110000
0001100
0000010
Sample 4
0010011
0001110
0000010
0000000
Sample 4
0000001
0101101
0001011
0000010
Sample 5
0011101
0001100
0000010
0000000
Sample 5
0000100
0101010
0001010
0000010
Sample 6
0100101
0001011
0000001
0000000
Sample 6
0001000
0100111
0001001
0000001
Sample 7
0101011
0001010
0000001
0000000
Sample 7
0001110
0100100
0001000
0000001
Sample 8
0110001
0001001
0000001
0000000
Sample 8
0010100
0100001
0000111
0000001
Sample 9
0110110
0001000
0000001
0000000
Sample 9
0011011
0011110
0000110
0000001
Sample 10
0111010
0000111
0000001
0000000
Sample 10
0100010
0011100
0000110
0000001
Sample 11
0111001
0000110
0000001
0000000
Sample 11
0101010
0011010
0000101
0000001
Sample 12
0110000
0000101
0000001
0000000
Sample 12
0110000
0010111
0000101
0000001
Sample 13
0101000
0000100
0000000
0000000
Sample 13
0110101
0010101
0000100
0000001
Sample 14
0100000
0000100
0000000
0000000
Sample 14
0110111
0010100
0000100
0000000
Sample 15
0011010
0000011
0000000
0000000
Sample 15
0111000
0010010
0000011
0000000
Sample 16
0010111
0000011
0000000
0000000
Sample 16
0110111
0010000
0000011
0000000
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘010001’. One step change of this value
results in 6.25% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
Functional Description
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘001000’. One step change of the value
results in 12.5% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
107
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
UI 1
UI 2
UI 3
UI 4
Sample 1
0000000
0101100
0011110
0001000
When more than one UI are used to compose the pulse template and
the pulse amplitude is not set properly, the overlap of two consecutive
pulses will make the pulse amplitude overflow (exceed the maximum
limitation). This overflow is captured by the DAC_IS bit, and if enabled
by the DAC_IE bit, an interrupt will be reported by the INT pin.
Sample 2
0000000
0101110
0011100
0000111
Table 74: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.24
Sample 3
0000000
0110000
0011010
0000110
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
Sample 4
0000000
0110001
0011000
0000101
PULS[3:0]
Transmit Configuration 1
023, 123, 223, 323,
423, 523, 623, 723
Sample 5
0000001
0110010
0010111
0000101
UI[1:0]
Sample 6
0000011
0110010
0010101
0000100
SAMP[3:0]
Transmit Configuration 3
025, 125, 225, 325,
425, 525, 625, 725
WDAT[6:0]
Transmit Configuration 4
026, 126, 226, 326,
426, 526, 626, 726
SCAL[5:0]
Transmit Configuration 2
024, 124, 224, 324,
424, 524, 624, 724
DAC_IS
Interrupt Status 1
03B, 13B, 23B, 33B,
43B, 53B, 63B, 73B
DAC_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 1
034, 134, 234, 334,
434, 534, 634, 734
Table 73: Transmit Waveform Value For DS1 -22.5 dB LBO
Sample 7
0000111
0110010
0010100
0000100
Sample 8
0001011
0110001
0010011
0000011
Sample 9
0001111
0110000
0010001
0000011
Sample 10
0010101
0101110
0010000
0000010
Sample 11
0011001
0101100
0001111
0000010
Sample 12
0011100
0101001
0001110
0000010
Sample 13
0100000
0100111
0001101
0000001
Sample 14
0100011
0100100
0001100
0000001
Sample 15
0100111
0100010
0001010
0000001
Sample 16
0101010
0100000
0001001
0000001
RW
DONE
The standard value of the SCAL[5:0] bits is ‘000100’. One step change of this value
results in 25% scaling up/down against the pulse amplitude.
Functional Description
108
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
3.25 LINE DRIVER
The Line Driver can be set to High-Z for redundant application.
The following ways will set the drivers to High-Z:
- Setting the THZ pin to high will globally set all the Line Drivers to
High-Z;
- When there is no clock input on the OSCI pin, all the Line Drivers
will be High-Z (no clock means this: the input on the OSCI pin is
in high/low level, or the duty cycle is less than 30% or larger than
70%);
- After software reset, hardware reset or power on, all the Line
Drivers will be High-Z;
- Setting the T_HZ bit to ‘1’ will set the corresponding Line Driver
to High-Z;
- In Transmit Clock Master mode, if the XTS bit is ‘1’, the source of
the transmit clock is from the recovered clock from the line side.
When the recovered clock from the line side is lost, the Line
Driver in the corresponding link will be High-Z;
- In Transmit Clock Slave mode, if the XTS bit is ‘0’, the source of
the transmit clock is from the backplane timing clock. When the
backplane timing clock is lost (i.e., no transition for more than 72
T1/E1/J1 cycles), the Line Driver in the corresponding link will be
High-Z. However, there is an exception in this case. That is, if the
link is in Remote Loopback mode, the Line Driver will not be
High-Z.
- When the transmit path is power down, the Line Driver in the corresponding link will be High-Z.
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Figure 2 shows the appropriate components to connect with the
cable for one link. Table 75 lists the recommended impedance matching
values for the transmitter.
Table 75: Impedance Matching Value For The Transmitter
Cable
Configuration
Internal Termination
T_TERM[2:0]
75 Ω (E1)
000
120 Ω (E1)
001
100 Ω (T1)
010
110 Ω (J1)
011
RT
External Termination
T_TERM[2:0]
RT
1XX
9.4 Ω
-
-
-
-
0Ω
Table 76: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.25 & Chapter 3.26
Register
Address (Hex)
Transmit Configuration 1
023, 123, 223, 323,
423, 523, 623, 723
XTS
Transmit Timing Option
070, 170, 270, 370,
470, 570, 670, 770
DF_S
Line Status Register 0
036, 136, 236, 336,
436, 536, 636, 736
By these ways, the TTIPn and TRINGn pins will enter into high
impedance state immediately.
DF_IES
Interrupt Trigger Edges Select
035, 135, 235, 335,
435, 535, 635, 735
Controlled by the DFM_ON bit, the output driver short-circuit protection can be enabled. The driver’s output current (peak to peak) is limited
to 110 mA typically. When the output current exceeds the limitation, the
transmit driver failure will be captured by the DF_S bit. Selected by the
DF_IES bit, a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the DF_S bit or any transition
from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the DF_S bit will set the DF_IS bit.
When the DF_IS bit is ‘1’, an interrupt on the INT pin will be reported if
enabled by the DF_IE bit.
DF_IS
Interrupt Status 0
03A, 13A, 23A, 33A,
43A, 53A, 63A, 73A
DF_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 0
033, 133, 233, 333,
433, 533, 633, 733
T_TERM[2:0]
Transmit And Receive Termination Configuration
032, 132, 232, 332,
432, 532, 632, 732
3.26 TRANSMITTER IMPEDANCE MATCHING
In T1/J1 mode, the transmitter impedance matching can be realized
by using internal impedance matching circuit. 100 Ω, 110 Ω, 75 Ω or
120 Ω internal impedance matching circuit can be selected by the
T_TERM[1:0] bits. The external impedance circuitry is not supported in
T1/J1 mode.
In E1 mode, the transmitter impedance matching can be realized by
using internal impedance matching circuit or external impedance
matching circuit. When the T_TERM[2] bit is ‘0’, the internal impedance
matching circuit is enabled. 100 Ω, 110 Ω, 75 Ω or 120 Ω internal
impedance matching circuit can be selected by the T_TERM[1:0] bits.
When the T_TERM[2] bit is ‘1’, the internal impedance matching circuit
is disabled, and different external resistors should be used to realize
different impedance matching.
Functional Description
Bit
T_HZ
DFM_ON
3.27 TESTING AND DIAGNOSTIC FACILITIES
3.27.1 PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR
The PRBS Generator / Detector generates test pattern to either the
transmit or receive direction, and detects the pattern in the opposite
direction. The direction is determined by the PRBSDIR bit. The pattern
can be generated or detected in unframed mode, in 8-bit-based mode or
in 7-bit-based mode. This selection is made by the PRBSMODE[1:0]
bits. In unframed mode, all the data streams are extracted or replaced
and the per-channel/per-TS configuration in the TEST bit is ignored. In
8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode, the extracted or replaced
channel/timeslot is specified by the TEST bit. (In 7-bit-based mode, only
the higher 7 bits of the selected channel/timeslot are used for PRBS
test).
109
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.27.1.1 Pattern Generator
The extracted data is compared with the re-generated pattern. If the
extracted data coincides with the pattern, the pattern is synchronized
and it will be indicated by the SYNCV bit. In synchronization state, each
mismatched bit will generate a PRGD Bit Error event. This event is
captured by the BERI bit and is forwarded to the Performance Monitor.
An interrupt reported on the INT pin will be enabled by the BERE bit if
the BERI bit is ‘1’. When there are more than 10-bit errors detected in
the fixed 48-bit window, the extracted data is out of synchronization and
it also will be indicated by the SYNCV bit. Any transition (from ‘1’ to ‘0’ or
from ‘0’ to ‘1’) on the SYNCV bit will set the SYNCI bit. An interrupt
reported on the INT pin will be enabled by the SYNCE bit if the SYNCI
bit is ‘1’.
Three patterns are generated: 211-1 pattern per O.150, 215-1 pattern
per O.152 and 220-1 pattern per O.150-4.5. They are selected by the
PATS[1:0] bits.
The selected pattern is generated once there is a transition from ‘0’
to ‘1’ on the TESTEN bit.
A single bit error will be inserted to the generated pattern when the
INV bit is set to ‘1’. Before the insertion, the generated pattern can be
inverted when the TINV bit is set.
3.27.1.2 Pattern Detector
Before the data extracted to the pattern detector, the data can be
inverted by setting the RINV bit.
When there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the TESTEN bit, the
pattern detector starts to extract the data. The extracted data is used to
re-generate a desired pattern which is selected by the PATS[1:0] bits.
Table 77: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.27.1
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
TPLC / RPLC / PRGD Test Configuration
0C7, 1C7, 2C7, 3C7, 4C7, 5C7, 6C7, 7C7
ID * - Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code
RPLC & TPLC ID * - 41~58 (for T1/J1) / 41~4F & 51~5F (for E1)
PRGD Control
071, 171, 271, 371, 471, 571, 671, 771
PRGD Status/Error Control
072, 172, 272, 372, 472, 572, 672, 772
PRGD Interrupt Indication
073, 173, 273, 373, 473, 573, 673, 773
PRBSDIR
PRBSMODE[1:0]
TESTEN
TEST
PATS[1:0]
TINV
RINV
INV
SYNCV
BERE
SYNCE
BERI
SYNCI
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Receive & Transmit Payload Control function blocks.
Functional Description
110
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
3.27.2 LOOPBACK
3.27.2.2 Payload Loopback
System Loopback, Payload Loopback, Local Digital Loopback 1 & 2,
Remote Loopback and Analog Loopback are all supported in the
IDT82P2288. Their routes are shown in the Functional Block Diagram.
By programming the GSUBST[2:0] bits or the SUBST[2:0] bits, the
Payload Loopback can be implemented. The received data output from
the Elastic Store Buffer is internally looped to the Transmit Payload
Control.
3.27.2.1 System Loopback
The System Loopback can only be implemented when the Receive
System Interface and the Transmit System Interface are in different
Non-multiplexed operating modes (one in Clock Master mode and the
other in Clock Slave mode). However, in T1/J1 mode, when either the
receive path or the transmit path is in T1/J1 mode E1 rate, the System
Loopback is not supported.
Distinguished by the loopback direction, the System Loopback can
be divided into System Remote Loopback and System Local Loopback.
When the data and signaling bits from the transmit path are looped to
the receive path, it is System Remote Loopback. When the data and
signaling bits from the receive path are looped to the transmit path, it is
System Local Loopback.
System Remote Loopback
Enabled by the SRLP bit, the System Remote Loopback is implemented. The data and signaling bits to be transmitted on the TSDn and
TSIGn pins are internally looped to the RSDn and RSIGn pins. When
the receive path is in Receive Clock Master mode and the transmit path
is in Transmit Clock Slave mode, the clock signal and the framing pulse
from the system side on the TSCKn and TSFSn pins are looped to the
RSCKn and RSFSn pins respectively. When the transmit path is in
Transmit Clock Master mode and the receive path is in Receive Clock
Slave mode, the clock signal and the framing pulse from the system side
on the RSCKn and RSFSn pins are looped to the TSCKn and TSFSn
pins respectively.
In System Remote Loopback mode, the data stream to be transmitted is still output to the line side, while the data stream received from
the line side is replaced by the System Remote Loopback data.
System Local Loopback
Enabled by the SLLP bit, the System Local Loopback is implemented. The received data and signaling bits to be output on the RSDn
and RSIGn pins are internally looped to the TSDn and TSIGn pins.
When the receive path is in Receive Clock Master mode and the
transmit path is in Transmit Clock Slave mode, the recovered clock
signal and framing pulse on the RSCKn and RSFSn pins are looped to
the TSCKn and TSFSn pins respectively. When the transmit path is in
Transmit Clock Master mode and the receive path is in Receive Clock
Slave mode, the TSCKn and TSFSn pins are looped to the RSCKn and
RSFSn pins respectively.
In System Local Loopback mode, the data stream received from the
line side is still output to the system through the RSDn and RSIGn pins,
while the data stream to be transmitted through the TSDn and TSIGn
pins are replaced by the System Local Loopback data.
Functional Description
In Payload Loopback mode, the received data is still output to the
system side, while the data to be transmitted from the system side is
replaced by the Payload Loopback data.
3.27.2.3 Local Digital Loopback 1
Enabled by the DLLP bit, the Local Digital Loopback 1 is implemented. The data stream output from the Transmit Buffer is internally
looped to the Frame Processor.
In Local Digital Loopback 1 mode, the data stream to be transmitted
is still output to the line side, while the data stream received from the line
side is replaced by the Local Digital Loopback 1 data.
3.27.2.4 Remote Loopback
Enabled by the RLP bit, the Remote Loopback is implemented. The
data stream output from the optional Receive Jitter Attenuator is internally looped to the optional Transmit Jitter Attenuator.
In Remote Loopback mode, the data stream received from the line
side is still output to the system, while the data stream to be transmitted
is replaced by the Remote Loopback data.
3.27.2.5 Local Digital Loopback 2
Enabled by the DLP bit, the Local Digital Loopback 2 is implemented.
The data stream output from the optional Transmit Jitter Attenuator is
internally looped to the Optional Receive Jitter Attenuator.
In Local Digital Loopback 2 mode, the data stream to be transmitted
is still output to the line side, while the data stream received from the line
side is replaced by the Local Digital Loopback 2 data.
3.27.2.6 Analog Loopback
Enabled by the ALP bit, the Analog Loopback is implemented. The
data stream to be transmitted on the TTIPn/TRINGn pins is internally
looped to the RTIPn/RRINGn pins.
In Analog Loopback mode, the data stream to be transmitted is still
output to the line side, while the data stream received from the line side
is replaced by the Analog Loopback data.
If analog loopback is enabled, line driver should be set to normal
(T_HZ=0 & THZ pin is tied to ground).
3.27.3 G.772 NON-INTRUSIVE MONITORING
When the G.772 Non-Intrusive Monitoring is implemented, only
seven links are in normal operation and the Link 1 is configured to
monitor the receive path or transmit path of any of the remaining links.
Whether the G.772 Non-Intrusive Monitoring is implemented and
which direction (receive/transmit) and link is monitored are both determined by the MON[3:0] bits.
111
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
The G.772 Non-Intrusive Monitoring meets the ITU-T G.772. It is
shown in Figure 36. The data stream of Link 1 is received from the
selected path of any of the remaining links, then processed as normal.
The operation of the monitored link is not effected.
Link 1
TSD1 / MTSDA1
TTIP1
TSIG1 / MTSIGA1
TSFS1 / MTSFS
Transmit System
Interface
Transmit Internal
Termination
TRING1
TSCK1 / MTSCK
RSCK1 / MRSCK
RTIP1
RSFS1 / MRSFS
RSIG1 / MRSIGA1
Receive System
Interface
Receive Internal
Termination
RRING1
RSD1 / MRSDA1
G.772 NonIntrusive Monitor
TSDn / MTSDA2 /
MTSDB[1:2]
TSIGn / MTSIGA2 /
MTSIGB[1:2]
TSFSn
Any Of The Remaining Links (8 > n > 2)
TTIPn
Transmit System
Interface
Transmit Internal
Termination
TRINGn
TSCKn
RSCKn
RTIPn
RSFSn
RSIGn / MRSIGA2
/ MRSIGB[1:2]
RSDn / MRSDA2 /
MRSDB[1:2]
Receive System
Interface
Receive Internal
Termination
RRINGn
Figure 36. G.772 Non-Intrusive Monitor
Functional Description
112
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 78: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.27.2 & Chapter 3.27.3
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
Maintenance Function Control 0
02B, 12B, 22B, 32B, 42B, 52B, 62B, 72B
GSUBST[2:0]
TPLC Configuration
0CB, 1CB, 2CB, 3CB, 4CB, 5CB, 6CB, 7CB
SUBST[2:0]
ID * - Channel Control (for T1/J1) / Timeslot Control (for E1)
TPLC ID * - 01~18 (for T1/J1) / 00~1F (for E1)
MON[3:0]
G.772 Monitor Control
005
SRLP
SLLP
DLLP
RLP
DLP
ALP
Note:
* ID means Indirect Register in the Transmit Payload Control function block.
3.28 INTERRUPT SUMMARY
When the INT pin is asserted low, it means at least one interrupt has
occurred in the device. Reading the Timer Interrupt Indication register
and Interrupt Requisition Link ID register will find whether the timer interrupt occurs or in which link the interrupt occurs.
If the TMOVI bit in the Timer Interrupt Indication register is ‘1’ and the
TMOVE bit in the Timer Interrupt Control register is enabled, the one
second timer of the device generates an interrupt. Then the source is
served after it is found.
Functional Description
After reading the Interrupt Requisition Link ID register, the Interrupt
Module Indication registers of the interrupting link are read. The Interrupt
Module Indication bits will be ‘1’ if there are interrupts in the corresponding function block. To find the eventual interrupt sources, the Interrupt Indication and Status bits in the block are polled if their Interrupt
Enable bits are enabled. Then the sources are served after they are
found.
113
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 79: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 3.28
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
TMOVI
Timer Interrupt Indication
00B
INT[8:1]
Interrupt Requisition Link ID
009
TMOVE
Timer Interrupt Control
00A
LIU
Interrupt Module Indication 2
03F, 13F, 23F, 33F, 43F, 53F, 63F, 73F
Interrupt Module Indication 0
040, 140, 240, 340, 440, 540, 640, 740
Interrupt Module Indication 1
041, 141, 241, 341, 441, 541, 641, 741
IBCD (T1/J1 only)
RBOC (T1/J1 only)
ALARM
PMON
PRGD
RCRB
FGEN
FRMR
THDLC3
THDLC2
THDLC1
RHDLC3
RHDLC2
RHDLC1
ELST
TRSI/RESI
Functional Description
114
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
4
OPERATION
4.1
POWER-ON SEQUENCE
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Vdd
To power on the device, the following sequence should be followed:
• Apply ground;
• Apply 3.3 V;
• Apply 1.8 V.
4.2
RESET
2ms
RESET
Microprocessor
Interface
When the device is powered-up, all the registers contain random
values.
The hardware reset pin RESET must be asserted low during the
power-up and the low signal should last at least 10 ms to initialize the
device. After the RESET pin is asserted high, all the registers are in their
default values and can be accessed after 2 ms (refer to Figure 37).
access
Figure 37. Hardware Reset When Powered-Up
100 ns
During normal operation, the device can be reset by hardware or
software anytime. When it is hardware reset, the RESET pin should be
asserted low for at least 100 ns. Then all the registers are in their default
values and can be accessed after 2 ms (refer to Figure 38). When it is
software reset, a write signal to the Software Reset register will reset all
the registers except the T1/J1 Or E1 Mode register to their default
values. Then the registers are accessible after 2 ms. However, the T1/J1
Or E1 Mode register can not be reset by the software reset. It can only
be reset by the hardware reset.
It should be mentioned that when the setting in the T1/J1 Or E1
Mode register is changed, a software reset must be applied.
10ms
RESET
2ms
Microprocessor
Interface
access
Figure 38. Hardware Reset In Normal Operation
4.3
RECEIVE / TRANSMIT PATH POWER DOWN
The receive path of any of the eight links can be power down by
setting the R_OFF bit. During the receive path power down, the output
of the corresponding path is low.
The transmit path of any of the eight links can be set to power down
by the T_OFF bit. During the transmit path power down, the output of the
corresponding path is High-Z.
4.4
MICROPROCESSOR INTERFACE
The microprocessor interface provides access to read and write the
registers in the device. The interface consists of Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) and parallel microprocessor interface.
Operation
115
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
4.4.1
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
SPI MODE
edge of the SCLK pin. First byte consists of one instruction bit at MSB
and three address bits at LSB, and the second byte is low 8 address
bits. If the MSB is ‘1’, it is read operation. If the MSB is ‘0’, it is write
operation. If the device is in read operation, the data read from the specified register is output on the SDO pin on the falling edge of the SCLK
(refer to Figure 39). If the device is in write operation, the data written to
the specified register is input on the SDI pin following the address byte
(refer to Figure 40).
Pull the SPIEN pin to high, and the microprocessor interface will be
set in SPI mode.
In this mode, only the CS, SCLK, SDI and SDO pins are interfaced
with the microprocessor. A falling transition on CS pin indicates the start
of a read/write operation, and a rising transition indicates the end of the
operation. After the CS pin is set to low, two bytes include instruction
and address bytes on the SDI pin are input to the device on the rising
CS
1
0
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
SCLK
Instruction
Register Address
SDI
X
X
X A11 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0
High Impedance
SDO
Don't Care
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Figure 39. Read Operation In SPI Mode
CS
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
SCLK
Instruction
X
SDI
Data Byte
Register Address
X
X A11 A10 A9 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
High Impedance
SDO
Figure 40. Write Operation In SPI Mode
4.4.2
PARALLEL MICROPROCESSOR INTERFACE
Pull the SPIEN pin to low, the microprocessor interface will be set in
parallel mode. In this mode, the interface is compatible with the Motorola
and the Intel microprocessor, which is selected by the MPM pin. The
IDT82P2288 uses separate address bus and data bus. The mode selection and the interfaced pin are tabularized in Table 80.
Operation
Table 80: Parallel Microprocessor Interface
116
Pin MPM
Microprocessor Interface
Interfaced Pin
Low
Motorola
CS, DS, RW, A[10:0], D[7:0]
High
Intel
CS, RD, WR, A[10:0], D[7:0]
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
4.5
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
INDIRECT REGISTER ACCESS SCHEME
• Read the indirect register data from the Access Data register.
An indirect register access request is completed within 4 µs.
In Receive CAS/RBS Buffer, Receive Payload Control and Transmit
Payload Control blocks, per-channel/per-timeslot indirect register is
accessed by using an indirect register access scheme.
4.5.1
4.5.2
INDIRECT REGISTER WRITE ACCESS
The indirect register write access is as follows:
• Read the BUSY bit in the Access Status register to confirm the bit
is ‘0’;
• Write the Access Data register;
• Write the Access Control register to initiate the write operation and
specify the indirect register address.
INDIRECT REGISTER READ ACCESS
The indirect register read access is as follows:
• Read the BUSY bit in the Access Status register to confirm the bit
is ‘0’;
• Write the Access Control register to initiate the read operation and
specify the indirect register address;
• Read the BUSY bit in the Access Status register again to confirm
the bit is ‘0’;
An indirect register access request is completed within 4 µs.
Table 81: Related Bit / Register In Chapter 4
Bit
Register
Address (Hex)
-
Software Reset
004
T1/J1 Or E1 Mode
020, 120, 220, 320, 420, 520, 620, 720
R_OFF
Receive Configuration 0
028, 128, 228, 328, 428, 528, 628, 728
T_OFF
Transmit Configuration 0
022, 122, 222, 322, 422, 522, 622, 722
BUSY
TPLC Access Status / RPLC Access Status / RCRB Access Status
0C8, 1C8, 2C8, 3C8, 4C8, 5C8, 6C8, 7C8 / 0CD, 1CD, 2CD,
3CD, 4CD, 5CD, 6CD, 7CD / 0D3, 1D3, 2D3, 3D3, 4D3, 5D3,
6D3, 7D3
RWN
ADDRESS[6:0]
TPLC Access Control / RPLC Access Control
/ RCRB Access Control
0C9, 1C9, 2C9, 3C9, 4C9, 5C9, 6C9, 7C9 / 0CE, 1CE, 2CE, 3CE,
4CE, 5CE, 6CE, 7CE / 0D4, 1D4, 2D4, 3D4, 4D4, 5D4, 6D4, 7D4
D[7:0]
TPLC Access Data / RPLC Access Data / RCRB Access Data
0CA, 1CA, 2CA, 3CA, 4CA, 5CA, 6CA, 7CA / 0CF, 1CF, 2CF,
3CF, 4CF, 5CF, 6CF, 7CF / 0D5, 1D5, 2D5, 3D5, 4D5, 5D5, 6D5,
7D5
T1/J1
FM[1:0]
TEMODE
Operation
117
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
5
PROGRAMMING INFORMATION
5.1
REGISTER MAP
In the ‘Reg’ column, the ‘X’ represents 0 ~ 7, corresponding to the eight links.
5.1.1
T1/J1 MODE
5.1.1.1 Direct Register
T1/J1 Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register Name
Reference
Page
000
ID7
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
ID2
ID1
ID0
Chip ID For Octal Transceiver
P 135
001 ~ 003
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Reserved
004
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Software Reset
P 135
005
-
-
-
-
MON3
MON2
MON1
MON0
G.772 Monitor Control
P 136
006
-
-
-
-
LEVEL1
LEVEL0
DIR1
DIR0
GPIO Control
P 137
007
-
-
RO22
RO21
RO20
RO12
RO11
RO10
Reference
Select
008
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Reserved
009
INT8
INT7
INT6
INT5
INT4
INT3
INT2
INT1
00A
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
00B
-
-
-
-
-
-
00C ~
00D
-
-
-
-
-
-
00E
LINKSEL2 LINKSEL1 LINKSEL0
-
Clock
Output
P 138
-
Interrupt Requisition Link ID
P 139
TMOVE
Timer Interrupt Control
P 139
-
TMOVI
Timer Interrupt Indication
P 139
-
-
-
ADDR3
ADDR2
ADDR1
ADDR0
PMON Access Port
P 140
Reserved
-
00F
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
PMON Access Data
P 140
010
-
-
-
RSLVCK
RMUX
MTSDA
TSLVCK
TMUX
Backplane Global Configuration
P 141
011 ~ 01F
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X20
-
-
-
-
T1/J1
FM1
FM0
TEMODE
T1/J1 Or E1 Mode
P 134
X21
-
-
TJITT_TE
ST
TJA_LIMT
TJA_E
TJA_DP1
TJA_DP0
TJA_BW
Transmit Jitter Attenuation
Configuration
P 142
X22
-
-
-
T_OFF
-
-
-
T_MD
Transmit Configuration 0
P 143
X23
-
-
DFM_ON
T_HZ
PULS3
PULS2
PULS1
PULS0
Transmit Configuration 1
P 144
X24
-
-
SCAL5
SCAL4
SCAL3
SCAL2
SCAL1
SCAL0
Transmit Configuration 2
P 145
X25
DONE
RW
UI1
UI0
SAMP3
SAMP2
SAMP1
SAMP0
Transmit Configuration 3
P 146
X26
-
WDAT6
WDAT5
WDAT4
WDAT3
WDAT2
WDAT1
WDAT0
Transmit Configuration 4
P 147
X27
-
-
RJA_E
RJA_DP1
RJA_DP0
RJA_BW
Receive Jitter Attenuation
Configuration
P 147
X28
-
-
-
R_OFF
-
-
-
R_MD
Receive Configuration 0
P 148
X29
-
EQ_ON
-
LOS4
LOS3
LOS2
LOS1
LOS0
Receive Configuration 1
P 149
X2A
-
-
SLICE1
SLICE0
UPDW1
UPDW0
MG1
MG0
Receive Configuration 2
P 150
Programming Information
RJITT_TE RJA_LIMT
ST
118
Reserved
-
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register Name
X2B
-
DLLP
SLLP
SRLP
-
RLP
ALP
DLP
Maintenance Function Control 0
P 151
X2C
-
-
-
-
-
LAC
RAISE
ATAO
Maintenance Function Control 1
P 152
X2D ~
X30
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X31
-
BPV_INS
-
EXZ_DEF
EXZ_ERR
1
EXZ_ERR
0
CNT_MD
CNT_TRF Maintenance Function Control 2
P 153
X32
-
-
T_TERM2
T_TERM1
T_TERM0
R_TERM2
R_TERM1 R_TERM0 Transmit And Receive Termination Configuration
P 154
X33
-
-
-
-
-
DF_IE
-
LOS_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 0
P 154
X34
-
DAC_IE
TJA_IE
RJA_IE
-
EXZ_IE
CV_IE
CNT_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 1
P 155
X35
-
-
-
-
-
DF_IES
-
LOS_IES
Interrupt Trigger Edges Select
P 155
X36
-
-
-
-
-
DF_S
-
LOS_S
Line Status Register 0
P 156
X37
-
-
-
LATT4
LATT3
LATT2
LATT1
LATT0
Line Status Register 1
P 156
X38
-
TJITT6
TJITT5
TJITT4
TJITT3
TJITT2
TJITT1
TJITT0
Transmit Jitter Measure Value
Indication
P 157
X39
-
RJITT6
RJITT5
RJITT4
RJITT3
RJITT2
RJITT1
RJITT0
Receive Jitter Measure Value
Indication
P 157
X3A
-
-
-
-
-
DF_IS
-
LOS_IS
Interrupt Status 0
P 158
X3B
-
DAC_IS
TJA_IS
RJA_IS
-
EXZ_IS
CV_IS
CNTOV_I
S
Interrupt Status 1
P 159
X3C
CNTH[7]
CNTH[6]
CNTH[5]
CNTH[4]
CNTH[3]
CNTH[2]
CNTH[1]
CNTH[0]
EXZ Error Counter H-Byte
P 160
X3D
CNTL[7]
CNTL[6]
CNTL[5]
CNTL[4]
CNTL[3]
CNTL[2]
CNTL[1]
CNTL[0]
EXZ Error Counter L-Byte
P 160
X3E
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X3F
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
LIU
Interrupt Module Indication 2
P 161
X40
IBCD
RBOC
ALARM
PMON
PRGD
RCRB
FGEN
FRMR
Interrupt Module Indication 0
P 162
X41
THDLC3
THDLC2
THDLC1
RHDLC3
RHDLC2
RHDLC1
ELST
TRSI/
RESI
Interrupt Module Indication 1
P 163
X42
-
-
FBITGAP
DE
FE
CMS
FSINV
FSTYP
TBIF Option Register
P 164
X43
-
-
-
-
-
MAP1
MAP0
TMODE
TBIF Operating Mode
P 165
X44
-
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
TBIF TS Offset
P 165
X45
-
-
-
-
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
TBIF Bit Offset
P 166
X46
-
-
-
FBITGAP
DE
FE
CMS
TRI
RBIF Option Register
P 167
X47
-
-
-
-
-
MAP1
MAP0
RMODE
RBIF Mode
P 168
X48
-
-
-
FSINV
-
-
CMFS
ALTFIS
RBIF Frame Pulse
P 169
X49
-
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
RBIF TS Offset
P 170
X4A
-
-
-
-
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
RBIF Bit Offset
P 170
Programming Information
119
Reference
Page
Reserved
-
REFH_LO Reference Clock Output ConS
trol *
P 161
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X4B
-
-
-
-
-
-
RCOFAI
TCOFAI
RTSFS Change Indication
P 171
X4C
-
-
-
-
-
-
RCOFAE
TCOFAE
RTSFS Interrupt Control
P 171
X4D
-
-
-
-
UNFM
REFCRCE
REFEN
REFR
FRMR Mode 0
P 172
X4E
-
-
-
-
DDSC
MIMICC
M2O1
M2O0
FRMR Mode 1
P 173
X4F
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
OOFV
FRMR Status
P 174
X50
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
OOFE
FRMR Interrupt Control 0
P 174
X51
-
-
-
RMFBE
SFEE
BEEE
FERE
COFAE
FRMR Interrupt Control 1
P 175
X52
-
-
EXCRCE
RI
MIMICI
-
-
-
OOFI
FRMR Interrupt Indication 0
P 176
X53
-
-
-
RMFBI
SFEI
BEEI
FERI
COFAI
FRMR Interrupt Indication 1
P 177
X54 ~ X55
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X56
C8
C7
C6
C5
C4
C3
C2
C1
RDL0
P 178
X57
-
-
M3
M2
M1
C11
C10
C9
RDL1
P 178
X58
-
-
S4
S3
S2
S1
A2
A1
RDL2
P 179
X59 ~
X5B
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SCDEB
SCAE
SCSE
SCME
SCCE
DLB Interrupt Control
P 180
DLB Interrupt Indication
P 180
X5C
Reference
Page
Register Name
Reserved
-
Reserved
-
X5D
-
-
-
-
SCAI
SCSI
SCMI
SCCI
X5E ~
X61
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X62
-
-
-
-
-
FDLBYP
CRCBYP
FDIS
X63 ~ X64
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X65
C8
C7
C6
C5
C4
C3
C2
C1
XDL0
P 181
X66
-
-
M3
M2
M1
C11
C10
C9
XDL1
P 182
X67
-
-
S4
S3
S2
S1
A2
A1
XDL2
P 182
X68 ~
X6A
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X6B
-
-
-
-
-
-
AUTOYEL
LOW
XYEL
FGEN Maintenance 0
P 182
X6C
-
-
-
-
MIMICEN
COFAEN
TXDIS
TAIS
FGEN Maintenance 1
P 183
X6D
-
-
-
-
-
-
MFE
BFE
FGEN Interrupt Control
P 183
X6E
-
-
-
-
-
-
MFI
BFI
FGEN Interrupt Indication
P 184
X6F
-
-
-
-
DDSINV
CRCINV
FsINV
FtINV
Error Insertion
P 185
X70
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
XTS
Transmit Timing Option
P 186
X71
-
-
-
-
RINV
TINV
PATS1
PATS0
PRGD Control
P 186
X72
-
-
-
-
BERE
INV
SYNCV
SYNCE
PRGD Status/Error Control
P 187
X73
-
-
-
-
BERI
-
-
SYNCI
PRGD Interrupt Indication
P 187
Programming Information
120
Reserved
-
T1/J1 Mode
P 181
Reserved
-
Reserved
-
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X74
-
-
-
-
IBCDEN
IBCDUNFM
CL1
CL0
XIBC Control
P 188
X75
IBC7
IBC6
IBC5
IBC4
IBC3
IBC2
IBC1
IBC0
XIBC Code
P 188
X76
-
-
-
IBCDIDLE
DSEL1
DSEL0
ASEL1
ASEL0
IBCD Detector Configuration
P 189
X77
-
-
-
-
-
-
LBA
LBD
IBCD Detector Status
P 190
X78
ACT7
ACT6
ACT5
ACT4
ACT3
ACT2
ACT1
ACT0
IBCD Activate Code
P 190
X79
DACT7
DACT6
DACT5
DACT4
DACT3
DACT2
DACT1
DACT0
IBCD Deactivate Code
P 190
X7A
-
-
-
-
-
-
LBAE
LBDE
IBCD Interrupt Control
P 191
X7B
-
-
-
-
-
-
LBAI
LBDI
IBCD Interrupt Indication
P 191
X7C
-
-
-
-
-
TRKEN
SLIPD
SLIPE
ELST Configuration
P 192
X7D
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SLIPI
ELST Interrupt Indication
P 192
X7E
TRKCOD
E7
TRKCOD
E6
TRKCOD
E5
TRKCOD
E4
TRKCOD
E3
TRKCODE
2
TRKCOD
E1
TRKCOD
E0
ELST Trunk Code
P 192
X7F
-
-
LBBIT
U2BIT
U1BIT
RBIT
CRBIT
AUTOPRM
APRM Control
P 193
X80
-
-
XBOC5
XBOC4
XBOC3
XBOC2
XBOC1
XBOC0
XBOC Code
P 193
X81
-
-
-
-
-
-
AVC
BOCE
BOC Control
P 194
X82
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
BOCI
BOC Interrupt Indication
P 194
X83
-
-
BOC5
BOC4
BOC3
BOC2
BOC1
BOC0
RBOC Code
P 194
X84
-
-
-
-
-
TDLEN3
TDLEN2
TDLEN1
THDLC Enable Control
P 195
X85
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X86
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
THDLC2 Assignment
P 195
X87
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
THDLC3 Assignment
P 196
X88
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X89
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
THDLC2 Bit Select
P 197
X8A
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
THDLC3 Bit Select
P 197
X8B
-
-
-
-
-
RDLEN3
RDLEN2
RDLEN1
RHDLC Enable Control
P 197
X8C
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X8D
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
RHDLC2 Assignment
P 198
X8E
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
RHDLC3 Assignment
P 198
X8F
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X90
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
RHDLC2 Bit Select
P 198
X91
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
RHDLC3 Bit Select
P 199
X92
-
-
-
-
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
RHDLC1 Control Register
P 199
X93
-
-
-
-
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
RHDLC2 Control Register
P 199
X94
-
-
-
-
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
RHDLC3 Control Register
P 200
Programming Information
121
Reference
Page
Register Name
Reserved
-
Reserved
-
Reserved
-
Reserved
-
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Reference
Page
T1/J1 Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register Name
X95
-
-
-
-
-
-
EMP
PACK
RHDLC1 RFIFO Access Status
P 201
X96
-
-
-
-
-
-
EMP
PACK
RHDLC2 RFIFO Access Status
P 201
X97
-
-
-
-
-
-
EMP
PACK
RHDLC3 RFIFO Access Status
P 201
X98
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
RHDLC1 Data
P 202
X99
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
RHDLC2 Data
P 202
X9A
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
RHDLC3 Data
P 202
X9B
-
-
-
-
-
-
OVFLE
RMBEE
RHDLC1 Interrupt Control
P 203
X9C
-
-
-
-
-
-
OVFLE
RMBEE
RHDLC2 Interrupt Control
P 203
X9D
-
-
-
-
-
-
OVFLE
RMBEE
RHDLC3 Interrupt Control
P 203
X9E
-
-
-
-
-
-
OVFLI
RMBEI
RHDLC1 Interrupt Indication
P 204
X9F
-
-
-
-
-
-
OVFLI
RMBEI
RHDLC2 Interrupt Indication
P 204
XA0
-
-
-
-
-
-
OVFLI
RMBEI
RHDLC3 Interrupt Indication
P 204
XA1
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
RHDLC1 High Address
P 205
XA2
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
RHDLC2 High Address
P 205
XA3
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
RHDLC3 High Address
P 205
XA4
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
RHDLC1 Low Address
P 206
XA5
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
RHDLC2 Low Address
P 206
XA6
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
RHDLC3 Low Address
P 206
XA7
-
-
-
EOM
-
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
THDLC1 Control
P 206
XA8
-
-
-
EOM
-
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
THDLC2 Control
P 207
XA9
-
-
-
EOM
-
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
THDLC3 Control
P 207
XAA
-
-
-
-
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
TFIFO1 Threshold
P 208
XAB
-
-
-
-
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
TFIFO2 Threshold
P 208
XAC
-
-
-
-
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
TFIFO3 Threshold
P 208
XAD
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
THDLC1 Data
P 209
XAE
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
THDLC2 Data
P 209
XAF
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
THDLC3 Data
P 209
XB0
-
-
-
-
-
FUL
EMP
RDY
TFIFO1 Status
P 210
XB1
-
-
-
-
-
FUL
EMP
RDY
TFIFO2 Status
P 210
XB2
-
-
-
-
-
FUL
EMP
RDY
TFIFO3 Status
P 210
XB3
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNE
RDYE
THDLC1 Interrupt Control
P 211
XB4
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNE
RDYE
THDLC2 Interrupt Control
P 211
XB5
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNE
RDYE
THDLC3 Interrupt Control
P 211
XB6
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNI
RDYI
THDLC1 Interrupt Indication
P 212
Programming Information
122
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reference
Page
XB7
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNI
RDYI
THDLC2 Interrupt Indication
P 212
XB8
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNI
RDYI
THDLC3 Interrupt Indication
P 212
XB9
-
-
-
-
-
AIS
YEL
RED
Alarm Status
P 213
XBA
-
-
-
-
-
AISE
YELE
REDE
Alarm Control
P 214
XBB
-
-
-
-
-
AISI
YELI
REDI
Alarm Indication
P 214
Register Name
XBC
REDDTH7 REDDTH6 REDDTH5 REDDTH4 REDDTH3 REDDTH2 REDDTH1 REDDTH0 RED Declare Threshold
P 215
XBD
REDCTH7 REDCTH6 REDCTH5 REDCTH4 REDCTH3 REDCTH2 REDCTH1 REDCTH0 RED Clear Threshold
P 215
XBE
YELDTH7
YELDTH6
YELDTH5
YELDTH4
YELDTH3
YELDTH2
YELDTH1
YELDTH0 Yellow Declare Threshold
P 215
XBF
YELCTH7
YELCTH6
YELCTH5
YELCTH4
YELCTH3
YELCTH2
YELCTH1
YELCTH0 Yellow Clear Threshold
P 216
XC0
AISDTH7
AISDTH6
AISDTH5
AISDTH4
AISDTH3
AISDTH2
AISDTH1
AISDTH0
AIS Declare Threshold
P 216
XC1
AISCTH7
AISCTH6
AISCTH5
AISCTH4
AISCTH3
AISCTH2
AISCTH1
AISCTH0
AIS Clear Threshold
P 216
XC2
-
-
-
-
-
-
UPDAT
AUTOUP
D
PMON Control
P 217
XC3
PRDGOV
E
-
-
DDSOVE
COFAOV
E
OOFOVE
FEROVE
CRCOVE
PMON Interrupt Control 0
P 217
XC4
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
LCVOVE
PMON Interrupt Control 1
P 218
XC5
PRDGOVI
-
-
DDSOVI/
COFAOVI
OOFOVI
FEROVI
CRCOVI
PMON Interrupt Indication 0
P 218
XC6
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
LCVOVI
PMON Interrupt Indication 1
P 219
XC7
-
-
-
-
PRBSMO
DE1
PRBSMO
DE0
PRBSDIR
TESTEN
TPLC / RPLC / PRGD Test
Configuration
P 219
XC8
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
BUSY
TPLC Access Status
P 219
XC9
RWN
ADDRES
S6
ADDRES
S5
ADDRES
S4
ADDRES
S3
ADDRESS
2
ADDRES
S1
ADDRES
S0
TPLC Access Control
P 220
XCA
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TPLC Access Data
P 220
XCB
SIGSNAP
GSTRKE
N
ZCS2
ZCS1
ZCS0
GSUBST2
GSUBST1 GSUBST0 TPLC Configuration
P 221
XCC
-
-
-
-
ABXX
-
-
PCCE
TPLC Control Enable
P 222
XCD
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
BUSY
RPLC Access Status
P 222
XCE
RWN
ADDRES
S6
ADDRES
S5
ADDRES
S4
ADDRES
S3
ADDRESS
2
ADDRES
S1
ADDRES
S0
RPLC Access Control
P 222
XCF
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
RPLC Access Data
P 223
XD0
SIGSNAP
GSTRKE
N
-
-
-
GSUBST2
GSUBST1 GSUBST0 RPLC Configuration
P 223
XD1
-
-
-
-
ABXX
SIGFIX
POL
PCCE
RPLC Control Enable
P 224
XD2
-
-
-
-
FREEZE
DEB
SIGE
SIGF
RCRB Configuration
P 225
XD3
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
BUSY
RCRB Access Status
P 225
XD4
RWN
ADDRES
S6
ADDRES
S5
ADDRES
S4
ADDRES
S3
ADDRESS
2
ADDRES
S1
ADDRES
S0
RCRB Access Control
P 226
XD5
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
RCRB Access Data
P 226
Programming Information
123
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register Name
Reference
Page
XD6
COSI8
COSI7
COSI6
COSI5
COSI4
COSI3
COSI2
COSI1
RCRB State Change Indication 0
P 226
XD7
COSI16
COSI15
COSI14
COSI13
COSI12
COSI11
COSI10
COSI9
RCRB State Change Indication 1
P 227
XD8
COSI24
COSI23
COSI22
COSI21
COSI20
COSI19
COSI18
COSI17
RCRB State Change Indication 2
P 227
Note:
* The Reference Clock Output Control register (addressed X3E) is available in ZB revision only, otherwise, it is reserved.
Programming Information
124
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
5.1.1.2 Indirect Register
PMON
Address (Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
00
CRCE7
CRCE6
CRCE5
CRCE4
CRCE3
CRCE2
CRCE1
CRCE0
CRCE Counter Mapping 0
P 228
01
-
-
-
-
-
-
CRCE9
CRCE8
CRCE Counter Mapping 1
P 228
02
FER7
FER6
FER5
FER4
FER3
FER2
FER1
FER0
FER Counter Mapping 0
P 228
03
-
-
-
-
FER11
FER10
FER9
FER8
FER Counter Mapping 1
P 229
04
-
-
-
-
-
COFA2
COFA1
COFA0
COFA Counter Mapping
P 229
05
-
-
-
OOF4
OOF3
OOF2
OOF1
OOF0
OOF Counter Mapping
P 229
06
PRGD7
PRGD6
PRGD5
PRGD4
PRGD3
PRGD2
PRGD1
PRGD0
PRGD Counter Mapping 0
P 229
07
PRGD15
PRGD14
PRGD13
PRGD12
PRGD11
PRGD10
PRGD9
PRGD8
PRGD Counter Mapping 1
P 230
08
LCV7
LCV6
LCV5
LCV4
LCV3
LCV2
LCV1
LCV0
LCV Counter Mapping 0
P 230
09
LCV15
LCV14
LCV13
LCV12
LCV11
LCV10
LCV9
LCV8
LCV Counter Mapping 1
P 230
0A
DDSE7
DDSE6
DDSE5
DDSE4
DDSE3
DDSE2
DDSE1
DDSE0
DDSE Counter Mapping 0
P 230
0B
-
-
-
-
-
-
DDSE9
DDSE8
DDSE Counter Mapping 1
P 231
Address (Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
01 ~ 18
-
-
-
EXTRACT
A
B
C
D
Extracted Signaling Data/Extract
Enable Register for CH1 ~ CH24
P 231
Address (Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
01 ~ 18
SUBST2
SUBST1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Channel Control Register for
CH1 ~ CH24
P 232
21 ~ 38
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Data Trunk Conditioning Code
Register for CH1 ~ CH24
P 233
41 ~ 58
-
TEST
-
STRKE
N
A
B
C
D
Signaling Trunk Conditioning
Code Register for CH1 ~ CH24
P 233
Address
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
01 ~ 18
SUBST2
SUBST1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Channel Control Register for
CH1 ~ CH24
P 234
21 ~ 38
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Data Trunk Conditioning Code
Register for CH1 ~ CH24
P 235
41 ~ 58
-
TEST
SIGINS
STRKE
N
A
B
C
D
Signaling Trunk Conditioning
Code Register for CH1 ~ CH24
P 235
RCRB
RPLC
TPLC
Programming Information
125
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
5.1.2
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 MODE
5.1.2.1 Direct Register
E1
Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register Name
Reference
Page
000
ID7
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
ID2
ID1
ID0
Chip ID For Octal Transceiver
P 236
001 ~
003
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Reserved
004
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Software Reset
P 236
005
-
-
-
-
MON3
MON2
MON1
MON0
G.772 Monitor Control
P 236
006
-
-
-
-
LEVEL1
LEVEL0
DIR1
DIR0
GPIO Control
P 238
007
-
-
RO22
RO21
RO20
RO12
RO11
RO10
Reference Clock Output Select
P 239
008
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
009
INT8
INT7
INT6
INT5
INT4
INT3
INT2
INT1
00A
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
00B
-
-
-
-
-
-
00C ~
00D
-
-
-
-
-
00E
LINKSEL2
LINKSEL1
LINKSEL0
-
00F
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
010
-
-
011 ~
01F
-
X20
-
Reserved
-
Interrupt Requisition Link ID
P 240
TMOVE
Timer Interrupt Control
P 240
-
TMOVI
Timer Interrupt Indication
P 240
-
-
-
ADDR3
ADDR2
ADDR1
ADDR0
PMON Access Port
P 241
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
PMON Access Data
P 241
-
RSLVCK
RMUX
MTSDA
TSLVCK
TMUX
Backplane Global Configuration
P 242
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
T1/J1
FM1
FM0
TEMODE
T1/J1 Or E1 Mode
X21
-
-
TJITT_TE
ST
TJA_LIMT
TJA_E
TJA_DP1
TJA_DP0
TJA_BW
Transmit Jitter
Configuration
X22
-
-
-
T_OFF
-
-
-
T_MD
Transmit Configuration 0
P 244
X23
-
-
DFM_ON
T_HZ
PULS3
PULS2
PULS1
PULS0
Transmit Configuration 1
P 245
X24
-
-
SCAL5
SCAL4
SCAL3
SCAL2
SCAL1
SCAL0
Transmit Configuration 2
P 246
X25
DONE
RW
UI1
UI0
SAMP3
SAMP2
SAMP1
SAMP0
Transmit Configuration 3
P 247
X26
-
WDAT6
WDAT5
WDAT4
WDAT3
WDAT2
WDAT1
WDAT0
Transmit Configuration 4
P 248
X27
-
-
RJITT_TE
ST
RJA_LIMT
RJA_E
RJA_DP1
RJA_DP0
RJA_BW
Receive Jitter
Configuration
P 248
X28
-
-
-
R_OFF
-
-
-
R_MD
Receive Configuration 0
P 249
X29
-
EQ_ON
-
LOS4
LOS3
LOS2
LOS1
LOS0
Receive Configuration 1
P 250
X2A
-
-
SLICE1
SLICE0
UPDW1
UPDW0
MG1
MG0
Receive Configuration 2
P 251
X2B
-
DLLP
SLLP
SRLP
-
RLP
ALP
DLP
Maintenance Function Control
0
P 252
X2C
-
-
-
-
-
LAC
RAISE
ATAO
Maintenance Function Control
1
P 253
Programming Information
126
Reserved
-
Reserved
P 134
Attenuation
Attenuation
P 243
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
E1
Reg
(Hex)
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Reference
Page
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X2D ~
X30
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X31
-
BPV_INS
-
EXZ_DEF
EXZ_ERR
1
EXZ_ERR
0
CNT_MD
CNT_TRF
Maintenance Function Control
2
P 254
X32
-
-
T_TERM2
T_TERM1
T_TERM0
R_TERM2
R_TERM1
R_TERM0
Transmit And Receive Termination Configuration
P 255
X33
-
-
-
-
-
DF_IE
-
LOS_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 0
P 255
X34
-
DAC_IE
TJA_IE
RJA_IE
-
EXZ_IE
CV_IE
CNT_IE
Interrupt Enable Control 1
P 256
X35
-
-
-
-
-
DF_IES
-
LOS_IES
Interrupt Trigger Edges Select
P 256
X36
-
-
-
-
-
DF_S
-
LOS_S
Line Status Register 0
P 257
X37
-
-
-
LATT4
LATT3
LATT2
LATT1
LATT0
Line Status Register 1
P 257
X38
-
TJITT6
TJITT5
TJITT4
TJITT3
TJITT2
TJITT1
TJITT0
Transmit Jitter Measure Value
Indication
P 258
X39
-
RJITT6
RJITT5
RJITT4
RJITT3
RJITT2
RJITT1
RJITT0
Receive Jitter Measure Value
Indication
P 258
X3A
-
-
-
-
-
DF_IS
-
LOS_IS
Interrupt Status 0
P 259
X3B
-
DAC_IS
TJA_IS
RJA_IS
-
EXZ_IS
CV_IS
CNTOV_IS Interrupt Status 1
P 260
X3C
CNTH[7]
CNTH[6]
CNTH[5]
CNTH[4]
CNTH[3]
CNTH[2]
CNTH[1]
CNTH[0]
EXZ Error Counter H-Byte
P 261
X3D
CNTL[7]
CNTL[6]
CNTL[5]
CNTL[4]
CNTL[3]
CNTL[2]
CNTL[1]
CNTL[0]
EXZ Error Counter L-Byte
P 261
X3E
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
REFH_LO
S
Reference Clock Output Control *
P 261
X3F
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
LIU
Interrupt Module Indication 2
P 262
X40
-
-
ALARM
PMON
PRGD
RCRB
FGEN
FRMR
Interrupt Module Indication 0
P 262
X41
THDLC3
THDLC2
THDLC1
RHDLC3
RHDLC2
RHDLC1
ELST
TRSI/RESI Interrupt Module Indication 1
P 263
X42
-
-
-
DE
FE
CMS
FSINV
FSTYP
TBIF Option Register
P 264
X43
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
TMODE
TBIF Operating Mode
P 265
X44
-
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
TBIF TS Offset
P 265
X45
-
-
-
-
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
TBIF Bit Offset
P 265
X46
-
-
-
-
DE
FE
CMS
TRI
RBIF Option Register
P 266
X47
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
RMODE
RBIF Mode
P 266
X48
-
-
-
FSINV
OHD
SMFS
CMFS
-
RBIF Frame Pulse
P 267
X49
-
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
RBIF TS Offset
P 267
X4A
-
-
-
-
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
RBIF Bit Offset
P 268
X4B
-
-
-
-
-
-
RCOFAI
TCOFAI
RTSFS Change Indication
P 268
X4C
-
-
-
-
-
-
RCOFAE
TCOFAE
RTSFS Interrupt Control
P 269
X4D
-
-
-
-
UNFM
REFCRCE
REFEN
REFR
FRMR Mode 0
P 269
X4E
BIT2C
CASEN
CRCEN
CNTNFAS
WORDER
R
TS16C
SMFASC
C2NCIWC
K
FRMR Mode 1
P 270
Programming Information
127
Register Name
Reserved
-
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1
Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X4F
-
-
-
C2NCIWV
OOSMFV
OOCMFV
OOOFV
OOFV
FRMR Status
P 271
X50
-
-
-
C2NCIWE
OOSMFE
OOCMFE
OOOFE
OOFE
FRMR Interrupt Control 0
P 272
X51
ISMFPE
ICSMFPE
SMFERE
ICMFPE
CMFERE
CRCEE
FERE
COFAE
FRMR Interrupt Control 1
P 273
X52
-
-
EXCRCER
I
C2NCIWI
OOSMFI
OOCMFI
OOOFI
OOFI
FRMR Interrupt Indication 0
P 274
X53
ISMFPI
ICSMFPI
SMFERI
ICMFPI
CMFERI
CRCEI
FERI
COFAI
FRMR Interrupt Indication 1
P 275
X54
Si0
Si1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
TS0 International / National
P 276
X55
-
-
-
-
X0
Y
X1
X2
TS16 Spare
P 277
X56
-
-
-
-
Sa41
Sa42
Sa43
Sa44
Sa4 Codeword
P 277
X57
-
-
-
-
Sa51
Sa52
Sa53
Sa54
Sa5 Codeword
P 278
X58
-
-
-
-
Sa61
Sa62
Sa63
Sa64
Sa6 Codeword
P 278
X59
-
-
-
-
Sa71
Sa72
Sa73
Sa74
Sa7 Codeword
P 278
X5A
-
-
-
-
Sa81
Sa82
Sa83
Sa84
Sa8 Codeword
P 279
X5B
-
-
-
Sa6-FI
Sa6-EI
Sa6-CI
Sa6-AI
Sa6-8I
Sa6 Codeword Indication
P 279
X5C
Sa6SYN
SaDEB
Sa6SCE
Sa4E
Sa5E
Sa6E
Sa7E
Sa8E
Sa Codeword Interrupt Control
P 280
X5D
-
-
Sa6SCI
Sa4I
Sa5I
Sa6I
Sa7I
Sa8I
Sa Codeword Interrupt Indication
P 281
X5E
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X5F
-
-
-
-
-
RAICRCV
CFEBEV
V52LINKV
Overhead Error Status
P 282
X60
-
-
TCRCEE
TFEBEE
FEBEE
RAICRCE
CFEBEE
V52LINKE
Overhead Interrupt Control
P 283
X61
-
-
TCRCEI
TFEBEI
FEBEI
RAICRCI
CFEBEI
V52LINKI
Overhead Interrupt Indication
P 284
X62
-
XDIS
SiDIS
FEBEDIS
CRCM
SIGEN
GENCRC
FDIS
E1 Mode
P 285
X63
-
-
-
-
-
-
Si0
Si1
FGEN International Bit
P 286
X64
-
-
-
Sa4EN
Sa5EN
Sa6EN
Sa7EN
Sa8EN
FGEN Sa Control
P 286
X65
-
-
-
-
Sa41
Sa42
Sa43
Sa44
Sa4 Code-word
P 288
X66
-
-
-
-
Sa51
Sa52
Sa53
Sa54
Sa5 Code-word
P 288
X67
-
-
-
-
Sa61
Sa62
Sa63
Sa64
Sa6 Code-word
P 288
X68
-
-
-
-
Sa71
Sa72
Sa73
Sa74
Sa7 Code-word
P 288
X69
-
-
-
-
Sa81
Sa82
Sa83
Sa84
Sa8 Code-word
P 289
X6A
-
-
-
-
X0
-
X1
X2
FGEN Extra
P 289
X6B
-
-
TS16LOS
TS16AIS
MFAIS
G706RAI
AUTOYELLOW
REMAIS
FGEN Maintenance 0
P 290
X6C
-
-
-
-
-
COFAEN
TXDIS
TAIS
FGEN Maintenance 1
P 291
X6D
-
-
-
SMFE
FASE
SIGMFE
MFE
BFE
FGEN Interrupt Control
P 291
X6E
-
-
-
SMFI
FASI
SIGMFI
MFI
BFI
FGEN Interrupt Indication
P 292
X6F
-
-
CRCINV
CRCPINV
CASPINV
NFASINV
FASALLIN
V
FAS1INV
Error Insertion
P 293
Programming Information
128
Reference
Page
Register Name
Reserved
-
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1
Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register Name
X70
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
XTS
Transmit Timing Option
P 294
X71
-
-
-
-
RINV
TINV
PATS1
PATS0
PRGD Control
P 294
X72
-
-
-
-
BERE
INV
SYNCV
SYNCE
PRGD Status/Error Control
P 295
X73
-
-
-
-
BERI
-
-
SYNCI
PRGD Interrupt Indication
P 295
X74 ~
X7B
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X7C
-
-
-
-
-
TRKEN
SLIPD
SLIPE
ELST Configuration
P 296
X7D
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SLIPI
ELST Interrupt Indication
P 296
X7E
TRKCODE
7
TRKCOD
E6
X7F ~
X83
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
X84
-
-
-
-
-
TDLEN3
TDLEN2
TDLEN1
X85
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
X86
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
X87
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
X88
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
X89
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
X8A
BITEN7
BITEN6
X8B
-
X8C
Reference
Page
Reserved
-
TRKCODE TRKCODE TRKCODE TRKCODE TRKCODE TRKCODE ELST Trunk Code
5
4
3
2
1
0
P 296
Reserved
-
THDLC Enable Control
P 297
TS0
THDLC1 Assignment
P 297
TS1
TS0
THDLC2 Assignment
P 297
TS2
TS1
TS0
THDLC3 Assignment
P 298
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
THDLC1 Bit Select
P 298
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
THDLC2 Bit Select
P 298
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
THDLC3 Bit Select
P 299
-
-
-
-
RDLEN3
RDLEN2
RDLEN1
RHDLC Enable Control
P 299
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
RHDLC1 Assignment
P 300
X8D
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
RHDLC2 Assignment
P 300
X8E
-
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
RHDLC3 Assignment
P 300
X8F
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
RHDLC1 Bit Select
P 301
X90
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
RHDLC2 Bit Select
P 301
X91
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
RHDLC3 Bit Select
P 301
X92
-
-
-
-
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
RHDLC1 Control Register
P 301
X93
-
-
-
-
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
RHDLC2 Control Register
P 302
X94
-
-
-
-
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
RHDLC3 Control Register
P 302
X95
-
-
-
-
-
-
EMP
PACK
RHDLC1 RFIFO Access Status
P 303
X96
-
-
-
-
-
-
EMP
PACK
RHDLC2 RFIFO Access Status
P 303
X97
-
-
-
-
-
-
EMP
PACK
RHDLC3 RFIFO Access Status
P 303
X98
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
RHDLC1 Data
P 304
X99
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
RHDLC2 Data
P 304
Programming Information
129
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1
Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X9A
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
X9B
-
-
-
-
-
-
OVFLE
X9C
-
-
-
-
-
-
X9D
-
-
-
-
-
X9E
-
-
-
-
X9F
-
-
-
XA0
-
-
XA1
HA7
XA2
Reference
Page
Register Name
RHDLC3 Data
P 304
RMBEE
RHDLC1 Interrupt Control
P 305
OVFLE
RMBEE
RHDLC2 Interrupt Control
P 305
-
OVFLE
RMBEE
RHDLC3 Interrupt Control
P 305
-
-
OVFLI
RMBEI
RHDLC1 Interrupt Indication
P 306
-
-
-
OVFLI
RMBEI
RHDLC2 Interrupt Indication
P 306
-
-
-
-
OVFLI
RMBEI
RHDLC3 Interrupt Indication
P 306
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
RHDLC1 High Address
P 307
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
RHDLC2 High Address
P 307
XA3
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
RHDLC3 High Address
P 307
XA4
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
RHDLC1 Low Address
P 308
XA5
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
RHDLC2 Low Address
P 308
XA6
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
RHDLC3 Low Address
P 308
XA7
-
-
-
EOM
-
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
THDLC1 Control
P 308
XA8
-
-
-
EOM
-
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
THDLC2 Control
P 309
XA9
-
-
-
EOM
-
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
THDLC3 Control
P 309
XAA
-
-
-
-
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
TFIFO1 Threshold
P 310
XAB
-
-
-
-
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
TFIFO2 Threshold
P 310
XAC
-
-
-
-
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
TFIFO3 Threshold
P 310
XAD
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
THDLC1 Data
P 311
XAE
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
THDLC2 Data
P 311
XAF
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
THDLC3 Data
P 311
XB0
-
-
-
-
-
FUL
EMP
RDY
TFIFO1 Status
P 312
XB1
-
-
-
-
-
FUL
EMP
RDY
TFIFO2 Status
P 312
XB2
-
-
-
-
-
FUL
EMP
RDY
TFIFO3 Status
P 312
XB3
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNE
RDYE
THDLC1 Interrupt Control
P 313
XB4
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNE
RDYE
THDLC2 Interrupt Control
P 313
XB5
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNE
RDYE
THDLC3 Interrupt Control
P 313
XB6
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNI
RDYI
THDLC1 Interrupt Indication
P 314
XB7
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNI
RDYI
THDLC2 Interrupt Indication
P 314
XB8
-
-
-
-
-
-
UDRUNI
RDYI
THDLC3 Interrupt Indication
P 314
XB9
-
-
TS16LOS
V
TS16AISV
RMAIV
AIS
RAIV
RED
Alarm Status
P 315
XBA
-
-
TS16LOS
E
TS16AISE
RMAIE
AISE
RAIE
REDE
Alarm Control
P 316
XBB
-
-
TS16LOSI
TS16AISI
RMAII
AISI
RAII
REDI
Alarm Indication
P 317
Programming Information
130
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1
Reg
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
XBC
-
-
-
-
-
-
AISC
RAIC
XBD ~
XC1
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
XC2
-
-
-
-
-
-
UPDAT
XC3
PRDGOV
E
TFEBEOVE
OOFOVE
XC4
-
-
-
-
-
XC5
PRDGOVI
TFEBEOVI
FEBEOVI
TCRCOVI
XC6
-
-
-
XC7
-
-
XC8
-
-
XC9
RWN
XCA
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
TPLC Access Data
P 322
XCB
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
-
-
-
GSUBST2
GSUBST1
GSUBST0
TPLC Configuration
P 323
XCC
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PCCE
TPLC Control Enable
P 323
XCD
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
BUSY
RPLC Access Status
P 324
XCE
RWN
XCF
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
RPLC Access Data
P 324
XD0
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
-
-
-
GSUBST2
GSUBST1
GSUBST0
RPLC Configuration
P 325
XD1
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PCCE
RPLC Control Enable
P 325
XD2
-
-
-
-
FREEZE
DEB
SIGE
-
RCRB Configuration
P 326
XD3
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
BUSY
RCRB Access Status
P 326
XD4
RWN
XD5
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
XD6
COSI8
COSI7
COSI6
COSI5
COSI4
COSI3
COSI2
XD7
COSI16
COSI15
COSI14
COSI13
COSI12
COSI11
XD8
COSI24
COSI23
COSI22
COSI21
COSI20
XD9
-
-
COSI30
COSI29
COSI28
Reference
Page
Register Name
Alarm Criteria Control
P 318
Reserved
-
AUTOUPD PMON Control
P 318
FEROVE
CRCOVE
PMON Interrupt Control 0
P 319
-
-
LCVOVE
PMON Interrupt Control 1
P 319
COFAOVI
OOFOVI
FEROVI
CRCOVI
PMON Interrupt Indication 0
P 320
-
-
-
-
LCVOVI
PMON Interrupt Indication 1
P 321
-
-
PRBSMO
DE1
PRBSMO
DE0
PRBSDIR
TESTEN
TPLC / RPLC / PRGD Test
Configuration
P 321
-
-
-
-
-
BUSY
TPLC Access Status
P 321
FEBEOVE TCRCOVE COFAOVE
ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS
6
5
4
3
2
ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS
6
5
4
3
2
ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS ADDRESS
6
5
4
3
2
ADDRESS
1
ADDRESS
1
ADDRESS
1
ADDRESS TPLC Access Control
0
P 322
ADDRESS RPLC Access Control
0
P 324
ADDRESS RCRB Access Control
0
P 326
RCRB Access Data
P 327
COSI1
RCRB State Change Indication 0
P 327
COSI10
COSI9
RCRB State Change Indication 1
P 327
COSI19
COSI18
COSI17
RCRB State Change Indication 2
P 328
COSI27
COSI26
COSI25
RCRB State Change Indication 3
P 328
Note:
* The Reference Clock Output Control register (addressed X3E) is available in ZB revision only, otherwise, it is reserved.
Programming Information
131
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
5.1.2.2 Indirect Register
PMON
Address (Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
00
CRCE7
CRCE6
CRCE5
CRCE4
CRCE3
CRCE2
CRCE1
CRCE0
CRCE Counter Mapping 0
P 329
01
-
-
-
-
-
-
CRCE9
CRCE8
CRCE Counter Mapping 1
P 329
02
FER7
FER6
FER5
FER4
FER3
FER2
FER1
FER0
FER Counter Mapping 0
P 329
03
-
-
-
-
FER11
FER10
FER9
FER8
FER Counter Mapping 1
P 330
04
-
-
-
-
-
COFA2
COFA1
COFA0
COFA Counter Mapping
P 330
05
-
-
-
OOF4
OOF3
OOF2
OOF1
OOF0
OOF Counter Mapping
P 330
06
PRGD7
PRGD6
PRGD5
PRGD4
PRGD3
PRGD2
PRGD1
PRGD0
PRGD Counter Mapping 0
P 330
07
PRGD15
PRGD14
PRGD13 PRGD12
PRGD11
PRGD10
PRGD9
PRGD8
PRGD Counter Mapping 1
P 331
08
LCV7
LCV6
LCV5
LCV4
LCV3
LCV2
LCV1
LCV0
LCV Counter Mapping 0
P 331
09
LCV15
LCV14
LCV13
LCV12
LCV11
LCV10
LCV9
LCV8
LCV Counter Mapping 1
P 331
0A
TCRCE7
TCRCE6
TCRCE3
TCRCE2
TCRCE1
TCRCE0
TCRCE Counter Mapping 0
P 331
0B
-
-
-
-
-
-
TCRCE9
TCRCE8
TCRCE Counter Mapping 1
P 332
0C
FEBE7
FEBE6
FEBE5
FEBE4
FEBE3
FEBE2
FEBE1
FEBE0
FEBE Counter Mapping 0
P 332
0D
-
-
-
-
-
-
FEBE9
FEBE8
FEBE Counter Mapping 1
P 332
0E
TFEBE7
TFEBE6
TFEBE5
TFEBE4
TFEBE3
TFEBE2
TFEBE1
TFEBE0
TFEBE Counter Mapping 0
P 333
0F
-
-
-
-
-
-
TFEBE9
TFEBE8
TFEBE Counter Mapping 1
P 333
TCRCE5 TCRCE4
RCRB
Address
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
01 ~ 0F
-
-
-
EXTRACT
A
B
C
D
Extracted Signaling Data/Extract
Enable Register for TS1 ~ TS15
P 334
11 ~ 1F
-
-
-
EXTRACT
A
B
C
D
Extracted Signaling Data/Extract
Enable Register for TS17 ~ TS31
P 334
RPLC
Address
(Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
00 ~ 1F
SUBST2
SUBST1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Timeslot Control Register for TS0
~ TS31
P 335
20 ~ 3F
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Data Trunk Conditioning Code
Register for TS0 ~ TS31
P 336
41 ~ 4F
-
TEST
-
STRKE
N
A
B
C
D
Signaling Trunk Conditioning
Code Register for TS1 ~ TS15
P 336
51 ~ 5F
-
TEST
-
STRKE
N
A
B
C
D
Signaling Trunk Conditioning
Code Register for TS17 ~ TS31
P 336
Programming Information
132
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
TPLC
Address (Hex)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Register
Reference Page
00 ~ 1F
SUBST2
SUBST
1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Timeslot Control Register for TS0
~ TS31
P 337
20 ~ 3F
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Data Trunk Conditioning Code
Register for TS0 ~ TS31
P 338
41 ~ 4F
-
TEST
-
STRKE
N
A
B
C
D
Signaling Trunk Conditioning
Code Register for TS1 ~ TS15
P 338
51 ~ 5F
-
TEST
-
STRKE
N
A
B
C
D
Signaling Trunk Conditioning
Code Register for TS17 ~ TS31
P 338
Programming Information
133
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
5.2
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
REGISTER DESCRIPTION
Depending on the operating mode, the registers are configured for T1/J1 or E1. Before setting any other registers, the operating mode should be
selected in registers 020H, 120H, 220H, 320H, 420H, 520H, 620H and 720H.
According to the access method, the registers can be divided into direct registers and indirect registers. In the direct registers, the registers can be
divided into global configuration registers and per-link configuration registers. The register with only one address following its name is the global
configuration register, and the register with a set of address (eight addresses) following its name is the per-link configuration register.
T1/J1 Or E1 Mode (020H, 120H, 220H, 320H, 420H, 520H, 620H, 720H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
T1/J1
FM1
FM0
TEMODE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
T1/J1:
This bit is valid when T1/J1 operating mode is selected by the corresponding TEMODE bit (b0, 020H,...). It selects the operating mode between T1
and J1 for the current link.
= 0: T1 mode is selected.
= 1: J1 mode is selected.
FM[1:0]:
These two bits are valid when T1/J1 operating mode is selected by the corresponding TEMODE bit (b0, 020H,...). They select the operating format.
= 00: SF format is selected.
= 01: ESF format is selected.
= 10: T1 DM format is selected. This selection is valid in T1 operating mode only.
= 11: SLC-96 format is selected. This selection is valid in T1 operating mode only.
TEMODE:
This bit selects the operating mode for the current link.
= 0: E1 mode is selected.
= 1: T1/J1 mode is selected.
Programming Information
134
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
5.2.1
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 MODE
5.2.1.1 Direct Register
T1/J1 Chip ID For Octal Transceiver (000H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
ID7
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
ID2
ID1
ID0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
ID[7:0]:
The ID[7:0] bits are pre-set. The ID[7:4] bits represent the IDT82P2288 device. The ID[3:0] bits represent the current version number (‘0001’ is for
the first version).
T1/J1 Software Reset (004H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
Type
X
Default
A write operation to this register will generate a software reset.
The software reset will set all the registers except the T1/J1 Or E1 Mode register (020H,...) to their default values. If the setting is changed in the
T1/J1 Or E1 Mode register (020H,...), a software reset must be applied.
Programming Information
135
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 G.772 Monitor Control (005H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
MON3
MON2
MON1
MON0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
MON[3:0]:
These bits determine whether the G.772 Monitor is implemented. When the G.772 Monitor is implemented, these bits select one transmitter or
receiver to be monitored by the Link 1.
MON[3:0]
Monitored Path
MON[3:0]
Monitored Path
0000
No transmitter or receiver is monitored.
1000
No transmitter or receiver is monitored.
0001
The receiver of the Link 2 is monitored.
1001
The transmitter of the Link 2 is monitored.
0010
The receiver of the Link 3 is monitored.
1010
The transmitter of the Link 3 is monitored.
0011
The receiver of the Link 4 is monitored.
1011
The transmitter of the Link 4 is monitored.
0100
The receiver of the Link 5 is monitored.
1100
The transmitter of the Link 5 is monitored.
0101
The receiver of the Link 6 is monitored.
1101
The transmitter of the Link 6 is monitored.
0110
The receiver of the Link 7 is monitored.
1110
The transmitter of the Link 7 is monitored.
0111
The receiver of the Link 8 is monitored.
1111
The transmitter of the Link 8 is monitored.
Programming Information
136
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 GPIO Control (006H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
LEVEL1
LEVEL0
DIR1
DIR0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
1
LEVEL[1]:
When the GPIO[1] pin is defined as an output port, this bit can be read and written:
= 0: The GPIO[1] pin outputs low level.
= 1: The GPIO[1] pin outputs high level.
When the GPIO[1] pin is defined as an input port, this bit can only be read:
= 0: Low level is input on the GPIO[1] pin.
= 1: High level is input on the GPIO[1] pin.
LEVEL[0]:
When the GPIO[0] pin is defined as an output port, this bit can be read and written:
= 0: The GPIO[0] pin outputs low level.
= 1: The GPIO[0] pin outputs high level.
When the GPIO[0] pin is defined as an input port, this bit can only be read:
= 0: Low level is input on the GPIO[0] pin.
= 1: High level is input on the GPIO[0] pin.
DIR[1]:
= 0: The GPIO[1] pin is used as an output port.
= 1: The GPIO[1] pin is used as an input port.
DIR[0]:
= 0: The GPIO[0] pin is used as an output port.
= 1: The GPIO[0] pin is used as an input port.
Programming Information
137
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Reference Clock Output Select (007H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
RO22
RO21
RO20
RO12
RO11
RO10
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
RO2[2:0]:
When no LOS is detected, the REFB_OUT pin outputs a recovered clock from the Clock and Data Recovery function block of one of the eight links.
The link is selected by these bits:
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
000
Link 1
100
Link 5
001
Link 2
101
Link 6
010
Link 3
110
Link 7
011
Link 4
111
Link 8
When LOS is detected, the REFB_OUT pin outputs MCLK or high level, as selected by the REFH_LOS bit (b0, T1/J1-03EH,...). (This feature is
available in ZB revision only).
RO1[2:0]:
When no LOS is detected, the REFA_OUT pin outputs a recovered clock from the Clock and Data Recovery function block of one of the eight links.
The link is selected by these bits:
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
000
Link 1
100
Link 5
001
Link 2
101
Link 6
010
Link 3
110
Link 7
011
Link 4
111
Link 8
When LOS is detected, the REFA_OUT pin outputs MCLK or high level, as selected by the REFH_LOS bit (b0, T1/J1-03EH,...). (This feature is
available in ZB revision only).
Programming Information
138
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Interrupt Requisition Link ID (009H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
INT8
INT7
INT6
INT5
INT4
INT3
INT2
INT1
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
0
INTn:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the corresponding link.
= 1: At least one interrupt is generated in the corresponding link.
T1/J1 Timer Interrupt Control (00AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
TMOVE
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
TMOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TMOVI bit (b0, T1/J1-00BH) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TMOVI bit (b0, T1/J1-00BH) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 Timer Interrupt Indication (00BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
TMOVI
Reserved
Default
R
0
TMOVI:
The device times every one second.
= 0: One second timer is not over.
= 1: One second timer is over.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
139
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 PMON Access Port (00EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
LINKSEL2
LINKSEL1
LINKSEL0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
Reserved
3
2
1
0
ADDR3
ADDR2
ADDR1
ADDR0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
:
These bits select one of the eight links. One of the PMON indirect registers of the selected link can be accessed by the microprocessor.
LINKSEL[2:0]
Selected Link
LINKSEL[2:0]
Selected Link
000
Link 1
100
Link 5
001
Link 2
101
Link 6
010
Link 3
110
Link 7
011
Link 4
111
Link 8
ADDR[3:0]:
These bits select one of the PMON indirect registers of the selected link to be accessed by the microprocessor.
Address
PMON Indirect Register
Address
PMON Indirect Register
00H
CRCE Counter Mapping 0
06H
PRGD Counter Mapping 0
01H
CRCE Counter Mapping 1
07H
PRGD Counter Mapping 1
02H
FER Counter Mapping 0
08H
LCV Counter Mapping 0
03H
FER Counter Mapping 1
09H
LCV Counter Mapping 1
04H
COFA Counter Mapping
0AH
DDSE Counter Mapping 0
05H
OOF Counter Mapping
0BH
DDSE Counter Mapping 1
T1/J1 PMON Access Data (00FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DAT[7:0]:
These bits hold the value which is read from the selected PMON indirect register.
Programming Information
140
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Backplane Global Configuration (010H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSLVCK
RMUX
MTSDA
TSLVCK
TMUX
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
0
1
1
0
RSLVCK:
This bit is valid when all eight links are in the Receive Clock Slave mode.
= 0: Each link uses its own clock signal on the RSCKn pin and framing pulse on the RSFSn pin.
= 1: All eight links use the clock signal on the RSCK[1] pin and the framing pulse on the RSFS[1] pin.
RMUX:
= 0: The Receive System Interface of the device is operated in the Non-multiplexed mode.
= 1: The Receive System Interface of the device is operated in the Multiplexed mode.
MTSDA:
This bit is valid in Transmit Multiplexed mode. It selects one multiplexed bus for the Transmit System Interface of the device.
= 0: The multiplexed bus B is selected. The data and signaling bits are de-multiplexed from multiplexed bus B.
= 1: The multiplexed bus A is selected. The data and signaling bits are de-multiplexed from multiplexed bus A.
TSLVCK:
This bit is valid when all eight links are in the Transmit Clock Slave mode.
= 0: Each link uses its own timing signal on the TSCKn pin and framing pulse on the TSFSn pin.
= 1: All eight links use the timing signal on the TSCK[1] pin and the framing pulse on the TSFS[1] pin.
TMUX:
= 0: The Transmit System Interface of the device is operated in the Non-multiplexed mode.
= 1: The Transmit System Interface of the device is operated in the Multiplexed mode.
Programming Information
141
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Jitter Attenuation Configuration (021H, 121H, 221H, 321H, 421H, 521H, 621H, 721H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
2
1
0
TJITT_TEST
TJA_LIMT
TJA_E
TJA_DP1
TJA_DP0
TJA_BW
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
TJITT_TEST:
= 0: The real time interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-038H,...). That is, the
current interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO will be written into the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-038H,...).
= 1: The peak-peak interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-038H,...). That is, the
current interval is compared with the old one in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-038H,...) and the larger one will be indicated by the TJITT[6:0] bits
(b6~0, T1/J1-038H,...); otherwise, the value in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-038H,...) will not be changed.
TJA_LIMT:
When the read and write pointer of the FIFO are within 2/3/4 bits (corresponding to the FIFO depth) of overflowing or underflowing, the bandwidth
of the JA can be widened to track the short term input jitter, thereby avoiding data corruption. This bit selects whether the bandwidth is normal or
widened.
= 0: Normal bandwidth is selected.
= 1: Widen bandwidth is selected. In this case, the JA will not attenuate the input jitter until the read/write pointer’s position is outside the 2/3/4 bits
window.
TJA_E:
= 0: Disable the Transmit Jitter Attenuator.
= 1: Enable the Transmit Jitter Attenuator.
TJA_DP[1:0]:
These two bits select the Jitter Attenuation Depth.
= 00: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 128-bit.
= 01: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 64-bit.
= 10 / 11: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 32-bit.
TJA_BW:
This bit select the Jitter Transfer Function Bandwidth.
= 0: 5 Hz.
= 1: 1.26 Hz.
Programming Information
142
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Configuration 0 (022H, 122H, 222H, 322H, 422H, 522H, 622H, 722H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
5
4
3
2
T_OFF
Reserved
R/W
0
1
0
T_MD
Reserved
R/W
0
T_OFF:
= 0: The transmit path is power up.
= 1: The transmit path is power down. The Line Driver is in high impedance.
T_MD:
This bit selects the line code rule to encode the data stream to be transmitted.
= 0: The B8ZS encoder is selected.
= 1: The AMI encoder is selected.
Programming Information
143
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Configuration 1 (023H, 123H, 223H, 323H, 423H, 523H, 623H, 723H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
DFM_ON
T_HZ
PULS3
PULS2
PULS1
PULS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
1
0
0
0
0
DFM_ON:
= 0: The Driver Failure Monitor is disabled.
= 1: The Driver Failure Monitor is enabled.
T_HZ:
= 0: The Line Driver works normally.
= 1: Set the Line Driver High-Z. (The other parts of the transmit path still work normally.)
PULS[3:0]:
These bits determine the template shapes for short/long haul transmission:
PULS[3:0]
Operating Mode
Transmit Clock
Cable Impedance
0000
Application
Reserved
0001
DSX1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
0 - 133 ft
J1
1.544 MHz
110 Ω
0 - 655 ft
DS1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
0 dB LBO
0011
DSX1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
133 - 266 ft
0100
DSX1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
266 - 399 ft
0101
DSX1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
399 - 533 ft
0110
DSX1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
533 - 655 ft
0010
0111
Reserved
1000
1001
DS1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
-7.5 dB LBO
1010
DS1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
-15.0 dB LBO
1011
DS1
1.544 MHz
100 Ω
-22.5 dB LBO
11xx
Programming Information
Arbitrary waveform setting.
144
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Configuration 2 (024H, 124H, 224H, 324H, 424H, 524H, 624H, 724H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
SCAL5
SCAL4
SCAL3
SCAL2
SCAL1
SCAL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
0
0
0
0
1
SCAL[5:0]:
The following setting lists the standard values of normal amplitude in different operating modes. Each step change (one increasing or decreasing
from the standard value) will scale the amplitude of the D/A output by a certain offset. These bits are only effective when user programmable arbitrary
waveform is used.
= 000100: Normal amplitude in T1 long haul LBO/-22.5 dB operating mode. Each step change scales about 25% offset.
= 001000: Normal amplitude in T1 long haul LBO/-15 dB operating mode. Each step change scales about 12.5% offset.
= 010001: Normal amplitude in T1 long haul LBO/-7.5 dB operating mode. Each step change scales about 6.25% offset.
= 110110: Normal amplitude in T1 0~133 ft, 133~266 ft, 266~399 ft, 399~533 ft, 533~655 ft, DS1 0 dB & J1 0~655 ft operating modes. Each step
change scales about 2% offset.
Programming Information
145
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Configuration 3 (025H, 125H, 225H, 325H, 425H, 525H, 625H, 725H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DONE
RW
UI1
UI0
SAMP3
SAMP2
SAMP1
SAMP0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
This register is valid when the PULS[3:0] bits (b3~0, T1/J1-023H,...) are set to ‘11xx’.
DONE:
= 0: Disable the read/write operation to the pulse template RAM.
= 1: Enable the read/write operation to the pulse template RAM.
RW:
= 0: Write the data to the pulse template RAM.
= 1: Read the data to the pulse template RAM.
UI[1:0]:
These bits specify one Unit Interval (UI) address.
= 00: UI addressed 0 is specified.
= 01: UI addressed 1 is specified.
= 10: UI addressed 2 is specified.
= 11: UI addressed 3 is specified.
SAMP[3:0]:
There bits specify one sample address. There are 16 samples in each UI.
SAMP[3:0]
Specified Sample Address
SAMP[3:0]
Specified Sample Address
0000
0
1000
8
0001
1
1001
9
0010
2
1010
10
0011
3
1011
11
0100
4
1100
12
0101
5
1101
13
0110
6
1110
14
0111
7
1111
15
Programming Information
146
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Configuration 4 (026H, 126H, 226H, 326H, 426H, 526H, 626H, 726H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WDAT6
WDAT5
WDAT4
WDAT3
WDAT2
WDAT1
WDAT0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Default
WDAT[6:0]:
These bits contain the data to be stored in the pulse template RAM which is addressed by the UI[1:0] bits (b5~4, T1/J1-025H,...) and the
SAMP[3:0] bits (b3~0, T1/J1-025H,...).
T1/J1 Receive Jitter Attenuation Configuration (027H, 127H, 227H, 327H, 427H, 527H, 627H, 727H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
2
1
0
RJITT_TEST
RJA_LIMT
RJA_E
RJA_DP1
RJA_DP0
RJA_BW
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
RJITT_TEST:
= 0: The real time interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-039H,...). That is, the
current interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO will be written into the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-039H,...).
= 1: The peak-peak interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-039H,...). That is, the
current interval is compared with the old one in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-039H,...) and the larger one will be indicated by the RJITT[6:0] bits
(b6~0, T1/J1-039H,...); otherwise, the value in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, T1/J1-039H,...) will not be changed.
RJA_LIMT:
When the read and write pointer of the FIFO are within 2/3/4 bits (corresponding to the FIFO depth) of overflowing or underflowing, the bandwidth
of the JA can be widened to track the short term input jitter, thereby avoiding data corruption. This bit selects whether the bandwidth is normal or
widened.
= 0: Normal bandwidth is selected.
= 1: Widen bandwidth is selected. In this case, the JA will not attenuate the input jitter until the read/write pointer’s position is outside the 2/3/4 bits
window.
RJA_E:
= 0: Disable the Receive Jitter Attenuator.
= 1: Enable the Receive Jitter Attenuator.
RJA_DP[1:0]:
These two bits select the Jitter Attenuation Depth.
= 00: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 128-bit.
= 01: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 64-bit.
= 10 / 11: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 32-bit.
RJA_BW:
This bit select the Jitter Transfer Function Bandwidth.
= 0: 5 Hz.
= 1: 1.26 Hz.
Programming Information
147
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Receive Configuration 0 (028H, 128H, 228H, 328H, 428H, 528H, 628H, 728H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
2
R_OFF
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
1
0
R_MD
Reserved
R/W
0
R_OFF:
= 0: The receive path is power up.
= 1: The receive path is power down.
R_MD:
This bit selects the line code rule to decode the received data stream.
= 0: The B8ZS decoder is selected.
= 1: The AMI decoder is selected.
Programming Information
148
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Receive Configuration 1 (029H, 129H, 229H, 329H, 429H, 529H, 629H, 729H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
6
5
EQ_ON
Reserved
Default
R/W
Reserved
0
4
3
2
1
0
LOS4
LOS3
LOS2
LOS1
LOS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
0
1
0
1
EQ_ON:
= 0: The Equalizer is off in short haul applications.
= 1: The Equalizer is on in long haul applications.
LOS[4:0]:
A LOS is detected when the incoming signals has “no transitions”, i.e., when the signal level is less than Q dB below nominal for N consecutive
pulse intervals. In long haul applications, these bits select the LOS declare threshold (Q). These bits are invalid in short haul applications.
Programming Information
LOS[4:0]
LOS Declare Threshold (Q)
LOS[4:0]
LOS Declare Threshold (Q)
00000
-4 dB
01100
-28 dB
00001
-6 dB
01101
-30 dB
00010
-8 dB
01110
-32 dB
00011
-10 dB
01111
-34 dB
00100
-12 dB
10000
-36 dB
00101
-14 dB
10001
-38 dB
00110
-16 dB
10010
-40 dB
00111
-18 dB
10011
-42 dB
01000
-20 dB
10100
-44 dB
01001
-22 dB
10101
-46 dB
01010
-24 dB
01011
-26 dB
10110 11111
-48 dB
149
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Receive Configuration 2 (02AH, 12AH, 22AH, 32AH, 42AH, 52AH, 62AH, 72AH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
SLICE1
SLICE0
UPDW1
UPDW0
MG1
MG0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
1
1
0
0
0
SLICE[1:0]:
These two bits define the Data Slicer threshold.
= 00: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 40% of the peak amplitude.
= 01: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 50% of the peak amplitude.
= 10: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 60% of the peak amplitude.
= 11: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 70% of the peak amplitude.
UPDW[1:0]:
These two bits select the observation period, during which the peak value of the incoming signals is measured.
= 00: The observation period is 32 bits.
= 01: The observation period is 64 bits.
= 10: The observation period is 128 bits.
= 11: The observation period is 256 bits.
MG[1:0]:
These two bits select the Monitor Gain.
= 00: The Monitor Gain is 0 dB.
= 01: The Monitor Gain is 22 dB.
= 10: Reserved.
= 11: Reserved.
Programming Information
150
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Maintenance Function Control 0 (02BH, 12BH, 22BH, 32BH, 42BH, 52BH, 62BH, 72BH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
DLLP
SLLP
SRLP
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
Reserved
2
1
0
RLP
ALP
DLP
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
DLLP:
= 0: Disable the Local Digital Loopback 1.
= 1: Enable the Local Digital Loopback 1.
SLLP:
= 0: Disable the System Local Loopback.
= 1: Enable the System Local Loopback.
SRLP:
= 0: Disable the System Remote Loopback.
= 1: Enable the System Remote Loopback.
RLP:
= 0: Disable the Remote Loopback.
= 1: Enable the Remote Loopback.
ALP:
= 0: Disable the Analog Loopback.
= 1: Enable the Analog Loopback.
DLP:
= 0: Disable the Local Digital Loopback 2.
= 1: Enable the Local Digital Loopback 2.
Programming Information
151
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Maintenance Function Control 1 (02CH, 12CH, 22CH, 32CH, 42CH, 52CH, 62CH, 72CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
LAC
RAISE
ATAO
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
LAC:
This bit selects the LOS criterion.
= 0: The T1.231 is selected. In short haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is less than 800 mVpp for 175 consecutive bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming signal level is greater than 1 Vpp and has an average mark density of at least 12.5% and less
than 100 consecutive zeros in 128 consecutive bit periods. In long haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is less than
Q dB below nominal (set in the LOS[4:0] bits (b4~0, T1/J1-029H,...)) for 175 consecutive bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming signal level
is greater than (Q + 4 dB) and has an average mark density of at least 12.5% and less than 100 consecutive zeros in 128 consecutive bit periods.
= 1: The I.431 is selected. In short haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is less than 800 mVpp for 1544 consecutive
bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming signal level is greater than 1 Vpp and has an average mark density of at least 12.5% and less than
100 consecutive zeros in 128 consecutive bit periods. In long haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is less than Q
dB below nominal (set in the LOS[4:0] bits (b4~0, T1/J1-029H,...)) for 1544 consecutive bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming signal level
is greater than (Q + 4 dB) and has an average mark density of at least 12.5% and less than 100 consecutive zeros in 128 consecutive bit periods.
RAISE:
This bit determines whether all ’One’s can be inserted in the receive path when the LOS is detected.
= 0: Disable the insertion.
= 1: Enable the insertion.
ATAO:
This bit determines whether all ’One’s can be inserted in the transmit path when the LOS is detected in the receive path.
= 0: Disable the insertion.
= 1: Enable the insertion.
Programming Information
152
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Maintenance Function Control 2 (031H, 131H, 231H, 331H, 431H, 531H, 631H, 731H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
6
5
BPV_INS
Reserved
Default
R/W
Reserved
0
4
3
2
1
0
EXZ_DEF
EXZ_ERR1
EXZ_ERR0
CNT_MD
CNT_TRF
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
BPV_INS:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit generates a single Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error to be inserted to the data stream to be transmitted.
This bit must be cleared and set again for the next BPV error insertion.
EXZ_DEF:
This bit selects the Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error criterion.
= 0: The ANSI is selected. In AMI line code rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 15 consecutive zeros in the data stream. In B8ZS line code
rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 7 consecutive zeros in the data stream.
= 1: The FCC is selected. In AMI line code rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 80 consecutive zeros in the data stream. In B8ZS line code
rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 7 consecutive zeros in the data stream.
EXZ_ERR[1:0]:
These bits must be set to ‘01’ to enable the Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error event to be counted in an internal 16-bit EXZ counter.
CNT_MD:
= 0: The Manual Report mode is selected. The internal 16-bit EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers
when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the CNT_TRF bit.
= 1: The Auto Report mode is selected. The internal 16-bit EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers
every one second automatically.
CNT_TRF:
This bit is valid when the CNT_MD bit is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit updates the content in the EXZ Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers with the value in the internal 16-bit EXZ
counter.
This bit must be cleared and set again for the next updating.
Programming Information
153
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit And Receive Termination Configuration (032H, 132H, 232H, 332H, 432H, 532H, 632H, 732H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
T_TERM2
T_TERM1
T_TERM0
R_TERM2
R_TERM1
R_TERM0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
1
1
2
1
0
T_TERM[2:0]:
These bits select the internal impedance of the transmit path to match the cable impedance:
= 000: The 75 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 001: The 120 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 010: The 100 Ω internal impedance matching is selected. (It is the standard value for T1 mode).
= 011: The 110 Ω internal impedance matching is selected. (It is the standard value for J1 mode).
= 1xx: Reserved.
In T1/J1 mode, the external impedance circuit is not supported in transmit path.
R_TERM[2:0]:
These bits select the internal impedance of the receive path to match the cable impedance:
= 000: The 75 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 001: The 120 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 010: The 100 Ω internal impedance matching is selected. (It is the standard value for T1 mode).
= 011: The 110 Ω internal impedance matching is selected. (It is the standard value for J1 mode).
= 1xx: The internal impedance matching is bypassed, and external impedance circuit should be used.
T1/J1 Interrupt Enable Control 0 (033H, 133H, 233H, 333H, 433H, 533H, 633H, 733H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
DF_IE
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
LOS_IE
Reserved
R/W
0
DF_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DF_IS bit (b2, T1/J1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DF_IS bit (b2, T1/J1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
LOS_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LOS_IS bit (b0, T1/J1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LOS_IS bit (b0, T1/J1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
154
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Interrupt Enable Control 1 (034H, 134H, 234H, 334H, 434H, 534H, 634H, 734H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
DAC_IE
TJA_IE
RJA_IE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
Reserved
2
1
0
EXZ_IE
CV_IE
CNT_IE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
2
1
0
DAC_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DAC_IS bit (b6, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DAC_IS bit (b6, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
TJA_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TJA_IS bit (b5, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TJA_IS bit (b5, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
RJA_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RJA_IS bit (b4, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RJA_IS bit (b4, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
EXZ_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the EXZ_IS bit (b2, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the EXZ_IS bit (b2, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
CV_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CV_IS bit (b1, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CV_IS bit (b1, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
CNT_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CNTOV_IS bit (b0, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CNTOV_IS bit (b0, T1/J1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 Interrupt Trigger Edges Select (035H, 135H, 235H, 335H, 435H, 535H, 635H, 735H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
DF_IES
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
LOS_IES
Reserved
R/W
0
DF_IES:
= 0: The DF_IS bit (b2, T1/J1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the DF_S bit (b2, T1/J1-036H,...).
= 1: The DF_IS bit (b2, T1/J1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is any transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the DF_S bit (b2, T1/J1036H,...).
LOS_IES:
= 0: The LOS_IS bit (b0, T1/J1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the LOS_S bit (b0, T1/J1-036H,...).
= 1: The LOS_IS bit (b0, T1/J1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is any transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the LOS_S bit (b0, T1/J1036H,...).
Programming Information
155
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Line Status Register 0 (036H, 136H, 236H, 336H, 436H, 536H, 636H, 736H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
1
0
DF_S
Type
Reserved
R
Default
LOS_S
Reserved
R
0
0
DF_S:
= 0: No transmit driver failure is detected.
= 1: Transmit driver failure is detected.
LOS_S:
= 0: No LOS is detected.
= 1: Loss of signal (LOS) is detected.
T1/J1 Line Status Register 1 (037H, 137H, 237H, 337H, 437H, 537H, 637H, 737H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
LATT4
LATT3
LATT2
LATT1
LATT0
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
LATT[4:0]:
These bits indicate the current gain of the VGA relative to 3 V peak pulse level.
LATT[4:0]
Gain (dB)
LATT[4:0]
Gain (dB)
00000
0-2
01011
22 - 24
00001
2-4
01100
24 - 26
00010
4-6
01101
26 - 28
00011
6-8
01110
28 - 30
00100
8 - 10
01111
30 - 32
00101
10 - 12
10000
32 - 34
00110
12 - 14
10001
34 - 36
00111
14 - 16
10010
36 - 38
01000
16 - 18
10011
38 - 40
01001
18 - 20
10100
40 - 42
01010
20 - 22
10101 ~ 11111
42 - 44
Programming Information
156
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Jitter Measure Value Indication (038H, 138H, 238H, 338H, 438H, 538H, 638H, 738H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TJITT6
TJITT5
TJITT4
TJITT3
TJITT2
TJITT1
TJITT0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TJITT[6:0]:
When the TJITT_TEST bit (b5, T1/J1-021H,...) is ‘0’, these bits represent the current interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO.
When the TJITT_TEST bit (b5, T1/J1-021H,...) is ‘1’, these bits represent the P-P interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO since last
read.
These bits will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to the register.
T1/J1 Receive Jitter Measure Value Indication (039H, 139H, 239H, 339H, 439H, 539H, 639H, 739H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RJITT6
RJITT5
RJITT4
RJITT3
RJITT2
RJITT1
RJITT0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RJITT[6:0]:
When the RJITT_TEST bit (b5, T1/J1-027H,...) is ‘0’, these bits represent the current interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO.
When the RJITT_TEST bit (b5, T1/J1-027H,...) is ‘1’, these bits represent the P-P interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO since last
read.
These bits will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to the register.
Programming Information
157
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Interrupt Status 0 (03AH, 13AH, 23AH, 33AH, 43AH, 53AH, 63AH, 73AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
DF_IS
Reserved
R
Default
0
0
LOS_IS
Reserved
R
0
DF_IS:
= 0: There is no status change on the DF_S bit (b2, T1/J1-036H,...).
= 1: When the DF_IES bit (b2, T1/J1-035H,...) is ‘0’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the DF_S bit (b2, T1/J1036H,...); when the DF_IES bit (b2, T1/J1-035H,...) is ‘1’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the DF_S
bit (b2, T1/J1-036H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
LOS_IS:
= 0: There is no status change on the LOS_S bit (b0, T1/J1-036H,...).
= 1: When the LOS_IES bit (b0, T1/J1-035H,...) is ‘0’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the LOS_S bit (b0, T1/J1036H,...); when the LOS_IES bit (b0, T1/J1-035H,...) is ‘1’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the
LOS_S bit (b0, T1/J1-036H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
158
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Interrupt Status 1 (03BH, 13BH, 23BH, 33BH, 43BH, 53BH, 63BH, 73BH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
DAC_IS
TJA_IS
RJA_IS
R
R
R
0
0
0
Reserved
2
1
0
EXZ_IS
CV_IS
CNTOV_IS
R
R
R
0
0
0
DAC_IS:
= 0: The sum of a pulse template does not exceed the D/A limitation (+63) when more than one UI is used to compose the arbitrary pulse template.
= 1: The sum of a pulse template exceeds the D/A limitation (+63) when more than one UI is used to compose the arbitrary pulse template.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
TJA_IS:
= 0: The transmit JA FIFO has not overflowed or underflowed.
= 1: The transmit JA FIFO has overflowed or underflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RJA_IS:
= 0: The receive JA FIFO has not overflowed or underflowed.
= 1: The receive JA FIFO has overflowed or underflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
EXZ_IS:
= 0: No Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is detected.
= 1: The Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CV_IS:
= 0: No Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error is detected.
= 1: The Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CNTOV_IS:
= 0: The internal 16-bit EXZ counter has not overflowed.
= 1: The internal 16-bit EXZ counter has overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
159
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 EXZ Error Counter H-Byte (03CH, 13CH, 23CH, 33CH, 43CH, 53CH, 63CH, 73CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
CNTH[7]
CNTH[6]
CNTH[5]
CNTH[4]
CNTH[3]
CNTH[2]
CNTH[1]
CNTH[0]
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CNTH[7:0]:
These bits, together with the CNTL[7:0] bits, reflect the content in the internal 16-bit EXZ counter.
T1/J1 EXZ Error Counter L-Byte (03DH, 13DH, 23DH, 33DH, 43DH, 53DH, 63DH, 73DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
CNTL[7]
CNTL[6]
CNTL[5]
CNTL[4]
CNTL[3]
CNTL[2]
CNTL[1]
CNTL[0]
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CNTL[7:0]:
These bits, together with the CNTH[7:0] bits, reflect the content in the internal 16-bit EXZ counter.
Programming Information
160
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Reference Clock Output Control (03EH, 13EH, 23EH, 33EH, 43EH, 53EH, 63EH, 73EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
REFH_LOS
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
REFH_LOS:
In case of LOS, this bit determines the outputs on the REFA_OUT and REFB_OUT pins.
= 0: Output MCLK.
= 1: Output high level.
T1/J1 Interrupt Module Indication 2 (03FH, 13FH, 23FH, 33FH, 43FH, 53FH, 63FH, 73FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
0
LIU
Reserved
Default
R
0
LIU:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Receive / Transmit Internal Termination, Adaptive Equalizer, Data Slicer, CLK&Data Recovery, Receive /
Transmit Jitter Attenuator, B8ZS/HDB3/AMI Decoder / Encoder, Waveform Shaper / Line Build Out or Line Driver block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Receive / Transmit Internal Termination, Adaptive Equalizer, Data Slicer, CLK&Data Recovery, Receive / Transmit
Jitter Attenuator, B8ZS/HDB3/AMI Decoder / Encoder, Waveform Shaper / Line Build Out or Line Driver function block.
Programming Information
161
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Interrupt Module Indication 0 (040H, 140H, 240H, 340H, 440H, 540H, 640H, 740H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
IBCD
RBOC
ALARM
PMON
PRGD
RCRB
FGEN
FRMR
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IBCD:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Inband Loopback Code Detector function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Inband Loopback Code Detector function block.
RBOC:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Bit-Oriented Message Receiver function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Bit-Oriented Message Receiver function block.
ALARM:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Alarm Detector function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Alarm Detector function block.
PMON:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Performance Monitor function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Performance Monitor function block.
PRGD:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the PRBS Generator / Detector function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the PRBS Generator / Detector function block.
RCRB:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer function block.
FGEN:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Frame Generator function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Frame Generator function block.
FRMR:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Frame Processor function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Frame Processor function block.
Programming Information
162
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Interrupt Module Indication 1 (041H, 141H, 241H, 341H, 441H, 541H, 641H, 741H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
THDLC3
THDLC2
THDLC1
RHDLC3
RHDLC2
RHDLC1
ELST
TRSI/RESI
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
THDLC3:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #3 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #3 function block.
THDLC2:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #2 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #2 function block.
THDLC1:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #1 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #1 function block.
RHDLC3:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #3 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #3 function block.
RHDLC2:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #2 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #2 function block.
RHDLC1:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #1 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #1 function block.
ELST:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Elastic Store Buffer function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Elastic Store Buffer function block.
TRSI/RESI:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Transmit / Receive System Interface function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Transmit / Receive System Interface function block.
Programming Information
163
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TBIF Option Register (042H, 142H, 242H, 342H, 442H, 542H, 642H, 742H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
FBITGAP
DE
FE
CMS
FSINV
FSTYP
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
FBITGAP:
This bit is valid in Transmit Clock Master mode.
= 0: The F-bit is not gapped.
= 1: The F-bit is gapped (no clock signal during the F-bit).
DE:
This bit selects the active edge of TSCKn to sample the data on TSDn and TSIGn and the active edge of MTSCK to sample the data on MTSDA
(MTSDB) and MTSIGA (MTSIGB).
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FE:
This bit selects the active edge of TSCKn to update/sample the pulse on TSFSn and the active edge of MTSCK to sample the pulse on MTSFS.
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
CMS:
This bit is valid in Transmit Clock Slave T1/J1 mode E1 rate and Transmit Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The speed of the TSCKn / MTSCK is the same as the data rate on the system side (2.048 MHz / 8.192 MHz).
= 1: The speed of the TSCKn / MTSCK is double the data rate on the system side (4.096 MHz / 16.384 MHz).
In Transmit Clock Slave T1/J1 mode E1 rate, if all eight links use the TSCK[1] and TSFS[1] to input the data (i.e., the TSLVCK bit (b, T1/J1-010H)
is set to ‘1’), the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FSINV:
= 0: The transmit framing pulse TSFSn is active high.
= 1: The transmit framing pulse TSFSn is active low.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, this bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FSTYP:
= 0: In Transmit Non-multiplexed mode, TSFSn pulses during each F-bit. In Transmit Multiplexed mode, MTSFS pulses during each F-bit of the
first link.
= 1: In Transmit Non-multiplexed mode, TSFSn pulses during the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 frame. In Transmit Multiplexed mode,
MTSFS pulses during the first F-bit of every SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 frame of the first link.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, this bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
Programming Information
164
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TBIF Operating Mode (043H, 143H, 243H, 343H, 443H, 543H, 643H, 743H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
2
1
0
MAP1
MAP0
TMODE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
Default
MAP[1:0]:
In Transmit Clock Slave mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode, these 2 bits select the T1/J1 to E1 format mapping schemes.
MAP[1:0]
T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping Schemes
00*
T1/J1 Rate
01
T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802
10
T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every Four CHs
11
T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs
Note:
* These 2 bits can not be set to ‘00’ in the Transmit Multiplexed mode.
TMODE:
In Transmit Non-multiplexed mode, this bit selects the sub-mode.
= 0: The Transmit System Interface is operated in Transmit Clock Master mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to
align the data input on the TSDn pin are provided from the processed data from the device.
= 1: The Transmit System Interface is operated in Transmit Clock Slave mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to align
the data input on the TSDn pin are provided by the system side.
T1/J1 TBIF TS Offset (044H, 144H, 244H, 344H, 444H, 544H, 644H, 744H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TSOFF[6:0]:
These bits give a binary number to define the channel offset. The channel offset is between the framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin and the
start of the corresponding frame input on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin are always perchannel aligned with the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin.
In Non-multiplexed mode, the channel offset can be configured from 0 to 23 channels (0 & 23 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the channel
offset can be configured from 0 to 127 channels (0 & 127 are included).
Programming Information
165
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TBIF Bit Offset (045H, 145H, 245H, 345H, 445H, 545H, 645H, 745H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
EDGE:
This bit is valid when the CMS bit (b2, T1/J1-042H,...) is ‘1’.
= 0: The first active edge of TSCKn/MTSCK is selected to sample the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) and TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pins.
= 1: The second active edge of TSCKn/MTSCK is selected to sample the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) and TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pins.
BOFF[2:0]:
These bits give a binary number to define the bit offset. The bit offset is between the framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin and the start of the
corresponding frame input on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin are always per-channel aligned
with the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin.
Programming Information
166
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RBIF Option Register (046H, 146H, 246H, 346H, 446H, 546H, 646H, 746H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
FBITGAP
DE
FE
CMS
TRI
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
1
1
0
1
FBITGAP:
This bit is valid in Receive Clock Master mode.
= 0: The F-bit is not gapped.
= 1: The F-bit is gapped (no clock signal during the F-bit).
DE:
This bit selects the active edge of RSCKn to update the data on RSDn and RSIGn and the active edge of MRSCK to update the data on MRSDA
(MRSDB) and MRSIGA (MRSIGB).
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FE:
This bit selects the active edge of RSCKn to update/sample the pulse on RSFSn and the active edge of MRSCK to sample the pulse on MRSFS.
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
CMS:
This bit is valid in Receive Clock Slave T1/J1 mode E1 rate and Receive Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The speed of the RSCKn/MRSCK is the same as the data rate on the system side (2.048 MHz / 8.192 MHz).
= 1: The speed of the RSCKn/MRSCK is double the data rate on the system side (4.096 MHz / 16.384 MHz).
In Receive Clock Slave T1/J1 mode E1 rate, if all eight links use the RSCK[1] and RSFS[1] to output the data (i.e., the RSLVCK bit (b, T1/J1-010H)
is set to ‘1’), the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
TRI:
= 0: The processed data and signaling bits are output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pins and the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins respectively.
= 1: The output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pins and the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins are in high impedance.
Programming Information
167
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RBIF Mode (047H, 147H, 247H, 347H, 447H, 547H, 647H, 747H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
2
1
0
MAP1
MAP0
RMODE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
Default
MAP[1:0]:
In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, these 2 bits select the T1/J1 to E1 format mapping schemes.
MAP[1:0]
T1/J1 To E1 Format Mapping Schemes
00*
T1/J1 Rate
01
T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per G.802
10
T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per One Filler Every Four CHs
11
T1/J1 Mode E1 Rate per Continuous CHs
Note:
* These 2 bits can not be set to ‘00’ in the Receive Multiplexed mode.
RMODE:
In Receive Non-multiplexed mode, this bit selects the sub-mode.
= 0: The Receive System Interface is operated in Receive Clock Master mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to
align the data output on the RSDn pin are received from each line side.
= 1: The Receive System Interface is operated in Receive Clock Slave mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to align
the data output on the RSDn pin are provided by the system side.
Programming Information
168
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RBIF Frame Pulse (048H, 148H, 248H, 348H, 448H, 548H, 648H, 748H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
4
3
2
FSINV
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
Reserved
0
1
0
CMFS
ALTFIS
R/W
R/W
0
0
FSINV:
= 0: The receive framing pulse RSFSn is active high.
= 1: The receive framing pulse RSFSn is active low.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, this bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
CMFS, ALTIFS:
In Receive Clock Master mode, these bits select what the pulse on RSFSn indicates. The ALTIFS bit is only valid in SF format.
Format
SF
ESF, T1DM,
SLC-96
CMFS
ALTIFS
0
0
The RSFSn pulses during each F-bit.
0
1
The RSFSn pulses during every second F-bit.
1
0
The RSFSn pulses during the first F-bit of every SF frame.
1
1
The RSFSn pulses during the first F-bit of every second SF frame.
0
X
The RSFSn pulses during each F-bit.
1
X
The RSFSn pulses during the first F-bit of every ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 frame.
Programming Information
RSFSn Indication
169
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RBIF TS Offset (049H, 149H, 249H, 349H, 449H, 549H, 649H, 749H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TSOFF[6:0]:
These bits give a binary number to define the channel offset. The channel offset is between the framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin and the
start of the corresponding frame output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin are always perchannel aligned with the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin.
In Non-multiplexed mode, the channel offset can be configured from 0 to 23 channels (0 & 23 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the channel
offset can be configured from 0 to 127 channels (0 & 127 are included).
T1/J1 RBIF Bit Offset (04AH, 14AH, 24AH, 34AH, 44AH, 54AH, 64AH, 74AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
EDGE:
This bit is valid when the CMS bit (b1, T1/J1-046H,...) is ‘1’.
= 0: The first active edge of RSCKn/MRSCK is selected to update the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins.
= 1: The second active edge of RSCKn/MRSCK is selected to update the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB)
pins.
BOFF[2:0]:
These bits give a binary number to define the bit offset. The bit offset is between the framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin and the start of the
corresponding frame output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin are always per-channel
aligned with the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin.
Programming Information
170
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RTSFS Change Indication (04BH, 14BH, 24BH, 34BH, 44BH, 54BH, 64BH, 74BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
RCOFAI
TCOFAI
R
R
0
0
1
0
RCOFAE
TCOFAE
R/W
R/W
0
0
RCOFAI:
This bit is valid in Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The interval of the pulses on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin is an integer multiple of 125 µs.
= 1: The interval of the pulses on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs.
This bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it.
TCOFAI:
This bit is valid in Transmit Clock Slave mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The interval of the pulses on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin is an integer multiple of 125 µs.
= 1: The interval of the pulses on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs.
This bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it.
T1/J1 RTSFS Interrupt Control (04CH, 14CH, 24CH, 34CH, 44CH, 54CH, 64CH, 74CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
RCOFAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit (b1, T1/J1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit (b1, T1/J1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
TCOFAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCOFAI bit (b0, T1/J1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCOFAI bit (b0, T1/J1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
171
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FRMR Mode 0 (04DH, 14DH, 24DH, 34DH, 44DH, 54DH, 64DH, 74DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
UNFM
REFCRCE
REFEN
REFR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
1
1
0
UNFM:
= 0: The data stream is received in framed mode and is processed by the Frame Processor.
= 1: The data stream is received in unframed mode and the Frame Processor is bypassed.
REFCRCE:
In ESF format:
= 0: Disable from re-searching for synchronization when the Excessive CRC-6 Error occurs.
= 1: Search for synchronization again when the Excessive CRC-6 Error occurs. This function can only be implemented only if the REFEN bit is
logic 1.
REFEN:
= 0: “Locked in frame”. Once the previous frame synchronization is acquired, no errors can lead to reframe except for manually setting by the
REFR bit.
= 1: Search for synchronization again when it is out of synchronization.
REFR:
A transition from logic 0 to logic 1 forces to re-search for a new SF, ESF, T1 DM frame.
Programming Information
172
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FRMR Mode 1 (04EH, 14EH, 24EH, 34EH, 44EH, 54EH, 64EH, 74EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
DDSC
MIMICC
M2O1
M2O0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
DDSC:
This bit selects the synchronization criteria of T1 DM format.
= 0: If a correct DDS pattern is received before the first F-bit of a single correct Frame Alignment Pattern and there is no mimic pattern, the T1 DM
synchronization is acquired.
= 1: If a single correct Frame Alignment Pattern is received, and twelve correct DDS patterns before each F-bit of the correct Frame Alignment
Pattern are all detected, and there is no mimic pattern, the T1 DM synchronization is acquired.
MIMICC:
This bit selects the synchronization criteria in SF format and ESF format.
In SF format:
= 0: When two consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are received error free in the data stream, the SF is synchronized. In this case, the existence
of mimic patterns is ignored.
= 1: When two consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are received error free in the data stream without mimic pattern, the SF is synchronized.
In ESF format:
= 0: When a single correct Frame Alignment Pattern and a single correct CRC-6 are found in the same frame, the ESF is synchronized. In this
case, the existence of mimic patterns is ignored.
= 1: When four consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are detected error free in the received data stream without mimic pattern, the ESF is
synchronized.
M2O[2:1]:
In SF format, these two bits define the threshold of the F Bit Error numbers in N-bit sliding F bits window. Exceeding the threshold will lead to out of
synchronization.
In ESF format, these two bits define the threshold of the Frame Alignment Bit Error numbers in N-bit sliding Frame Alignment bits window.
Exceeding the threshold will lead to out of synchronization.
In T1 DM format, these two bits define the threshold of the 7-bit pattern error numbers in N-pattern sliding 7-bit patterns window. The 7-bit pattern
consists of the 6-bit DDS pattern and its following F-bit. Exceeding the threshold will lead to out of synchronization.
In SLC-96 format, these two bits define the threshold of the Ft bit error numbers in N-bit sliding Ft bits window or the Fs bit error numbers in N-bit
sliding Fs bits in Frame (2n) (0<n<12 and n=36) window. Exceeding the threshold will lead to out of synchronization.
M2O[1:0]
Error Numbers
N-Bit/Pattern Sliding Window
00
2
4
01
2
5
10
2
6
11
Programming Information
Reserved
173
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FRMR Status (04FH, 14FH, 24FH, 34FH, 44FH, 54FH, 64FH, 74FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
OOFV
Type
Reserved
R
Default
1
OOFV:
= 0: The SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 frame is in synchronization.
= 1: The frame is out of synchronization.
T1/J1 FRMR Interrupt Control 0 (050H, 150H, 250H, 350H, 450H, 550H, 650H, 750H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
0
OOFE
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
OOFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFI bit (b0, T1/J1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFI bit (b0, T1/J1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
174
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FRMR Interrupt Control 1 (051H, 151H, 251H, 351H, 451H, 551H, 651H, 751H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
RMFBE
SFEE
BEEE
FERE
COFAE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
RMFBE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMFBI bit (b4, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMFBI bit (b4, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
SFEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SFEI bit (b3, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SFEI bit (b3, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
BEEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BEEI bit (b2, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BEEI bit (b2, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
FERE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FERI bit (b1, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FERI bit (b1, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
COFAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAI bit (b0, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAI bit (b0, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
175
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FRMR Interrupt Indication 0 (052H, 152H, 252H, 352H, 452H, 552H, 652H, 752H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
EXCRCERI
MIMICI
R
R
0
0
2
1
0
OOFI
Reserved
R
0
EXCRCERI:
In ESF format, once the accumulated CRC-6 errors exceed 319 (>319) in a 1 second fixed window, an excessive CRC-6 error event is generated
= 0: No Excessive CRC-6 Error event is detected.
= 1: The Excessive CRC-6 Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
MIMICI:
This bit is valid in SF and ESF formats.
= 0: No mimic pattern is detected in the received data stream.
= 1: Mimic pattern is detected in the received data stream.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
OOFI:
= 0: There is no status change on the OOFV bit (b0, T1/J1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the OOFV bit (b0, T1/J1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
176
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FRMR Interrupt Indication 1 (053H, 153H, 253H, 353H, 453H, 553H, 653H, 753H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
RMFBI
SFEI
BEEI
FERI
COFAI
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
RMFBI:
= 0: The received bit is not the first bit of each SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 frame.
= 1: The first bit of each SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 frame is received.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it. This bit can not be updated during out of synchronization state.
SFEI:
In SF format, each received Ft bit is compared with the expected one (refer to Table 12). Each unmatched Ft bit leads to an Ft bit error event.
When 2 or more Ft bit errors are detected in a 6-basic-frame fixed window, the severely Ft bit error occurs
= 0: No Severely Ft Bit Error event is detected.
= 1: The Severely Ft Bit Error event is detected.
In ESF format, when 2 or more frame alignment bit errors are detected in a 1-ESF-frame fixed window, the severely frame alignment bit error
occurs.
= 0: No Severely Frame Alignment Bit Error event is detected.
= 1: The Severely Frame Alignment Bit Error event is detected.
In T1 DM format, each received Ft bit is compared with the expected one (refer to Table 14). Each unmatched Ft bit leads to an Ft bit error event.
When 2 or more Ft bit errors are detected in a 6-basic-frame fixed window, the severely Ft bit error occurs.
= 0: No Severely Ft Bit Error event is detected.
= 1: The Severely Ft Bit Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
BEEI:
In ESF format, when the local calculated CRC-6 of the current received ESF frame does not match the received CRC-6 of the next received ESF
frame, a single CRC-6 error event is generated
= 0: No CRC-6 Error event is detected.
= 1: The CRC-6 Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
FERI:
In SF format, each received F bit is compared with the expected one (refer to Table 12). Each unmatched F bit leads to an F bit error event.
= 0: No F Bit Error event is detected.
= 1: The F Bit Error event is detected.
In ESF format, each received Frame Alignment bit is compared with the expected one (refer to Table 13). Each unmatched bit leads to a frame
alignment bit error event.
= 0: No Frame Alignment Bit Error event is detected.
= 1: The Frame Alignment Bit Error event is detected.
In T1 DM format, each received F bit is compared with the expected one (refer to Table 14). Each unmatched F bit leads to an F bit error event
= 0: No F Bit Error event is detected.
= 1: The F Bit Error event is detected.
Programming Information
177
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
In SLC-96 format, The Ft bit in each odd frame and the Fs bit in Frame (2n) (0<n<12 and n=36) is compared with the expected one (refer to
Table 15). Each unmatched bit leads to a F-bit error event.
= 0: No F Bit Error event is detected.
= 1: The F Bit Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
COFAI:
= 0: The F bit position is not changed.
= 1: The new-found F bit position differs from the previous one.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
T1/J1 RDL0 (056H, 156H, 256H, 356H, 456H, 556H, 656H, 756H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
C8
C7
C6
C5
C4
C3
C2
C1
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
C[8:1]:
In SLC-96 format, these bits together with the C[11:9] bits reflect the content in the Concentrator bits. The C[1] bit is the LSB.
In de-bounce condition, these bits are updated if the received Concentrator bits are the same for 2 consecutive SLC-96 frames; otherwise they are
updated every SLC-96 frame.
They are held during out of SLC-96 synchronization state.
T1/J1 RDL1 (057H, 157H, 257H, 357H, 457H, 557H, 657H, 757H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
M3
M2
M1
C11
C10
C9
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
M[3:1]:
In SLC-96 format, these bits reflect the content in the Maintenance bits. The M[1] bit is the LSB.
In de-bounce condition, these bits are updated if the received Maintenance bits are the same for 2 consecutive SLC-96 frames; otherwise they are
updated every SLC-96 frame.
They are held during out of SLC-96 synchronization state.
C[11:9]:
In SLC-96 format, these bits together with the C[8:1] bits reflect the content in the Concentrator bits. The C[11] bit is the MSB.
In de-bounce condition, these bits are updated if the received Concentrator bits are the same for 2 consecutive SLC-96 frames; otherwise they are
updated every SLC-96 frame.
They are held during out of SLC-96 synchronization state.
Programming Information
178
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RDL2 (058H, 158H, 258H, 358H, 458H, 558H, 658H, 758H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
S4
S3
S2
S1
A2
A1
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
S[4:1]:
In SLC-96 format, these bits reflect the content in the Switch bits. The S[1] bit is the LSB.
In de-bounce condition, these bits are updated if the received Switch bits are the same for 2 consecutive SLC-96 frames; otherwise they are
updated every SLC-96 frame.
They are held during out of SLC-96 synchronization state.
A[2:1]:
In SLC-96 format, these bits reflect the content in the Alarm bits. The A[1] bit is the LSB.
In de-bounce condition, these bits are updated if the received Alarm bits are the same for 2 consecutive SLC-96 frames; otherwise they are
updated every SLC-96 frame.
They are held during out of SLC-96 synchronization state.
Programming Information
179
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 DLB Interrupt Control (05CH, 15CH, 25CH, 35CH, 45CH, 55CH, 65CH, 75CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
SCDEB
SCAE
SCSE
SCME
SCCE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
0
SCAI
SCSI
SCMI
SCCI
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
SCDEB:
= 0: Disable the de-bounce function of the overhead extraction.
= 1: Enable the de-dounce function of the overhead extraction.
SCAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCAI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCAI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
SCSE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCSI bit (b2, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCSI bit (b2, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
SCME:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCMI bit (b1, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCMI bit (b1, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
SCCE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCCI bit (b0, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCCI bit (b0, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 DLB Interrupt Indication (05DH, 15DH, 25DH, 35DH, 45DH, 55DH, 65DH, 75DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
SCAI:
= 0: The value in the A[2:1] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the A[2:1] bits is changed.
SCSI:
= 0: The value in the S[4:1] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the S[4:1] bits is changed.
SCMI:
= 0: The value in the M[3:1] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the M[3:1] bits is changed.
SCCI:
= 0: The value in the C[11:1] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the C[11:1] bits is changed.
Programming Information
180
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Mode (062H, 162H, 262H, 362H, 462H, 562H, 662H, 762H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
FDLBYP
CRCBYP
FDIS
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
FDLBYP:
In ESF format, this bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
= 0: Enable the DL bit position to be replaced by the Bit-Oriented Code, the Automatic Performance Report Message, the HDLC data or the idle
code (‘FFFF’ for T1 / ‘FF7E’ for J1).
= 1: Disable the DL bit position to be replaced by the above codes.
In T1 DM format, this bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
= 0: The ‘D’ bit in Bit 6 of each Channel 24 is replaced with the HDLC data.
= 1: Disable the D bit position to be replaced by the HDLC data.
In SLC-96 format, this bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
= 0: The Concentrator (C) bit, the Maintenance (M) bit, the Alarm (A) bit and the Switch (S) bit are replaced by the contents in the C[11:1] bits
(b2~0, T1/J1-066H,... & b7~0, T1/J1-065H,...), the M[3:1] bits (b5~3, T1/J1-066H,...), the A[2:1] bits (b1~0, T1/J1-067H,...) and the S[4:1] bits
(b5~2, T1/J1-067H,...) respectively.
= 1: Disable the Concentrator (C) bit, the Maintenance (M) bit, the Alarm (A) bit and the Switch (S) bit replacement.
CRCBYP:
This bit is valid in ESF format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
= 0: The calculated 6-bit CRC of the previous ESF frame is inserted in the current CRC-bit positions in every 4th frame starting with Frame 2 of the
current ESF frame.
= 1: Disable the CRC-6 insertion.
FDIS:
= 0: Enable the generation of the SF / ESF / T1 DM / SLC-96 frame.
= 1: Disable the generation of the SF / ESF / T1 DM / SLC-96 frame.
T1/J1 XDL0 (065H, 165H, 265H, 365H, 465H, 565H, 665H, 765H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
C8
C7
C6
C5
C4
C3
C2
C1
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
C[8:1]:
These bits, together with the C[11:9] bits (b2~0, T1/J1-066H,...), are valid in SLC-96 format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) and the
FDLBYP bit (b2, T1/J1-062H,...) are both ‘0’s. They contain the data to replace the Concentrator (C) bit. The C[1] is the LSB and it is transmitted first.
Programming Information
181
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 XDL1 (066H, 166H, 266H, 366H, 466H, 566H, 666H, 766H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
M3
M2
M1
C11
C10
C9
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
M[3:1]:
These bits are valid in SLC-96 format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) and the FDLBYP bit (b2, T1/J1-062H,...) are both ‘0’s. They contain
the data to replace the Maintenance (M) bit. The M[1] is transmitted first.
C[11:9]:
These bits, together with the C[8:1] bits (b7~1, T1/J1-065H,...), are valid in SLC-96 format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) and the FDLBYP
bit (b2, T1/J1-062H,...) are both ‘0’s. They contain the data to replace the Concentrator (C) bit. The C[11] is the MSB and it is transmitted last.
T1/J1 XDL2 (067H, 167H, 267H, 367H, 467H, 567H, 667H, 767H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
S4
S3
S2
S1
A2
A1
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
S[4:1]:
These bits are valid in SLC-96 format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) and the FDLBYP bit (b2, T1/J1-062H,...) are both ‘0’s. They contain
the data to replace the Switch (S) bit. The S[1] is transmitted first.
A[2:1]:
These bits are valid in SLC-96 format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) and the FDLBYP bit (b2, T1/J1-062H,...) are both ‘0’s. They contain
the data to replace the Alarm (A) bit. The A[1] is transmitted first.
T1/J1 FGEN Maintenance 0 (06BH, 16BH, 26BH, 36BH, 46BH, 56BH, 66BH, 76BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
AUTOYELLOW
XYEL
R/W
R/W
0
0
AUTOYELLOW:
= 0: Disable the automatic Yellow alarm signal insertion.
= 1: The Yellow alarm signal is automatically inserted into the data stream to be transmitted when Red alarm is declared in the received data
stream.
XYEL:
= 0: Disable the manual Yellow alarm signal insertion.
= 1: The Yellow alarm signal is manually inserted into the data stream to be transmitted.
Programming Information
182
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FGEN Maintenance 1 (06CH, 16CH, 26CH, 36CH, 46CH, 56CH, 66CH, 76CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
MIMICEN
COFAEN
TXDIS
TAIS
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
MIMICEN:
This bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
= 0: Disable the mimic pattern insertion.
= 1: The mimic pattern is inserted into the bit right after each F-bit. The content of the mimic pattern is the same as the F-bit.
COFAEN:
Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on this bit will lead to one bit deletion or one bit repetition in the data stream to be transmitted, that is,
to change the frame alignment position. The one bit deletion or repetition occurs randomly.
TXDIS:
= 0: Normal operation.
= 1: The data stream to be transmitted are overwritten with all ‘Zero’s.
TAIS:
= 0: Normal operation.
= 1: The data stream to be transmitted are overwritten with all ’One’s.
T1/J1 FGEN Interrupt Control (06DH, 16DH, 26DH, 36DH, 46DH, 56DH, 66DH, 76DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
MFE
BFE
R/W
R/W
0
0
MFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the MFI bit (b1, T1/J1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the MFI bit (b1, T1/J1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
BFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BFI bit (b0, T1/J1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BFI bit (b0, T1/J1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
183
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FGEN Interrupt Indication (06EH, 16EH, 26EH, 36EH, 46EH, 56EH, 66EH, 76EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
MFI
BFI
R
R
0
0
MFI:
= 0: The bit input to the Frame Generator is not the first bit of each SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multiframe.
= 1: The first bit of each SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 multiframe is input to the Frame Generator.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
BFI:
= 0: The bit input to the Frame Generator is not the first bit of each basic frame.
= 1: The first bit of each basic frame is input to the Frame Generator.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
184
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Error Insertion (06FH, 16FH, 26FH, 36FH, 46FH, 56FH, 66FH, 76FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
DDSINV
CRCINV
FsINV
FtINV
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
DDSINV:
This bit is valid in T1 DM format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit wil invert one 6-bit DDS pattern.
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
CRCINV:
This bit is valid in ESF format when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one 6-bit CRC pattern.
This bit is cleared when the invertion is completed.
FsINV:
In SF, T1 DM formats, this bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one Fs bit (the F-bit in even frame).
In ESF format, this bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one Frame Alignment bit.
In SLC-96 format, this bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one Synchronization Fs bit.
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
FtINV:
In SF, T1 DM, SLC-96 formats, this bit is valid when the FDIS bit (b0, T1/J1-062H,...) is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one Ft bit (the F-bit in odd frame).
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
Programming Information
185
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Transmit Timing Option (070H, 170H, 270H, 370H, 470H, 570H, 670H, 770H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
XTS
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
XTS:
In Transmit Clock Master mode:
= 0: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the clock generated by the internal clock generator (1.544 MHz).
= 1: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the recovered clock from the line side.
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the Transmit Buffer is bypassed automatically.
In Transmit Clock Slave T1/J1 mode E1 rate, this bit is invalid. In the other Transmit Clock Slave modes and in Transmit Multiplexed mode:
= 0: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the clock from the backplane. The Transmit Buffer is bypassed.
= 1: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the clock generated by the internal clock generator (1.544 MHz). The Transmit Buffer is not
bypassed.
T1/J1 PRGD Control (071H, 171H, 271H, 371H, 471H, 571H, 671H, 771H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
RINV
TINV
PATS1
PATS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
RINV:
= 0: The data is not inverted before extracted to the pattern detector.
= 1: The data is inverted before extracted to the pattern detector.
TINV:
= 0: The generated pattern is not inverted.
= 1: The generated pattern is inverted.
PATS[1:0]:
These bits select the PRBS generated and detected pattern.
= 00: The 215-1 pattern per O.152 is selected.
= 01: The 220-1 pattern per O.150-4.5 is selected.
= 10: The 211-1 pattern per O.150 is selected.
= 11: Reserved.
Programming Information
186
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 PRGD Status/Error Control (072H, 172H, 272H, 372H, 472H, 572H, 672H, 772H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
3
2
1
0
BERE
INV
SYNCV
SYNCE
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
0
0
0
0
Default
BERE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BERI bit (b3, T1/J1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BERI bit (b3, T1/J1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
INV:
= 0: No bit error is inserted to the generated pattern.
= 1: A single bit error is inserted to the generated pattern.
This bit is cleared after the single bit error insertion is completed.
SYNCV:
= 0: The pattern is out of synchronization (the pattern detector has detected 10 or more bit errors in a fixed 48-bit window).
= 1: The pattern is in synchronization (the pattern detector has detected at least 48 consecutive error-free bit periods).
SYNCE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI bit (b0, T1/J1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI bit (b0, T1/J1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 PRGD Interrupt Indication (073H, 173H, 273H, 373H, 473H, 573H, 673H, 773H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
BERI
Reserved
R
Default
0
SYNCI
Reserved
0
R
0
BERI:
= 0: No bit is mismatched with the PRGD pattern when the extracted data is in synchronization state.
= 1: At least one bit is mismatched with the PRGD pattern when the extracted data is in synchronization state.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
SYNCI:
= 0: There is no status change on the SYNCV bit (b1, T1/J1-072H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the SYNCV bit (b1, T1/J1-072H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
187
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 XIBC Control (074H, 174H, 274H, 374H, 474H, 574H, 674H, 774H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
IBCDEN
IBCDUNFM
CL1
CL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
IBCDEN:
= 0: Disable transmitting the inband loopback code.
= 1: Enable transmitting the inband loopback code.
IBCDUNFM:
= 0: The inband loopback code is transmitted in framed mode, that is, the bits in all 24 channels are overwritten with the inband loopback code and
the F-bit is not changed.
= 1: The inband loopback code is transmitted in unframed mode, that is, all the bits in 24 channels and the F-bit are overwritten with the inband
loopback code.
CL[1:0]:
These 2 bits define the length of the inband loopback code to be transmitted, meanwhile, they define the valid code in the IBC[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/
J1-075H,...).
CL[1:0]
Loopback Code Length & Valid Code In The IBC[7:0]
00
5-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:3] is valid
01
6-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:2] is valid
10
7-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:1] is valid
11
8-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:0] is valid
T1/J1 XIBC Code (075H, 175H, 275H, 375H, 475H, 575H, 675H, 775H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
IBC7
IBC6
IBC5
IBC4
IBC3
IBC2
IBC1
IBC0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IBC[7:0]:
The IBC[7:X] bits define the content of the inband loopback code. The ‘X’ is one of 0 to 3 which depends on the length defined by the CL[1:0] bits
(b1~0, T1/J1-074H,...). The IBC[7] is the MSB.
Programming Information
188
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 IBCD Detector Configuration (076H, 176H, 276H, 376H, 476H, 576H, 676H, 776H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
IBCDIDLE
DSEL1
DSEL0
ASEL1
ASEL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
0
IBCDIDLE:
= 0: The F-bit is compared with the target activate/deactivate inband loopback code, but the result of the F-bit comparison is discarded.
= 1: The F-bit is skipped in the comparison process.
DSEL[1:0]:
These two bits define the length of the target deactivate inband loopback code, meanwhile, they define the valid code in the DACT[7:0] bits (b7~0,
T1/J1-079H,...).
DSEL[1:0]
Deactivate Code Length & Valid Code In The DACT[7:0]
00
5-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:3] is valid
01
6-bit or 3-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:2] is valid
10
7-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:1] is valid
11
8-bit or 4-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:0] is valid
ASEL[1:0]:
These two bits define the length of the target activate inband loopback code, meanwhile, they define the valid code in the ACT[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/
J1-078H,...).
Programming Information
ASEL[1:0]
Activate Code Length & Valid Code In The ACT[7:0]
00
5-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:3] is valid
01
6-bit or 3-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:2] is valid
10
7-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:1] is valid
11
8-bit or 4-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:0] is valid
189
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 IBCD Detector Status (077H, 177H, 277H, 377H, 477H, 577H, 677H, 777H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
LBA
LBD
R
R
0
0
LBA:
= 0: The activate code is loss. That is, more than 600 bits are not matched with the target activate inband loopback code in a 39.8ms fixed period.
= 1: The activate code is detected. That is, in more than 126 consecutive 39.8ms fixed periods, the target activate inband loopback code is
matched with less than 600 bit errors in each 39.8ms.
LBD:
= 0: The deactivate code is loss. That is, more than 600 bits are not matched with the target deactivate inband loopback code in a 39.8ms fixed
period.
= 1: The deactivate code is detected. That is, in more than 126 consecutive 39.8ms fixed periods, the target deactivate inband loopback code is
matched with less than 600 bit errors in each 39.8ms.
T1/J1 IBCD Activate Code (078H, 178H, 278H, 378H, 478H, 578H, 678H, 778H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
ACT7
ACT6
ACT5
ACT4
ACT3
ACT2
ACT1
ACT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
ACT[7:0]:
The ACT[7:X] bits define the content of the target activate inband loopback code. The ‘X’ is 3, 2, 1 or 0 which depends on the definition by the
ASEL[1:0] bits (b1~0, T1/J1-076H,...). The unused bits should be ignored. The ACT[7] bit is the MSB and compares with the first received code bit.
T1/J1 IBCD Deactivate Code (079H, 179H, 279H, 379H, 479H, 579H, 679H, 779H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DACT7
DACT6
DACT5
DACT4
DACT3
DACT2
DACT1
DACT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
DACT[7:0]:
The DACT[7:X] bits define the content of the target deactivate inband loopback code. The ‘X’ is 3, 2, 1 or 0 which depends on the definition by the
DSEL[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1-076H,...). The unused bits should be ignored. The DACT[7] bit is the MSB and compares with the first received code bit.
Programming Information
190
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 IBCD Interrupt Control (07AH, 17AH, 27AH, 37AH, 47AH, 57AH, 67AH, 77AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
LBAE
LBDE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
LBAI
LBDI
R
R
0
0
LBAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LBAI bit (b1, T1/J1-07BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LBAI bit (b1, T1/J1-07BH,...) is ‘1’.
LBDE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LBDI bit (b0, T1/J1-07BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LBDI bit (b0, T1/J1-07BH,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 IBCD Interrupt Indication (07BH, 17BH, 27BH, 37BH, 47BH, 57BH, 67BH, 77BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
LBAI:
= 0: There is no status change on the LBA bit (b1, T1/J1-077H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the LBA bit (b1, T1/J1-077H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
LBDI:
= 0: There is no status change on the LBD bit (b0, T1/J1-077H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the LBD bit (b0, T1/J1-077H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
191
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 ELST Configuration (07CH, 17CH, 27CH, 37CH, 47CH, 57CH, 67CH, 77CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
TRKEN
SLIPD
SLIPE
R/W
R
R/W
0
0
0
TRKEN:
In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, if it is out of synchronization, the trunk code programmed in the TRKCODE[7:0] bits
(b7~0, T1/J1-07EH,...) can be set to replace the data or not.
= 0: Disable the replacement.
= 1: Enable the replacement.
SLIPD:
This bit makes sense only when the SLIPI bit (b0, T1/J1-07DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 0: The latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being empty.
= 1: The latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being full.
SLIPE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SLIPI bit (b0, T1/J1-07DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SLIPI bit (b0, T1/J1-07DH,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 ELST Interrupt Indication (07DH, 17DH, 27DH, 37DH, 47DH, 57DH, 67DH, 77DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
SLIPI
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
SLIPI:
= 0: No slip occurs.
= 1: A slip occurs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
T1/J1 ELST Trunk Code (07EH, 17EH, 27EH, 37EH, 47EH, 57EH, 67EH, 77EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
TRKCODE7
TRKCODE6
TRKCODE5
TRKCODE4
TRKCODE3
TRKCODE2
TRKCODE1
TRKCODE0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRKCODE[7:0]:
In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, if it is out of synchronization and the TRKEN bit (b2, T1/J1-07CH,...) is ‘1’, these bits
are the trunk code to replace the received data stream.
Programming Information
192
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 APRM Control (07FH, 17FH, 27FH, 37FH, 47FH, 57FH, 67FH, 77FH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
LBBIT
U2BIT
U1BIT
RBIT
CRBIT
AUTOPRM
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
LBBIT:
This bit is valid in ESF format when the AUTOPRM bit (b0, T1/J1-07FH,...) is ‘1’. The value in this bit will be transmitted in the LB bit position of the
APRM.
U2BIT:
This bit is valid in ESF format when the AUTOPRM bit (b0, T1/J1-07FH,...) is ‘1’. The value in this bit will be transmitted in the U2 bit position of the
APRM.
U1BIT:
This bit is valid in ESF format when the AUTOPRM bit (b0, T1/J1-07FH,...) is ‘1’. The value in this bit will be transmitted in the U1 bit position of the
APRM.
RBIT:
This bit is valid in ESF format when the AUTOPRM bit (b0, T1/J1-07FH,...) is ‘1’. The value in this bit will be transmitted in the R bit position of the
APRM.
CRBIT:
This bit is valid in ESF format when the AUTOPRM bit (b0, T1/J1-07FH,...) is ‘1’. The value in this bit will be transmitted in the CR bit position of the
APRM.
AUTOPRM:
This bit is only valid in ESF format.
= 0: Disable the APRM transmission.
= 1: The Automatic Performance Report Message (APRM) is generated every one second and transmitted on the DL bit positions.
T1/J1 XBOC Code (080H, 180H, 280H, 380H, 480H, 580H, 680H, 780H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
XBOC5
XBOC4
XBOC3
XBOC2
XBOC1
XBOC0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
XBOC[5:0]:
These bits are only valid in the ESF format.
When the XBOC[5:0] bits are written with any 6-bit code other than the ‘111111’, the code will be transmitted as the Bit Oriented Message (BOM).
The BOM pattern is ‘111111110XBOC[0]XBOC[1]XBOC[2]XBOC[3]XBOC[4]XBOC[5]0’ which occupies the DL of the F-bit position.
Programming Information
193
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 BOC Control (081H, 181H, 281H, 381H, 481H, 581H, 681H, 781H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
AVC
BOCE
R/W
R/W
0
0
AVC:
This bit selects the validation criteria used to declare the Bit Oriented Message (BOM) in the received data stream. It is only valid in ESF format.
= 0: The BOM is declared when the pattern is matched and the received message is identical 8 out of 10 consecutive times and differs from the
previous message.
= 1: The BOM is declared when the pattern is matched and the received message is identical 4 out of 5 consecutive times and differs from the
previous message.
BOCE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BOCI bit (b0, T1/J1-082H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BOCI bit (b0, T1/J1-082H,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 BOC Interrupt Indication (082H, 182H, 282H, 382H, 482H, 582H, 682H, 782H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BOCI
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
BOCI:
= 0: The BOC[5:0] bits (b5~0, T1/J1-083H,...) are not updated.
= 1: The BOC[5:0] bits (b5~0, T1/J1-083H,...) are updated.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
T1/J1 RBOC Code (083H, 183H, 283H, 383H, 483H, 583H, 683H, 783H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
BOC5
BOC4
BOC3
BOC2
BOC1
BOC0
R
R
R
R
R
R
1
1
1
1
1
1
BOC[5:0]:
When the received BOM is declared, the message is loaded into these bits. The BOC[5] bit corresponds to the LSB of the message.
Programming Information
194
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 THDLC Enable Control (084H, 184H, 284H, 384H, 484H, 584H, 684H, 784H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
TDLEN3
TDLEN2
TDLEN1
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
TDLEN3:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #3 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #3 is enabled.
TDLEN2:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #2 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #2 is enabled.
TDLEN1:
This bit is only valid in T1/J1 mode ESF & T1 DM formats.
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #1 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #1 is enabled.
T1/J1 THDLC2 Assignment (086H, 186H, 286H, 386H, 486H, 586H, 686H, 786H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
Programming Information
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
195
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 THDLC3 Assignment (087H, 187H, 287H, 387H, 487H, 587H, 687H, 787H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above two sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
EVEN:
= 0: The data is not inserted to the even frames.
= 1: The data is inserted to the even frames.
ODD:
= 0: The data is not inserted to the odd frames.
= 1: The data is inserted to the odd frames.
TS[4:0]:
These bits binary define one channel of even and/or odd frames to insert the data to. ‘00000’ corresponds to CH 1 and ‘10111’ corresponds to CH
24. The value above ‘10111’ is meanless. These bits are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are both ‘0’.
Programming Information
196
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 THDLC2 Bit Select (089H, 189H, 289H, 389H, 489H, 589H, 689H, 789H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 THDLC3 Bit Select (08AH, 18AH, 28AH, 38AH, 48AH, 58AH, 68AH, 78AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
RDLEN3
RDLEN2
RDLEN1
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
The function of the above two sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
BITENn:
= 0: The data is not inserted to the corresponding bit.
= 1: The data is inserted to the corresponding bit of the assigned channel.
These bits are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are both logic 0.
The BITEN[7] bit corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected channel.
T1/J1 RHDLC Enable Control (08BH, 18BH, 28BH, 38BH, 48BH, 58BH, 68BH, 78BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
RDLEN3:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #3 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #3 is enabled.
RDLEN2:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #2 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #2 is enabled.
RDLEN1:
This bit is only valid in T1/J1 mode ESF & T1 DM formats.
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #1 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #1 is enabled.
Programming Information
197
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC2 Assignment (08DH, 18DH, 28DH, 38DH, 48DH, 58DH, 68DH, 78DH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC3 Assignment (08EH, 18EH, 28EH, 38EH, 48EH, 58EH, 68EH, 78EH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above two sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
EVEN:
= 0: The data is not extracted from the even frames.
= 1: The data is extracted from the even frames.
ODD:
= 0: The data is not extracted from the odd frames.
= 1: The data is extracted from the odd frames.
TS[4:0]:
These bits binary define one channel of even and/or odd frames to extract the data from. ‘00000’ corresponds to CH 1 and ‘10111’ corresponds to
CH 24. The value above ‘10111’ is meanless. These bits are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are both ‘0’.
T1/J1 RHDLC2 Bit Select (090H, 190H, 290H, 390H, 490H, 590H, 690H, 790H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Programming Information
198
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC3 Bit Select (091H, 191H, 291H, 391H, 491H, 591H, 691H, 791H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above two sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
BITENn:
= 0: The data is not extracted from the corresponding bit.
= 1: The data is extracted from the corresponding bit of the assigned channel.
These bits are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are both logic 0.
The BITEN[7] bit corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected channel.
T1/J1 RHDLC1 Control Register (092H, 192H, 292H, 392H, 492H, 592H, 692H, 792H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
3
2
1
0
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
0
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
Default
T1/J1 RHDLC2 Control Register (093H, 193H, 293H, 393H, 493H, 593H, 693H, 793H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
Programming Information
199
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC3 Control Register (094H, 194H, 294H, 394H, 494H, 594H, 694H, 794H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
ADRM[1:0]:
These two bits select the address comparison mode in HDLC mode.
= 00: No address is compared.
= 01: High byte address is compared.
= 10: Low byte address is compared.
= 11: Both high byte address and low byte address are compared.
RHDLCM:
= 0: HDLC mode is selected.
= 1: Reserved.
RRST:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit resets the corresponding HDLC Receiver. The reset will clear the FIFO, the PACK bit (b0, T1/J1-095H,... /
096H,... / 097H,...) and the EMP bit (b1, T1/J1-095H,... / 096H,... / 097H,...).
Programming Information
200
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC1 RFIFO Access Status (095H, 195H, 295H, 395H, 495H, 595H, 695H, 795H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
EMP
PACK
R
R
1
0
1
0
EMP
PACK
R
R
1
0
1
0
EMP
PACK
R
R
1
0
T1/J1 RHDLC2 RFIFO Access Status (096H, 196H, 296H, 396H, 496H, 596H, 696H, 796H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
T1/J1 RHDLC3 RFIFO Access Status (097H, 197H, 297H, 397H, 497H, 597H, 697H, 797H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
EMP:
= 0: The FIFO is not empty.
= 1: The FIFO is empty, i.e., all the blocks are read from the FIFO.
The corresponding HDLC Receiver reset will clear this bit.
PACK:
= 0: The byte read from the FIFO is not an overhead byte.
= 1: The byte read from the FIFO is an overhead byte.
The corresponding HDLC Receiver reset will clear this bit.
Programming Information
201
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC1 Data (098H, 198H, 298H, 398H, 498H, 598H, 698H, 798H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC2 Data (099H, 199H, 299H, 399H, 499H, 599H, 699H, 799H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC3 Data (09AH, 19AH, 29AH, 39AH, 49AH, 59AH, 69AH, 79AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
DAT[7:0]:
These bits represent the bytes read from the FIFO. The DAT[0] bit corresponds to the first bit of the serial received data from the FIFO.
Programming Information
202
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC1 Interrupt Control (09BH, 19BH, 29BH, 39BH, 49BH, 59BH, 69BH, 79BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
OVFLE
RMBEE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
OVFLE
RMBEE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
OVFLE
RMBEE
R/W
R/W
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC2 Interrupt Control (09CH, 19CH, 29CH, 39CH, 49CH, 59CH, 69CH, 79CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
T1/J1 RHDLC3 Interrupt Control (09DH, 19DH, 29DH, 39DH, 49DH, 59DH, 69DH, 79DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
OVFLE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVFLI bit (b1, T1/J1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVFLI bit (b1, T1/J1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
RMBEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMBEI bit (b0, T1/J1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMBEI bit (b0, T1/J1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
203
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC1 Interrupt Indication (09EH, 19EH, 29EH, 39EH, 49EH, 59EH, 69EH, 79EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
OVFLI
RMBEI
R
R
0
0
1
0
OVFLI
RMBEI
R
R
0
0
1
0
OVFLI
RMBEI
R
R
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC2 Interrupt Indication (09FH, 19FH, 29FH, 39FH, 49FH, 59FH, 69FH, 79FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
T1/J1 RHDLC3 Interrupt Indication (0A0H, 1A0H, 2A0H, 3A0H, 4A0H, 5A0H, 6A0H, 7A0H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
OVFLI:
The overwritten condition will occur if data is still attempted to write into the FIFO when the FIFO has already been full (128 bytes).
= 0: No overwriting occurs.
= 1: The overwriting occurs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RMBEI:
= 0: No block is pushed into the FIFO.
= 1: A block of the HDLC packet is pushed into the FIFO.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
204
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC1 High Address (0A1H, 1A1H, 2A1H, 3A1H, 4A1H, 5A1H, 6A1H, 7A1H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC2 High Address (0A2H, 1A2H, 2A2H, 3A2H, 4A2H, 5A2H, 6A2H, 7A2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC3 High Address (0A3H, 1A3H, 2A3H, 3A3H, 4A3H, 5A3H, 6A3H, 7A3H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
HA[7:0]:
In HDLC mode, when high byte address comparison or both bytes address comparison is required, the high byte address position (the byte
following the opening flag) is compared with the value in these bits, or with ‘0xFC’ or ‘0xFE’. The HA[1] bit (the ‘C/R’ bit position) is excluded to
compare.
Programming Information
205
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RHDLC1 Low Address (0A4H, 1A4H, 2A4H, 3A4H, 4A4H, 5A4H, 6A4H, 7A4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC2 Low Address (0A5H, 1A5H, 2A5H, 3A5H, 4A5H, 5A5H, 6A5H, 7A5H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 RHDLC3 Low Address (0A6H, 1A6H, 2A6H, 3A6H, 4A6H, 5A6H, 6A6H, 7A6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
LA[7:0]:
In HDLC mode, when low byte address comparison is required, the high byte address position (the byte following the opening flag) is compared
with the value in these bits. When both bytes address comparison is required, the low byte address position (the byte following the high byte address
position) is compared with the value in these bits.
T1/J1 THDLC1 Control (0A7H, 1A7H, 2A7H, 3A7H, 4A7H, 5A7H, 6A7H, 7A7H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Programming Information
5
4
3
EOM
Reserved
R/W
0
206
Reserved
2
1
0
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 THDLC2 Control (0A8H, 1A8H, 2A8H, 3A8H, 4A8H, 5A8H, 6A8H, 7A8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
4
3
EOM
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
Reserved
0
2
1
0
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
2
1
0
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
T1/J1 THDLC3 Control (0A9H, 1A9H, 2A9H, 3A9H, 4A9H, 5A9H, 6A9H, 7A9H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
EOM
Reserved
Default
R/W
Reserved
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
EOM:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit indicates an entire HDLC packet is stored in the FIFO and starts the packet transmission.
ABORT:
= 0: Disable the manual abort sequence insertion.
= 1: The abort sequence (‘01111111’) is manually inserted to the current HDLC packet.
This bit is self-cleared after the abortion.
THDLCM:
= 0: HDLC mode is selected.
= 1: Reserved.
TRST:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the this bit resets the corresponding HDLC Transmitter. The reset will clear the FIFO.
Programming Information
207
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TFIFO1 Threshold (0AAH, 1AAH, 2AAH, 3AAH, 4AAH, 5AAH, 6AAH, 7AAH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
3
2
1
0
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
3
2
1
0
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
T1/J1 TFIFO2 Threshold (0ABH, 1ABH, 2ABH, 3ABH, 4ABH, 5ABH, 6ABH, 7ABH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
T1/J1 TFIFO3 Threshold (0ACH, 1ACH, 2ACH, 3ACH, 4ACH, 5ACH, 6ACH, 7ACH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
LL[1:0]:
These 2 bits set the lower threshold of the FIFO. If the fill level is below the lower threshold, an interrupt may be generated.
= 00: 16 bytes
= 01: 32 bytes
= 10: 64 bytes
= 11: 96 bytes
HL[1:0]:
These 2 bits set the upper threshold of the FIFO. Once the fill level exceeds the upper threshold, the data stored in the FIFO will start to be transmitted.
= 00: 16 bytes
= 01: 32 bytes
= 10: 64 bytes
= 11: 128 bytes
Programming Information
208
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 THDLC1 Data (0ADH, 1ADH, 2ADH, 3ADH, 4ADH, 5ADH, 6ADH, 7ADH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 THDLC2 Data (0AEH, 1AEH, 2AEH, 3AEH, 4AEH, 5AEH, 6AEH, 7AEH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T1/J1 THDLC3 Data (0AFH, 1AFH, 2AFH, 3AFH, 4AFH, 5AFH, 6AFH, 7AFH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
DAT[7:0]:
The bytes to be stored in the FIFO. The DAT[0] bit corresponds to the first bit of the serial data in the FIFO to be transmitted.
Programming Information
209
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TFIFO1 Status (0B0H, 1B0H, 2B0H, 3B0H, 4B0H, 5B0H, 6B0H, 7B0H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
FUL
EMP
RDY
R
R
R
0
1
1
2
1
0
FUL
EMP
RDY
R
R
R
0
1
1
2
1
0
FUL
EMP
RDY
R
R
R
0
1
1
T1/J1 TFIFO2 Status (0B1H, 1B1H, 2B1H, 3B1H, 4B1H, 5B1H, 6B1H, 7B1H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
T1/J1 TFIFO3 Status (0B2H, 1B2H, 2B2H, 3B2H, 4B2H, 5B2H, 6B2H, 7B2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
FUL:
= 0: The FIFO is not full.
= 1: The FIFO is full of 128 bytes.
EMP:
= 0: The FIFO is not empty.
= 1: The FIFO is empty.
RDY:
= 0: The fill level of the FIFO is not below the lower threshold set by the LL[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1-0AAH,... / 0ABH,... / 0ACH,...).
= 1: The fill level of the FIFO is below the lower threshold set by the LL[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1-0AAH,... / 0ABH,... / 0ACH,...).
Programming Information
210
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 THDLC1 Interrupt Control (0B3H, 1B3H, 2B3H, 3B3H, 4B3H, 5B3H, 6B3H, 7B3H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
UDRUNE
RDYE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
UDRUNE
RDYE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
UDRUNE
RDYE
R/W
R/W
0
0
T1/J1 THDLC2 Interrupt Control (0B4H, 1B4H, 2B4H, 3B4H, 4B4H, 5B4H, 6B4H, 7B4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
T1/J1 THDLC3 Interrupt Control (0B5H, 1B5H, 2B5H, 3B5H, 4B5H, 5B5H, 6B5H, 7B5H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
UDRUNE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRUNI bit (b1, T1/J1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRUNI bit (b1, T1/J1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
RDYE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RDYI bit (b0, T1/J1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RDYI bit (b0, T1/J1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
211
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 THDLC1 Interrupt Indication (0B6H, 1B6H, 2B6H, 3B6H, 4B6H, 5B6H, 6B6H, 7B6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
UDRUNI
RDYI
R
R
0
0
1
0
UDRUNI
RDYI
R
R
0
0
1
0
UDRUNI
RDYI
R
R
0
0
T1/J1 THDLC2 Interrupt Indication (0B7H, 1B7H, 2B7H, 3B7H, 4B7H, 5B7H, 6B7H, 7B7H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
T1/J1 THDLC3 Interrupt Indication (0B8H, 1B8H, 2B8H, 3B8H, 4B8H, 5B8H, 6B8H, 7B8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
UDRUNI:
When the FIFO is empty and the last transmitted byte is not the end of the current HDLC packet, the under-run occurs. This bit indicates whether
the under-run occurs.
= 0: No under-run occurs.
= 1: Under-run occurs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RDYI:
= 0: There is no status change on the RDY bit (b0, T1/J1-0B0H,... / 0B1H,... / 0B2H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’) on the RDY bit (b0, T1/J1-0B0H,... / 0B1H,... / 0B2H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
212
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Alarm Status (0B9H, 1B9H, 2B9H, 3B9H, 4B9H, 5B9H, 6B9H, 7B9H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
AIS
YEL
RED
R
R
R
0
0
0
AIS:
= 0: More than 60 zeros are detected in a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms. Here ‘M’ is decided by the AISCTH[7:0] bits
(b7~0, T1/J1-0C1H,...).
= 1: Less than 61 zeros are detected in a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the AISDTH[7:0] bits
(b7~0, T1/J1-0C0H,...).
YEL:
The Yellow Alarm is detected when the frame is synchronized.
In T1 SF / SLC-96 format:
= 0: More than 76 ’One’s are detected on the Bit 2 of each channel during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms. Here ‘M’ is
decided by the YELCTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BFH,...).
= 1: Less than 77 ’One’s are detected on the Bit 2 of each channel during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms. Here ‘N’ is
decided by the YELDTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BEH,...).
In T1 ESF format:
= 0: Less than 8 ‘0xFF00’ (MSB first) are detected on the DL bits during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms. Here ‘M’ is
decided by the YELCTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BFH,...).
= 1: More than 7 ‘0xFF00’ (MSB first) are detected on the DL bits during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms. Here ‘N’ is
decided by the YELDTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BEH,...).
In T1 DM format:
= 0: More than 3 ’One’s are detected on the Y bit (Bit 6 in each CH 24) during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms. Here ‘M’
is decided by the YELCTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BFH,...).
= 1: Less than 4 ’One’s are detected on the Y bit (Bit 6 in each CH 24) during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms. Here ‘N’ is
decided by the YELDTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BEH,...).
In J1 SF format:
= 0: More than 3 zeros are detected on the F-bit of the 12nd frame during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms. Here ‘M’ is
decided by the YELCTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BFH,...).
= 1: Less than 4 zeros are detected on the F-bit of the 12nd frame during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms. Here ‘N’ is
decided by the YELDTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BEH,...).
In J1 ESF format:
= 0: More than 2 zeros are detected on the DL bits during a 40 ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40 ms. Here ‘M’ is decided by the
YELCTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BFH,...).
= 1: Less than 3 zeros are detected on the DL bits during a 40 ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40 ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the
YELDTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-0BEH,...).
RED:
= 0: The in SF / ESF / T1 DM / SLC-96 synchronization status persists for Mx120ms. Here ‘M’ is decided by the REDCTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J10BDH,...).
= 1: The out of SF / ESF / T1 DM / SLC-96 synchronization status persists for Nx40ms. Here ‘N’ is decided by the REDDTH[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J10BCH,...).
Programming Information
213
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Alarm Control (0BAH, 1BAH, 2BAH, 3BAH, 4BAH, 5BAH, 6BAH, 7BAH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
AISE
YELE
REDE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
2
1
0
AISI
YELI
REDI
R
R
R
0
0
0
AISE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
YELE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the YELI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the YELI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
REDE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 Alarm Indication (0BBH, 1BBH, 2BBH, 3BBH, 4BBH, 5BBH, 6BBH, 7BBH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
AISI:
= 0: There is no status change on the AIS bit (b1, T1/J1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the AIS bit (b1, T1/J1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
YELI:
= 0: There is no status change on the YEL bit (b1, T1/J1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the YEL bit (b1, T1/J1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
REDI:
= 0: There is no status change on the RED bit (b1, T1/J1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the RED bit (b1, T1/J1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
214
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RED Declare Threshold (0BCH, 1BCH, 2BCH, 3BCH, 4BCH, 5BCH, 6BCH, 7BCH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
REDDTH7
REDDTH6
REDDTH5
REDDTH4
REDDTH3
REDDTH2
REDDTH1
REDDTH0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
REDDTH[7:0]:
The RED alarm is declared when the out of SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 synchronization status persists for Nx40ms. The value of the ‘N’ is decided by
these bits.
T1/J1 RED Clear Threshold (0BDH, 1BDH, 2BDH, 3BDH, 4BDH, 5BDH, 6BDH, 7BDH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
REDCTH7
REDCTH6
REDCTH5
REDCTH4
REDCTH3
REDCTH2
REDCTH1
REDCTH0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
REDCTH[7:0]:
The RED alarm is cleared when the in SF/ESF/T1 DM/SLC-96 synchronization status persists for Mx120ms. The value of the ‘M’ is decided by
these bits.
T1/J1 Yellow Declare Threshold (0BEH, 1BEH, 2BEH, 3BEH, 4BEH, 5BEH, 6BEH, 7BEH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
YELDTH7
YELDTH6
YELDTH5
YELDTH4
YELDTH3
YELDTH2
YELDTH1
YELDTH0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
YELDTH[7:0]:
In T1 SF/SLC-96 format, the Yellow alarm is declared when less than 77 ’One’s are detected on the Bit 2 of each channel during a 40ms fixed
window and this status persists for Nx40ms; in T1 ESF format, the Yellow alarm is declared when more than 7 ‘0xFF00’ (MSB first) are detected on the
sliding DL bits during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms; in T1 DM format, the Yellow alarm is declared when less than 77
’One’s are detected on the Y bit (Bit 6 in each CH 24) during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms; in J1 SF format, the Yellow
alarm is declared when less than 4 ’One’s are detected on the F-bit of the 12nd frame during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms;
in J1 ESF format, the Yellow alarm is declared when less than 3 zeros are detected on the DL bits during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists
for Nx40ms. The value of the ‘N’ are all decided by these bits.
Programming Information
215
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Yellow Clear Threshold (0BFH, 1BFH, 2BFH, 3BFH, 4BFH, 5BFH, 6BFH, 7BFH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
YELCTH7
YELCTH6
YELCTH5
YELCTH4
YELCTH3
YELCTH2
YELCTH1
YELCTH0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
YELCTH[7:0]:
In T1 SF/SLC-96 format, the Yellow alarm is cleared when more than 76 ’One’s are detected on the Bit 2 of each channel during a 40ms fixed
window and this status persists for Mx40ms; in T1 ESF format, the Yellow alarm is cleared when less than 8 ‘0xFF00’ (MSB first) are detected on the
sliding DL bits during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms; in T1 DM format, the Yellow alarm is cleared when more than 76
’One’s are detected on the Y bit (Bit 6 in each CH 24) during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms; in J1 SF format, the Yellow
alarm is cleared when more than 3 ’One’s are detected on the F-bit of the 12nd frame during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms;
in J1 ESF format, the Yellow alarm is cleared when more than 2 zeros are detected on the DL bits during a 40ms fixed window and this status persists
for Mx40ms. The value of the ‘M’ are all decided by these bits.
T1/J1 AIS Declare Threshold (0C0H, 1C0H, 2C0H, 3C0H, 4C0H, 5C0H, 6C0H, 7C0H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
AISDTH7
AISDTH6
AISDTH5
AISDTH4
AISDTH3
AISDTH2
AISDTH1
AISDTH0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
AISDTH[7:0]:
The Blue alarm is declared when less than 61 zeros are detected in a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Nx40ms. The value of the ‘N’
is decided by these bits.
T1/J1 AIS Clear Threshold (0C1H, 1C1H, 2C1H, 3C1H, 4C1H, 5C1H, 6C1H, 7C1H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
AISCTH7
AISCTH6
AISCTH5
AISCTH4
AISCTH3
AISCTH2
AISCTH1
AISCTH0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
AISCTH[7:0]:
The Blue alarm is cleared when more than 60 zeros are detected in a 40ms fixed window and this status persists for Mx40ms. The value of the ‘M’
is decided by these bits.
Programming Information
216
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 PMON Control (0C2H, 1C2H, 2C2H, 3C2H, 4C2H, 5C2H, 6C2H, 7C2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
UPDAT
AUTOUPD
R/W
R/W
0
0
UPDAT:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit updates all the PMON indirect registers.
AUTOUPD:
= 0: Disable the automatic update function of the PMON indirect registers.
= 1: All the PMON indirect registers are updated every one second automatically.
T1/J1 PMON Interrupt Control 0 (0C3H, 1C3H, 2C3H, 3C3H, 4C3H, 5C3H, 6C3H, 7C3H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
PRDGOVE
Type
R/W
Default
0
6
5
Reserved
4
3
2
1
0
DDSOVE
COFAOVE
OOFOVE
FEROVE
CRCOVE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
PRDGOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the PRDGOVI bit (b7, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the PRDGOVI bit (b7, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
DDSOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DDSOVI bit (b4, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DDSOVI bit (b4, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
COFAOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAOVI bit (b3, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAOVI bit (b3, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
OOFOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFOVI bit (b2, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFOVI bit (b2, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
FEROVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEROVI bit (b1, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEROVI bit (b1, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
CRCOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CRCOVI bit (b0, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CRCOVI bit (b0, T1/J1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
217
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 PMON Interrupt Control 1 (0C4H, 1C4H, 2C4H, 3C4H, 4C4H, 5C4H, 6C4H, 7C4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
LCVOVE
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
LCVOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LCVOVI bit (b0, T1/J1-0C6H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LCVOVI bit (b0, T1/J1-0C6H,...) is ‘1’.
T1/J1 PMON Interrupt Indication 0 (0C5H, 1C5H, 2C5H, 3C5H, 4C5H, 5C5H, 6C5H, 7C5H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
PRDGOVI
Type
R
Default
0
6
5
Reserved
4
3
2
1
0
DDSOVI
COFAOVI
OOFOVI
FEROVI
CRCOVI
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
PRDGOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect PRGD Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect PRGD Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
DDSOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect DDSE Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect DDSE Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
COFAOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect COFA Counter Mapping register has not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect COFA Counter Mapping register has overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
OOFOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect OOF Counter Mapping register has not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect OOF Counter Mapping register has overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
FEROVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect FER Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect FER Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CRCOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect CRCE Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect CRCE Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
218
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 PMON Interrupt Indication 1 (0C6H, 1C6H, 2C6H, 3C6H, 4C6H, 5C6H, 6C6H, 7C6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
LCVOVI
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
LCVOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect LCV Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect LCV Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
T1/J1 TPLC / RPLC / PRGD Test Configuration (0C7H, 1C7H, 2C7H, 3C7H, 4C7H, 5C7H, 6C7H, 7C7H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
PRBSMODE1
PRBSMODE0
PRBSDIR
TESTEN
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
PRBSMODE[1:0]:
These two bits select one mode to extract/replace the data for the PRBS Generator/Detector.
= 00: The unframed mode is selected. All 24 channels are extracted/replaced and the per-channel configuration in the TEST bit (b6, T1/J1-ID41~58H) is ignored.
= 01: The 8-bit-based mode is selected. The received data will only be extracted/replaced on the channel configured by the TEST bit (b6, T1/J1-ID41~58H).
= 10: The 7-bit-based mode is selected. The received data will only be extracted/replaced on the 7 MSB of the channel configured by the TEST bit
(b6, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
= 11: Reserved.
PRBSDIR:
= 0: The pattern in the PRBS Generator/Detector is generated in the transmit path and is detected in the receive path.
= 1: The pattern in the PRBS Generator/Detector is generated in the receive path and is detected in the transmit path.
TESTEN:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit initiates the PRBS Generator/Detector.
T1/J1 TPLC Access Status (0C8H, 1C8H, 2C8H, 3C8H, 4C8H, 5C8H, 6C8H, 7C8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
1
0
BUSY
Reserved
Default
R
0
BUSY:
= 0: No reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.
= 1: An internal indirect register is being accessed. Any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.
Programming Information
219
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TPLC Access Control (0C9H, 1C9H, 2C9H, 3C9H, 4C9H, 5C9H, 6C9H, 7C9H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
RWN
ADDRESS6
ADDRESS5
ADDRESS4
ADDRESS3
ADDRESS2
ADDRESS1
ADDRESS0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RWN:
= 0: Write the data to the specified indirect register.
= 1: Read the data to the specified indirect register.
ADDRESS[6:0]:
These bits specify the address of the indirect register (from 01H to 18H & from 21H to 38H & from 41H to 58H) for the microprocessor access.
T1/J1 TPLC Access Data (0CAH, 1CAH, 2CAH, 3CAH, 4CAH, 5CAH, 6CAH, 7CAH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D[7:0]:
This register holds the value which will be read from or written into the indirect registers (from 01H to 18H & from 21H to 38H & from 41H to 58H).
If data is to be written into the indirect register, this register must be written before the target indirect register’s address and RWN=0 is written into the
TPLC Access Control register. If data is to be read from the indirect register, the target indirect register’s address and RWN=1 must be written into the
TPLC Access Control register first, then this register will contain the requested data byte.
Programming Information
220
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TPLC Configuration (0CBH, 1CBH, 2CBH, 3CBH, 4CBH, 5CBH, 6CBH, 7CBH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
ZCS2
ZCS1
ZCS0
GSUBST2
GSUBST1
GSUBST0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SIGSNAP:
This bit is valid in SF, ESF or SLC-96 format.
= 0: Disable the signaling snapshot.
= 1: Enable the signaling snapshot. That is, the signaling bits of the first frame are locked and input on the TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin as the
signaling bits of the current whole SF, ESF or SLC-96 frame.
GSTRKEN:
= 0: The replacement is performed on a per-channel basis by setting the STRKEN bit (b4, T1/J1-ID-41~58H) in the corresponding channel.
= 1: The signaling bits (ABCD) of all channels are replaced by the signaling trunk conditioning code in the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
ZCS[2:0]:
These bits select one type of Zero Code Suppression. (Bit 1 is the MSB in the following table).
ZCS[2:0]
Zero Code Suppression
000
No Zero Code Suppression.
001
GTE Zero Code Suppression. Bit 8 of an all-zero channel is replaced by a ‘1’, except in signaling frames where Bit 7 is
forced to be a ‘1’.
010
Jammed Bit 8 Zero Code Suppression. Bit 8 of all channels are replaced by a ‘1’.
011
Bell Zero Code Suppression. Bit 7 of an all-zero channel is replaced by a ‘1’.
100
DDS Zero Code Suppression. An all-zero channel is replaced with ‘10011000’.
others
Reserved.
GSUBST[2:0]:
These bits select the replacement of all the channels.
GSUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
The replacement is performed on a per-channel basis by setting the SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, T1/J1-ID-01~18H) in the
corresponding channel.
001
The data of all channels is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-ID-21~38H).
010
The data of all channels is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of all channels is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
100
The data of all channels is replaced by the payload loopback code extracted from the Elastic Store Buffer in the receive
path.
others
Reserved.
Programming Information
221
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 TPLC Control Enable (0CCH, 1CCH, 2CCH, 3CCH, 4CCH, 5CCH, 6CCH, 7CCH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
2
1
ABXX
Type
Reserved
PCCE
R/W
Default
0
Reserved
R/W
0
0
ABXX:
This bit is valid in ESF & SLC-96 format.
= 0: The signaling bits are valid in the lower nibble of each channel.
= 1: The signaling bits are valid in the upper 2-bit positions of the lower nibble of each channel. The other bits of the channel are Don’t Care conditions.
PCCE:
= 0: Disable all the functions in the Transmit Payload Control.
= 1: Enable all the functions in the Transmit Payload Control.
T1/J1 RPLC Access Status (0CDH, 1CDH, 2CDH, 3CDH, 4CDH, 5CDH, 6CDH, 7CDH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
BUSY
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
BUSY:
= 0: No reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.
= 1: An internal indirect register is being accessed. Any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.
T1/J1 RPLC Access Control (0CEH, 1CEH, 2CEH, 3CEH, 4CEH, 5CEH, 6CEH, 7CEH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
RWN
ADDRESS6
ADDRESS5
ADDRESS4
ADDRESS3
ADDRESS2
ADDRESS1
ADDRESS0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RWN:
= 0: Write the data to the specified indirect register.
= 1: Read the data to the specified indirect register.
ADDRESS[6:0]:
These bits specify the address of the indirect register (from 01H to 18H & from 21H to 38H & from 41H to 58H) for the microprocessor access.
Programming Information
222
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RPLC Access Data (0CFH, 1CFH, 2CFH, 3CFH, 4CFH, 5CFH, 6CFH, 7CFH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D[7:0]:
This register holds the value which will be read from or written into the indirect registers (from 01H to 18H & from 21H to 38H & from 41H to 58H).
If data is to be written into the indirect register, this register must be written before the target indirect register’s address and RWN=0 is written into the
RPLC Access Control register. If data is to be read from the indirect register, the target indirect register’s address and RWN=1 must be written into the
RPLC Access Control register first, then this register will contain the requested data byte.
T1/J1 RPLC Configuration (0D0H, 1D0H, 2D0H, 3D0H, 4D0H, 5D0H, 6D0H, 7D0H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
Type
R/W
R/W
Default
1
0
5
4
3
Reserved
2
1
0
GSUBST2
GSUBST1
GSUBST0
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
SIGSNAP:
This bit is valid when SF, ESF or SLC-96 frame is in synchronization.
= 0: Disable the signaling snapshot.
= 1: Enable the signaling snapshot. That is, the signaling bits of the first frame are locked and output on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin as the
signaling bits of the current whole SF, ESF or SLC-96 frame.
GSTRKEN:
= 0: The replacement is performed on a per-channel basis by setting the STRKEN bit (b4, T1/J1-ID-41~58H) in the corresponding channel.
= 1: The signaling bits (ABCD) of all channels are replaced by the signaling trunk conditioning code in the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
GSUBST[2:0]:
These bits select the replacement of all the channels.
GSUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
The replacement is performed on a per-channel basis by setting the SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, T1/J1-ID-01~18H) in the corresponding channel.
001
The data of all channels is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-ID-21~38H).
010
The data of all channels is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of all channels is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
others
Reserved.
Programming Information
223
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RPLC Control Enable (0D1H, 1D1H, 2D1H, 3D1H, 4D1H, 5D1H, 6D1H, 7D1H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
ABXX
SIGFIX
POL
PCCE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
ABXX:
This bit is valid in ESF & SLC-96 format.
= 0: The signaling bits are valid in the lower nibble of each channel.
= 1: The signaling bits are valid in the upper 2-bit positions of the lower nibble of each channel. The other bits of the channel are Don’t Care conditions.
SIGFIX:
This bit is only valid in the SF, ESF and SLC-96 formats.
= 0: Disable the signaling bits fixing function.
= 1: The signaling bits (ABCD) are fixed to the value set in the POL bit (b1, T1/J1-0D1H,...).
POL:
This bit is only valid when the SIGFIX bit is ‘1’.
= 0: The signaling bits (ABCD) are fixed to logic 0.
= 1: The signaling bits (ABCD) are fixed to logic 1.
PCCE:
= 0: Disable all the functions in the Receive Payload Control.
= 1: Enable all the functions in the Receive Payload Control.
Programming Information
224
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RCRB Configuration (0D2H, 1D2H, 2D2H, 3D2H, 4D2H, 5D2H, 6D2H, 7D2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
FREEZE
DEB
SIGE
SIGF
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
Reserved
Default
FREEZE:
= 0: Disable the manual signaling freezing.
= 1: Manually freeze the signaling data in the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-01~18H) as the previous valid value.
DEB:
= 0: Disable the signaling de-bounce.
= 1: Enable the signaling de-bounce. That is, the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-01~18H) are updated only if 2 consecutive received AB/ABCD
codewords of the same channel are identical.
SIGE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when any of the COSI bits (T1/J1-0D8H,... & T1/J1-0D7H,... & T1/J1-0D6H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when any of the COSI bits (T1/J1-0D8H,... & T1/J1-0D7H,... & T1/J1-0D6H,...) is ‘1’.
SIGF:
This bit is valid only in the ESF and SLC-96 format.
= 0: The extracted signaling bits are in 4 states signaling, i.e., the signaling bits on Framer 6 & 18 of a signaling multi-frame are recognized as ‘A’
and the signaling bits on Framer 12 & 24 are recognized as ‘B’. Only the signaling bits A & B are saved in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract
Enable register. The C & D bits in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable register are not cared.
= 1: The extracted signaling bits are in 16 states signaling, i.e., four signaling bits A, B, C & D are all saved in the Extracted Signaling Data/Extract
Enable register.
T1/J1 RCRB Access Status (0D3H, 1D3H, 2D3H, 3D3H, 4D3H, 5D3H, 6D3H, 7D3H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
1
0
BUSY
Reserved
Default
R
0
BUSY:
= 0: No reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.
= 1: An internal indirect register is being accessed. Any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.
Programming Information
225
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RCRB Access Control (0D4H, 1D4H, 2D4H, 3D4H, 4D4H, 5D4H, 6D4H, 7D4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
RWN
ADDRESS6
ADDRESS5
ADDRESS4
ADDRESS3
ADDRESS2
ADDRESS1
ADDRESS0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RWN:
= 0: Write the data to the specified indirect register.
= 1: Read the data to the specified indirect register.
ADDRESS[6:0]:
These bits specify the address of the indirect register (from 01H to 18H) for the microprocessor access.
T1/J1 RCRB Access Data (0D5H, 1D5H, 2D5H, 3D5H, 4D5H, 5D5H, 6D5H, 7D5H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D1
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D[7:0]:
This register holds the value which will be read from or written into the indirect registers (from 01H to 18H). If data is to be written into the indirect
register, this register must be written before the target indirect register’s address and RWN=0 is written into the RCRB Access Control register. If data
is to be read from the indirect register, the target indirect register’s address and RWN=1 must be written into the RCRB Access Control register first,
then this register will contain the requested data byte.
T1/J1 RCRB State Change Indication 0 (0D6H, 1D6H, 2D6H, 3D6H, 4D6H, 5D6H, 6D6H, 7D6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
COSI8
COSI7
COSI6
COSI5
COSI4
COSI3
COSI2
COSI1
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
COSI[X]:
= 0: The signaling bits in its corresponding channel is not changed.
= 1: The signaling bits in its corresponding channel is changed.
The corresponding bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it. The COSI[8:1] bits correspond to channel 8 ~ 1 respectively.
Programming Information
226
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 RCRB State Change Indication 1 (0D7H, 1D7H, 2D7H, 3D7H, 4D7H, 5D7H, 6D7H, 7D7H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
COSI16
COSI15
COSI14
COSI13
COSI12
COSI11
COSI10
COSI9
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
COSI[X]:
= 0: The signaling bits in its corresponding channel is not changed.
= 1: The signaling bits in its corresponding channel is changed.
The corresponding bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it. The COSI[16:9] bits correspond to channel 16 ~ 9 respectively.
T1/J1 RCRB State Change Indication 2 (0D8H, 1D8H, 2D8H, 3D8H, 4D8H, 5D8H, 6D8H, 7D8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
COSI24
COSI23
COSI22
COSI21
COSI20
COSI19
COSI18
COSI17
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
COSI[X]:
= 0: The signaling bits in its corresponding channel is not changed.
= 1: The signaling bits in its corresponding channel is changed.
The corresponding bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it. The COSI[24:17] bits correspond to channel 24 ~ 17 respectively.
Programming Information
227
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
5.2.1.2 Indirect Register
PMON:
The PMON Counter Mapping Registers (00H ~ 0BH) of a link are updated as a group in the following ways:
• A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the UPDAT bit (b1, T1/J1-0C2H,...) updates all the registers;
• If the AUTOUPD bit (b0, T1/J1-0C2H,...) is set to ‘1’, the registers will be updated every one second;
T1/J1 CRCE Counter Mapping 0 (00H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
CRCE7
CRCE6
CRCE5
CRCE4
CRCE3
CRCE2
CRCE1
CRCE0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CRCE[7:0]:
In ESF format, these bits together with the CRCE[9:8] bits count the CRC-6 Error numbers. The CRCE[0] bit is the LSB.
T1/J1 CRCE Counter Mapping 1 (01H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
CRCE9
CRCE8
R
R
0
0
CRCE[9:8]:
In ESF format, these bits together with the CRCE[7:0] bits count the CRC-6 Error numbers. The CRCE[9] bit is the MSB.
T1/J1 FER Counter Mapping 0 (02H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
FER7
FER6
FER5
FER4
FER3
FER2
FER1
FER0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FER[7:0]:
In SF / T1 DM / SLC-96 format, these bits together with the FER[11:8] bits count the F Bit Error numbers. The FER[0] bit is the LSB.
In ESF format, these bits together with the FER[11:8] bits count the Frame Alignment Bit Error numbers. The FER[0] bit is the LSB.
Programming Information
228
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 FER Counter Mapping 1 (03H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
FER11
FER10
FER9
FER8
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
FER[11:8]:
In SF / T1 DM / SLC-96 format, these bits together with the FER[7:0] bits count the F Bit Error numbers. The FER[11] bit is the MSB.
In ESF format, these bits together with the FER[7:0] bits count the Frame Alignment Bit Error numbers. The FER[11] bit is the MSB.
T1/J1 COFA Counter Mapping (04H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
COFA2
COFA1
COFA0
R
R
R
0
0
0
COFA[2:0]:
These bits count the times of the new-found F bit position being different from the previous one events.
T1/J1 OOF Counter Mapping (05H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
OOF4
OOF3
OOF2
OOF1
OOF0
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
OOF[4:0]:
In SF / ESF / T1 DM / SLC-96 format, these bits count the times of out of SF / ESF / T1 DM / SLC-96 synchronization events.
T1/J1 PRGD Counter Mapping 0 (06H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
PRGD7
PRGD6
PRGD5
PRGD4
PRGD3
PRGD2
PRGD1
PRGD0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PRGD[7:0]:
These bits together with the PRGD[15:8] bits count the PRGD Bit Error numbers. The PRGD[0] bit is the LSB.
Programming Information
229
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 PRGD Counter Mapping 1 (07H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
PRGD15
PRGD14
PRGD13
PRGD12
PRGD11
PRGD10
PRGD9
PRGD8
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PRGD[15:8]:
These bits together with the PRGD[7:0] bits count the PRGD Bit Error numbers. The PRGD[15] bit is the MSB.
T1/J1 LCV Counter Mapping 0 (08H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LCV7
LCV6
LCV5
LCV4
LCV3
LCV2
LCV1
LCV0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LCV[7:0]:
These bits together with the LCV[15:8] bits count the Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or B8ZS Code Violation (CV) Error (in B8ZS
decoding) numbers. The LCV[0] bit is the LSB.
T1/J1 LCV Counter Mapping 1 (09H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LCV15
LCV14
LCV13
LCV12
LCV11
LCV10
LCV9
LCV8
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LCV[15:8]:
These bits together with the LCV[7:0] bits count the Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or B8ZS Code Violation (CV) Error (in B8ZS
decoding) numbers. The LCV[15] bit is the MSB.
T1/J1 DDSE Counter Mapping 0 (0AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DDSE7
DDSE6
DDSE5
DDSE4
DDSE3
DDSE2
DDSE1
DDSE0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDSE[7:0]:
In T1 DM format, these bits together with the DDSE[9:8] bits count the DDS Pattern Error numbers. The DDSE[0] bit is the LSB.
Programming Information
230
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 DDSE Counter Mapping 1 (0BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
DDSE9
DDSE8
R
R
0
0
DDSE[9:8]:
In T1 DM format, these bits together with the DDSE[7:0] bits count the DDS Pattern Error numbers. The DDSE[9] bit is the MSB
RCRB:
The indirect registers of RCRB addressed from 01H to 18H are the Extracted Signaling Data / Extract Enable Registers for CH1 to CH24. Each
address corresponds to one channel.
T1/J1 Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable Register (01H ~ 18H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
EXTRACT
A
B
C
D
R/W
R
R
R
R
1
0
0
0
0
EXTRACT:
This bit is valid when the SF/ESF/SLC-96 frame is synchronized.
= 0: Disable the signaling bits extraction.
= 1: The signaling bits are extracted to the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-01~18H).
In T1-DM format, there is no signaling bits. The EXTRACT bit of all the channels should be set to ‘0’.
A, B, C, D:
These bits are valid when the EXTRACT bit (b4, T1/J1-ID-01~18H) is enabled.
These bits are the extracted signaling bits. In SF format, the C, D bits are the repetition of the signaling bits A & B.
RPLC:
The indirect registers of RPLC addressed from 01H to 18H are the Channel Control Registers for CH1 to CH24. Each address corresponds to one
channel.
The indirect registers of RPLC addressed from 21H to 38H are the Data Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for CH1 to CH24. Each address corresponds to one channel.
The indirect registers of RPLC addressed from 41H to 58H are the Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for CH1 to CH24. Each address
corresponds to one channel.
Programming Information
231
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Channel Control Register (01H ~ 18H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
SUBST2
SUBST1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SUBST[2:0]:
When the GSUBST[2:0] bits (b2~0, T1/J1-0D0H,...) are ‘000’, these bits select the replacement on a per-channel basis.
SUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
No operation.
001
The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-ID-21~38H).
010
The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
others
Reserved.
SINV, OINV, EINV:
These three bits select how to invert the bits in the corresponding channel.
SINV
OINV
EINV
Bit Inversion
0
0
0
No inversion.
0
0
1
Invert the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
0
Invert the odd bits (bit 3, 5, 7) except the MSB of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
1
Invert the bits from bit 2 to bit 8 of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
0
0
Invert the MSB (bit 1) of the corresponding channel.
1
0
1
Invert the MSB (bit 1) and the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding channel.
1
1
0
Invert all the odd bits (bit 1, 3, 5, 7) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
1
1
Invert all the bits (bit 1 ~ bit 8) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
G56K, GAP:
These bits are valid in Receive Clock Master mode when the PCCE bit (b0, T1/J1-0D1H,...) is ‘1’.
G56K
GAP
0
0
The corresponding channel is not gapped.
1
0
Bit 8 (LSB) of the corresponding channel is gapped (no clock signal during the Bit 8).
X
1
The corresponding channel is gapped (no clock signal during the channel).
Programming Information
Gap Mode
232
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Data Trunk Conditioning Code Register (21H ~ 38H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DTRK[7:0]:
These bits are the data trunk code that can replace the data of the channel selected by the GSUBST[2:0] bits (b2~0, T1/J1-0D0H,...) or the
SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, T1/J1-ID-01~18H).
T1/J1 Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Register (41H ~ 58H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
6
5
TEST
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
Reserved
4
3
2
1
0
STRKEN
A
B
C
D
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
TEST:
This bit is valid in 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode selected by the PRBSMODE[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1-0C7H,...).
= 0: Disable the data in the corresponding channel to be tested by the PRBS Generator/Detector.
= 1: Enable the data in the corresponding channel to be extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector for test (when the PRBSDIR bit (b1, T1/J10C7H,...) is ‘0’); or enable the test pattern from the PRBS Generator/Detector to replace the data in the corresponding channel for test (when the
PRBSDIR bit (b1, T1/J1-0C7H,...) is ‘1’). In 8-bit-based mode, the data refers to all 8 bits. In 7-bit-based mode, the data refers to the 7 MSB.
All the channels that are extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random
are searched for. Similarly, all the channels set to be replaced with the PRBS Generator/Detector test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the
PRBS.
STRKEN:
= 0: No operation.
= 1: The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the signaling trunk code set in the A, B, C, D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
A, B, C, D:
These bits are the signaling trunk code that can replace the signaling bits of the channel selected by the GSTRKEN bit (b6, T1/J1-0D0H,...) or the
STRKEN bit (b4, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
TPLC:
The indirect registers of TPLC addressed from 01H to 18H are the Channel Control Registers for CH1 to CH24. Each address corresponds to one
channel.
The indirect registers of TPLC addressed from 21H to 38H are the Data Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for CH1 to CH24. Each address corresponds to one channel.
The indirect registers of TPLC addressed from 41H to 58H are the Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for CH1 to CH24. Each address
corresponds to one channel.
Programming Information
233
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Channel Control Register (01H ~ 18H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
SUBST2
SUBST1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SUBST[2:0]:
When the GSUBST[2:0] bits (b2~0, T1/J1-0CBH,...) are ‘000’, these bits select the replacement on a per-channel basis.
SUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
No operation.
001
The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-ID-21~38H).
010
The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
100
The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the payload loopback code extracted from the Elastic Store Buffer in the receive path.
others
Reserved.
SINV, OINV, EINV:
These three bits select how to invert the bits in the corresponding channel.
SINV
OINV
EINV
Bit Inversion
0
0
0
No inversion.
0
0
1
Invert the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
0
Invert the odd bits (bit 3, 5, 7) except the MSB of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
1
Invert the bits from bit 2 to bit 8 of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
0
0
Invert the MSB (bit 1) of the corresponding channel.
1
0
1
Invert the MSB (bit 1) and the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding channel.
1
1
0
Invert all the odd bits (bit 1, 3, 5, 7) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
1
1
Invert all the bits (bit 1 ~ bit 8) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
G56K, GAP:
These bits are valid in Transmit Clock Master mode when the PCCE bit (b0, T1/J1-0CCH,...) is ‘1’.
G56K
GAP
0
0
The corresponding channel is not gapped.
1
0
Bit 8 (LSB) of the corresponding channel is gapped (no clock signal during the Bit 8).
X
1
The corresponding channel is gapped (no clock signal during the channel).
Programming Information
Gap Mode
234
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 Data Trunk Conditioning Code Register (21H ~ 38H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DTRK[7:0]:
These bits are the data trunk code that can replace the data of the channel selected by the GSUBST[2:0] bits (b2~0, T1/J1-0CBH,...) or the
SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, T1/J1-ID-01~18H).
T1/J1 Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Register (41H ~ 58H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TEST
SIGINS
STRKEN
A
B
C
D
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TEST:
This bit is valid in 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode selected by the PRBSMODE[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1-0C7H,...).
= 0: Disable the data in the corresponding channel to be tested by the PRBS Generator/Detector.
= 1: Enable the data in the corresponding channel to be extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector for test (when the PRBSDIR bit (b1, T1/J10C7H,...) is ‘1’); or enable the test pattern from the PRBS Generator/Detector to replace the data in the corresponding channel for test (when the
PRBSDIR bit (b1, T1/J1-0C7H,...) is ‘0’). In 8-bit-based mode, the data refers to all 8 bits. In 7-bit-based mode, the data refers to the 7 MSB.
All the channels that are extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random
are searched for. Similarly, all the channels set to be replaced with the PRBS Generator/Detector test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the
PRBS.
SIGINS:
= 0: The signaling insertion is not allowed.
= 1: The signaling bits are inserted into the data stream to be transmitted. The signaling source is selected by the STRKEN bit (b4, T1/J1-ID41~58H).
STRKEN:
= 0: No operation.
= 1: The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the signaling trunk code set in the A, B, C, D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
A, B, C, D:
These bits are the signaling trunk code that can replace the signaling bits of the channel selected by the GSTRKEN bit (b6, T1/J1-0CBH,...) or the
STRKEN bit (b4, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
Programming Information
235
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
5.2.2
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 MODE
5.2.2.1 Direct Register
E1 Chip ID For Octal Transceiver (000H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
ID7
ID6
ID5
ID4
ID3
ID2
ID1
ID0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
ID[7:0]:
The ID[7:0] bits are pre-set. The ID[7:4] bits represent the IDT82P2288 device. The ID[3:0] bits represent the current version number (‘0001’ is for
the first version).
E1 Software Reset (004H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
Type
X
Default
A write operation to this register will generate a software reset.
The software reset will set all the registers except the T1/J1 Or E1 Mode register (020H,...) to their default values. If the setting is changed in the
T1/J1 Or E1 Mode register (020H,...), a software reset must be applied.
E1 G.772 Monitor Control (005H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
MON3
MON2
MON1
MON0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
MON[3:0]:
These bits determine whether the G.772 Monitor is implemented. When the G.772 Monitor is implemented, these bits select one transmitter or
receiver to be monitored by the Link 1.
Programming Information
236
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
MON[3:0]
Monitored Path
MON[3:0]
Monitored Path
0000
No transmitter or receiver is monitored.
1000
No transmitter or receiver is monitored.
0001
The receiver of the Link 2 is monitored.
1001
The transmitter of the Link 2 is monitored.
0010
The receiver of the Link 3 is monitored.
1010
The transmitter of the Link 3 is monitored.
0011
The receiver of the Link 4 is monitored.
1011
The transmitter of the Link 4 is monitored.
0100
The receiver of the Link 5 is monitored.
1100
The transmitter of the Link 5 is monitored.
0101
The receiver of the Link 6 is monitored.
1101
The transmitter of the Link 6 is monitored.
0110
The receiver of the Link 7 is monitored.
1110
The transmitter of the Link 7 is monitored.
0111
The receiver of the Link 8 is monitored.
1111
The transmitter of the Link 8 is monitored.
Programming Information
237
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 GPIO Control (006H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
LEVEL1
LEVEL0
DIR1
DIR0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
1
LEVEL[1]:
When the GPIO[1] pin is defined as an output port, this bit can be read and written:
= 0: The GPIO[1] pin outputs low level.
= 1: The GPIO[1] pin outputs high level.
When the GPIO[1] pin is defined as an input port, this bit can only be read:
= 0: Low level is input on the GPIO[1] pin.
= 1: High level is input on the GPIO[1] pin.
LEVEL[0]:
When the GPIO[0] pin is defined as an output port, this bit can be read and written:
= 0: The GPIO[0] pin outputs low level.
= 1: The GPIO[0] pin outputs high level.
When the GPIO[0] pin is defined as an input port, this bit can only be read:
= 0: Low level is input on the GPIO[0] pin.
= 1: High level is input on the GPIO[0] pin.
DIR[1]:
= 0: The GPIO[1] pin is used as an output port.
= 1: The GPIO[1] pin is used as an input port.
DIR[0]:
= 0: The GPIO[0] pin is used as an output port.
= 1: The GPIO[0] pin is used as an input port.
Programming Information
238
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Reference Clock Output Select (007H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
RO22
RO21
RO20
RO12
RO11
RO10
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
RO2[2:0]:
When no LOS is detected, the REFB_OUT pin outputs a recovered clock from the Clock and Data Recovery function block of one of the eight links.
The link is selected by these bits:
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
000
Link 1
100
Link 5
001
Link 2
101
Link 6
010
Link 3
110
Link 7
011
Link 4
111
Link 8
When LOS is detected, the REFB_OUT pin outputs MCLK or high level, as selected by the REFH_LOS bit (b0, E1-03EH,...). (This feature is available in ZB revision only).
RO1[2:0]:
When no LOS is detected, the REFA_OUT pin outputs a recovered clock from the Clock and Data Recovery function block of one of the eight links.
The link is selected by these bits:
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
RO2[2:0]
Selected Link
000
Link 1
100
Link 5
001
Link 2
101
Link 6
010
Link 3
110
Link 7
011
Link 4
111
Link 8
When LOS is detected, the REFA_OUT pin outputs MCLK or high level, as selected by the REFH_LOS bit (b0, E1-03EH,...). (This feature is available in ZB revision only).
Programming Information
239
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Interrupt Requisition Link ID (009H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
INT8
INT7
INT6
INT5
INT4
INT3
INT2
INT1
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
0
INTn:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the corresponding link.
= 1: At least one interrupt is generated in the corresponding link.
E1 Timer Interrupt Control (00AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
TMOVE
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
TMOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TMOVI bit (b0, E1-00BH) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TMOVI bit (b0, E1-00BH) is ‘1’.
E1 Timer Interrupt Indication (00BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
TMOVI
Reserved
Default
R
0
TMOVI:
The device times every one second.
= 0: One second timer is not over.
= 1: One second timer is over.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
240
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 PMON Access Port (00EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
LINKSEL2
LINKSEL1
LINKSEL0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
0
ADDR3
ADDR2
ADDR1
ADDR0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
Reserved
:
These bits select one of the eight links. One of the PMON indirect registers of the selected link can be accessed by the microprocessor.
LINKSEL[2:0]
Selected Link
LINKSEL[2:0]
Selected Link
000
Link 1
100
Link 5
001
Link 2
101
Link 6
010
Link 3
110
Link 7
011
Link 4
111
Link 8
ADDR[3:0]:
These bits select one of the PMON indirect registers of the selected link to be accessed by the microprocessor.
Address
PMON Indirect Register
Address
PMON Indirect Register
00H
CRCE Counter Mapping 0
08H
LCV Counter Mapping 0
01H
CRCE Counter Mapping 1
09H
LCV Counter Mapping 1
02H
FER Counter Mapping 0
0AH
TCRCE Counter Mapping 0
03H
FER Counter Mapping 1
0BH
TCRCE Counter Mapping 1
04H
COFA Counter Mapping
0CH
FEBE Counter Mapping 0
05H
OOF Counter Mapping
0DH
FEBE Counter Mapping 1
06H
PRGD Counter Mapping 0
0EH
TFEBE Counter Mapping 0
07H
PRGD Counter Mapping 1
0FH
TFEBE Counter Mapping 1
E1 PMON Access Data (00FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DAT[7:0]:
These bits hold the value which is read from the selected PMON indirect register.
Programming Information
241
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Backplane Global Configuration (010H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSLVCK
RMUX
MTSDA
TSLVCK
TMUX
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
0
1
1
0
RSLVCK:
This bit is valid when all eight links are in the Receive Clock Slave mode.
= 0: Each link uses its own clock signal on the RSCKn pin and framing pulse on the RSFSn pin.
= 1: All eight links use the clock signal on the RSCK[1] pin and the framing pulse on the RSFS[1] pin.
RMUX:
= 0: The Receive System Interface of the device is operated in the Non-multiplexed mode.
= 1: The Receive System Interface of the device is operated in the Multiplexed mode.
MTSDA:
This bit is valid in Transmit Multiplexed mode. It selects one multiplexed bus for the Transmit System Interface of the device.
= 0: The multiplexed bus B is selected. The data and signaling bits are de-multiplexed from multiplexed bus B.
= 1: The multiplexed bus A is selected. The data and signaling bits are de-multiplexed from multiplexed bus A.
TSLVCK:
This bit is valid when all eight links are in the Transmit Clock Slave mode.
= 0: Each link uses its own timing signal on the TSCKn pin and framing pulse on the TSFSn pin.
= 1: All eight links use the timing signal on the TSCK[1] pin and the framing pulse on the TSFS[1] pin.
TMUX:
= 0: The Transmit System Interface of the device is operated in the Non-multiplexed mode.
= 1: The Transmit System Interface of the device is operated in the Multiplexed mode.
Programming Information
242
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Jitter Attenuation Configuration (021H, 121H, 221H, 321H, 421H, 521H, 621H, 721H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
2
1
0
TJITT_TEST
TJA_LIMT
TJA_E
TJA_DP1
TJA_DP0
TJA_BW
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
TJITT_TEST:
= 0: The real time interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-038H,...). That is, the current
interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO will be written into the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-038H,...).
= 1: The peak-peak interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-038H,...). That is, the
current interval is compared with the old one in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-038H,...) and the larger one will be indicated by the TJITT[6:0] bits
(b6~0, E1-038H,...); otherwise, the value in the TJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-038H,...) is not changed.
TJA_LIMT:
When the read and write pointer of the FIFO are within 2/3/4 bits (corresponding to the FIFO depth) of overflowing or underflowing, the bandwidth
of the JA can be widened to track the short term input jitter, thereby avoiding data corruption. This bit selects whether the bandwidth is normal or
widened.
= 0: Normal bandwidth is selected.
= 1: Widen bandwidth is selected. In this case, the JA will not attenuate the input jitter until the read/write pointer’s position is outside the 2/3/4 bits
window.
TJA_E:
= 0: Disable the Transmit Jitter Attenuator.
= 1: Enable the Transmit Jitter Attenuator.
TJA_DP[1:0]:
These two bits select the Jitter Attenuation Depth.
= 00: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 128-bit.
= 01: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 64-bit.
= 10 / 11: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 32-bit.
TJA_BW:
This bit select the Jitter Transfer Function Bandwidth.
= 0: 6.77 Hz.
= 1: 0.87 Hz.
Programming Information
243
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Configuration 0 (022H, 122H, 222H, 322H, 422H, 522H, 622H, 722H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
5
4
3
2
T_OFF
Reserved
R/W
0
1
0
T_MD
Reserved
R/W
0
T_OFF:
= 0: The transmit path is power up.
= 1: The transmit path is power down. The Line Driver is in high impedance.
T_MD:
This bit selects the line code rule to encode the data stream to be transmitted.
= 0: The HDB3 encoder is selected.
= 1: The AMI encoder is selected.
Programming Information
244
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Configuration 1 (023H, 123H, 223H, 323H, 423H, 523H, 623H, 723H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
DFM_ON
T_HZ
PULS3
PULS2
PULS1
PULS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
1
0
0
0
0
DFM_ON:
= 0: The Driver Failure Monitor is disabled.
= 1: The Driver Failure Monitor is enabled.
T_HZ:
= 0: The Line Driver works normally.
= 1: Set the Line Driver High-Z. (The other parts of the transmit path still work normally.)
PULS[3:0]:
These bits determine the template shapes for short/long haul transmission:
PULS[3:0]
Transmit Clock
Cable Impedance
0000
2.048 MHz
75 Ω (in internal impedance matching mode) / Reserved (in external impedance matching mode)
0001
2.048 MHz
120 Ω (in internal impedance matching mode) / 75 Ω & 120 Ω (in external impedance matching mode)
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
Reserved
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
11xx
Programming Information
Arbitrary waveform setting.
245
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Configuration 2 (024H, 124H, 224H, 324H, 424H, 524H, 624H, 724H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
SCAL5
SCAL4
SCAL3
SCAL2
SCAL1
SCAL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
0
0
0
0
1
SCAL[5:0]:
The following setting lists the standard value of normal amplitude in different operating modes. Each step change (one increasing or decreasing
from the standard value) will scale the amplitude of the D/A output by a certain offset. These bits are only effective when user programmable arbitrary
waveform is used.
= 100001: Normal amplitude in E1 - 75 Ω & 120 Ω operating modes. Each step change scales about 3% offset.
Programming Information
246
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Configuration 3 (025H, 125H, 225H, 325H, 425H, 525H, 625H, 725H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DONE
RW
UI1
UI0
SAMP3
SAMP2
SAMP1
SAMP0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
This register is valid when the PULS[3:0] bits (b3~0, E1-023H,...) are set to ‘11xx’.
DONE:
= 0: Disable the read/write operation to the pulse template RAM.
= 1: Enable the read/write operation to the pulse template RAM.
RW:
= 0: Write the data to the pulse template RAM.
= 1: Read the data to the pulse template RAM.
UI[1:0]:
These bits specify one Unit Interval (UI) address.
= 00: UI addressed 0 is specified.
= 01: UI addressed 1 is specified.
= 10: UI addressed 2 is specified.
= 11: UI addressed 3 is specified.
SAMP[3:0]:
There bits specify one sample address. There are 16 samples in each UI.
SAMP[3:0]
Specified Sample Address
SAMP[3:0]
Specified Sample Address
0000
0
1000
8
0001
1
1001
9
0010
2
1010
10
0011
3
1011
11
0100
4
1100
12
0101
5
1101
13
0110
6
1110
14
0111
7
1111
15
Programming Information
247
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Configuration 4 (026H, 126H, 226H, 326H, 426H, 526H, 626H, 726H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WDAT6
WDAT5
WDAT4
WDAT3
WDAT2
WDAT1
WDAT0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Default
WDAT[6:0]:
These bits contain the data to be stored in the pulse template RAM which is addressed by the UI[1:0] bits (b5~4, E1-025H,...) and the SAMP[3:0]
bits (b3~0, E1-025H,...).
E1 Receive Jitter Attenuation Configuration (027H, 127H, 227H, 327H, 427H, 527H, 627H, 727H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
2
1
0
RJITT_TEST
RJA_LIMT
RJA_E
RJA_DP1
RJA_DP0
RJA_BW
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
RJITT_TEST:
= 0: The real time interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-039H,...). That is, the current
interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO will be written into the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-039H,...).
= 1: The peak-peak interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO is indicated in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-039H,...). That is, the
current interval is compared with the old one in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-039H,...) and the larger one will be indicated by the RJITT[6:0] bits
(b6~0, E1-039H,...); otherwise, the value in the RJITT[6:0] bits (b6~0, E1-039H,...) is not changed.
RJA_LIMT:
When the read and write pointer of the FIFO are within 2/3/4 bits (corresponding to the FIFO depth) of overflowing or underflowing, the bandwidth
of the JA can be widened to track the short term input jitter, thereby avoiding data corruption. This bit selects whether the bandwidth is normal or
widened.
= 0: Normal bandwidth is selected.
= 1: Widen bandwidth is selected. In this case, the JA will not attenuate the input jitter until the read/write pointer’s position is outside the 2/3/4 bits
window.
RJA_E:
= 0: Disable the Receive Jitter Attenuator.
= 1: Enable the Receive Jitter Attenuator.
RJA_DP[1:0]:
These two bits select the Jitter Attenuation Depth.
= 00: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 128-bit.
= 01: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 64-bit.
= 10 / 11: The Jitter Attenuation Depth is 32-bit.
RJA_BW:
This bit select the Jitter Transfer Function Bandwidth.
= 0: 6.77 Hz.
= 1: 0.87 Hz.
Programming Information
248
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Receive Configuration 0 (028H, 128H, 228H, 328H, 428H, 528H, 628H, 728H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
2
R_OFF
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
1
0
R_MD
Reserved
R/W
0
R_OFF:
= 0: The receive path is power up.
= 1: The receive path is power down.
R_MD:
This bit selects the line code rule to decode the received data stream.
= 0: The HDB3 decoder is selected.
= 1: The AMI decoder is selected.
Programming Information
249
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Receive Configuration 1 (029H, 129H, 229H, 329H, 429H, 529H, 629H, 729H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
6
5
EQ_ON
Reserved
Default
R/W
Reserved
0
4
3
2
1
0
LOS4
LOS3
LOS2
LOS1
LOS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
0
1
0
1
EQ_ON:
= 0: The Equalizer is off in short haul applications.
= 1: The Equalizer is on in long haul applications.
LOS[4:0]:
A LOS is detected when the incoming signals has “no transitions”, i.e., when the signal level is less than Q dB below nominal for N consecutive
pulse intervals. In long haul applications, these bits select the LOS declare threshold (Q). These bits are invalid in short haul applications.
LOS[4:0]
LOS Declare Threshold (Q)
LOS[4:0]
LOS Declare Threshold (Q)
00000
-4 dB
01100
-28 dB
00001
-6 dB
01101
-30 dB
00010
-8 dB
01110
-32 dB
00011
-10 dB
01111
-34 dB
00100
-12 dB
10000
-36 dB
00101
-14 dB
10001
-38 dB
00110
-16 dB
10010
-40 dB
00111
-18 dB
10011
-42 dB
01000
-20 dB
10100
-44 dB
01001
-22 dB
10101
-46 dB
01010
-24 dB
10110 - 11111
01011
-26 dB
Programming Information
250
-48 dB
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Receive Configuration 2 (02AH, 12AH, 22AH, 32AH, 42AH, 52AH, 62AH, 72AH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
SLICE1
SLICE0
UPDW1
UPDW0
MG1
MG0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
1
1
0
0
0
SLICE[1:0]:
These two bits define the Data Slicer threshold.
= 00: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 40% of the peak amplitude.
= 01: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 50% of the peak amplitude.
= 10: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 60% of the peak amplitude.
= 11: The Data Slicer generates a mark if the voltage on the RTIPn/RRINGn pins exceeds 70% of the peak amplitude.
UPDW[1:0]:
These two bits select the observation period, during which the peak value of the incoming signals are measured.
= 00: The observation period is 32 bits.
= 01: The observation period is 64 bits.
= 10: The observation period is 128 bits.
= 11: The observation period is 256 bits.
MG[1:0]:
These two bits select the Monitor Gain.
= 00: The Monitor Gain is 0 dB.
= 01: The Monitor Gain is 22 dB.
= 10: Reserved.
= 11: Reserved.
Programming Information
251
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Maintenance Function Control 0 (02BH, 12BH, 22BH, 32BH, 42BH, 52BH, 62BH, 72BH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
DLLP
SLLP
SRLP
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
Reserved
2
1
0
RLP
ALP
DLP
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
DLLP:
= 0: Disable the Local Digital Loopback 1.
= 1: Enable the Local Digital Loopback 1.
SLLP:
= 0: Disable the System Local Loopback.
= 1: Enable the System Local Loopback.
SRLP:
= 0: Disable the System Remote Loopback.
= 1: Enable the System Remote Loopback.
RLP:
= 0: Disable the Remote Loopback.
= 1: Enable the Remote Loopback.
ALP:
= 0: Disable the Analog Loopback.
= 1: Enable the Analog Loopback.
DLP:
= 0: Disable the Local Digital Loopback 2.
= 1: Enable the Local Digital Loopback 2.
Programming Information
252
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Maintenance Function Control 1 (02CH, 12CH, 22CH, 32CH, 42CH, 52CH, 62CH, 72CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
LAC
RAISE
ATAO
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
LAC:
This bit selects the LOS criteria.
= 0: The G.775 is selected. In short haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is less than 800 mVpp for 32 consecutive
bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming signal level is greater than 1 Vpp and has an average mark density of at least 12.5% and less than
16 consecutive zeros in 32 consecutive bit periods. In long haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is less than Q dB
below nominal (set in the LOS[4:0] bits (b4~0, E1-029H,...)) for 32 consecutive bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming signal level is greater
than (Q + 4 dB) and has an average mark density of at least 12.5% and less than 16 consecutive zeros in 32 consecutive bit periods.
= 1: The I.431/ETSI is selected. In short haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is less than 800 mVpp for 2048
consecutive bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming signal level is greater than 1 Vpp and has an average mark density of at least 12.5%
and less than 16 consecutive zeros in 32 consecutive bit periods. In long haul application, the LOS is declared when the incoming signal level is
less than Q dB below nominal (set in the LOS[4:0] bits (b4~0, E1-029H,...)) for 2048 consecutive bit intervals and is cleared when the incoming
signal level is greater than (Q + 4 dB) and has an average mark density of at least 12.5% and less than 16 consecutive zeros in 32 consecutive bit
periods.
RAISE:
This bit determines whether all ‘One’s can be inserted in the receive path when the LOS is detected.
= 0: Disable the insertion.
= 1: Enable the insertion.
ATAO:
This bit determines whether all ‘One’s can be inserted in the transmit path when the LOS is detected in the receive path.
= 0: Disable the insertion.
= 1: Enable the insertion.
Programming Information
253
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Maintenance Function Control 2 (031H, 131H, 231H, 331H, 431H, 531H, 631H, 731H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
6
5
BPV_INS
Reserved
Default
R/W
Reserved
0
4
3
2
1
0
EXZ_DEF
EXZ_ERR1
EXZ_ERR0
CNT_MD
CNT_TRF
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
BPV_INS:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit generates a single Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error to be inserted to the data stream to be transmitted.
This bit must be cleared and set again for the next BPV error insertion.
EXZ_DEF:
This bit selects the Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error criteria.
= 0: The ANSI is selected. In AMI line code rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 15 consecutive zeros in the data stream. In HDB3 line code
rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 3 consecutive zeros in the data stream.
= 1: The FCC is selected. In AMI line code rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 80 consecutive zeros in the data stream. In HDB3 line code
rule, the EXZ error is defined as more than 3 consecutive zeros in the data stream.
EXZ_ERR[1:0]:
These bits must be set to ‘01’ to enable the Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error event to be counted in an internal 16-bit EXZ counter.
CNT_MD:
= 0: The Manual Report mode is selected. The internal 16-bit EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers
when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the CNT_TRF bit.
= 1: The Auto Report mode is selected. The internal 16-bit EXZ counter transfers its content to the EXZ Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers
every one second automatically.
CNT_TRF:
This bit is valid when the CNT_MD bit is ‘0’.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit updates the content in the EXZ Error Counter L-Byte & H-Byte registers with the value in the internal 16-bit EXZ
counter.
This bit must be cleared and set again for the next updating.
Programming Information
254
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit And Receive Termination Configuration (032H, 132H, 232H, 332H, 432H, 532H, 632H, 732H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
T_TERM2
T_TERM1
T_TERM0
R_TERM2
R_TERM1
R_TERM0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
1
1
2
1
0
T_TERM[2:0]:
These bits select the internal impedance of the transmit path to match the cable impedance:
= 000: The 75 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 001: The 120 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
(The above two values are the standard value for E1 mode).
= 010: The 100 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 011: The 110 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 1xx: The internal impedance matching is bypassed, and external impedance circuit should be used.
R_TERM[2:0]:
These bits select the internal impedance of the receive path to match the cable impedance:
= 000: The 75 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 001: The 120 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
(The above two values are the standard values for E1 mode).
= 010: The 100 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 011: The 110 Ω internal impedance matching is selected.
= 1xx: The internal impedance matching is bypassed, and external impedance circuit should be used.
E1 Interrupt Enable Control 0 (033H, 133H, 233H, 333H, 433H, 533H, 633H, 733H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
DF_IE
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
LOS_IE
Reserved
R/W
0
DF_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DF_IS bit (b2, E1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DF_IS bit (b2, E1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
LOS_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LOS_IS bit (b0, E1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LOS_IS bit (b0, E1-03AH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
255
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Interrupt Enable Control 1 (034H, 134H, 234H, 334H, 434H, 534H, 634H, 734H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
DAC_IE
TJA_IE
RJA_IE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
Reserved
2
1
0
EXZ_IE
CV_IE
CNT_IE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
2
1
0
DAC_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DAC_IS bit (b6, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the DAC_IS bit (b6, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
TJA_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TJA_IS bit (b5, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TJA_IS bit (b5, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
RJA_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RJA_IS bit (b4, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RJA_IS bit (b4, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
EXZ_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the EXZ_IS bit (b2, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the EXZ_IS bit (b2, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
CV_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CV_IS bit (b1, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CV_IS bit (b1, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
CNT_IE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CNTOV_IS bit (b0, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CNTOV_IS bit (b0, E1-03BH,...) is ‘1’.
E1 Interrupt Trigger Edges Select (035H, 135H, 235H, 335H, 435H, 535H, 635H, 735H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
DF_IES
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
LOS_IES
Reserved
R/W
0
DF_IES:
= 0: The DF_IS bit (b2, E1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the DF_S bit (b2, E1-036H,...).
= 1: The DF_IS bit (b2, E1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is any transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the DF_S bit (b2, E1-036H,...).
LOS_IES:
= 0: The LOS_IS bit (b0, E1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the LOS_S bit (b0, E1-036H,...).
= 1: The LOS_IS bit (b0, E1-03AH,...) will be set to ‘1’ when there is any transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the LOS_S bit (b0, E1-036H,...).
Programming Information
256
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Line Status Register 0 (036H, 136H, 236H, 336H, 436H, 536H, 636H, 736H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
2
1
DF_S
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
LOS_S
Reserved
0
R
0
DF_S:
= 0: No transmit driver failure is detected.
= 1: Transmit driver failure is detected.
LOS_S:
= 0: No LOS is detected.
= 1: Loss of signal (LOS) is detected.
E1 Line Status Register 1 (037H, 137H, 237H, 337H, 437H, 537H, 637H, 737H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
LATT4
LATT3
LATT2
LATT1
LATT0
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
LATT[4:0]:
These bits indicate the current gain of the VGA relative to 3 V peak pulse level.
LATT[4:0]
Gain (dB)
LATT[4:0]
Gain (dB)
00000
0-2
01011
22 - 24
00001
2-4
01100
24 - 26
00010
4-6
01101
26 - 28
00011
6-8
01110
28 - 30
00100
8 - 10
01111
30 - 32
00101
10 - 12
10000
32 - 34
00110
12 - 14
10001
34 - 36
00111
14 - 16
10010
36 - 38
01000
16 - 18
10011
38 - 40
01001
18 - 20
10100
40 - 42
01010
20 - 22
10101 ~ 11111
42 - 44
Programming Information
257
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Jitter Measure Value Indication (038H, 138H, 238H, 338H, 438H, 538H, 638H, 738H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TJITT6
TJITT5
TJITT4
TJITT3
TJITT2
TJITT1
TJITT0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TJITT[6:0]:
When the TJITT_TEST bit (b5, E1-021H,...) is ‘0’, these bits represent the current interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO.
When the TJITT_TEST bit (b5, E1-021H,...) is ‘1’, these bits represent the P-P interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO since last
read.
These bits will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to the register.
E1 Receive Jitter Measure Value Indication (039H, 139H, 239H, 339H, 439H, 539H, 639H, 739H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RJITT6
RJITT5
RJITT4
RJITT3
RJITT2
RJITT1
RJITT0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RJITT[6:0]:
When the RJITT_TEST bit (b5, E1-027H,...) is ‘0’, these bits represent the current interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO.
When the RJITT_TEST bit (b5, E1-027H,...) is ‘1’, these bits represent the P-P interval between the read and write pointer of the FIFO since last
read.
These bits will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to the register.
Programming Information
258
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Interrupt Status 0 (03AH, 13AH, 23AH, 33AH, 43AH, 53AH, 63AH, 73AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
DF_IS
Reserved
R
Default
0
0
LOS_IS
Reserved
R
0
DF_IS:
= 0: There is no status change on the DF_S bit (b2, E1-036H,...).
= 1: When the DF_IES bit (b2, E1-035H,...) is ‘0’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the DF_S bit (b2, E1-036H,...);
when the DF_IES bit (b2, E1-035H,...) is ‘1’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the DF_S bit (b2, E1036H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
LOS_IS:
= 0: There is no status change on the LOS_S bit (b0, E1-036H,...).
= 1: When the LOS_IES bit (b0, E1-035H,...) is ‘0’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the LOS_S bit (b0, E1-036H,...);
when the LOS_IES bit (b0, E1-035H,...) is ‘1’, the ‘1’ on this bit indicates there is a transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’ on the LOS_S bit (b0,
E1-036H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
259
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Interrupt Status 1 (03BH, 13BH, 23BH, 33BH, 43BH, 53BH, 63BH, 73BH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
DAC_IS
TJA_IS
RJA_IS
R
R
R
0
0
0
Reserved
2
1
0
EXZ_IS
CV_IS
CNTOV_IS
R
R
R
0
0
0
DAC_IS:
= 0: The sum of a pulse template does not exceed the D/A limitation (+63) when more than one UI is used to compose the arbitrary pulse template.
= 1: The sum of a pulse template exceeds the D/A limitation (+63) when more than one UI is used to compose the arbitrary pulse template.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
TJA_IS:
= 0: The transmit JA FIFO has not overflowed or underflowed.
= 1: The transmit JA FIFO has overflowed or underflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RJA_IS:
= 0: The receive JA FIFO has not overflowed or underflowed.
= 1: The receive JA FIFO has overflowed or underflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
EXZ_IS:
= 0: No Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is detected.
= 1: The Excessive Zero (EXZ) Error is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CV_IS:
= 0: No Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error or HDB3 Code Violation (CV) Error is detected.
= 1: The Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error or HDB3 Code Violation (CV) Error is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CNTOV_IS:
= 0: The internal 16-bit EXZ counter has not overflowed.
= 1: The internal 16-bit EXZ counter has overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
260
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 EXZ Error Counter H-Byte (03CH, 13CH, 23CH, 33CH, 43CH, 53CH, 63CH, 73CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
CNTH[7]
CNTH[6]
CNTH[5]
CNTH[4]
CNTH[3]
CNTH[2]
CNTH[1]
CNTH[0]
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CNTH[7:0]:
These bits, together with the CNTL[7:0] bits, reflect the content in the internal 16-bit EXZ counter.
E1 EXZ Error Counter L-Byte (03DH, 13DH, 23DH, 33DH, 43DH, 53DH, 63DH, 73DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
CNTL[7]
CNTL[6]
CNTL[5]
CNTL[4]
CNTL[3]
CNTL[2]
CNTL[1]
CNTL[0]
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
CNTL[7:0]:
These bits, together with the CNTH[7:0] bits, reflect the content in the internal 16-bit EXZ counter.
E1 Reference Clock Output Control (03EH, 13EH, 23EH, 33EH, 43EH, 53EH, 63EH, 73EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
REFH_LOS
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
REFH_LOS:
In case of LOS, this bit determines the outputs on the REFA_OUT and REFB_OUT pins.
= 0: Output MCLK.
= 1: Output high level.
Programming Information
261
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Interrupt Module Indication 2 (03FH, 13FH, 23FH, 33FH, 43FH, 53FH, 63FH, 73FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
LIU
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
LIU:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Receive / Transmit Internal Termination, Adaptive Equalizer, Data Slicer, CLK&Data Recovery, Receive /
Transmit Jitter Attenuator, B8ZS/HDB3/AMI Decoder / Encoder, Waveform Shaper / Line Build Out or Line Driver block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Receive / Transmit Internal Termination, Adaptive Equalizer, Data Slicer, CLK&Data Recovery, Receive / Transmit
Jitter Attenuator, B8ZS/HDB3/AMI Decoder / Encoder, Waveform Shaper / Line Build Out or Line Driver function block.
E1 Interrupt Module Indication 0 (040H, 140H, 240H, 340H, 440H, 540H, 640H, 740H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
ALARM
PMON
PRGD
RCRB
FGEN
FRMR
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
ALARM:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Alarm Detector function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Alarm Detector function block.
PMON:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Performance Monitor function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Performance Monitor function block.
PRGD:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the PRBS Generator / Detector function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the PRBS Generator / Detector function block.
RCRB:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer function block.
FGEN:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Frame Generator function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Frame Generator function block.
FRMR:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Frame Processor function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Frame Processor function block.
Programming Information
262
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Interrupt Module Indication 1 (041H, 141H, 241H, 341H, 441H, 541H, 641H, 741H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
THDLC3
THDLC2
THDLC1
RHDLC3
RHDLC2
RHDLC1
ELST
TRSI/RESI
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
THDLC3:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #3 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #3 function block.
THDLC2:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #2 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #2 function block.
THDLC1:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #1 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Transmitter #1 function block.
RHDLC3:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #3 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #3 function block.
RHDLC2:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #2 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #2 function block.
RHDLC1:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #1 function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the HDLC Receiver #1 function block.
ELST:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Elastic Store Buffer function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Elastic Store Buffer function block.
TRSI/RESI:
= 0: No interrupt is generated in the Transmit / Receive System Interface function block.
= 1: Interrupt is generated in the Transmit / Receive System Interface function block.
Programming Information
263
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TBIF Option Register (042H, 142H, 242H, 342H, 442H, 542H, 642H, 742H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
DE
FE
CMS
FSINV
FSTYP
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
DE:
This bit selects the active edge of TSCKn to sample the data on TSDn and TSIGn and the active edge of MTSCK to sample the data on MTSDA
(MTSDB) and MTSIGA (MTSIGB).
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FE:
This bit selects the active edge of TSCKn to update/sample the pulse on TSFSn and the active edge of MTSCK to sample the pulse on MTSFS.
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
CMS:
This bit is valid in Transmit Clock Slave mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The speed of TSCKn/MTSCK is the same as the data rate on the system side (2.048 Mb/s / 8.192 Mb/s).
= 1: The speed of TSCKn/MTSCK is double the data rate on the system side (4.096 Mb/s / 16.384 Mb/s).
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, if all eight links use TSCK[1] and TSFS[1] to input the data (i.e., the TSLVCK bit (b, T1/J1-01H) is set to ‘1’), the bit
of the eight links should be set to the same value.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FSINV:
= 0: The transmit framing pulse TSFSn is active high.
= 1: The transmit framing pulse TSFSn is active low.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, this bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FSTYP:
= 0: In Transmit Non-multiplexed mode, TSFSn pulses during the first bit of each Basic frame. In Transmit Multiplexed mode, MTSFS pulses during
the first bit of each Basic frame of the first link.
= 1: In Transmit Non-multiplexed mode, if the CRC Multi-frame is to be generated, TSFSn pulses during the first bit of each CRC Multi-frame; if the
Signaling Multi-frame is to be generated, TSFSn pulses during the first bit of each Signaling Multi-frame; if both the CRC Multi-frame and the
Signaling Multi-frame are to be generated, TSFSn goes high/low during the first bit of each Signaling Multi-frame and goes the opposite during the
second bit of each CRC Multi-frame. In Transmit Multiplexed mode, if the CRC Multi-frame is to be generated, MTSFS pulses during the first bit of
each CRC Multi-frame of the first link; if the Signaling Multi-frame is to be generated, MTSFS pulses during the first bit of each Signaling Multiframe of the first link; if both the CRC Multi-frame and the Signaling Multi-frame are to be generated, MTSFS goes high/low during the first bit of
each Signaling Multi-frame and goes the opposite during the second bit of each CRC Multi-frame of the first link.
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, this bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
Programming Information
264
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TBIF Operating Mode (043H, 143H, 243H, 343H, 443H, 543H, 643H, 743H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
TMODE
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
1
TMODE:
In Transmit Non-multiplexed mode, this bit selects the sub-mode.
= 0: The Transmit System Interface is operated in Transmit Clock Master mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to
align the data input on the TSDn pin are provided from the processed data from the device.
= 1: The Transmit System Interface is operated in Transmit Clock Slave mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to align
the data input on the TSDn pin are provided by the system side.
E1 TBIF TS Offset (044H, 144H, 244H, 344H, 444H, 544H, 644H, 744H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TSOFF[6:0]:
These bits give a binary number to define the timeslot offset. The timeslot offset is between the framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin and the
start of the corresponding frame input on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin are always pertimeslot aligned with the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin.
In Non-multiplexed mode, the timeslot offset can be configured from 0 to 31 timeslots (0 & 31 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the timeslot offset
can be configured from 0 to 127 timeslots (0 & 127 are included).
E1 TBIF Bit Offset (045H, 145H, 245H, 345H, 445H, 545H, 645H, 745H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
EDGE:
This bit is valid when the CMS bit (b2, E1-042H,...) is ‘1’.
= 0: The first active edge of TSCKn/MTSCK is selected to sample the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) and TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pins.
= 1: The second active edge of TSCKn/MTSCK is selected to sample the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) and TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pins.
BOFF[2:0]:
These bits give a binary number to define the bit offset. The bit offset is between the framing pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin and the start of the
corresponding frame input on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin are always per-timeslot aligned
with the data on the TSDn/MTSDA(MTSDB) pin.
Programming Information
265
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RBIF Option Register (046H, 146H, 246H, 346H, 446H, 546H, 646H, 746H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
DE
FE
CMS
TRI
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
1
0
1
DE:
This bit selects the active edge of RSCKn to update the data on RSDn and RSIGn and the active edge of MRSCK to update the data on
MRSDA(MRSDB) and MRSIGA(MRSIGB).
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
FE:
This bit selects the active edge of RSCKn to update/sample the pulse on RSFSn and the active edge of MRSCK to sample the pulse on MRSFS.
= 0: The falling edge is selected.
= 1: The rising edge is selected.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
CMS:
This bit is valid in Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The speed of RSCKn/MRSCK is the same as the data rate on the system side (2.048 Mb/s / 8.192 Mb/s).
= 1: The speed of RSCKn/MRSCK is double the data rate on the system side (4.096 Mb/s / 16.384 Mb/s).
In Receive Clock Slave mode, if all eight links use the RSCK[1] and RSFS[1] to output the data (i.e., the RSLVCK bit (b, E1-01H) is set to ‘1’), the
bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
TRI:
= 0: The processed data and signaling bits are output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins respectively.
= 1: The output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins are in high impedance.
E1 RBIF Mode (047H, 147H, 247H, 347H, 447H, 547H, 647H, 747H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
0
RMODE
Reserved
Default
R/W
1
RMODE:
In Receive Non-multiplexed mode, this bit selects the sub-mode.
= 0: The Receive System Interface is operated in Receive Clock Master mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to
align the data output on the RSDn pin are received from each line side.
= 1: The Receive System Interface is operated in Receive Clock Slave mode. The timing signal for clocking the data and the framing pulse to align
the data output on the RSDn pin are provided by the system side.
Programming Information
266
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RBIF Frame Pulse (048H, 148H, 248H, 348H, 448H, 548H, 648H, 748H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
FSINV
OHD
SMFS
CMFS
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
FSINV:
= 0: The receive framing pulse RSFSn is active high.
= 1: The receive framing pulse RSFSn is active low.
In Receive Multiplexed mode, this bit of the eight links should be set to the same value.
OHD, SMFS, CMFS:
In Receive Clock Master mode, these bits select what the pulse on RSFSn indicates.
OHD
SMFS
CMFS
RSFSn Indication
0
0
0
The RSFSn pulses during the first bit of each Basic frame.
0
0
1
The RSFSn pulses during the first bit of each CRC Multi-frame.
0
1
0
The RSFSn pulses during the first bit of each Signaling Multi-frame.
0
1
1
The RSFSn goes high/low during the first bit of each Signaling Multi-frame and goes the opposite during the
second bit of each CRC Multi-frame.
1
0
0
The RSFSn pulses during the TS0 and TS16.
E1 RBIF TS Offset (049H, 149H, 249H, 349H, 449H, 549H, 649H, 749H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSOFF6
TSOFF5
TSOFF4
TSOFF3
TSOFF2
TSOFF1
TSOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TSOFF[6:0]:
Except that in the Receive Master mode, when the OHD bit (b3, E1-048H,...), the SMFS bit (b2, E1-048H,...) and the CMFS bit (b1, E1-048H,...)
are set to TS1 and TS16 overhead indication, the timeslot offset is supported in all the other conditions.
These bits give a binary number to define the timeslot offset. The timeslot offset is between the framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin and the
start of the corresponding frame output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin are always pertimeslot aligned with the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin.
In Non-multiplexed mode, the timeslot offset can be configured from 0 to 31 timeslots (0 & 31 are included). In Multiplexed mode, the timeslot offset
can be configured from 0 to 127 timeslots (0 & 127 are included).
Programming Information
267
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RBIF Bit Offset (04AH, 14AH, 24AH, 34AH, 44AH, 54AH, 64AH, 74AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
3
2
1
0
EDGE
BOFF2
BOFF1
BOFF0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
Default
EDGE:
This bit is valid when the CMS bit (b1, E1-046H,...) is ‘1’.
= 0: The first active edge of RSCKn/MRSCK is selected to update the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pins.
= 1: The second active edge of RSCKn/MRSCK is selected to update the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) and RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB)
pins.
BOFF[2:0]:
Except that in the Receive Master mode, when the OHD bit (b3, E1-048H,...), the SMFS bit (b2, E1-048H,...) and the CMFS bit (b1, E1-048H,...)
are set to TS1 and TS16 overhead indication, the bit offset is supported in all the other conditions.
These bits give a binary number to define the bit offset. The bit offset is between the framing pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin and the start of the
corresponding frame output on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin. The signaling bits on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin are always per-channel
aligned with the data on the RSDn/MRSDA(MRSDB) pin.
E1 RTSFS Change Indication (04BH, 14BH, 24BH, 34BH, 44BH, 54BH, 64BH, 74BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
RCOFAI
TCOFAI
R
R
0
0
RCOFAI:
This bit is valid in Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The interval of the pulses on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin is an integer multiple of 125 µs.
= 1: The interval of the pulses on the RSFSn/MRSFS pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
TCOFAI:
This bit is valid in Transmit Clock Slave mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode.
= 0: The pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin is an integer multiple of 125 µs.
= 1: The pulse on the TSFSn/MTSFS pin is not an integer multiple of 125 µs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
268
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RTSFS Interrupt Control (04CH, 14CH, 24CH, 34CH, 44CH, 54CH, 64CH, 74CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
RCOFAE
TCOFAE
R/W
R/W
0
0
RCOFAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit (b1, E1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RCOFAI bit (b1, E1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
TCOFAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCOFAI bit (b0, E1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCOFAI bit (b0, E1-04BH,...) is ‘1’.
E1 FRMR Mode 0 (04DH, 14DH, 24DH, 34DH, 44DH, 54DH, 64DH, 74DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
UNFM
REFCRCE
REFEN
REFR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
1
1
0
UNFM:
= 0: The data stream is received in framed mode and is processed by the Frame Processor.
= 1: The data stream is received in unframed mode and the Frame Processor is bypassed.
REFCRCE:
= 0: disable from re-searching for synchronization when the Excessive CRC-4 Error occurs.
= 1: Search for synchronization again when the Excessive CRC-4 Error occurs. This function can only be implemented only if the REFEN bit is
logic 1.
REFEN:
= 0: “Locked in frame”. Once the previous Basic frame synchronization is acquired, and no errors can lead to reframe except for manually setting
by the REFR bit.
= 1: Search for Basic frame synchronization again when it is out of synchronization.
REFR:
A transition from logic 0 to logic 1 forces to re-search for a new Basic frame synchronization.
Programming Information
269
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FRMR Mode 1 (04EH, 14EH, 24EH, 34EH, 44EH, 54EH, 64EH, 74EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BIT2C
CASEN
CRCEN
CNTNFAS
WORDERR
TS16C
SMFASC
C2NCIWCK
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
BIT2C:
This bit determines the criteria of out of Basic frame synchronization.
= 0: 3 consecutive FAS pattern errors lead to out of Basic frame synchronization.
= 1: 3 consecutive FAS pattern errors or 3 consecutive NFAS errors lead to out of Basic frame synchronization.
CASEN:
= 0: Disable searching for the Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame.
= 1: Enable searching for the Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame after the Basic frame synchronization is acquired.
CRCEN:
= 0: Disable searching for the CRC Multi-Frame.
= 1: Enable searching for the CRC Multi-Frame after the Basic frame synchronization is acquired.
CNTNFAS & WORDERR:
These two bits determine the criteria of FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error generation:
WORDERR
CNTNFAS
Error Generation
0
0
Each bit error in FAS is counted as an error event.
1
0
A FAS pattern error is counted as an error event.
0
1
Each bit error in FAS or NFAS error is counted as an error event.
1
1
A FAS pattern error or NFAS error is counted as an error event.
TS16C & SMFASC:
These two bits determine the criteria of out of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization:
TS16C
SMFASC
Out Of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Synchronization Criteria
X
0
2 consecutive CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Errors occur.
0
1
2 consecutive CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Errors occur or all the contents in TS16 are
zeros for one Signaling Multi-Frame.
1
1
2 consecutive CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Errors occur or all the contents in TS16 are
zeros for two consecutive Signaling Multi-Frames.
C2NCIWCK:
= 0: Stop searching for CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern in CRC to non-CRC interworking mode.
= 1: Enable searching for CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern even if CRC to non-CRC interworking has been declared.
Programming Information
270
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FRMR Status (04FH, 14FH, 24FH, 34FH, 44FH, 54FH, 64FH, 74FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
C2NCIWV
OOSMFV
OOCMFV
OOOFV
OOFV
R
R
R
R
R
0
1
1
0
1
C2NCIWV:
= 0: The Frame Processor does not operate in CRC to non-CRC interworking mode.
= 1: The Frame Processor operates in CRC to non-CRC interworking mode.
OOSMFV:
= 0: The CAS Signaling Multi-Frame is in synchronization.
= 1: The CAS Signaling Multi-Frame is out of synchronization.
OOCMFV:
= 0: The CRC Multi-Frame is in synchronization.
= 1: The CRC Multi-Frame is out of synchronization.
OOOFV:
= 0: The offline Basic frame is in synchronization.
= 1: The offline Basic frame is out of synchronization.
OOFV:
= 0: The Basic frame is in synchronization.
= 1: The Basic frame is out of synchronization.
Programming Information
271
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FRMR Interrupt Control 0 (050H, 150H, 250H, 350H, 450H, 550H, 650H, 750H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
C2NCIWE
OOSMFE
OOCMFE
OOOFE
OOFE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
C2NCIWE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the C2NCIWI bit (b4, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the C2NCIWI bit (b4, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
OOSMFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOSMFI bit (b3, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOSMFI bit (b3, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
OOCMFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOCMFI bit (b2, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOCMFI bit (b2, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
OOOFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOOFI bit (b1, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOOFI bit (b1, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
OOFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFI bit (b0, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFI bit (b0, E1-052H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
272
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FRMR Interrupt Control 1 (051H, 151H, 251H, 351H, 451H, 551H, 651H, 751H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
ISMFPE
ICSMFPE
SMFERE
ICMFPE
CMFERE
CRCEE
FERE
COFAE
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ISMFPE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the ISMFPI bit (b4, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the ISMFPI bit (b4, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
ICSMFPE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the ICSMFPI bit (b3, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the ICSMFPI bit (b3, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
SMFERE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SMFERI bit (b2, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SMFERI bit (b2, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
ICMFPE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the ICMFPI bit (b2, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the ICMFPI bit (b2, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
CMFERE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CMFERI bit (b2, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CMFERI bit (b2, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
CRCEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CRCEI bit (b2, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CRCEI bit (b2, T1/J1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
FERE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FERI bit (b1, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FERI bit (b1, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
COFAE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAI bit (b0, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAI bit (b0, E1-053H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
273
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FRMR Interrupt Indication 0 (052H, 152H, 252H, 352H, 452H, 552H, 652H, 752H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
EXCRCERI
C2NCIWI
OOSMFI
OOCMFI
OOOFI
OOFI
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
EXCRCERI:
When CRC Multi-Frame is synchronized, once the accumulated CRC-4 errors are not less than 915 (≥915) in a 1 second fixed window, an excessive CRC-4 error event is generated. During out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization state, the Excessive CRC-4 Error detection is suspended.
= 0: No Excessive CRC-4 Error event is detected.
= 1: The Excessive CRC-4 Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
C2NCIWI:
= 0: There is no status change on the C2NCIWV bit (b4, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the C2NCIWV bit (b4, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
OOSMFI:
= 0: There is no status change on the OOSMFV bit (b3, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the OOSMFV bit (b3, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
OOCMFI:
= 0: There is no status change on the OOCMFV bit (b2, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the OOCMFV bit (b2, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
OOOFI:
= 0: There is no status change on the OOOFV bit (b1, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the OOOFV bit (b1, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
OOFI:
= 0: There is no status change on the OOFV bit (b0, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the OOFV bit (b0, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
274
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FRMR Interrupt Indication 1 (053H, 153H, 253H, 353H, 453H, 553H, 653H, 753H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
ISMFPI
ICSMFPI
SMFERI
ICMFPI
CMFERI
CRCEI
FERI
COFAI
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ISMFPI:
= 0: The received bit is not the first bit of each CAS Signaling Multi-Frame.
= 1: The first bit of each CAS Signaling Multi-Frame is received.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it. It can not be updated during out of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization state
ICSMFPI:
= 0: The received bit is not the first bit of each CRC Sub Multi-Frame.
= 1: The first bit of each CRC Sub Multi-Frame is received.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it. It can not be updated during out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization state.
SMFERI:
When Signaling Multi-Frame is synchronized, the received Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signals are compared with the expected one (‘0000’).
When one or more bits do not match, a single CAS Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern error event is generated. During out of CAS Signaling
Multi-Frame synchronization state, the CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error detection is suspended.
= 0: No CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error event is detected.
= 1: The CAS Signaling Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
ICMFPI:
= 0: The received bit is not the first bit of each CRC Multi-Frame.
= 1: The first bit of each CRC Multi-Frame is received.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it. It can not be updated during out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization state.
CMFERI:
When CRC Multi-Frame is synchronized, the received CRC Multi-Frame alignment signals are compared with the expected one (‘001011’). If one
or more bits do not match, a single CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern error event is generated. During out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization
state, the CRC Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error detection is suspended.
= 0: No CRC Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error event is detected.
= 1: The CRC Multi-Frame Alignment Pattern Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CRCEI:
When CRC Multi-Frame is synchronized and the local calculated CRC-4 of the current received CRC Sub Multi-Frame does not match the
received CRC-4 of the next received CRC Sub Multi-Frame, a single CRC-4 error event is generated. During out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization
state, the CRC-4 Error detection is suspended.
= 0: No CRC-4 Error event is detected.
= 1: The CRC-4 Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
275
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
FERI:
When Basic frame is synchronized and the criteria set by the WORDERR bit (b3, E1-04EH,...) and the CNTNFAS bit (b4, E1-04EH,...) are met, a
FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error event is generated. During out of Basic frame synchronization state, the FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error detection is
suspended.
= 0: No FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error event is detected.
= 1: The FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
COFAI:
= 0: The Basic frame alignment pattern position is not changed.
= 1: The new-found Basic frame alignment pattern position differs from the previous one.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
E1 TS0 International / National (054H, 154H, 254H, 354H, 454H, 554H, 654H, 754H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
Si0
Si1
A
Sa4
Sa5
Sa6
Sa7
Sa8
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Si0:
This bit reflects the content in the International bit of the latest received NFAS frame. It is updated on the boundary of the associated NFAS frame
and is held during out of Basic frame state.
Si1:
This bit reflects the content in the International bit of the latest received FAS frame. It is updated on the boundary of the associated FAS frame and
is held during out of Basic frame state.
A:
This bit reflects the content in the Remote Alarm Indication bit of the latest received NFAS frame. It is updated on the boundary of the associated
NFAS frame and is held during out of Basic frame state.
Sa[4:8]:
These bits reflect the content in the National bit of the latest received NFAS frame. They are updated on the boundary of the associated NFAS
frame and are held during out of Basic frame state.
Programming Information
276
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TS16 Spare (055H, 155H, 255H, 355H, 455H, 555H, 655H, 755H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
X0
Y
X1
X2
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
X[0:2]:
These bits reflect the content in the Extra bits. They are updated at the first bit of the next CAS Signaling Multi-Frame and are held during out of
CAS Signaling Multi-Frame state.
Y:
This bit reflects the content in the Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication bit. It is updated at the first bit of the next CAS Signaling MultiFrame and is held during out of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame state.
E1 Sa4 Codeword (056H, 156H, 256H, 356H, 456H, 556H, 656H, 756H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa41
Sa42
Sa43
Sa44
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
Sa4[1:4]:
These bits reflect the content in the Sa4 National Bit codeword.
If de-bounce is enabled by the SaDEB bit (b6, E1-05CH,...), they are updated when the received Sa4 National Bit codeword is the same for 2
consecutive CRC Sub Multi-Frames. If de-bounce is disabled, they are updated every CRC Sub Multi-Frame. These bits are held during out of CRC
Multi-Frame synchronization state.
Programming Information
277
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Sa5 Codewo3rd (057H, 157H, 257H, 357H, 457H, 557H, 657H, 757H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa51
Sa52
Sa53
Sa54
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
Sa5[1:4]:
These bits reflect the content in the Sa5 National Bit codeword.
If de-bounce is enabled by the SaDEB bit (b6, E1-05CH,...), they are updated when the received Sa5 National Bit codeword is the same for 2
consecutive CRC Sub Multi-Frames. If de-bounce is disabled, they are updated every CRC Sub Multi-Frame. These bits are held during out of CRC
Multi-Frame synchronization state.
E1 Sa6 Codeword (058H, 158H, 258H, 358H, 458H, 558H, 658H, 758H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa61
Sa62
Sa63
Sa64
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
Sa6[1:4]:
These bits reflect the content in the Sa6 National Bit codeword.
If de-bounce is enabled by the SaDEB bit (b6, E1-05CH,...), they are updated when the received Sa6 National Bit codeword is the same for 2
consecutive CRC Sub Multi-Frames. If de-bounce is disabled, they are updated every CRC Sub Multi-Frame. These bits are held during out of CRC
Multi-Frame synchronization state.
E1 Sa7 Codeword (059H, 159H, 259H, 359H, 459H, 559H, 659H, 759H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa71
Sa72
Sa73
Sa74
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
Sa7[1:4]:
These bits reflect the content in the Sa7 National Bit codeword.
If de-bounce is enabled by the SaDEB bit (b6, E1-05CH,...), they are updated when the received Sa7 National Bit codeword is the same for 2
consecutive CRC Sub Multi-Frames. If de-bounce is disabled, they are updated every CRC Sub Multi-Frame. These bits are held during out of CRC
Multi-Frame synchronization state.
Programming Information
278
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Sa8 Codeword (05AH, 15AH, 25AH, 35AH, 45AH, 55AH, 65AH, 75AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
Sa81
Sa82
Sa83
Sa84
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
Sa8[1:4]:
These bits reflect the content in the Sa8 National Bit codeword.
If de-bounce is enabled by the SaDEB bit (b6, E1-05CH,...), they are updated when the received Sa8 National Bit codeword is the same for 2
consecutive CRC Sub Multi-Frames. If de-bounce is disabled, they are updated every CRC Sub Multi-Frame. These bits are held during out of CRC
Multi-Frame synchronization state.
E1 Sa6 Codeword Indication (05BH, 15BH, 25BH, 35BH, 45BH, 55BH, 65BH, 75BH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
Sa6-FI
Sa6-EI
Sa6-CI
Sa6-AI
Sa6-8I
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
Sa6-FI:
= 0: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are not matched with 0xFFF.
= 1: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are matched with 0xFFF.
Sa6-EI:
= 0: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are not matched with 0xEEE.
= 1: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are matched with 0xEEE.
Sa6-CI:
= 0: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are not matched with 0xCCC.
= 1: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are matched with 0xCCC.
Sa6-AI:
= 0: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are not matched with 0xAAA.
= 1: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are matched with 0xAAA.
Sa6-8I:
= 0: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are not matched with 0x888.
= 1: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are matched with 0x888.
Programming Information
279
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Sa Codeword Interrupt Control (05CH, 15CH, 25CH, 35CH, 45CH, 55CH, 65CH, 75CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
Sa6SYN
SaDEB
Sa6SCE
Sa4E
Sa5E
Sa6E
Sa7E
Sa8E
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sa6SYN:
= 0: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits are compared with 0x888, 0xAAA, 0xCCC, 0xEEE and 0xFFF when CRC Multi-Frame is synchronized.
= 1: Any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are compared with 0x888, 0xAAA, 0xCCC, 0xEEE and 0xFFF when CRC
Multi-Frame is synchronized.
SaDEB:
= 0: Disable the de-bounce function of the National Bit codeword extraction.
= 1: Enable the de-dounce function of the National Bit codeword extraction.
Sa6SCE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCAI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SCAI bit (b3, T1/J1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
Sa4E:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa4I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa4I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
Sa5E:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa5I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa5I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
Sa6E:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa6I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa6I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
Sa7E:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa7I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa7I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
Sa8E:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa8I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the Sa8I bit (b2, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
280
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Sa Codeword Interrupt Indication (05DH, 15DH, 25DH, 35DH, 45DH, 55DH, 65DH, 75DH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
2
1
0
Sa6SCI
Sa4I
Sa5I
Sa6I
Sa7I
Sa8I
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
Sa6SCI:
= 0: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are not matched with 0x888, 0xAAA,
0xCCC, 0xEEE or 0xFFF.
= 1: Any 12 consecutive Sa6 bits or any 3 consecutive 4-bit Sa6 codewords in the CRC Sub Multi-Frame are matched with 0x888, 0xAAA, 0xCCC,
0xEEE or 0xFFF.
Sa4I:
= 0: The value in the Sa4[1:4] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the Sa4[1:4] bits is changed.
Sa5I:
= 0: The value in the Sa5[1:4] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the Sa5[1:4] bits is changed.
Sa6I:
= 0: The value in the Sa6[1:4] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the Sa6[1:4] bits is changed.
Sa7I:
= 0: The value in the Sa7[1:4] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the Sa7[1:4] bits is changed.
Sa8I:
= 0: The value in the Sa8[1:4] bits is not changed.
= 1: The value in the Sa8[1:4] bits is changed.
Programming Information
281
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Overhead Error Status (05FH, 15FH, 25FH, 35FH, 45FH, 55FH, 65FH, 75FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
RAICRCV
CFEBEV
V52LINKV
R
R
R
0
0
0
RAICRCV:
The Continuous RAI & FEBE Error event is detected on the base of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization.
= 0: No Continuous RAI & FEBE Error event is detected.
= 1: The Continuous RAI & FEBE Error event is detected, i.e., a logic 1 is received in the A bit and a logic 0 is received in any of the E1 and E2 bits
for 10ms.
CFEBEV:
The Continuous FEBE Error event is detected on the base of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization.
= 0: No Continuous FEBE Error event is detected.
= 1: The Continuous FEBE Error event is detected, i.e., a logic 0 is received in any of the E1 or E2 bit on ≥ 990 occasions per second for the latest
5 consecutive seconds.
V52LINKV:
The V5.2 link ID signal can be received on the base of Basic Frame synchronization.
= 0: The V5.2 link ID signal is not received.
= 1: The V5.2 link ID signal is received, i.e., 2 out of 3 sliding Sa7 bits are logic 0s.
Programming Information
282
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Overhead Interrupt Control (060H, 160H, 260H, 360H, 460H, 560H, 660H, 760H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
TCRCEE
TFEBEE
FEBEE
RAICRCE
CFEBEE
V52LINKE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
TCRCEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCRCEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCRCEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
TFEBEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TFEBEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TFEBEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
FEBEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEBEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEBEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
RAICRCE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RAICRCI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RAICRCI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
CFEBEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CFEBEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CFEBEI bit (b3, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
V52LINKE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the V52LINKI bit (b0, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the V52LINKI bit (b0, E1-05DH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
283
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Overhead Interrupt Indication (061H, 161H, 261H, 361H, 461H, 561H, 661H, 761H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
TCRCEI
TFEBEI
FEBEI
RAICRCI
CFEBEI
V52LINKI
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
TCRCEI:
If the 4-bit Sa6 codeword of a CRC Sub Multi-Frame is matched with ‘0010’ or ‘0011’, the Network Terminal CRC Error event is generated.
= 0: No NT CRC Error event is detected.
= 1: The NT CRC Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
TFEBEI:
If the 4-bit Sa6 codeword of a CRC Sub Multi-Frame is matched with ‘0001’ or ‘0011’, the Network Terminal Far End Block Error event is generated.
= 0: No NT FEBE Error event is detected.
= 1: The NT FEBE Error event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
FEBEI:
When CRC Multi-Frame is synchronized and any of the CRC error indication (E1 or E2) bits is received as a logic 0, a far end block error event is
generated. During out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization state, the Far End Block Error (FEBE) detection is suspended.
= 0: No Far End Block Error (FEBE) event is detected.
= 1: The Far End Block Error (FEBE) event is detected.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RAICRCI:
= 0: There is no status change on the RAICRCV bit (b, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the RAICRCV bit (b2, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CFEBEI:
= 0: There is no status change on the CFEBEV bit (b, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the CFEBEV bit (b, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
V52LINKI:
= 0: There is no status change on the V52LINKV bit (b, E1-04FH,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the V52LINKV bit (b, E1-04FH,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
284
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Mode (062H, 162H, 262H, 362H, 462H, 562H, 662H, 762H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
XDIS
SiDIS
FEBEDIS
CRCM
SIGEN
GENCRC
FDIS
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
XDIS:
This bit is valid when the Signaling Multi-frame is generated.
= 0: The Extra bits (the Bit 5, 7 & 8 of TS16 of Frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame) are replaced by the value set in the X[0:2] bits (b3 & b1~0, E106AH,...).
= 1: Disable the Extra bits to be replaced by the value set in the X[0:2] bits (b3 & b1~0, E1-06AH,...).
SiDIS:
When the Basic frame is generated, this bit determines how to replace the International bit.
= 0: The International bit (Bit 1) of FAS frame and NFAS frame are replaced by the value set in the Si[1] (b0, E1-063H,...) and Si[0] bits (b1, E1063H,...) respectively.
= 1: Disable the International bit (Bit 1) of FAS frame and NFAS frame to be replaced by the value set in the Si[1] (b0, E1-063H,...) and Si[0] bits
(b1, E1-063H,...) respectively.
When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, this bit, together with the FEBEDIS bit (b4, E1-062H,...) and the OOCMFV bit (b2, E1-04FH,...), determines how to replace the E bit (refer to the description of the FEBEDIS bit).
FEBEDIS:
When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, this bit, together with the SiDIS bit (b5, E1-062H,...) and the OOCMFV bit (b2, E1-04FH,...), determines
how to replace the E bit.
FEBEDIS (b4, E1-062H,...)
OOCMFV (b2, E1-04FH,...)
SiDIS (b5, E1-062H,...)
E Bits Insertion
0
0
X
A single zero is inserted into the E bit when a CRC-4 Error event is
detected in the receive path. (the E1 bit corresponds to SMFI and the E2
bit corresponds to SMFII)
0
1
X
The value in the Si[1] bit (b0, E1-063H,...) is inserted into the E1 bit position. The value in the Si[0] bit (b1, E1-063H,...) is inserted into the E2 bit
position.
1
X
0
The value in the Si[1] bit (b0, E1-063H,...) is inserted into the E1 bit position. The value in the Si[0] bit (b1, E1-063H,...) is inserted into the E2 bit
position.
1
X
1
The E bit positions are unchanged.
CRCM, SIGEN, GENCRC:
These bits are valid when the FDIS bit (b0, E1-062H,...) is 0. They control what kind of frame is generated:
SIGEN =1: signaling multiframe enable.
GENCRC=1: CRC multiframe enable.
CRCM=1: Modified CRC multiframe. This bit is only valid when GENCRC=1.
FDIS:
= 0: Enable the generation of the Basic frame, CRC Multi-Frame and Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame.
= 1: Disable the generation of the Basic frame, CRC Multi-Frame and Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame.
Programming Information
285
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FGEN International Bit (063H, 163H, 263H, 363H, 463H, 563H, 663H, 763H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
Si0
Si1
R/W
R/W
1
1
Si0:
When the Basic frame is generated and the SiDIS bit (b5, E1-062H,...) is ‘0’, it contains the value to replace the International bit (Bit 1) of the NFAS
frame.
When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, controlled by the FEBEDIS bit (b4, E1-062H,...), the OOCMFV bit (b2, E1-04FH,...) bit and the SiDIS bit
(b5, E1-062H,...), it contains the value to replace the E2 bit.
Si1:
When the Basic frame is generated and the SiDIS bit (b5, E1-062H,...) is ‘0’, it contains the value to replace the International bit (Bit 1) of the FAS
frame.
When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, controlled by the FEBEDIS bit (b4, E1-062H,...), the OOCMFV bit (b2, E1-04FH,...) bit and the SiDIS bit
(b5, E1-062H,...), it contains the value to replace the E1 bit.
E1 FGEN Sa Control (064H, 164H, 264H, 364H, 464H, 564H, 664H, 764H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
Sa4EN
Sa5EN
Sa6EN
Sa7EN
Sa8EN
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
Sa4EN:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the Sa4[1:4] bits to be replaced by the value set in the Sa4[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-065H,...).
= 1: The Sa4[1:4] bits are replaced by the value set in the Sa4[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-065H,...).
Sa5EN:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the Sa5[1:4] bits to be replaced by the value set in the Sa5[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-066H,...).
= 1: The Sa5[1:4] bits are replaced by the value set in the Sa5[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-066H,...).
Sa6EN:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the Sa6[1:4] bits to be replaced by the value set in the Sa6[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-067H,...).
= 1: The Sa6[1:4] bits are replaced by the value set in the Sa6[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-067H,...).
Sa7EN:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the Sa7[1:4] bits to be replaced by the value set in the Sa7[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-068H,...).
= 1: The Sa7[1:4] bits are replaced by the value set in the Sa7[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-068H,...).
Programming Information
286
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Sa8EN:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the Sa8[1:4] bits to be replaced by the value set in the Sa8[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-069H,...).
= 1: The Sa8[1:4] bits are replaced by the value set in the Sa8[1:4] bits (b3~0, E1-069H,...).
Programming Information
287
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Sa4 Code-word (065H, 165H, 265H, 365H, 465H, 565H, 665H, 765H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa41
Sa42
Sa43
Sa44
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
1
1
1
Sa4[1:4]:
These bits are valid when the Basic frame is generated and the Sa4EN bit (b4, E1-064H,...) is ‘1’. When only the Basic frame is generated, the
value in the Sa4[1] bit replaces the Sa4 bit. When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, they contain the value to replace the Sa4[1:4] bits.
E1 Sa5 Code-word (066H, 166H, 266H, 366H, 466H, 566H, 666H, 766H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa51
Sa52
Sa53
Sa54
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
1
1
1
Sa5[1:4]:
These bits are valid when the Basic frame is generated and the Sa5EN bit (b3, E1-064H,...) is ‘1’. When only the Basic frame is generated, the
value in the Sa5[1] bit replaces the Sa5 bit. When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, they contain the value to replace the Sa5[1:4] bits.
E1 Sa6 Code-word (067H, 167H, 267H, 367H, 467H, 567H, 667H, 767H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa61
Sa62
Sa63
Sa64
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
1
1
1
Sa6[1:4]:
These bits are valid when the Basic frame is generated and the Sa6EN bit (b2, E1-064H,...) is ‘1’. When only the Basic frame is generated, the
value in the Sa6[1] bit replaces the Sa6 bit. When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, they contain the value to replace the Sa6[1:4] bits.
E1 Sa7 Code-word (068H, 168H, 268H, 368H, 468H, 568H, 668H, 768H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa71
Sa72
Sa73
Sa74
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
1
1
1
Sa7[1:4]:
These bits are valid when the Basic frame is generated and the Sa7EN bit (b1, E1-064H,...) is ‘1’. When only the Basic frame is generated, the
value in the Sa7[1] bit replaces the Sa7 bit. When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, they contain the value to replace the Sa7[1:4] bits.
Programming Information
288
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Sa8 Code-word (069H, 169H, 269H, 369H, 469H, 569H, 669H, 769H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
Sa81
Sa82
Sa83
Sa84
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
1
1
1
1
Sa8[1:4]:
These bits are valid when the Basic frame is generated and the Sa8EN bit (b0, E1-064H,...) is ‘1’. When only the Basic frame is generated, the
value in the Sa8[1] bit replaces the Sa8 bit. When the CRC Multi-frame is generated, they contain the value to replace the Sa8[1:4] bits.
E1 FGEN Extra (06AH, 16AH, 26AH, 36AH, 46AH, 56AH, 66AH, 76AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
X0
Reserved
R/W
Default
1
Reserved
1
0
X1
X2
R/W
R/W
1
1
X[0:2]:
These bits are valid when the Signaling Multi-frame is generated and the XDIS bit (b6, E1-062H,...) is ‘0’. They contain the value to replace the
Extra bits (the Bit 5, 7 & 8 of TS16 of Frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame).
Programming Information
289
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FGEN Maintenance 0 (06BH, 16BH, 26BH, 36BH, 46BH, 56BH, 66BH, 76BH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
TS16LOS
TS16AIS
MFAIS
G706RAI
AUTOYELLOW
REMAIS
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
TS16LOS:
= 0: Normal operation.
= 1: The data stream to be transmitted on TS16 is overwritten with all zeros.
TS16AIS:
= 0: Normal operation.
= 1: The data stream to be transmitted on TS16 is overwritten with all ‘One’s.
MFAIS:
This bit is valid when the Signaling Multi-Frame is generated. The value in this bit will be continuously transmitted in the Y bit position (the Bit 6 of
TS16 of Frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame).
G706RAI:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated. It selects the criteria for automatic RAI transmission.
= 0: The RAI is transmitted automatically when: 1). out of Basic frame sync is declared in the receive path; 2). the receive path is operated in CRC4 to non-CRC-4 inter-working mode; 3). the offline searching in the receive path is out of Basic Frame sync; 4). the REMAIS bit (b0, E1-06BH,...) is
1.
= 1: The RAI is transmitted automatically when: 1). out of Basic frame sync is declared in the receive path; 2). the REMAIS bit (b0, E1-06BH,...) is
1.
AUTOYELLOW:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the automatic RAI transmission.
= 1: The Remote Alarm Indication (RAI) is automatically transmitted as logic 1 in the A bit position when conditions meet the criteria selected by the
G706RAI bit (b2, E1-06BH,...).
REMAIS:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the manual RAI transmission.
= 1: The Remote Alarm Indication (RAI) is manually transmitted as logic 1 in the A bit position.
Programming Information
290
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FGEN Maintenance 1 (06CH, 16CH, 26CH, 36CH, 46CH, 56CH, 66CH, 76CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
COFAEN
TXDIS
TAIS
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
COFAEN:
Any transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on this bit will lead to one bit deletion or one bit repetition in the data stream to be transmitted, that is,
to change the frame alignment position. The one bit deletion or repetition occurs randomly.
TXDIS:
= 0: Normal operation.
= 1: The data stream to be transmitted is overwritten with all ‘Zero’s.
TAIS:
= 0: Normal operation.
= 1: The data stream to be transmitted is overwritten with all ‘One’s.
E1 FGEN Interrupt Control (06DH, 16DH, 26DH, 36DH, 46DH, 56DH, 66DH, 76DH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
SMFE
FASE
SIGMFE
MFE
BFE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
SMFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SMFI bit (b4, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SMFI bit (b4, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
FASE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FASI bit (b3, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FASI bit (b3, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
SIGMFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SIGMFI bit (b2, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SIGMFI bit (b2, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
MFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the MFI bit (b1, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the MFI bit (b1, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
BFE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BFI bit (b0, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BFI bit (b0, E1-06EH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
291
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FGEN Interrupt Indication (06EH, 16EH, 26EH, 36EH, 46EH, 56EH, 66EH, 76EH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
SMFI
FASI
SIGMFI
MFI
BFI
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
SMFI:
= 0: The bit input to the Frame Generator is not the first bit of each CRC Sub Multi-Frame.
= 1: The first bit of each CRC Sub Multi-Frame is input to the Frame Generator.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
FASI:
= 0: The bit input to the Frame Generator is not the first bit of each FAS.
= 1: The first bit of each FAS is input to the Frame Generator.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
SIGMFI:
= 0: The bit input to the Frame Generator is not the first bit of each Signaling Multi-Frame.
= 1: The first bit of each Signaling Multi-Frame is input to the Frame Generator.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
MFI:
= 0: The bit input to the Frame Generator is not the first bit of each CRC Multi-Frame.
= 1: The first bit of each CRC Multi-Frame is input to the Frame Generator.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
BFI:
= 0: The bit input to the Frame Generator is not the first bit of each Basic frame.
= 1: The first bit of each Basic frame is input to the Frame Generator.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
292
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Error Insertion (06FH, 16FH, 26FH, 36FH, 46FH, 56FH, 66FH, 76FH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
5
4
3
2
1
0
CRCINV
CRCPINV
CASPINV
NFASINV
FASALLINV
FAS1INV
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
Default
CRCINV:
This bit is valid when the CRC Multi-frame or the Modified CRC Multi-frame is generated.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert all 4 calculated CRC bits in one Sub-Multi-Frame.
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
CRCPINV:
This bit is valid when the CRC Multi-frame is generated.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one 6-bit CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern (‘001011’).
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
CASPINV:
This bit is valid when the CAS Multi-frame is generated.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one 4-bit Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern (‘0000’).
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
NFASINV:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one NFAS bit (the Bit 2 of TS0 of each odd frame).
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
FASALLINV:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one 7-bit FAS pattern (the Bit 2 ~ Bit 8 of TS0 of each even frame).
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
FAS1INV:
This bit is valid when the Basic frame is generated.
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit will invert one FAS bit (the Bit 2 ~ Bit 8 of TS0 of each even frame).
This bit is cleared when the inversion is completed.
Programming Information
293
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Transmit Timing Option (070H, 170H, 270H, 370H, 470H, 570H, 670H, 770H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
XTS
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
0
XTS:
In Transmit Clock Master mode:
= 0: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the clock generated by the internal clock generator (2.048 MHz).
= 1: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the recovered clock from the line side.
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the Transmit Buffer is bypassed automatically.
In Transmit Clock Slave mode and in Transmit Multiplexed mode:
= 0: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the clock from the backplane. The Transmit Buffer is bypassed.
= 1: The source of the transmit clock is selected from the clock generated by the internal clock generator (2.048 MHz). The Transmit Buffer is not
bypassed.
E1 PRGD Control (071H, 171H, 271H, 371H, 471H, 571H, 671H, 771H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
RINV
TINV
PATS1
PATS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
RINV:
= 0: The data is not inverted before extracted to the pattern detector.
= 1: The data is inverted before extracted to the pattern detector.
TINV:
= 0: The generated pattern is not inverted.
= 1: The generated pattern is inverted.
PATS[1:0]:
These bits select the PRBS generated and detected pattern.
= 00: The 215-1 pattern per O.152 is selected.
= 01: The 220-1 pattern per O.150-4.5 is selected.
= 10: The 211-1 pattern per O.150 is selected.
= 11: Reserved.
Programming Information
294
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 PRGD Status/Error Control (072H, 172H, 272H, 372H, 472H, 572H, 672H, 772H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
BERE
INV
SYNCV
SYNCE
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
BERE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BERI bit (b3, E1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the BERI bit (b3, E1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
INV:
= 0: No bit error is inserted to the generated pattern.
= 1: A single bit error is inserted to the generated pattern.
This bit is cleared after the single bit error insertion is completed.
SYNCV:
= 0: The pattern is out of synchronization (the pattern detector has detected 10 or more bit errors in a fixed 48-bit window).
= 1: The pattern is in synchronization (the pattern detector has detected at least 48 consecutive error-free bit periods).
SYNCE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI bit (b0, E1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI bit (b0, E1-073H,...) is ‘1’.
E1 PRGD Interrupt Indication (073H, 173H, 273H, 373H, 473H, 573H, 673H, 773H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
BERI
Reserved
R
Default
0
SYNCI
Reserved
0
R
0
BERI:
= 0: No bit is mismatched with the PRGD pattern when the extracted data is in synchronization state.
= 1: At least one bit is mismatched with the PRGD pattern when the extracted data is in synchronization state.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
SYNCI:
= 0: There is no status change on the SYNCV bit (b1, E1-072H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the SYNCV bit (b1, E1-072H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
295
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 ELST Configuration (07CH, 17CH, 27CH, 37CH, 47CH, 57CH, 67CH, 77CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
TRKEN
SLIPD
SLIPE
R/W
R
R/W
0
0
0
TRKEN:
In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, if it is out of synchronization, the trunk code programmed in the TRKCODE[7:0] bits
(b7~0, E1-07EH,...) can be set to replace the data or not.
= 0: Disable the replacement.
= 1: Enable the replacement.
SLIPD:
This bit makes sense only when the SLIPI bit (b0, E1-07DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 0: The latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being empty.
= 1: The latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being full.
SLIPE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SLIPI bit (b0, E1-07DH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SLIPI bit (b0, E1-07DH,...) is ‘1’.
E1 ELST Interrupt Indication (07DH, 17DH, 27DH, 37DH, 47DH, 57DH, 67DH, 77DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
SLIPI
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
SLIPI:
= 0: No slip occurs.
= 1: A slip occurs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
E1 ELST Trunk Code (07EH, 17EH, 27EH, 37EH, 47EH, 57EH, 67EH, 77EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
TRKCODE7
TRKCODE6
TRKCODE5
TRKCODE4
TRKCODE3
TRKCODE2
TRKCODE1
TRKCODE0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
TRKCODE[7:0]:
In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, if it is out of synchronization and the TRKEN bit (b2, E1-07CH,...) is ‘1’, these bits
are the trunk codes to replace the received data stream.
Programming Information
296
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 THDLC Enable Control (084H, 184H, 284H, 384H, 484H, 584H, 684H, 784H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
TDLEN3
TDLEN2
TDLEN1
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
TDLEN3:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #3 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #3 is enabled.
TDLEN2:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #2 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #2 is enabled.
TDLEN1:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #1 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Transmitter #1 is enabled.
E1 THDLC1 Assignment (085H, 185H, 285H, 385H, 485H, 585H, 685H, 785H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 THDLC2 Assignment (086H, 186H, 286H, 386H, 486H, 586H, 686H, 786H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
Programming Information
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
297
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 THDLC3 Assignment (087H, 187H, 287H, 387H, 487H, 587H, 687H, 787H)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
EVEN:
= 0: The data is not inserted to the even frames.
= 1: The data is inserted to the even frames.
ODD:
= 0: The data is not inserted to the odd frames.
= 1: The data is inserted to the odd frames.
TS[4:0]:
These bits binary define one timeslot of even and/or odd frames to insert the data to. They are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are both
‘0’.
E1 THDLC1 Bit Select (088H, 188H, 288H, 388H, 488H, 588H, 688H, 788H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 THDLC2 Bit Select (089H, 189H, 289H, 389H, 489H, 589H, 689H, 789H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Programming Information
298
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 THDLC3 Bit Select (08AH, 18AH, 28AH, 38AH, 48AH, 58AH, 68AH, 78AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
RDLEN3
RDLEN2
RDLEN1
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
BITENn:
= 0: The data is not inserted to the corresponding bit.
= 1: The data is inserted to the corresponding bit of the assigned timeslot.
These bits are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are both logic 0.
The BITEN[7] bit corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected timeslot.
E1 RHDLC Enable Control (08BH, 18BH, 28BH, 38BH, 48BH, 58BH, 68BH, 78BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
RDLEN3:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #3 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #3 is enabled.
RDLEN2:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #2 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #2 is enabled.
RDLEN1:
= 0: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #1 is disabled.
= 1: All the functions of the HDLC Receiver #1 is enabled.
Programming Information
299
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 Assignment (08CH, 18CH, 28CH, 38CH, 48CH, 58CH, 68CH, 78CH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Default
E1 RHDLC2 Assignment (08DH, 18DH, 28DH, 38DH, 48DH, 58DH, 68DH, 78DH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Default
E1 RHDLC3 Assignment (08EH, 18EH, 28EH, 38EH, 48EH, 58EH, 68EH, 78EH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EVEN
ODD
TS4
TS3
TS2
TS1
TS0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
EVEN:
= 0: The data is not extracted from the even frames.
= 1: The data is extracted from the even frames.
The even frames are FAS frames.
ODD:
= 0: The data is not extracted from the odd frames.
= 1: The data is extracted from the odd frames.
The odd frames are NFAS frames.
TS[4:0]:
These bits binary define one timeslot of even and/or odd frames to extract the data from. They are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are
both ‘0’.
Programming Information
300
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 Bit Select (08FH, 18FH, 28FH, 38FH, 48FH, 58FH, 68FH, 78FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC2 Bit Select (090H, 190H, 290H, 390H, 490H, 590H, 690H, 790H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC3 Bit Select (091H, 191H, 291H, 391H, 491H, 591H, 691H, 791H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
BITEN7
BITEN6
BITEN5
BITEN4
BITEN3
BITEN2
BITEN1
BITEN0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
BITENn:
= 0: The data is not extracted from the corresponding bit.
= 1: The data is extracted from the corresponding bit of the assigned channel.
These bits are invalid when the EVEN bit and the ODD bit are both logic 0.
The BITEN[7] bit corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected channel.
E1 RHDLC1 Control Register (092H, 192H, 292H, 392H, 492H, 592H, 692H, 792H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
Programming Information
301
3
2
1
0
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC2 Control Register (093H, 193H, 293H, 393H, 493H, 593H, 693H, 793H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
0
ADRM1
ADRM0
RHDLCM
RRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC3 Control Register (094H, 194H, 294H, 394H, 494H, 594H, 694H, 794H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
ADRM[1:0]:
These two bits select the address comparison mode in HDLC mode.
= 00: No address is compared.
= 01: High byte address is compared.
= 10: Low byte address is compared.
= 11: Both high byte address and low byte address are compared.
RHDLCM:
= 0: HDLC mode is selected.
= 1: Reserved.
RRST:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the this bit will reset the corresponding HDLC Receiver. The reset will clear the FIFO, the PACK bit (b0, E1-095H,... /
096H,... / 097H,...) and the EMP bit (b1, E1-095H,... / 096H,... / 097H,...).
Programming Information
302
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 RFIFO Access Status (095H, 195H, 295H, 395H, 495H, 595H, 695H, 795H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
EMP
PACK
R
R
1
0
1
0
EMP
PACK
R
R
1
0
1
0
EMP
PACK
R
R
1
0
E1 RHDLC2 RFIFO Access Status (096H, 196H, 296H, 396H, 496H, 596H, 696H, 796H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
E1 RHDLC3 RFIFO Access Status (097H, 197H, 297H, 397H, 497H, 597H, 697H, 797H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
EMP:
= 0: The FIFO is not empty.
= 1: The FIFO is empty, i.e., all the blocks are read from the FIFO.
The corresponding HDLC Receiver reset will clear this bit.
PACK:
= 0: The byte read from the FIFO is not an overhead byte.
= 1: The byte read from the FIFO is an overhead byte.
The corresponding HDLC Receiver reset will clear this bit.
Programming Information
303
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 Data (098H, 198H, 298H, 398H, 498H, 598H, 698H, 798H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC2 Data (099H, 199H, 299H, 399H, 499H, 599H, 699H, 799H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC3 Data (09AH, 19AH, 29AH, 39AH, 49AH, 59AH, 69AH, 79AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
DAT[7:0]:
These bits represent the bytes read from the FIFO. The DAT[0] bit corresponds to the first bit of the serial received data from the FIFO.
Programming Information
304
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 Interrupt Control (09BH, 19BH, 29BH, 39BH, 49BH, 59BH, 69BH, 79BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
OVFLE
RMBEE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
OVFLE
RMBEE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
OVFLE
RMBEE
R/W
R/W
0
0
E1 RHDLC2 Interrupt Control (09CH, 19CH, 29CH, 39CH, 49CH, 59CH, 69CH, 79CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
E1 RHDLC3 Interrupt Control (09DH, 19DH, 29DH, 39DH, 49DH, 59DH, 69DH, 79DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
OVFLE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVFLI bit (b1, E1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVFLI bit (b1, E1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
RMBEE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMBEI bit (b0, E1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMBEI bit (b0, E1-09EH,... / 09FH,... / 0A0H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
305
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 Interrupt Indication (09EH, 19EH, 29EH, 39EH, 49EH, 59EH, 69EH, 79EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
OVFLI
RMBEI
R
R
0
0
1
0
OVFLI
RMBEI
R
R
0
0
1
0
OVFLI
RMBEI
R
R
0
0
E1 RHDLC2 Interrupt Indication (09FH, 19FH, 29FH, 39FH, 49FH, 59FH, 69FH, 79FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
E1 RHDLC3 Interrupt Indication (0A0H, 1A0H, 2A0H, 3A0H, 4A0H, 5A0H, 6A0H, 7A0H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
OVFLI:
The overwritten condition will occur if data is still attempted to write into the FIFO when the FIFO has already been full (128 bytes).
= 0: No overwriting occurs.
= 1: The overwriting occurs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RMBEI:
= 0: No block is pushed into the FIFO.
= 1: A block of the HDLC packet is pushed into the FIFO.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
306
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 High Address (0A1H, 1A1H, 2A1H, 3A1H, 4A1H, 5A1H, 6A1H, 7A1H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC2 High Address (0A2H, 1A2H, 2A2H, 3A2H, 4A2H, 5A2H, 6A2H, 7A2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC3 High Address (0A3H, 1A3H, 2A3H, 3A3H, 4A3H, 5A3H, 6A3H, 7A3H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
HA[7:0]:
In HDLC mode, when high byte address comparison or both bytes address comparison is required, the high byte address position (the byte
following the opening flag) is compared with the value in these bits, or with ‘0xFC’ or ‘0xFE’. The HA[1] bit (the ‘C/R’ bit position) is excluded to
compare.
Programming Information
307
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RHDLC1 Low Address (0A4H, 1A4H, 2A4H, 3A4H, 4A4H, 5A4H, 6A4H, 7A4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC2 Low Address (0A5H, 1A5H, 2A5H, 3A5H, 4A5H, 5A5H, 6A5H, 7A5H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 RHDLC3 Low Address (0A6H, 1A6H, 2A6H, 3A6H, 4A6H, 5A6H, 6A6H, 7A6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LA7
LA6
LA5
LA4
LA3
LA2
LA1
LA0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different RHDLC.
LA[7:0]:
In HDLC mode, when low byte address comparison is required, the high byte address position (the byte following the opening flag) is compared
with the value in these bits. When both bytes address comparison is required, the low byte address position (the byte following the high byte address
position) is compared with the value in these bits.
E1 THDLC1 Control (0A7H, 1A7H, 2A7H, 3A7H, 4A7H, 5A7H, 6A7H, 7A7H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Default
Programming Information
5
4
3
EOM
Reserved
R/W
0
308
Reserved
2
1
0
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 THDLC2 Control (0A8H, 1A8H, 2A8H, 3A8H, 4A8H, 5A8H, 6A8H, 7A8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
4
3
EOM
Type
Reserved
R/W
Default
Reserved
0
2
1
0
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
2
1
0
ABORT
THDLCM
TRST
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
E1 THDLC3 Control (0A9H, 1A9H, 2A9H, 3A9H, 4A9H, 5A9H, 6A9H, 7A9H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
5
4
3
EOM
Reserved
Default
R/W
Reserved
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
EOM:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit indicates an entire HDLC packet is stored in the FIFO and starts the packet transmission.
ABORT:
= 0: Disable the manual abort sequence insertion.
= 1: The abort sequence (‘01111111’) is manually inserted to the current HDLC packet.
This bit is self-cleared after the abortion.
THDLCM:
= 0: HDLC mode is selected.
= 1: Reserved.
TRST:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the this bit resets the corresponding HDLC Transmitter. The reset will clear the FIFO.
Programming Information
309
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TFIFO1 Threshold (0AAH, 1AAH, 2AAH, 3AAH, 4AAH, 5AAH, 6AAH, 7AAH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
3
2
1
0
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
3
2
1
0
LL1
LL0
HL1
HL0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
1
E1 TFIFO2 Threshold (0ABH, 1ABH, 2ABH, 3ABH, 4ABH, 5ABH, 6ABH, 7ABH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
E1 TFIFO3 Threshold (0ACH, 1ACH, 2ACH, 3ACH, 4ACH, 5ACH, 6ACH, 7ACH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
LL[1:0]:
These 2 bits set the lower threshold of the FIFO. If the fill level is below the lower threshold, an interrupt may be generated.
= 00: 16 bytes
= 01: 32 bytes
= 10: 64 bytes
= 11: 96 bytes
HL[1:0]:
These 2 bits set the upper threshold of the FIFO. Once the fill level exceeds the upper threshold, the data stored in the FIFO will start to be transmitted.
= 00: 16 bytes
= 01: 32 bytes
= 10: 64 bytes
= 11: 128 bytes
Programming Information
310
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 THDLC1 Data (0ADH, 1ADH, 2ADH, 3ADH, 4ADH, 5ADH, 6ADH, 7ADH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 THDLC2 Data (0AEH, 1AEH, 2AEH, 3AEH, 4AEH, 5AEH, 6AEH, 7AEH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
E1 THDLC3 Data (0AFH, 1AFH, 2AFH, 3AFH, 4AFH, 5AFH, 6AFH, 7AFH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
DAT[7:0]:
The bytes are to be stored in the FIFO. The DAT[0] bit corresponds to the first bit of the serial data in the FIFO to be transmitted.
Programming Information
311
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TFIFO1 Status (0B0H, 1B0H, 2B0H, 3B0H, 4B0H, 5B0H, 6B0H, 7B0H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
FUL
EMP
RDY
R
R
R
0
1
1
2
1
0
FUL
EMP
RDY
R
R
R
0
1
1
2
1
0
FUL
EMP
RDY
R
R
R
0
1
1
E1 TFIFO2 Status (0B1H, 1B1H, 2B1H, 3B1H, 4B1H, 5B1H, 6B1H, 7B1H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
E1 TFIFO3 Status (0B2H, 1B2H, 2B2H, 3B2H, 4B2H, 5B2H, 6B2H, 7B2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
FUL:
= 0: The FIFO is not full.
= 1: The FIFO is full of 128 bytes.
EMP:
= 0: The FIFO is not empty.
= 1: The FIFO is empty.
RDY:
= 0: The fill level of the FIFO is not below the lower threshold set by the LL[1:0] bits (b3~2, E1-0AAH,... / 0AB,... / 0ACH,...).
= 1: The fill level of the FIFO is below the lower threshold set by the LL[1:0] bits (b3~2, E1-0AAH,... / 0ABH,... / 0ACH,...).
Programming Information
312
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 THDLC1 Interrupt Control (0B3H, 1B3H, 2B3H, 3B3H, 4B3H, 5B3H, 6B3H, 7B3H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
UDRUNE
RDYE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
UDRUNE
RDYE
R/W
R/W
0
0
1
0
UDRUNE
RDYE
R/W
R/W
0
0
E1 THDLC2 Interrupt Control (0B4H, 1B4H, 2B4H, 3B4H, 4B4H, 5B4H, 6B4H, 7B4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
E1 THDLC3 Interrupt Control (0B5H, 1B5H, 2B5H, 3B5H, 4B5H, 5B5H, 6B5H, 7B5H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
UDRUNE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRUNI bit (b1, E1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRUNI bit (b1, E1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
RDYE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RDYI bit (b0, E1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RDYI bit (b0, E1-0B6H,... / 0B7H,... / 0B8H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
313
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 THDLC1 Interrupt Indication (0B6H, 1B6H, 2B6H, 3B6H, 4B6H, 5B6H, 6B6H, 7B6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
UDRUNI
RDYI
R
R
0
0
1
0
UDRUNI
RDYI
R
R
0
0
1
0
UDRUNI
RDYI
R
R
0
0
E1 THDLC2 Interrupt Indication (0B7H, 1B7H, 2B7H, 3B7H, 4B7H, 5B7H, 6B7H, 7B7H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
E1 THDLC3 Interrupt Indication (0B8H, 1B8H, 2B8H, 3B8H, 4B8H, 5B8H, 6B8H, 7B8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
The function of the above three sets of registers are the same. However, they correspond to different THDLC.
UDRUNI:
When the FIFO is empty and the last transmitted byte is not the end of the current HDLC packet, the under-run occurs. This bit indicates whether
the under-run occurs.
= 0: No under-run occurs.
= 1: Under-run occurs.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RDYI:
= 0: There is no status change on the RDY bit (b0, E1-0B0H,... / 0B1H,... / 0B2H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’) on the RDY bit (b0, E1-0B0H,... / 0B1H,... / 0B2H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
314
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Alarm Status (0B9H, 1B9H, 2B9H, 3B9H, 4B9H, 5B9H, 6B9H, 7B9H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
TS16LOSV
TS16AISV
RMAIV
AIS
RAIV
RED
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
TS16LOSV:
The LOS in TS16 is detected on the base of Basic frame synchronization.
= 0: The LOS in TS16 is cleared when 16 consecutive TS16 are not all received as ‘0’.
= 1: The LOS in TS16 is detected when 16 consecutive TS16 are all received as ‘0’.
TS16AISV:
The AIS in TS16 is detected on the base of Basic frame synchronization.
= 0: The AIS in TS16 is cleared when TS16 contains more than 3 zeros in a 16-consecutive-Basic-frame period.
= 1: The AIS in TS16 is detected when TS16 contains less than 4 zeros in each of two 16-consecutive-Basic-frame periods.
RMAIV:
The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm is detected on the base of CAS Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization.
= 0: The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm is cleared when a single Y bit is received as ‘0’.
= 1: The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm is detected when 3 consecutive Y bits are received as ‘1’.
AIS:
= 0: The AIS alarm is cleared. That is, when the AISC bit (b1, E1-0BCH,...) is ‘0’, more than 2 zeros are detected in a 512-bit fixed window; when
the AISC bit (b1, E1-0BCH,...) is ‘1’, more than 2 zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit fixed window.
= 1: The AIS alarm is detected. That is, when the AISC bit (b1, E1-0BCH,...) is ‘0’, less than 3 zeros are detected in a 512-bit fixed window and it is
out of Basic frame synchronization; when the AISC bit (b1, E1-0BCH,...) is ‘1’, less than 3 zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit fixed
window.
RAIV:
The Remote alarm is detected on the base of Basic frame synchronization.
= 0: The Remote alarm is cleared. That is, when the RAIC bit (b0, E1-0BCH,...) is ‘0’, a single A bit is received as ‘0’; when the RAIC bit (b0, E10BCH,...) is ‘1’, a single A bit is received as ‘0’.
= 1: The Remote alarm is detected. That is, when the RAIC bit (b0, E1-0BCH,...) is ‘0’, 4 consecutive A bits are received as ‘1’; when the RAIC bit
(b0, E1-0BCH,...) is ‘1’, a single A bit is received as ‘1’.
RED:
= 0: The RED alarm is cleared when in Basic frame synchronization persists for 100ms.
= 1: The RED alarm is detected when out of Basic frame synchronization persists for 100ms.
Programming Information
315
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Alarm Control (0BAH, 1BAH, 2BAH, 3BAH, 4BAH, 5BAH, 6BAH, 7BAH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
TS16LOSE
TS16AISE
RMAIE
AISE
RAIE
REDE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
TS16LOSE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TS16LOSI bit (b5, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TS16LOSI bit (b5, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
TS16AISE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TS16AISI bit (b4, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TS16AISI bit (b4, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
RMAIE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMAII bit (b3, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMAII bit (b3, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
AISE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI bit (b2, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI bit (b2, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
RAIE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RAII bit (b1, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RAII bit (b1, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
REDE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI bit (b0, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI bit (b0, E1-0BBH,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
316
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Alarm Indication (0BBH, 1BBH, 2BBH, 3BBH, 4BBH, 5BBH, 6BBH, 7BBH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
TS16LOSI
TS16AISI
RMAII
AISI
RAII
REDI
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
TS16LOSI:
= 0: There is no status change on the TS16LOSV bit (b5, E1-0B9H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the TS16LOSV bit (b5, E1-0B9H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
TS16AISI:
= 0: There is no status change on the TS16AISV bit (b4, E1-0B9H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the TS16AISV bit (b4, E1-0B9H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RMAII:
= 0: There is no status change on the RMAIV bit (b3, E1-0B9H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the RMAIV bit (b3, E1-0B9H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
AISI:
= 0: There is no status change on the AIS bit (b2, E1-0B9H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the AIS bit (b2, E1-0B9H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
RAII:
= 0: There is no status change on the RAIV bit (b1, E1-0B9H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the RAIV bit (b1, E1-0B9H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
REDI:
= 0: There is no status change on the RED bit (b0, E1-0B9H,...).
= 1: There is a transition (from ‘0’ to ‘1’ or from ‘1’ to ‘0’) on the RED bit (b0, E1-0B9H,...).
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
317
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Alarm Criteria Control (0BCH, 1BCH, 2BCH, 3BCH, 4BCH, 5BCH, 6BCH, 7BCH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
AISC
RAIC
R/W
R/W
0
0
AISC:
This bit selects the AIS alarm detection criteria.
= 0: The criterion meets I.431. The AIS alarm will be declared when less than 3 zeros are detected in a 512-bit fixed window and it is out of Basic
frame synchronization, and the AIS alarm will be cleared when more than 2 zeros are detected in a 512-bit fixed window.
= 1: The criterion meets G.775. The AIS alarm will be declared when less than 3 zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit fixed window,
and the AIS alarm will be cleared when more than 2 zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit fixed window.
RAIC:
This bit selects the Remote alarm detection criterion.
= 0: The Remote alarm will be declared when 4 consecutive A bits are received as ‘1’, and the Remote alarm will be cleared when a single A bit is
received as ‘0’.
= 1: The Remote alarm will be declared when a single A bit is received as ‘1’, and the Remote alarm will be cleared when a single A bit is received
as ‘0’.
E1 PMON Control (0C2H, 1C2H, 2C2H, 3C2H, 4C2H, 5C2H, 6C2H, 7C2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
2
1
0
UPDAT
AUTOUPD
R/W
R/W
0
0
UPDAT:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit updates all the PMON indirect registers.
AUTOUPD:
= 0: Disable the automatic update function of the PMON indirect registers.
= 1: All the PMON indirect registers are updated every one second automatically.
Programming Information
318
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 PMON Interrupt Control 0 (0C3H, 1C3H, 2C3H, 3C3H, 4C3H, 5C3H, 6C3H, 7C3H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
PRDGOVE
TFEBEOVE
FEBEOVE
TCRCOVE
COFAOVE
OOFOVE
FEROVE
CRCOVE
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
PRDGOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the PRDGOVI bit (b7, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the PRDGOVI bit (b7, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
TFEBEOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TFEBEOVI bit (b6, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TFEBEOVI bit (b6, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
FEBEOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEBEOVI bit (b5, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEBEOVI bit (b5, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
TCRCOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCRCOVI bit (b4, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the TCRCOVI bit (b4, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
COFAOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAOVI bit (b3, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the COFAOVI bit (b3, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
OOFOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFOVI bit (b2, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFOVI bit (b2, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
FEROVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEROVI bit (b1, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEROVI bit (b1, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
CRCOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CRCOVI bit (b0, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the CRCOVI bit (b0, E1-0C5H,...) is ‘1’.
E1 PMON Interrupt Control 1 (0C4H, 1C4H, 2C4H, 3C4H, 4C4H, 5C4H, 6C4H, 7C4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
LCVOVE
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
LCVOVE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LCVOVI bit (b0, E1-0C6H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LCVOVI bit (b0, E1-0C6H,...) is ‘1’.
Programming Information
319
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 PMON Interrupt Indication 0 (0C5H, 1C5H, 2C5H, 3C5H, 4C5H, 5C5H, 6C5H, 7C5H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
PRDGOVI
TFEBEOVI
FEBEOVI
TCRCOVI
COFAOVI
OOFOVI
FEROVI
CRCOVI
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PRDGOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect PRGD Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect PRGD Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
TFEBEOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect TFEBE Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect TFEBE Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
FEBEOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect FEBE Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect FEBE Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
TCRCOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect DDSE Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect DDSE Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
COFAOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect COFA Counter Mapping register has not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect COFA Counter Mapping register has overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
OOFOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect OOF Counter Mapping register has not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect OOF Counter Mapping register has overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
FEROVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect FER Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect FER Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
CRCOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect CRCE Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect CRCE Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
Programming Information
320
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 PMON Interrupt Indication 1 (0C6H, 1C6H, 2C6H, 3C6H, 4C6H, 5C6H, 6C6H, 7C6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
LCVOVI
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
LCVOVI:
= 0: The PMON indirect LCV Counter Mapping registers have not overflowed.
= 1: The PMON indirect LCV Counter Mapping registers have overflowed.
This bit will be cleared if a ’1’ is written to it.
E1 TPLC / RPLC / PRGD Test Configuration (0C7H, 1C7H, 2C7H, 3C7H, 4C7H, 5C7H, 6C7H, 7C7H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
3
2
1
0
PRBSMODE1
PRBSMODE0
PRBSDIR
TESTEN
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
Reserved
Default
PRBSMODE[1:0]:
These two bits select one mode to extract/replace the data for the PRBS Generator/Detector.
= 00: The unframed mode is selected. All 32 timeslots are extracted/replaced and the per-timeslot configuration in the TEST bit (b6, E1-ID-41~4FH
& 51~5FH) is ignored.
= 01: The 8-bit-based mode is selected. The received data will only be extracted/replaced on the timeslot configured by the TEST bit (b6, E1-ID41~4FH & 51~5FH).
= 10: The 7-bit-based mode is selected. The received data will only be extracted/replaced on the 7 MSB of the timeslot configured by the TEST bit
(b6, E1-ID-41~4FH & 51~5FH).
= 11: Reserved.
PRBSDIR:
= 0: The pattern in the PRBS Generator/Detector is generated in the transmit path and is detected in the receive path.
= 1: The pattern in the PRBS Generator/Detector is generated in the receive path and is detected in the transmit path.
TESTEN:
A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on this bit initiates the PRBS Generator/Detector.
E1 TPLC Access Status (0C8H, 1C8H, 2C8H, 3C8H, 4C8H, 5C8H, 6C8H, 7C8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
1
0
BUSY
Reserved
Default
R
0
BUSY:
= 0: No reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.
= 1: An internal indirect register is being accessed. Any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.
Programming Information
321
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TPLC Access Control (0C9H, 1C9H, 2C9H, 3C9H, 4C9H, 5C9H, 6C9H, 7C9H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
RWN
ADDRESS6
ADDRESS5
ADDRESS4
ADDRESS3
ADDRESS2
ADDRESS1
ADDRESS0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RWN:
= 0: Write the data to the specified indirect register.
= 1: Read the data to the specified indirect register.
ADDRESS[6:0]:
These bits specify the address of the indirect register (from 00H to 3FH & from 41H to 4FH & from 51H to 5FH) for the microprocessor access.
E1 TPLC Access Data (0CAH, 1CAH, 2CAH, 3CAH, 4CAH, 5CAH, 6CAH, 7CAH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D[7:0]:
This register holds the value which will be read from or written into the indirect registers (from 00H to 3FH & from 41H to 4FH & from 51H to 5FH).
If data is to be written into the indirect register, this register must be written before the target indirect register’s address and RWN=0 is written into the
TPLC Access Control register. If data is to be read from the indirect register, the target indirect register’s address and RWN=1 must be written into the
TPLC Access Control register first, then this register will contain the requested data byte.
Programming Information
322
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TPLC Configuration (0CBH, 1CBH, 2CBH, 3CBH, 4CBH, 5CBH, 6CBH, 7CBH)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
Type
R/W
R/W
Default
1
0
5
4
3
Reserved
2
1
0
GSUBST2
GSUBST1
GSUBST0
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
SIGSNAP:
This bit is valid when the Signaling Multi-frame is generated.
= 0: Disable the signaling snapshot.
= 1: Enable the signaling snapshot. That is, the signaling bits of the first Basic frame are locked and input on the TSIGn/MTSIGA(MTSIGB) pin as
the signaling bits of the current whole Signaling Multi-frame.
GSTRKEN:
= 0: The replacement is performed on a per-timeslot basis by setting the STRKEN bit (b4, E1-ID-41~4FH & 51~5FH) in the corresponding timeslot.
= 1: The signaling bits (ABCD) of all timeslots are replaced by the signaling trunk conditioning code in the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, E1-ID-41~4FH &
51~5FH).
GSUBST[2:0]:
These bits select the replacement of all the channels.
GSUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
The replacement is performed on a per-timeslot basis by setting the SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, E1-ID-00~1FH) in the corresponding timeslot.
001
The data of all timeslots is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, E1-ID-20~3FH).
010
The data of all timeslots is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of all timeslots is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
100
The data of all timeslots is replaced by the payload loopback code extracted from the Elastic Store Buffer in the receive path.
others
Reserved.
E1 TPLC Control Enable (0CCH, 1CCH, 2CCH, 3CCH, 4CCH, 5CCH, 6CCH, 7CCH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
0
PCCE
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
PCCE:
= 0: Disable all the functions in the Transmit Payload Control.
= 1: Enable all the functions in the Transmit Payload Control.
Programming Information
323
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RPLC Access Status (0CDH, 1CDH, 2CDH, 3CDH, 4CDH, 5CDH, 6CDH, 7CDH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
BUSY
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
BUSY:
= 0: No reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.
= 1: An internal indirect register is being accessed. Any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.
E1 RPLC Access Control (0CEH, 1CEH, 2CEH, 3CEH, 4CEH, 5CEH, 6CEH, 7CEH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
RWN
ADDRESS6
ADDRESS5
ADDRESS4
ADDRESS3
ADDRESS2
ADDRESS1
ADDRESS0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RWN:
= 0: Write the data to the specified indirect register.
= 1: Read the data to the specified indirect register.
ADDRESS[6:0]:
These bits specify the address of the indirect register (from 00H to 3FH & from 41H to 4FH & from 51H to 5FH) for the microprocessor access.
E1 RPLC Access Data (0CFH, 1CFH, 2CFH, 3CFH, 4CFH, 5CFH, 6CFH, 7CFH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
D[7:0]:
This register holds the value which will be read from or written into the indirect registers (from 00H to 3FH & from 41H to 4FH & from 51H to 5FH).
If data is to be written into the indirect register, this register must be written before the target indirect register’s address and RWN=0 is written into the
RPLC Access Control register. If data is to be read from the indirect register, the target indirect register’s address and RWN=1 must be written into the
RPLC Access Control register first, then this register will contain the requested data byte.
Programming Information
324
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RPLC Configuration (0D0H, 1D0H, 2D0H, 3D0H, 4D0H, 5D0H, 6D0H, 7D0H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
SIGSNAP
GSTRKEN
Type
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
5
4
3
Reserved
2
1
0
GSUBST2
GSUBST1
GSUBST0
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
SIGSNAP:
This bit is valid when Signaling Multi-frame is in synchronization.
= 0: Disable the signaling snapshot.
= 1: Enable the signaling snapshot. That is, the signaling bits of the first Basic frame are locked and output on the RSIGn/MRSIGA(MRSIGB) pin
as the signaling bits of the current whole Signaling Multi-frame.
GSTRKEN:
= 0: The replacement is performed on a per-timeslot basis by setting the STRKEN bit (b4, E1-ID-41~4FH & 51~5FH) in the corresponding timeslot.
= 1: The signaling bits (ABCD) of all timeslots are replaced by the signaling trunk conditioning code in the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, E1-ID-41~4FH &
51~5FH).
GSUBST[2:0]:
These bits select the replacement of all the timeslots.
GSUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
The replacement is performed on a per-timeslot basis by setting the SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, E1-ID-00~1FH) in the corresponding timeslot.
001
The data of all timeslots is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, E1-ID-20~3FH).
010
The data of all timeslots is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of all timeslots is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
others
Reserved.
E1 RPLC Control Enable (0D1H, 1D1H, 2D1H, 3D1H, 4D1H, 5D1H, 6D1H, 7D1H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
2
1
0
PCCE
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
PCCE:
= 0: Disable all the functions in the Receive Payload Control.
= 1: Enable all the functions in the Receive Payload Control.
Programming Information
325
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RCRB Configuration (0D2H, 1D2H, 2D2H, 3D2H, 4D2H, 5D2H, 6D2H, 7D2H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
FREEZE
DEB
SIGE
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
Reserved
FREEZE:
= 0: Disable the manual signaling freezing.
= 1: Manually freeze the signaling data in the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, E1-ID-01~0FH & 11~1FH) as the previous valid value.
DEB:
= 0: Disable the signaling de-bounce.
= 1: Enable the signaling de-bounce. That is, the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, E1-ID-01~0FH & 11~1FH) are updated only if 2 consecutive received ABCD
codeword of the same timeslot are identical.
SIGE:
= 0: Disable the interrupt on the INT pin when any of the COSI bits (E1-0D9H,... & E1-0D8H,... & E1-0D7H,... & E1-0D6H,...) is ‘1’.
= 1: Enable the interrupt on the INT pin when any of the COSI bits (E1-0D9H,... & E1-0D8H,... & E1-0D7H,... & E1-0D6H,...) is ‘1’.
E1 RCRB Access Status (0D3H, 1D3H, 2D3H, 3D3H, 4D3H, 5D3H, 6D3H, 7D3H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit Name
0
BUSY
Type
Reserved
R
Default
0
BUSY:
= 0: No reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.
= 1: An internal indirect register is being accessed. Any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.
E1 RCRB Access Control (0D4H, 1D4H, 2D4H, 3D4H, 4D4H, 5D4H, 6D4H, 7D4H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
RWN
ADDRESS6
ADDRESS5
ADDRESS4
ADDRESS3
ADDRESS2
ADDRESS1
ADDRESS0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RWN:
= 0: Write the data to the specified indirect register.
= 1: Read the data to the specified indirect register.
ADDRESS[6:0]:
These bits specify the address of the indirect register (from 01H to 0FH & from 11H to 1FH) for the microprocessor access.
Programming Information
326
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RCRB Access Data (0D5H, 1D5H, 2D5H, 3D5H, 4D5H, 5D5H, 6D5H, 7D5H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DAT7
DAT6
DAT5
DAT4
DAT3
DAT2
DAT1
DAT0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DAT[7:0]:
This register holds the value which will be read from or written into the indirect registers (from 01H to 0FH & from 11H to 1FH). If data is to be
written into the indirect register, this register must be written before the target indirect register’s address and RWN=0 is written into the RCRB Access
Control register. If data is to be read from the indirect register, the target indirect register’s address and RWN=1 must be written into the RCRB Access
Control register first, then this register will contain the requested data byte.
E1 RCRB State Change Indication 0 (0D6H, 1D6H, 2D6H, 3D6H, 4D6H, 5D6H, 6D6H, 7D6H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
COSI8
COSI7
COSI6
COSI5
COSI4
COSI3
COSI2
COSI1
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
COSI[X]:
= 0: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.
= 1: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is changed.
The corresponding bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it. The COSI[8:1] bits correspond to timeslot 8 ~ 1 respectively.
E1 RCRB State Change Indication 1 (0D7H, 1D7H, 2D7H, 3D7H, 4D7H, 5D7H, 6D7H, 7D7H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
COSI16
COSI15
COSI14
COSI13
COSI12
COSI11
COSI10
COSI9
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
COSI[X]:
= 0: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.
= 1: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is changed.
The corresponding bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it. The COSI[16] bit corresponds to timeslot 17. The COSI[15:9] bits correspond to timeslot
15 ~ 9 respectively.
Programming Information
327
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 RCRB State Change Indication 2 (0D8H, 1D8H, 2D8H, 3D8H, 4D8H, 5D8H, 6D8H, 7D8H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
COSI24
COSI23
COSI22
COSI21
COSI20
COSI19
COSI18
COSI17
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
COSI[X]:
= 0: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.
= 1: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is changed.
The corresponding bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it. The COSI[24:17] bits correspond to timeslot 25 ~ 18 respectively.
E1 RCRB State Change Indication 3 (0D9H, 1D9H, 2D9H, 3D9H, 4D9H, 5D9H, 6D9H, 7D9H)
Bit No.
7
6
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSI30
COSI29
COSI28
COSI27
COSI26
COSI25
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
COSI[X]:
= 0: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.
= 1: The signaling bits in its corresponding timeslot is changed.
The corresponding bit will be cleared if a ‘1’ is written to it. The COSI[30:25] bits correspond to timeslot 31 ~ 26 respectively.
Programming Information
328
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
5.2.2.2 Indirect Register
PMON:
The PMON Counter Mapping Registers (00H ~ 0FH) of a link are updated as a group in the following ways:
• A transition from ‘0’ to ‘1’ on the UPDAT bit (b1, E1-0C2H,...) updates all the registers;
• If the AUTOUPD bit (b0, E1-0C2H,...) is set to ‘1’, the registers will be updated every one second;
E1 CRCE Counter Mapping 0 (00H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
CRCE7
CRCE6
CRCE5
CRCE4
CRCE3
CRCE2
CRCE1
CRCE0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
CRCE9
CRCE8
R
R
0
0
CRCE[7:0]:
These bits together with the CRCE[9:8] bits count the CRC-4 Error numbers. The CRCE[0] bit is the LSB.
E1 CRCE Counter Mapping 1 (01H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
CRCE[9:8]:
These bits together with the CRCE[7:0] bits count the CRC-4 Error numbers. The CRCE[9] bit is the MSB.
E1 FER Counter Mapping 0 (02H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
FER7
FER6
FER5
FER4
FER3
FER2
FER1
FER0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FER[7:0]:
These bits together with the FER[11:8] bits count the FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error numbers. The FER[0] bit is the LSB.
Programming Information
329
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 FER Counter Mapping 1 (03H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
3
2
1
0
FER11
FER10
FER9
FER8
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
COFA2
COFA1
COFA0
R
R
R
0
0
0
FER[11:8]:
These bits together with the FER[7:0] bits count the FAS/NFAS Bit/Pattern Error numbers. The FER[11] bit is the MSB.
E1 COFA Counter Mapping (04H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
COFA[2:0]:
These bits count the times of the new-found Basic frame alignment pattern position being different from the previous one events.
E1 OOF Counter Mapping (05H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
OOF4
OOF3
OOF2
OOF1
OOF0
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
OOF[4:0]:
These bits count the times of out of Basic frame synchronization events.
E1 PRGD Counter Mapping 0 (06H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
PRGD7
PRGD6
PRGD5
PRGD4
PRGD3
PRGD2
PRGD1
PRGD0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PRGD[7:0]:
These bits together with the PRGD[15:8] bits count the PRGD Bit Error numbers. The PRGD[0] bit is the LSB.
Programming Information
330
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 PRGD Counter Mapping 1 (07H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
PRGD15
PRGD14
PRGD13
PRGD12
PRGD11
PRGD10
PRGD9
PRGD8
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PRGD[15:8]:
These bits together with the PRGD[7:0] bits count the PRGD Bit Error numbers. The PRGD[15] bit is the MSB.
E1 LCV Counter Mapping 0 (08H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LCV7
LCV6
LCV5
LCV4
LCV3
LCV2
LCV1
LCV0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LCV[7:0]:
These bits together with the LCV[15:8] bits count the Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or HDB3 Code Violation (CV) Error (in HDB3
decoding) numbers. The LCV[0] bit is the LSB.
E1 LCV Counter Mapping 1 (09H)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
LCV15
LCV14
LCV13
LCV12
LCV11
LCV10
LCV9
LCV8
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LCV[15:8]:
These bits together with the LCV[7:0] bits count the Bipolar Violation (BPV) Error (in AMI decoding) or HDB3 Code Violation (CV) Error (in HDB3
decoding) numbers. The LCV[15] bit is the MSB.
E1 TCRCE Counter Mapping 0 (0AH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
TCRCE7
TCRCE6
TCRCE5
TCRCE4
TCRCE3
TCRCE2
TCRCE1
TCRCE0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TCRCE[7:0]:
These bits together with the TCRCE[9:8] bits count the NT CRC Error numbers. The TCRCE[0] bit is the LSB.
Programming Information
331
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TCRCE Counter Mapping 1 (0BH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
1
0
TCRCE9
TCRCE8
R
R
0
0
TCRCE[9:8]:
These bits together with the TCRCE[7:0] bits count the NT CRC Error numbers. The TCRCE[9] bit is the MSB
E1 FEBE Counter Mapping 0 (0CH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
FEBE7
FEBE6
FEBE5
FEBE4
FEBE3
FEBE2
FEBE1
FEBE0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
FEBE9
FEBE8
R
R
0
0
FEBE[7:0]:
These bits together with the FEBE[9:8] bits count the Far End Block Error numbers. The FEBE[0] bit is the LSB.
E1 FEBE Counter Mapping 1 (0DH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
FEBE[9:8]:
These bits together with the FEBE[7:0] bits count the Far End Block Error numbers. The FEBE[9] bit is the MSB
Programming Information
332
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 TFEBE Counter Mapping 0 (0EH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
TFEBE7
TFEBE6
TFEBE5
TFEBE4
TFEBE3
TFEBE2
TFEBE1
TFEBE0
Type
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
TFEBE9
TFEBE8
R
R
0
0
TFEBE[7:0]:
These bits together with the TFEBE[9:8] bits count the NT FEBE Error numbers. The TFEBE[0] bit is the LSB.
E1 TFEBE Counter Mapping 1 (0FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
TFEBE[9:8]:
These bits together with the TFEBE[7:0] bits count the NT FEBE Error numbers. The TFEBE[9] bit is the MSB
RCRB:
The indirect registers of RCRB addressed from 01H to 0FH & from 11H to 1FH are the Extracted Signaling Data / Extract Enable Registers for TS1
to TS15 & TS17 to TS31. Each address corresponds to one timeslot.
Programming Information
333
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Extracted Signaling Data/Extract Enable Register (01H ~ 0FH & 11H ~ 1FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
Bit Name
Type
Reserved
Default
4
3
2
1
0
EXTRACT
A
B
C
D
R/W
R
R
R
R
1
0
0
0
0
EXTRACT:
This bit is valid when the Signaling Multi-Frame is synchronized.
= 0: Disable the signaling bits extraction.
= 1: The signaling bits are extracted to the A,B,C,D bits (b3~0, E1-ID-01~0FH & 11~1FH).
A, B, C, D:
These bits are valid when the EXTRACT bit is enabled.
These bits are the extracted signaling bits.
RPLC:
The indirect registers of RPLC addressed from 00H to 1FH are the Timeslot Control Registers for TS0 to TS31. Each address corresponds to one
timeslot.
The indirect registers of RPLC addressed from 20H to 3FH are the Data Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for TS0 to TS31. Each address corresponds to one timeslot.
The indirect registers of RPLC addressed from 41H to 4FH and from 51H to 5FH are the Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for TS1 to
TS15 and TS17 to TS31 respectively. Each address corresponds to one timeslot.
Programming Information
334
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Timeslot Control Register (00H ~ 1FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
SUBST2
SUBST1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SUBST[2:0]:
When the GSUBST[2:0] bits (b2~0, E1-0D0H,...) are ‘000’, these bits select the replacement on a per-timeslot basis.
SUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
No operation.
001
The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, E1-ID-20~3FH).
010
The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
others
Reserved.
SINV, OINV, EINV:
These three bits select how to invert the bits in the corresponding timeslot.
SINV
OINV
EINV
Bit Inversion
0
0
0
No inversion.
0
0
1
Invert the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding timeslot (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
0
Invert the odd bits (bit 3, 5, 7) except the MSB of the corresponding timeslot (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
1
Invert the bits from bit 2 to bit 8 of the corresponding timeslot (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
0
0
Invert the MSB (bit 1) of the corresponding timeslot.
1
0
1
Invert the MSB (bit 1) and the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding timeslot.
1
1
0
Invert all the odd bits (bit 1, 3, 5, 7) of the corresponding timeslot (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
1
1
Invert all the bits (bit 1 ~ bit 8) of the corresponding timeslot (bit 1 is the MSB).
G56K, GAP:
These bits are valid in Receive Clock Master mode when the PCCE bit (b0, E1-0D1H,...) is ‘1’.
G56K
GAP
0
0
The corresponding timeslot is not gapped.
1
0
Bit 8 (LSB) of the corresponding timeslot is gapped (no clock signal during the Bit 8).
X
1
The corresponding timeslot is gapped (no clock signal during the timeslot).
Programming Information
Gap Mode
335
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Data Trunk Conditioning Code Register (20H ~ 3FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DTRK[7:0]:
These bits are the data trunk codes that can replace the data of the timeslot selected by the GSUBST[2:0] bits (b2~0, E1-0D0H,...) or the
SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, E1-ID-00~1FH).
E1 Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Register (41H ~ 4FH & 51H ~ 5FH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
6
5
TEST
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
Reserved
4
3
2
1
0
STRKEN
A
B
C
D
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
TEST:
This bit is valid in 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode selected by the PRBSMODE[1:0] bits (b3~2, E1-0C7H,...).
= 0: Disable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be tested by the PRBS Generator/Detector.
= 1: Enable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector for test (when the PRBSDIR bit (b1, E10C7H,...) is ‘0’); or enable the test pattern from the PRBS Generator/Detector to replace the data in the corresponding timeslot for test (when the
PRBSDIR bit (b1, E1-0C7H,...) is ‘1’). In 8-bit-based mode, the data refers to all 8 bits. In 7-bit-based mode, the data refers to the 7 MSB.
All the timeslots that are extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random
are searched for. Similarly, all the timeslots set to be replaced with the PRBS Generator/Detector test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the
PRBS.
STRKEN:
= 0: No operation.
= 1: The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the signaling trunk code set in the A, B, C, D bits (b3~0, E1-ID-41~4FH & 51~5FH).
A, B, C, D:
These bits are the signaling trunk codes that can replace the signaling bits of the timeslot selected by the GSTRKEN bit (b6, E1-0D0H,...) or the
STRKEN bit (b4, E1-ID-41~4FH & 51~5FH).
TPLC:
The indirect registers of TPLC addressed from 00H to 1FH are the Timeslot Control Registers for TS0 to TS31. Each address corresponds to one
timeslot.
The indirect registers of TPLC addressed from 20H to 3FH are the Data Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for TS0 to TS31. Each address corresponds to one timeslot.
The indirect registers of TPLC addressed from 41H to 4FH and from 51H to 5FH are the Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Registers for TS1 to
TS15 and TS17 to TS31 respectively. Each address corresponds to one timeslot.
Programming Information
336
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Timeslot Control Register (00H ~ 1FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
SUBST2
SUBST1
SUBST0
SINV
OINV
EINV
G56K
GAP
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SUBST[2:0]:
When the GSUBST[2:0] bits(b2~0, E1-0CBH,...) are ‘000’, these bits select the replacement on a per-channel basis.
SUBST[2:0]
Replacement Selection
000
No operation.
001
The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the data trunk code set in the DTRK[7:0] bits (b7~0, T1/J1-ID-21~38H).
010
The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the A-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
011
The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the µ-Law digital milliwatt pattern.
100
The data of the corresponding timeslot is replaced by the payload loopback code extracted from the Elastic Store Buffer in the receive path.
others
Reserved.
SINV, OINV, EINV:
These three bits select how to invert the bits in the corresponding channel.
SINV
OINV
EINV
Bit Inversion
0
0
0
No inversion.
0
0
1
Invert the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
0
Invert the odd bits (bit 3, 5, 7) except the MSB of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
0
1
1
Invert the bits from bit 2 to bit 8 of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
0
0
Invert the MSB (bit 1) of the corresponding channel.
1
0
1
Invert the MSB (bit 1) and the even bits (bit 2, 4, 6, 8) of the corresponding channel.
1
1
0
Invert all the odd bits (bit 1, 3, 5, 7) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
1
1
1
Invert all the bits (bit 1 ~ bit 8) of the corresponding channel (bit 1 is the MSB).
G56K, GAP:
These bits are valid in Transmit Clock Master mode when the PCCE bit (b0, E1-0CCH,...) is ‘1’.
G56K
GAP
0
0
The corresponding timeslot is not gapped.
1
0
Bit 8 (LSB) of the corresponding timeslot is gapped (no clock signal during the Bit 8).
X
1
The corresponding timeslot is gapped (no clock signal during the timeslot).
Programming Information
Gap Mode
337
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 Data Trunk Conditioning Code Register (20H ~ 3FH)
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
DTRK7
DTRK6
DTRK5
DTRK4
DTRK3
DTRK2
DTRK1
DTRK0
Type
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Default
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DTRK[7:0]:
These bits are the data trunk codes that can replace the data of the channel selected by the GSUBST[2:0] bits (b2~0, T1/J1-0CBH,...) or the
SUBST[2:0] bits (b7~5, T1/J1-ID-01~18H).
E1 Signaling Trunk Conditioning Code Register (41H ~ 4FH & 51H ~ 5FH)
Bit No.
7
Bit Name
Type
6
5
TEST
Reserved
Default
R/W
0
Reserved
4
3
2
1
0
STRKEN
A
B
C
D
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
TEST:
This bit is valid in 8-bit-based mode or in 7-bit-based mode selected by the PRBSMODE[1:0] bits (b3~2, T1/J1-0C7H,...).
= 0: Disable the data in the corresponding channel to be tested by the PRBS Generator/Detector.
= 1: Enable the data in the corresponding channel to be extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector for test (when the PRBSDIR bit (b1, E10C7H,...) is ‘0’); or enable the test pattern from the PRBS Generator/Detector to replace the data in the corresponding channel for test (when the
PRBSDIR bit (b1, E1-0C7H,...) is ‘1’). In 8-bit-based mode, the data refers to all 8 bits. In 7-bit-based mode, the data refers to the 7 MSB.
All the channels that are extracted to the PRBS Generator/Detector are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random
are searched for. Similarly, all the channels set to be replaced with the PRBS Generator/Detector test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the
PRBS.
STRKEN:
= 0: No operation.
= 1: The data of the corresponding channel is replaced by the signaling trunk code set in the A, B, C, D bits (b3~0, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
A, B, C, D:
These bits are the signaling trunk codes that can replace the signaling bits of the channel selected by the GSTRKEN bit (b6, T1/J1-0CBH,...) or the
STRKEN bit (b4, T1/J1-ID-41~58H).
Programming Information
338
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
6
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG TEST
ACCESS PORT
Test Clock (TCK) input pins. Data is shifted into the registers via the Test
Data Input (TDI) pin, and shifted out of the registers via the Test Data
Output (TDO) pin. Both TDI and TDO are clocked at a rate determined
by TCK.
The IDT82P2288 supports the digital Boundary Scan Specification
as described in the IEEE 1149.1 standards.
The JTAG boundary scan registers include BSR (Boundary Scan
Register), DIR (Device Identification Register), BR (Bypass Register)
and IR (Instruction Register). These will be described in the following
pages. Refer to Figure - 41 for architecture.
The boundary scan architecture consists of data and instruction
registers plus a Test Access Port (TAP) controller. Control of the TAP is
achieved through signals applied to the Test Mode Select (TMS) and
BSR (Boundary Scan Register)
DIR (Device Identification Register)
MUX
TDI
MUX
BR (Bypass Register)
IR (Instruction Register)
TDO
Control<6:0>
TMS
TRST
TAP
(Test Access Port)
Controller
Select
Output Enable
TCK
Figure 41. JTAG Architecture
6.1 JTAG INSTRUCTIONS AND INSTRUCTION REGISTER (IR)
The instructions are shifted in LSB first to this 3-bit register. See
Table 82 for details of the codes and the instructions related.
The IR (Instruction Register) with instruction decode block is used to
select the test to be executed or the data register to be accessed or
both.
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port
339
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 82: IR Code
IR
Code
Instruction
Comment
000
EXTEST
The external test instruction allows testing of the interconnection to other devices. When the current instruction is the EXTEST instruction,
the boundary scan register is placed between TDI and TDO. The signal on the input pins can be sampled by loading the boundary scan
register using the Capture-DR state. The sampled values can then be viewed by shifting the boundary scan register using the Shift-DR
state. The signal on the output pins can be controlled by loading patterns shifted in through input TDI into the boundary scan register
using the Update-DR state.
010
SAMPLE /
PRELOAD
The sample/preload instruction is used to allow scanning of the boundary-scan register without causing interference to the normal operation of the on-chip system logic. Data received at system input pins is supplied without modification to the on-chip system logic; data from
the on-chip system logic is driven without modification through the system output pins. SAMPLE allows a snapshot to be taken of the data
flowing from the system pins to the on-chip system logic or vice versa, without interfering with the normal operation of the assembled
board. PRELOAD allows an initial data pattern to be placed at the latched parallel outputs of boundary-scan register cells prior to selection of another boundary-scan test operation.
001
IDCODE
The identification instruction is used to connect the identification register between TDI and TDO. The device’s identification code can then
be shifted out using the Shift-DR state.
111
BYPASS
The BYPASS instruction shifts data from input TDI to output TDO with one TCK clock period delay. The instruction is used to bypass the
device.
011
CLAMP
This instruction allows the state of the signals driven from device pins to be determined from the boundary-scan register while the bypass
register is selected as the serial path between TDI and TDO. The signals driven from the device pins will not change while the CLAMP
instruction is selected.
010
HIGHZ
Use of the HIGHZ instruction places the device in a state in which all of its system logic outputs are placed in an inactive drive state (e.g.,
high impedance). In this state, and in-circuit test system may drive signals onto the connections normally driven by a device output without incurring the risk of damage to the device.
101
-
(for IC manufactory test)
6.2
JTAG DATA REGISTER
6.2.1
DEVICE IDENTIFICATION REGISTER (IDR)
6.2.3
The bidirectional ports interface to 2 boundary scan cells:
- In cell: The Input cell is observable only (BC_4).
The IDR can be set to define the Vision, the Part Number, the Manufacturer Identity and a fixed bit. The IDR is 32 bits long and is partitioned
as in Table 83. Data from the IDR is shifted out to the TDO LSB first.
Table 83: IDR
6.2.2
BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER (BSR)
- Out cell: The output cell is controllable and observable (BC_1).
The Boundary Scan (BS) sequence is illustrated in Table 84.
Table 84: Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence
Bit No.
Comments
0
Set to ‘1’
1 ~ 11
Manufacturer Identity (033H)
12 ~ 27
Part Number (04D7H)
28 ~ 31
Version Number
BYPASS REGISTER (BYP)
The BYR consists of a single bit. It can provide a serial path between
the TDI input and TDO output, bypassing the BYR to reduce test access
times.
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port
340
BS-Cell Name
BS No.
BS-Cell Type
THZ
173
IN-CELL
CLE_GEN_2.048
172
OUT-CELL
CLE_GEN_1.544
171
OUT-CELL
REFB_OUT
170
OUT-CELL
REFA_OUT
169
OUT-CELL
IC
168
IN-CELL
IC
167
IN-CELL
CLK_SEL[0]
166
IN-CELL
CLK_SEL[1]
165
IN-CELL
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 84: Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence (Continued)
Table 84: Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence (Continued)
BS-Cell Name
BS No.
BS-Cell Type
BS-Cell Name
BS No.
BS-Cell Type
CLK_SEL[2]
164
IN-CELL
TSFS6_OUT
129
OUT-CELL
GPIO[0]_OUT
163
OUT-CELL
TSFS6_IN
128
IN-CELL
GPIO[0]_IN
162
IN-CELL
TSCK6_OUT
127
OUT-CELL
GPIO[0]_OE
161
OUT-CELL
TSCK6_IN
126
IN-CELL
GPIO[1]_OUT
160
OUT-CELL
TSCK_FS6_OE
125
OUT-CELL
GPIO[1]_IN
159
IN-CELL
TSFS5_OUT
124
OUT-CELL
GPIO[1]_OE
158
OUT-CELL
TSFS5_IN
123
IN-CELL
RESET
157
IN-CELL
TSCK5_OUT
122
OUT-CELL
OSCI
156
IN-CELL
TSCK5_IN
121
IN-CELL
TSIG[8]
155
IN-CELL
TSCK_FS5_OE
120
OUT-CELL
TSD[8]
154
IN-CELL
TSFS4_OUT
119
OUT-CELL
TSIG[7]
153
IN-CELL
TSFS4_IN
118
IN-CELL
TSD[7]
152
IN-CELL
TSCK4_OUT
117
OUT-CELL
TSIG[6]
151
IN-CELL
TSCK4_IN
116
IN-CELL
TSD[6]
150
IN-CELL
TSCK_FS4_OE
115
OUT-CELL
TSIG[5]
149
IN-CELL
TSFS3_OUT
114
OUT-CELL
TSD[5]
148
IN-CELL
TSFS3_IN
113
IN-CELL
TSIG[4]
147
IN-CELL
TSCK3_OUT
112
OUT-CELL
TSD[4]
146
IN-CELL
TSCK3_IN
111
IN-CELL
TSIG[3]
145
IN-CELL
TSCK_FS3_OE
110
OUT-CELL
TSD[3]
144
IN-CELL
TSFS2_OUT
109
OUT-CELL
TSIG[2]
143
IN-CELL
TSFS2_IN
108
IN-CELL
TSD[2]
142
IN-CELL
TSCK2_OUT
107
OUT-CELL
TSIG[1]
141
IN-CELL
TSCK2_IN
106
IN-CELL
TSD[1]
140
IN-CELL
TSCK_FS2_OE
105
OUT-CELL
TSFS8_OUT
139
OUT-CELL
TSFS1_OUT
104
OUT-CELL
TSFS8_IN
138
IN-CELL
TSFS1_IN
103
IN-CELL
TSCK8_OUT
137
OUT-CELL
TSCK1_OUT
102
OUT-CELL
TSCK8_IN
136
IN-CELL
TSCK1_IN
101
IN-CELL
TSCK_FS8_OE
135
OUT-CELL
TSCK_FS1_OE
100
OUT-CELL
TSFS7_OUT
134
OUT-CELL
RSIG[8]
99
OUT-CELL
TSFS7_IN
133
IN-CELL
RSD[8]
98
OUT-CELL
TSCK7_OUT
132
OUT-CELL
RSD_RSIG8_EN
97
OUT-CELL
TSCK7_IN
131
IN-CELL
RSIG[7]
96
OUT-CELL
TSCK_FS7_OE
130
OUT-CELL
RSD[7]
95
OUT-CELL
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port
341
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 84: Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence (Continued)
Table 84: Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence (Continued)
BS-Cell Name
BS No.
BS-Cell Type
BS-Cell Name
BS No.
BS-Cell Type
RSD_RSIG7_EN
94
OUT-CELL
RSFS5_IN
59
IN-CELL
RSIG[6]
93
OUT-CELL
RSCK5_OUT
58
OUT-CELL
RSD[6]
92
OUT-CELL
RSCK5_IN
57
IN-CELL
RSD_RSIG6_EN
91
OUT-CELL
RSCK_FS5_EN
56
OUT-CELL
RSIG[5]
90
OUT-CELL
RSFS4_OUT
55
OUT-CELL
RSD[5]
89
OUT-CELL
RSFS4_IN
54
IN-CELL
RSD_RSIG5_EN
88
OUT-CELL
RSCK4_OUT
53
OUT-CELL
RSIG[4]
87
OUT-CELL
RSCK4_IN
52
IN-CELL
RSD[4]
86
OUT-CELL
RSCK_FS4_EN
51
OUT-CELL
RSD_RSIG4_EN
85
OUT-CELL
RSFS3_OUT
50
OUT-CELL
RSIG[3]
84
OUT-CELL
RSFS3_IN
49
IN-CELL
RSD[3]
83
OUT-CELL
RSCK3_OUT
48
OUT-CELL
RSD_RSIG3_EN
82
OUT-CELL
RSCK3_IN
47
IN-CELL
RSIG[2]
81
OUT-CELL
RSCK_FS3_EN
46
OUT-CELL
RSD[2]
80
OUT-CELL
RSFS2_OUT
45
OUT-CELL
RSD_RSIG2_EN
79
OUT-CELL
RSFS2_IN
44
IN-CELL
RSIG[1]
78
OUT-CELL
RSCK2_OUT
43
OUT-CELL
RSD[1]
77
OUT-CELL
RSCK2_IN
42
IN-CELL
RSD_RSIG1_EN
76
OUT-CELL
RSCK_FS2_EN
41
OUT-CELL
RSFS8_OUT
75
OUT-CELL
RSFS1_OUT
40
OUT-CELL
RSFS8_IN
74
IN-CELL
RSFS1_IN
39
IN-CELL
RSCK8_OUT
73
OUT-CELL
RSCK1_OUT
38
OUT-CELL
RSCK8_IN
72
IN-CELL
RSCK1_IN
37
IN-CELL
RSCK_FS8_EN
71
OUT-CELL
RSCK_FS1_EN
36
OUT-CELL
RSFS7_OUT
70
OUT-CELL
INT_OUT
35
OUT-CELL
RSFS7_IN
69
IN-CELL
INT_OE
34
OUT-CELL
RSCK7_OUT
68
OUT-CELL
SPIEN
33
IN-CELL
RSCK7_IN
67
IN-CELL
MPM
32
IN-CELL
RSCK_FS7_EN
66
OUT-CELL
DS/RD/SCLK
31
IN-CELL
RSFS6_OUT
65
OUT-CELL
WR/RW/SDI
30
IN-CELL
RSFS6_IN
64
IN-CELL
CS
29
IN-CELL
RSCK6_OUT
63
OUT-CELL
D0_OUT
28
OUT-CELL
RSCK6_IN
62
IN-CELL
D0_IN
27
IN-CELL
RSCK_FS6_EN
61
OUT-CELL
D1_OUT
26
OUT-CELL
RSFS5_OUT
60
OUT-CELL
D1_IN
25
IN-CELL
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port
342
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 84: Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence (Continued)
Table 84: Boundary Scan (BS) Sequence (Continued)
BS-Cell Name
BS No.
BS-Cell Type
BS-Cell Name
BS No.
BS-Cell Type
D2_OUT
24
OUT-CELL
A[2]
9
IN-CELL
D2_IN
23
IN-CELL
A[3]
8
IN-CELL
D3_OUT
22
OUT-CELL
A[4]
7
IN-CELL
D3_IN
21
IN-CELL
A[5]
6
IN-CELL
D4_OUT
20
OUT-CELL
A[6]
5
IN-CELL
D4_IN
19
IN-CELL
A[7]
4
IN-CELL
D5_OUT
18
OUT-CELL
A[8]
3
IN-CELL
D5_IN
17
IN-CELL
A[9]
2
IN-CELL
D6_OUT
16
OUT-CELL
A[10]
1
IN-CELL
D6_IN
15
IN-CELL
D7_OUT
14
OUT-CELL
D7_IN
13
IN-CELL
D_OEN
12
OUT-CELL
A[0]
11
IN-CELL
A[1]
10
IN-CELL
6.3
TEST ACCESS PORT CONTROLLER
The TAP controller is a 16-state synchronous state machine. Figure 42 shows its state diagram. A description of each state is listed in
Table 85. Note that the figure contains two main branches to access
either the data or instruction registers. The value shown next to each
state transition in this figure states the value present at TMS at each
rising edge of TCK.
Table 85: TAP Controller State Description
State
Description
Test Logic
Reset
In this state, the test logic is disabled to continue normal operation of the device. During initialization, the device initializes the instruction register with
the IDCODE instruction.
Regardless of the original state of the controller, the controller enters the Test-Logic-Reset state when the TMS input is held high for at least 5 rising
edges of TCK. The controller remains in this state while TMS is high.
Run-Test/
Idle
This is a controller state between scan operations. Once in this state, the controller remains in the state as long as TMS is held low. The instruction register and all test data registers retain their previous state. When TMS is high and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Select-DR
state.
SelectDR-Scan
This is a temporary controller state and the instruction does not change in this state. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its
previous state. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK when in this state, the controller moves into the Capture-DR state and a scan
sequence for the selected test data register is initiated. If TMS is held high and a rising edge applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Select-IR-Scan
state.
CaptureDR
In this state, the Boundary Scan Register captures input pin data if the current instruction is EXTEST or SAMPLE/PRELOAD. The instruction does not
change in this state. The other test data registers, which do not have parallel input, are not changed. When the TAP controller is in this state and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Exit1-DR state if TMS is high or the Shift-DR state if TMS is low.
Shift-DR
In this controller state, the test data register connected between TDI and TDO as a result of the current instruction shifts data on stage toward its serial
output on each rising edge of TCK. The instruction does not change in this state. When the TAP controller is in this state and a rising edge is applied to
TCK, the controller enters the Exit1-DR state if TMS is high or remains in the Shift-DR state if TMS is low.
Exit1-DR
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller to enter the Update-DR state, which
terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Pause-DR state. The test data register
selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this state.
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port
343
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Table 85: TAP Controller State Description (Continued)
State
Description
PauseDR
The pause state allows the test controller to temporarily halt the shifting of data through the test data register in the serial path between TDI and TDO.
For example, this state could be used to allow the tester to reload its pin memory from disk during application of a long test sequence. The test data
register selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this state. The controller remains in this
state as long as TMS is low. When TMS goes high and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Exit2-DR state.
Exit2-DR
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller to enter the Update-DR state, which
terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Shift-DR state. The test data register
selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this state.
UpdateDR
The Boundary Scan Register is provided with a latched parallel output to prevent changes while data is shifted in response to the EXTEST and SAMPLE/PRELOAD instructions. When the TAP controller is in this state and the Boundary Scan Register is selected, data is latched into the parallel output
of this register from the shift-register path on the falling edge of TCK. The data held at the latched parallel output changes only in this state. All shift-register stages in the test data register selected by the current instruction retain their previous value and the instruction does not change during this state.
Select-IR- This is a temporary controller state. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its previous state. If TMS is held low and a rising
Scan
edge is applied to TCK when in this state, the controller moves into the Capture-IR state, and a scan sequence for the instruction register is initiated. If
TMS is held high and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Test-Logic-Reset state. The instruction does not change during this
state.
CaptureIR
In this controller state, the shift register contained in the instruction register loads a fixed value of '100' on the rising edge of TCK. This supports faultisolation of the board-level serial test data path. Data registers selected by the current instruction retain their value and the instruction does not change
during this state. When the controller is in this state and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Exit1-IR state if TMS is held high, or
the Shift-IR state if TMS is held low.
Shift-IR
In this state, the shift register contained in the instruction register is connected between TDI and TDO and shifts data one stage towards its serial output
on each rising edge of TCK. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this state. When the controller is in this state and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Exit1-IR state if TMS is held high, or
remains in the Shift-IR state if TMS is held low.
Exit1-IR
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller to enter the Update-IR state, which
terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Pause-IR state. The test data register
selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this state.
Pause-IR
The pause state allows the test controller to temporarily halt the shifting of data through the instruction register. The test data register selected by the
current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this state. The controller remains in this state as long as TMS is
low. When TMS goes high and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Exit2-IR state.
Exit2-IR
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller to enter the Update-IR state, which
terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Shift-IR state. The test data register
selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this state.
Update-IR The instruction shifted into the instruction register is latched into the parallel output from the shift-register path on the falling edge of TCK. When the
new instruction has been latched, it becomes the current instruction. The test data registers selected by the current instruction retain their previous
value.
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port
344
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
1
Test-logic Reset
0
0
1
Run Test/Idle
1
Select-DR
0
1
1
Select-IR
0
1
Capture-DR
Capture-IR
0
0
0
0
Shift-DR
Shift-IR
1
1
1
1
Exit1-DR
Exit1-IR
0
0
0
0
Pause-DR
Pause-IR
1
0
1
0
Exit2-DR
Exit2-IR
1
1
Update-DR
Update-IR
0
1
1
0
Figure 42. JTAG State Diagram
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port
345
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7
PHYSICAL AND ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
7.1
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS
Min
Max
Storage Temperature
-65 °C
+150 °C
Voltage on VDDAR/VDDAT/VDDAX/VDDAB/VDDAP w.r.t. GND
-0.5 V
4.6 V
Voltage on VDDDIO w.r.t. GND
-0.5 V
4.6 V
Voltage on VDDDC w.r.t. GND
-0.5 V
2.2 V
Voltage on Any Input Digital Pin
-0.5 V
6V
Voltage on Any Input Analog Pin
-0.5 V
VDDAR/VDDAT/VDDAX/
VDDAB/VDDAP + 0.5
ESD Performance (HBM)
2000 V
Latch-up Current on Any Pin
1.5 x Inormal *
Maximum Junction Temperature
150
Maximum Allowed Power Dissipation (Package)
2.57W
Note:
* Inormal is the total current in normal operation mode.
Caution: Long-term exposure to absolute maximum ratings may
affect the device’s reliability, and permanent damage may occur if the
rating is exceeded during operation. Functional operation under these
conditions is not implied. The device should be operated under recommended operating conditions.
7.2
RECOMMENDED OPERATING CONDITIONS
Parameter
Description
Min.
Typ.
Max
Unit
Top
Operating Temperature Range
-40
25
85
°C
VDDDIO
Digital IO Power Supply
3.0
3.3
3.6
V
VDDAR/VDDAT/VDDAX/VDDAB/VDDAP
Analog IO Power Supply
3.13
3.3
3.47
V
VDDDC
Digital Core Power
1.68
1.8
1.98
V
VIL
Input Low Voltage
0
0.8
V
VIH
Input High Voltage
2.0
3.3
V
Physical And Electrical Specifications
346
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
7.3
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
D.C. CHARACTERISTICS
@ TA = -40 to +85 °C, VDDDIO = 3.3 V + 0.3 V, VDDDC = 1.8 + 10%
Paramete
r
Description
VOL
Output Low Voltage
VOH
Output High Voltage
VT+
Schmitt Trigger Input Low to High Threshold Point for IOs with Schmitt Trigger
VT-
Schmitt Trigger Input High to Low Threshold Point for IOs with Schmitt Trigger
RPU
Pullup Resistor in Pull-up IOs
50
IIL
Input Low Current
IIH
Min.
Typ.
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
0.40
V
VDDDIO = min, IOL = 4 mA, 8 mA
2.4
V
VDDDIO = min, IOH = 4 mA, 8
mA
1.35
V
1.02
V
70
115
KΩ
-1
0
+1
µA
VIL = GNDD
Input High Current
-1
0
+1
µA
VIH = VDDDIO
IOLD
Output Low Current
8
mA
VO = VOL, D7 - D0
IOHD
Output High Current
8
mA
VO = VOH, D7 - D0
IOL
Output Low Current
4
mA
VO = VOL, except D7 - D0
IOH
Output High Current
4
mA
VO = VOH, except D7 - D0
CIN
Input Digital Pin Capacitance
IZL
Leakage Current of Digital Output in High-Impedance Mode
P
Power Dissipation
800
mW
P33
Power Dissipation in 3.3 V Domain
650
mW
P18
Power Dissipation in 1.8 V Domain
150
mW
Physical And Electrical Specifications
347
-10
10
pF
10
µA
GND < VO < VDDDIO
with the PRBS pattern, excluding
Loading Dissipation
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
7.4
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
DIGITAL I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
Delays are measured according to the cross of 50% of the rising/
falling edge.
The capacitive loading for timing measurement is:
The duty cycle for TSCKn/MTSCK & RSCKn/MRSCK is from 40% to
60%.
100 pF for BUS: D[7:0],
50 pF for other pins.
The system Input / Output timing in is listed as below:
The timing can be applied to both clock edges as defined by active
clock edge selection.
Symbol
Tprop
Parameter
Propagation Delay
Min.
Typ.
Max
Clock Master mode
-10
10
Clock Slave mode
2
20
Unit
ns
Ts
Set Up Time
10
ns
Thold
Hold Time
10
ns
TSCK / RSCK
Tprop
Outputs
Ts
Thold
Inputs
Figure 43. I/O Timing in Mode
7.5
CLOCK FREQUENCY REQUIREMENT
- Relative to nominal rate
Min
Max
Unit
TSCK
-100
+100
ppm
RSCK
-100
+100
ppm
OSCI
-32
+32
ppm
Physical And Electrical Specifications
348
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
7.6
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
T1/J1 LINE RECEIVER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
Min.
Typ.
Receiver Sensitivity
Short haul with cable loss @ 772 kHz:
Long haul with cable loss @ 772 kHz:
Analog LOS level
Short haul:
Long haul:
Receiver Differential Input Impedance
Physical And Electrical Specifications
10
36
dB
with nominal pulse amplitude of 3.0 V for 100 Ω termination
48
12.5
mVp-p
dB
% ‘One’s
A LOS level is programmable for long haul.
G.775, ETSI 300233
JA is enabled
0.02
0.025
0.025
0.05
U.I.
U.I.
U.I.
U.I.
138.0
28.0
0.4
U.I.
U.I.
U.I.
20
KΩ
Input Termination Resistor Tolerance
Receive Return Loss
39 KHz - 77 KHz:
77 KHz - 1.544 MHz:
1.544 MHz - 2.316 MHz
Test Conditions
175
1544
Receive Intrinsic Jitter
10 Hz - 8 KHz
10 Hz - 40 KHz
8 KHz - 40 KHz
Wide Band
Input Jitter Tolerance
0.1 Hz - 1 Hz:
4.9 Hz - 300 Hz:
10 KHz - 100 KHz:
Unit
800
4
Allowable consecutive zeros before LOS
T1.231 - 1993:
I.431:
LOS reset
Max
AT&T62411
±1%
20
20
20
dB
dB
dB
349
G.703
Internal Termination
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
7.7
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
E1 LINE RECEIVER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
Min.
Typ.
Receiver Sensitivity
Short haul with cable loss @ 1024 kHz:
Long haul with cable loss @ 1024 kHz:
Analog LOS level
Short haul:
Long haul:
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
10
43
dB
with nominal pulse amplitude of 3.0 V for 120 Ω and 2.37 V for
75 Ω termination
800
4
Allowable consecutive zeros before LOS
G.775:
I.431 / ETSI300233:
mVp-p
dB
48
32
2048
LOS reset
12.5
Receive Intrinsic Jitter
% ‘One’s
0.05
U.I.
Input Jitter Tolerance
1 Hz - 20 Hz:
20 Hz - 2.4 KHz:
18 KHz - 100 KHz:
37
5
2
U.I.
U.I.
U.I.
Receiver Differential Input Impedance
20
KΩ
Input Termination Resistor Tolerance
G.775, ETSI 300233
JA is enabled; wide band
G.823, with 6 dB cable attenuation
±1%
Receive Return Loss
51 KHz - 102 KHz:
102 KHz - 2.048 MHz:
2.048 MHz - 3.072 MHz
7.8
A LOS level is programmable for long haul.
20
20
20
dB
dB
dB
G.703
Internal Termination
T1/J1 LINE TRANSMITTER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
Output pulse amplitudes
Zero (space) level
Transmit amplitude variation with supply
Min.
Typ.
Max
Unit
2.4
3.0
3.6
V
-0.15
0.15
V
-1
+1
%
200
mV
362
ns
20
ns
Difference between pulse sequences for 17 consecutive pulses (T1.102)
Output pulse width at 50% of nominal amplitude
338
Pulse width variation at the half amplitude (T1.102)
Imbalance between Positive and Negative Pulses amplitude (T1.102)
Physical And Electrical Specifications
0.95
350
350
1.05
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Parameter
Min.
Typ.
Transmit Return Loss
39 KHz - 77 KHz:
77 KHz - 1.544 MHz:
1.544 MHz - 2.316 MHz:
Unit
20
15
12
Intrinsic Transmit Jitter (TSCK is jitter free)
10 Hz - 8 KHz:
8 KHz - 40 KHz:
10 Hz - 40 KHz:
wide band:
dB
dB
dB
0.020
0.025
0.025
0.050
Line short circuit current
7.9
Max
U.I.p-p
U.I.p-p
U.I.p-p
U.I.p-p
110
mA
Ip-p
E1 LINE TRANSMITTER ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
Output pulse amplitudes
E1, 75Ω load:
E1, 120Ω load:
Zero (space) level
E1, 75Ω load:
E1, 120Ω load:
Transmit amplitude variation with supply
Min.
Typ.
Max
Unit
2.14
2.7
2.37
3.0
2.60
3.3
V
V
-0.237
-0.3
0.237
0.3
V
V
-1
+1
%
200
mV
256
ns
Difference between pulse sequences for 17 consecutive pulses (T1.102)
Output pulse width at 50% of nominal amplitude
232
244
Ratio of the amplitudes of Positive and Negative pulses at the center of the pulse interval
(G.703)
0.95
1.05
Ratio of the width of Positive and Negative pulses at the center of the pulse interval (G.703)
0.95
1.05
Transmit Return Loss (G.703)
E1, 75 Ω / 120 Ω
51 KHz - 102 KHz:
102 KHz - 2.048 MHz:
2.048 MHz - 3.072 MHz:
dB
dB
dB
20
15
12
Intrinsic Transmit Jitter (TSCK is jitter free)
20 Hz - 100 KHz
0.050
Line short circuit current
U.I.
110
mA
Ip-p
7.10 JITTER TOLERANCE
7.10.1 T1/J1 MODE
Jitter Tolerance
Min.
1 Hz
138.0
U.I.
4.9 Hz - 300 Hz
28.0
U.I.
10 KHz - 100 KHz
0.4
U.I.
Physical And Electrical Specifications
Typ.
Max
351
Unit
Standard
AT&T 62411
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Figure 44. T1/J1 Jitter Tolerance Performance Requirement
Physical And Electrical Specifications
352
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.10.2 E1 MODE
Jitter Tolerance
Min.
Typ.
Max
Unit
1 Hz
37
U.I.
20 Hz - 2.4 KHz
1.5
U.I.
18 KHz - 100 KHz
0.2
U.I.
Standard
G.823
Cable attenuation is 6 dB
Figure 45. E1 Jitter Tolerance Performance Requirement
Physical And Electrical Specifications
353
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.11 JITTER TRANSFER
Parameter
Min.
Typ.
Max
Unit
Jitter Attenuator Latency Delay
32-bit FIFO:
64-bit FIFO:
128-bit FIFO:
16
32
64
U.I.
U.I.
U.I.
Input jitter tolerance before FIFO overflow or underflow
32-bit FIFO:
64-bit FIFO:
128-bit FIFO:
28
58
120
U.I.
U.I.
U.I.
7.11.1 T1/J1 MODE
T1/J1 Jitter Transfer performance is required by AT&T pub.62411.
Parameter
Min.
@ 1 Hz
0
@ 20 Hz
0
@ 1 kHz
+33.3
@ 1.4 kHz
40
@ 70 kHz
40
Physical And Electrical Specifications
Typ.
Max
Unit
dB
354
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
Figure 46. T1/J1 Jitter Transfer Performance Requirement (AT&T62411 / GR-253-CORE / TR-TSY-000009)
Physical And Electrical Specifications
355
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.11.2 E1 MODE
E1 Jitter Transfer performance is required by G.736.
Parameter
Min.
@ 3 Hz
-0.5
@ 40 Hz
-0.5
@ 400 Hz
+19.5
@ 100 kHz
+19.5
Typ.
Max
Unit
dB
Figure 47. E1 Jitter Transfer Performance Requirement (G.736)
Physical And Electrical Specifications
356
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.12 MICROPROCESSOR TIMING SPECIFICATION
7.12.1 MOTOROLA NON-MULTIPLEXED MODE
7.12.1.1 Read Cycle Specification
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Units
tRC
Read Cycle Time
237
ns
tDW
Valid DS Width
232
ns
tRWV
Delay from DS to Valid Read Signal
tRWH
tAV
tADH
21
RW to DS Hold Time
134
21
134
tPRD
DS to Valid Read Data Propagation Delay
tDAZ
Delay from Read Data Active to High Z
5
Recovery Time from Read Cycle
5
tRecovery
ns
Delay from DS to Valid Address
Address to DS Hold Time
ns
ns
ns
206
ns
20
ns
ns
tRC
tRecovery
tDW
DS+CS
tRWH
tRWV
RW
tADH
tAV
A[X:0]
Valid
Address
tDAZ
tPRD
READ D[7:0]
Valid Data
Figure 48. Motorola Non-Multiplexed Mode Read Cycle
Physical And Electrical Specifications
357
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.12.1.2 Write Cycle Specification
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Units
tWC
Write Cycle Time
237
ns
tDW
Valid DS width
232
ns
tRWV
Delay from DS to valid write signal
tRWH
RW to DS Hold Time
tAV
Delay from DS to Valid Address
tAH
Address to DS Hold Time
tDV
Delay from DS to valid write data
tDHW
tRecovery
21
165
ns
21
165
Recovery Time from Write Cycle
ns
ns
83
Write Data to DS Hold Time
ns
ns
165
ns
5
ns
tRecovery
tWC
tDW
DS+CS
tRWH
tRWV
RW
tAV
A[x:0]
tAH
Valid Address
tDV
tDHW
Valid Data
Write D[7:0]
Figure 49. Motorola Non-Multiplexed Mode Write Cycle
Physical And Electrical Specifications
358
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.12.2 INTEL NON-MULTIPLEXED MODE
7.12.2.1 Read Cycle Specification
Symbol
tRC
tRDW
Parameter
Min
Units
Read Cycle Time
237
ns
Valid RD Width
232
ns
tAV
Delay from RD to Valid Address
tAH
Address to RD Hold Time
tPRD
RD to Valid Read Data Propagation Delay
tDAZ
Delay from Read Data Active to High Z
5
Recovery Time from Read Cycle
5
tRecovery
Max
21
134
ns
ns
206
ns
20
ns
ns
tRC
tRecovery
tRDW
CS+RD
tAV
A[x:0]
tAH
Valid
Address
tDAZ
tPRD
READ D[7:0]
Valid Data
Note: The WR pin should be tied to high.
Figure 50. Intel Non-Multiplexed Mode Read Cycle
Physical And Electrical Specifications
359
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.12.2.2 Write Cycle Specification
Symbol
tWC
tWRW
Parameter
Units
237
ns
Valid WR width
232
ns
Delay from WR to Valid Address
tAH
Address to WR Hold Time
tDV
Delay from WR to valid write data
tRecovery
Max
Write Cycle Time
tAV
tDHW
Min
21
165
ns
83
Write Data to WR Hold Time
ns
ns
165
ns
5
ns
Recovery Time from Write Cycle
tRecovery
tWC
tWRW
WR+CS
tAH
tAV
A[x:0]
Valid Address
tDHW
tDV
Valid Data
Write D[7:0]
Note: The RD pin should be tied to high.
Figure 51. Intel Non-Multiplexed Mode Write Cycle
Physical And Electrical Specifications
360
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
7.12.3 SPI MODE
The maximum SPI data transfer clock is 2 MHz.
Symbol
Description
Min.
Max
Units
fOP
SCLK Frequency
2.0
MHz
tCSH
Min. CS High Time
100
ns
tCSS
CS Setup Time
50
ns
tCSD
CS Hold Time
100
ns
tCLD
Clock Disable Time
50
ns
tCLH
Clock High Time
205
ns
tCLL
Clock Low Time
205
ns
tDIS
Data Setup Time
50
ns
tDIH
Data Hold Time
150
ns
tPD
Output Delay
150
ns
tDF
Output Disable Time
50
ns
tCSH
CS
tCSS
tCLH
tCLL
tCLD
tCSD
SCLK
tDIS
SDI
tDIH
Valid Input
tPD
SDO
High Impedance
tDF
Valid Output
High Impedance
Figure 52. SPI Timing Diagram
Physical And Electrical Specifications
361
March 04, 2009
IDT82P2288
OCTAL T1/E1/J1 LONG HAUL / SHORT HAUL TRANSCEIVER
ORDERING INFORMATION
XXXXXXX
XX
X
Device Type
Package
Process/Temperature Range
BLANK
Industrial (-40 °C to +85 °C)
BB
Plastic Ball Grid Array (PBGA, BB256)
82P2288
Octal T1/E1/J1 Long / Short Haul Transceiver
DOCUMENT HISTORY
2/25/2008
4/6/2007
pgs. 74, 75, 76, 83, 84, 85
pgs. 11, 17, 24, 25, 26, 27, 53, 56, 59, 61, 62, 71, 77, 80, 86, 95, 111, 116, 200, 201, 204, 207, 208, 212, 285, 302, 303, 306, 309, 310,
314
4/27/2004
pg. 357
3/22/2004
pgs. 7, 70, 72, 101, 107, 117, 140, 167, 232, 256, 292
3/04/2009
pg. 362 Removed "IDT" from orderable part number.
CORPORATE HEADQUARTERS
6024 Silver Creek Valley Road
San Jose, CA 95138
for SALES:
1-800-345-7015 or 408-284-8200
fax: 408-284-2775
www.idt.com
IDT and the IDT logo are trademarks of Integrated Device Technology, Inc.
362
for Tech Support:
408-360-1552
email:[email protected]
Similar pages